summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/Documentation/scsi
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorLinus Torvalds <torvalds@ppc970.osdl.org>2005-04-16 15:20:36 -0700
committerLinus Torvalds <torvalds@ppc970.osdl.org>2005-04-16 15:20:36 -0700
commit1da177e4c3f41524e886b7f1b8a0c1fc7321cac2 (patch)
tree0bba044c4ce775e45a88a51686b5d9f90697ea9d /Documentation/scsi
Linux-2.6.12-rc2v2.6.12-rc2
Initial git repository build. I'm not bothering with the full history, even though we have it. We can create a separate "historical" git archive of that later if we want to, and in the meantime it's about 3.2GB when imported into git - space that would just make the early git days unnecessarily complicated, when we don't have a lot of good infrastructure for it. Let it rip!
Diffstat (limited to 'Documentation/scsi')
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/00-INDEX70
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/53c700.txt154
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/BusLogic.txt566
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.1992-19972023
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.ips122
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid349
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.ncr53c8xx495
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.sym53c8xx593
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.sym53c8xx_2144
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/FlashPoint.txt163
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.FlashPoint60
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/Mylex.txt5
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/NinjaSCSI.txt130
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/aha152x.txt183
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/aic79xx.txt516
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx.txt414
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx_old.txt511
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/cpqfc.txt272
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/dc395x.txt102
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/dpti.txt83
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/dtc3x80.txt43
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/g_NCR5380.txt63
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ibmmca.txt1402
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/in2000.txt202
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/megaraid.txt70
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ncr53c7xx.txt40
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ncr53c8xx.txt1854
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/osst.txt219
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/ppa.txt16
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/qla2xxx.revision.notes457
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/qlogicfas.txt79
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/qlogicisp.txt30
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt101
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/scsi.txt44
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/scsi_mid_low_api.txt1546
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/st.txt499
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/sym53c500_cs.txt23
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/sym53c8xx_2.txt1059
-rw-r--r--Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt449
39 files changed, 15151 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/00-INDEX b/Documentation/scsi/00-INDEX
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..f9cb5bdcce41
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/00-INDEX
@@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
+00-INDEX
+ - this file
+53c700.txt
+ - info on driver for 53c700 based adapters
+AM53C974.txt
+ - info on driver for AM53c974 based adapters
+BusLogic.txt
+ - info on driver for adapters with BusLogic chips
+ChangeLog
+ - Changes to scsi files, if not listed elsewhere
+ChangeLog.ips
+ - IBM ServeRAID driver Changelog
+ChangeLog.ncr53c8xx
+ - Changes to ncr53c8xx driver
+ChangeLog.sym53c8xx
+ - Changes to sym53c8xx driver
+ChangeLog.sym53c8xx_2
+ - Changes to second generation of sym53c8xx driver
+FlashPoint.txt
+ - info on driver for BusLogic FlashPoint adapters
+LICENSE.FlashPoint
+ - Licence of the Flashpoint driver
+Mylex.txt
+ - info on driver for Mylex adapters
+NinjaSCSI.txt
+ - info on WorkBiT NinjaSCSI-32/32Bi driver
+aha152x.txt
+ - info on driver for Adaptec AHA152x based adapters
+aic7xxx.txt
+ - info on driver for Adaptec controllers
+aic7xxx_old.txt
+ - info on driver for Adaptec controllers, old generation
+cpqfc.txt
+ - info on driver for Compaq Tachyon TS adapters
+dpti.txt
+ - info on driver for DPT SmartRAID and Adaptec I2O RAID based adapters
+dtc3x80.txt
+ - info on driver for DTC 2x80 based adapters
+g_NCR5380.txt
+ - info on driver for NCR5380 and NCR53c400 based adapters
+ibmmca.txt
+ - info on driver for IBM adapters with MCA bus
+in2000.txt
+ - info on in2000 driver
+ncr53c7xx.txt
+ - info on driver for NCR53c7xx based adapters
+ncr53c8xx.txt
+ - info on driver for NCR53c8xx based adapters
+osst.txt
+ - info on driver for OnStream SC-x0 SCSI tape
+ppa.txt
+ - info on driver for IOmega zip drive
+qlogicfas.txt
+ - info on driver for QLogic FASxxx based adapters
+qlogicisp.txt
+ - info on driver for QLogic ISP 1020 based adapters
+scsi-generic.txt
+ - info on the sg driver for generic (non-disk/CD/tape) SCSI devices.
+scsi.txt
+ - short blurb on using SCSI support as a module.
+scsi_mid_low_api.txt
+ - info on API between SCSI layer and low level drivers
+st.txt
+ - info on scsi tape driver
+sym53c500_cs.txt
+ - info on PCMCIA driver for Symbios Logic 53c500 based adapters
+sym53c8xx_2.txt
+ - info on second generation driver for sym53c8xx based adapters
+tmscsim.txt
+ - info on driver for AM53c974 based adapters
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/53c700.txt b/Documentation/scsi/53c700.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..0da681d497a2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/53c700.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,154 @@
+General Description
+===================
+
+This driver supports the 53c700 and 53c700-66 chips. It also supports
+the 53c710 but only in 53c700 emulation mode. It is full featured and
+does sync (-66 and 710 only), disconnects and tag command queueing.
+
+Since the 53c700 must be interfaced to a bus, you need to wrapper the
+card detector around this driver. For an example, see the
+NCR_D700.[ch] or lasi700.[ch] files.
+
+The comments in the 53c700.[ch] files tell you which parts you need to
+fill in to get the driver working.
+
+
+Compile Time Flags
+==================
+
+The driver may be either io mapped or memory mapped. This is
+selectable by configuration flags:
+
+CONFIG_53C700_MEM_MAPPED
+
+define if the driver is memory mapped.
+
+CONFIG_53C700_IO_MAPPED
+
+define if the driver is to be io mapped.
+
+One or other of the above flags *must* be defined.
+
+Other flags are:
+
+CONFIG_53C700_LE_ON_BE
+
+define if the chipset must be supported in little endian mode on a big
+endian architecture (used for the 700 on parisc).
+
+CONFIG_53C700_USE_CONSISTENT
+
+allocate consistent memory (should only be used if your architecture
+has a mixture of consistent and inconsistent memory). Fully
+consistent or fully inconsistent architectures should not define this.
+
+
+Using the Chip Core Driver
+==========================
+
+In order to plumb the 53c700 chip core driver into a working SCSI
+driver, you need to know three things about the way the chip is wired
+into your system (or expansion card).
+
+1. The clock speed of the SCSI core
+2. The interrupt line used
+3. The memory (or io space) location of the 53c700 registers.
+
+Optionally, you may also need to know other things, like how to read
+the SCSI Id from the card bios or whether the chip is wired for
+differential operation.
+
+Usually you can find items 2. and 3. from general spec. documents or
+even by examining the configuration of a working driver under another
+operating system.
+
+The clock speed is usually buried deep in the technical literature.
+It is required because it is used to set up both the synchronous and
+asynchronous dividers for the chip. As a general rule of thumb,
+manufacturers set the clock speed at the lowest possible setting
+consistent with the best operation of the chip (although some choose
+to drive it off the CPU or bus clock rather than going to the expense
+of an extra clock chip). The best operation clock speeds are:
+
+53c700 - 25MHz
+53c700-66 - 50MHz
+53c710 - 40Mhz
+
+Writing Your Glue Driver
+========================
+
+This will be a standard SCSI driver (I don't know of a good document
+describing this, just copy from some other driver) with at least a
+detect and release entry.
+
+In the detect routine, you need to allocate a struct
+NCR_700_Host_Parameters sized memory area and clear it (so that the
+default values for everything are 0). Then you must fill in the
+parameters that matter to you (see below), plumb the NCR_700_intr
+routine into the interrupt line and call NCR_700_detect with the host
+template and the new parameters as arguments. You should also call
+the relevant request_*_region function and place the register base
+address into the `base' pointer of the host parameters.
+
+In the release routine, you must free the NCR_700_Host_Parameters that
+you allocated, call the corresponding release_*_region and free the
+interrupt.
+
+Handling Interrupts
+-------------------
+
+In general, you should just plumb the card's interrupt line in with
+
+request_irq(irq, NCR_700_intr, <irq flags>, <driver name>, host);
+
+where host is the return from the relevant NCR_700_detect() routine.
+
+You may also write your own interrupt handling routine which calls
+NCR_700_intr() directly. However, you should only really do this if
+you have a card with more than one chip on it and you can read a
+register to tell which set of chips wants the interrupt.
+
+Settable NCR_700_Host_Parameters
+--------------------------------
+
+The following are a list of the user settable parameters:
+
+clock: (MANDATORY)
+
+Set to the clock speed of the chip in MHz.
+
+base: (MANDATORY)
+
+set to the base of the io or mem region for the register set. On 64
+bit architectures this is only 32 bits wide, so the registers must be
+mapped into the low 32 bits of memory.
+
+pci_dev: (OPTIONAL)
+
+set to the PCI board device. Leave NULL for a non-pci board. This is
+used for the pci_alloc_consistent() and pci_map_*() functions.
+
+dmode_extra: (OPTIONAL, 53c710 only)
+
+extra flags for the DMODE register. These are used to control bus
+output pins on the 710. The settings should be a combination of
+DMODE_FC1 and DMODE_FC2. What these pins actually do is entirely up
+to the board designer. Usually it is safe to ignore this setting.
+
+differential: (OPTIONAL)
+
+set to 1 if the chip drives a differential bus.
+
+force_le_on_be: (OPTIONAL, only if CONFIG_53C700_LE_ON_BE is set)
+
+set to 1 if the chip is operating in little endian mode on a big
+endian architecture.
+
+chip710: (OPTIONAL)
+
+set to 1 if the chip is a 53c710.
+
+burst_disable: (OPTIONAL, 53c710 only)
+
+disable 8 byte bursting for DMA transfers.
+
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/BusLogic.txt b/Documentation/scsi/BusLogic.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..98023baa0f0d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/BusLogic.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,566 @@
+ BusLogic MultiMaster and FlashPoint SCSI Driver for Linux
+
+ Version 2.0.15 for Linux 2.0
+ Version 2.1.15 for Linux 2.1
+
+ PRODUCTION RELEASE
+
+ 17 August 1998
+
+ Leonard N. Zubkoff
+ Dandelion Digital
+ lnz@dandelion.com
+
+ Copyright 1995-1998 by Leonard N. Zubkoff <lnz@dandelion.com>
+
+
+ INTRODUCTION
+
+BusLogic, Inc. designed and manufactured a variety of high performance SCSI
+host adapters which share a common programming interface across a diverse
+collection of bus architectures by virtue of their MultiMaster ASIC technology.
+BusLogic was acquired by Mylex Corporation in February 1996, but the products
+supported by this driver originated under the BusLogic name and so that name is
+retained in the source code and documentation.
+
+This driver supports all present BusLogic MultiMaster Host Adapters, and should
+support any future MultiMaster designs with little or no modification. More
+recently, BusLogic introduced the FlashPoint Host Adapters, which are less
+costly and rely on the host CPU, rather than including an onboard processor.
+Despite not having an onboard CPU, the FlashPoint Host Adapters perform very
+well and have very low command latency. BusLogic has recently provided me with
+the FlashPoint Driver Developer's Kit, which comprises documentation and freely
+redistributable source code for the FlashPoint SCCB Manager. The SCCB Manager
+is the library of code that runs on the host CPU and performs functions
+analogous to the firmware on the MultiMaster Host Adapters. Thanks to their
+having provided the SCCB Manager, this driver now supports the FlashPoint Host
+Adapters as well.
+
+My primary goals in writing this completely new BusLogic driver for Linux are
+to achieve the full performance that BusLogic SCSI Host Adapters and modern
+SCSI peripherals are capable of, and to provide a highly robust driver that can
+be depended upon for high performance mission critical applications. All of
+the major performance features can be configured from the Linux kernel command
+line or at module initialization time, allowing individual installations to
+tune driver performance and error recovery to their particular needs.
+
+The latest information on Linux support for BusLogic SCSI Host Adapters, as
+well as the most recent release of this driver and the latest firmware for the
+BT-948/958/958D, will always be available from my Linux Home Page at URL
+"http://www.dandelion.com/Linux/".
+
+Bug reports should be sent via electronic mail to "lnz@dandelion.com". Please
+include with the bug report the complete configuration messages reported by the
+driver and SCSI subsystem at startup, along with any subsequent system messages
+relevant to SCSI operations, and a detailed description of your system's
+hardware configuration.
+
+Mylex has been an excellent company to work with and I highly recommend their
+products to the Linux community. In November 1995, I was offered the
+opportunity to become a beta test site for their latest MultiMaster product,
+the BT-948 PCI Ultra SCSI Host Adapter, and then again for the BT-958 PCI Wide
+Ultra SCSI Host Adapter in January 1996. This was mutually beneficial since
+Mylex received a degree and kind of testing that their own testing group cannot
+readily achieve, and the Linux community has available high performance host
+adapters that have been well tested with Linux even before being brought to
+market. This relationship has also given me the opportunity to interact
+directly with their technical staff, to understand more about the internal
+workings of their products, and in turn to educate them about the needs and
+potential of the Linux community.
+
+More recently, Mylex has reaffirmed the company's interest in supporting the
+Linux community, and I am now working on a Linux driver for the DAC960 PCI RAID
+Controllers. Mylex's interest and support is greatly appreciated.
+
+Unlike some other vendors, if you contact Mylex Technical Support with a
+problem and are running Linux, they will not tell you that your use of their
+products is unsupported. Their latest product marketing literature even states
+"Mylex SCSI host adapters are compatible with all major operating systems
+including: ... Linux ...".
+
+Mylex Corporation is located at 34551 Ardenwood Blvd., Fremont, California
+94555, USA and can be reached at 510/796-6100 or on the World Wide Web at
+http://www.mylex.com. Mylex HBA Technical Support can be reached by electronic
+mail at techsup@mylex.com, by Voice at 510/608-2400, or by FAX at 510/745-7715.
+Contact information for offices in Europe and Japan is available on the Web
+site.
+
+
+ DRIVER FEATURES
+
+o Configuration Reporting and Testing
+
+ During system initialization, the driver reports extensively on the host
+ adapter hardware configuration, including the synchronous transfer parameters
+ requested and negotiated with each target device. AutoSCSI settings for
+ Synchronous Negotiation, Wide Negotiation, and Disconnect/Reconnect are
+ reported for each target device, as well as the status of Tagged Queuing.
+ If the same setting is in effect for all target devices, then a single word
+ or phrase is used; otherwise, a letter is provided for each target device to
+ indicate the individual status. The following examples
+ should clarify this reporting format:
+
+ Synchronous Negotiation: Ultra
+
+ Synchronous negotiation is enabled for all target devices and the host
+ adapter will attempt to negotiate for 20.0 mega-transfers/second.
+
+ Synchronous Negotiation: Fast
+
+ Synchronous negotiation is enabled for all target devices and the host
+ adapter will attempt to negotiate for 10.0 mega-transfers/second.
+
+ Synchronous Negotiation: Slow
+
+ Synchronous negotiation is enabled for all target devices and the host
+ adapter will attempt to negotiate for 5.0 mega-transfers/second.
+
+ Synchronous Negotiation: Disabled
+
+ Synchronous negotiation is disabled and all target devices are limited to
+ asynchronous operation.
+
+ Synchronous Negotiation: UFSNUUU#UUUUUUUU
+
+ Synchronous negotiation to Ultra speed is enabled for target devices 0
+ and 4 through 15, to Fast speed for target device 1, to Slow speed for
+ target device 2, and is not permitted to target device 3. The host
+ adapter's SCSI ID is represented by the "#".
+
+ The status of Wide Negotiation, Disconnect/Reconnect, and Tagged Queuing
+ are reported as "Enabled", Disabled", or a sequence of "Y" and "N" letters.
+
+o Performance Features
+
+ BusLogic SCSI Host Adapters directly implement SCSI-2 Tagged Queuing, and so
+ support has been included in the driver to utilize tagged queuing with any
+ target devices that report having the tagged queuing capability. Tagged
+ queuing allows for multiple outstanding commands to be issued to each target
+ device or logical unit, and can improve I/O performance substantially. In
+ addition, BusLogic's Strict Round Robin Mode is used to optimize host adapter
+ performance, and scatter/gather I/O can support as many segments as can be
+ effectively utilized by the Linux I/O subsystem. Control over the use of
+ tagged queuing for each target device as well as individual selection of the
+ tagged queue depth is available through driver options provided on the kernel
+ command line or at module initialization time. By default, the queue depth
+ is determined automatically based on the host adapter's total queue depth and
+ the number, type, speed, and capabilities of the target devices found. In
+ addition, tagged queuing is automatically disabled whenever the host adapter
+ firmware version is known not to implement it correctly, or whenever a tagged
+ queue depth of 1 is selected. Tagged queuing is also disabled for individual
+ target devices if disconnect/reconnect is disabled for that device.
+
+o Robustness Features
+
+ The driver implements extensive error recovery procedures. When the higher
+ level parts of the SCSI subsystem request that a timed out command be reset,
+ a selection is made between a full host adapter hard reset and SCSI bus reset
+ versus sending a bus device reset message to the individual target device
+ based on the recommendation of the SCSI subsystem. Error recovery strategies
+ are selectable through driver options individually for each target device,
+ and also include sending a bus device reset to the specific target device
+ associated with the command being reset, as well as suppressing error
+ recovery entirely to avoid perturbing an improperly functioning device. If
+ the bus device reset error recovery strategy is selected and sending a bus
+ device reset does not restore correct operation, the next command that is
+ reset will force a full host adapter hard reset and SCSI bus reset. SCSI bus
+ resets caused by other devices and detected by the host adapter are also
+ handled by issuing a soft reset to the host adapter and re-initialization.
+ Finally, if tagged queuing is active and more than one command reset occurs
+ in a 10 minute interval, or if a command reset occurs within the first 10
+ minutes of operation, then tagged queuing will be disabled for that target
+ device. These error recovery options improve overall system robustness by
+ preventing individual errant devices from causing the system as a whole to
+ lock up or crash, and thereby allowing a clean shutdown and restart after the
+ offending component is removed.
+
+o PCI Configuration Support
+
+ On PCI systems running kernels compiled with PCI BIOS support enabled, this
+ driver will interrogate the PCI configuration space and use the I/O port
+ addresses assigned by the system BIOS, rather than the ISA compatible I/O
+ port addresses. The ISA compatible I/O port address is then disabled by the
+ driver. On PCI systems it is also recommended that the AutoSCSI utility be
+ used to disable the ISA compatible I/O port entirely as it is not necessary.
+ The ISA compatible I/O port is disabled by default on the BT-948/958/958D.
+
+o /proc File System Support
+
+ Copies of the host adapter configuration information together with updated
+ data transfer and error recovery statistics are available through the
+ /proc/scsi/BusLogic/<N> interface.
+
+o Shared Interrupts Support
+
+ On systems that support shared interrupts, any number of BusLogic Host
+ Adapters may share the same interrupt request channel.
+
+
+ SUPPORTED HOST ADAPTERS
+
+The following list comprises the supported BusLogic SCSI Host Adapters as of
+the date of this document. It is recommended that anyone purchasing a BusLogic
+Host Adapter not in the following table contact the author beforehand to verify
+that it is or will be supported.
+
+FlashPoint Series PCI Host Adapters:
+
+FlashPoint LT (BT-930) Ultra SCSI-3
+FlashPoint LT (BT-930R) Ultra SCSI-3 with RAIDPlus
+FlashPoint LT (BT-920) Ultra SCSI-3 (BT-930 without BIOS)
+FlashPoint DL (BT-932) Dual Channel Ultra SCSI-3
+FlashPoint DL (BT-932R) Dual Channel Ultra SCSI-3 with RAIDPlus
+FlashPoint LW (BT-950) Wide Ultra SCSI-3
+FlashPoint LW (BT-950R) Wide Ultra SCSI-3 with RAIDPlus
+FlashPoint DW (BT-952) Dual Channel Wide Ultra SCSI-3
+FlashPoint DW (BT-952R) Dual Channel Wide Ultra SCSI-3 with RAIDPlus
+
+MultiMaster "W" Series Host Adapters:
+
+BT-948 PCI Ultra SCSI-3
+BT-958 PCI Wide Ultra SCSI-3
+BT-958D PCI Wide Differential Ultra SCSI-3
+
+MultiMaster "C" Series Host Adapters:
+
+BT-946C PCI Fast SCSI-2
+BT-956C PCI Wide Fast SCSI-2
+BT-956CD PCI Wide Differential Fast SCSI-2
+BT-445C VLB Fast SCSI-2
+BT-747C EISA Fast SCSI-2
+BT-757C EISA Wide Fast SCSI-2
+BT-757CD EISA Wide Differential Fast SCSI-2
+BT-545C ISA Fast SCSI-2
+BT-540CF ISA Fast SCSI-2
+
+MultiMaster "S" Series Host Adapters:
+
+BT-445S VLB Fast SCSI-2
+BT-747S EISA Fast SCSI-2
+BT-747D EISA Differential Fast SCSI-2
+BT-757S EISA Wide Fast SCSI-2
+BT-757D EISA Wide Differential Fast SCSI-2
+BT-545S ISA Fast SCSI-2
+BT-542D ISA Differential Fast SCSI-2
+BT-742A EISA SCSI-2 (742A revision H)
+BT-542B ISA SCSI-2 (542B revision H)
+
+MultiMaster "A" Series Host Adapters:
+
+BT-742A EISA SCSI-2 (742A revisions A - G)
+BT-542B ISA SCSI-2 (542B revisions A - G)
+
+AMI FastDisk Host Adapters that are true BusLogic MultiMaster clones are also
+supported by this driver.
+
+BusLogic SCSI Host Adapters are available packaged both as bare boards and as
+retail kits. The BT- model numbers above refer to the bare board packaging.
+The retail kit model numbers are found by replacing BT- with KT- in the above
+list. The retail kit includes the bare board and manual as well as cabling and
+driver media and documentation that are not provided with bare boards.
+
+
+ FLASHPOINT INSTALLATION NOTES
+
+o RAIDPlus Support
+
+ FlashPoint Host Adapters now include RAIDPlus, Mylex's bootable software
+ RAID. RAIDPlus is not supported on Linux, and there are no plans to support
+ it. The MD driver in Linux 2.0 provides for concatenation (LINEAR) and
+ striping (RAID-0), and support for mirroring (RAID-1), fixed parity (RAID-4),
+ and distributed parity (RAID-5) is available separately. The built-in Linux
+ RAID support is generally more flexible and is expected to perform better
+ than RAIDPlus, so there is little impetus to include RAIDPlus support in the
+ BusLogic driver.
+
+o Enabling UltraSCSI Transfers
+
+ FlashPoint Host Adapters ship with their configuration set to "Factory
+ Default" settings that are conservative and do not allow for UltraSCSI speed
+ to be negotiated. This results in fewer problems when these host adapters
+ are installed in systems with cabling or termination that is not sufficient
+ for UltraSCSI operation, or where existing SCSI devices do not properly
+ respond to synchronous transfer negotiation for UltraSCSI speed. AutoSCSI
+ may be used to load "Optimum Performance" settings which allow UltraSCSI
+ speed to be negotiated with all devices, or UltraSCSI speed can be enabled on
+ an individual basis. It is recommended that SCAM be manually disabled after
+ the "Optimum Performance" settings are loaded.
+
+
+ BT-948/958/958D INSTALLATION NOTES
+
+The BT-948/958/958D PCI Ultra SCSI Host Adapters have some features which may
+require attention in some circumstances when installing Linux.
+
+o PCI I/O Port Assignments
+
+ When configured to factory default settings, the BT-948/958/958D will only
+ recognize the PCI I/O port assignments made by the motherboard's PCI BIOS.
+ The BT-948/958/958D will not respond to any of the ISA compatible I/O ports
+ that previous BusLogic SCSI Host Adapters respond to. This driver supports
+ the PCI I/O port assignments, so this is the preferred configuration.
+ However, if the obsolete BusLogic driver must be used for any reason, such as
+ a Linux distribution that does not yet use this driver in its boot kernel,
+ BusLogic has provided an AutoSCSI configuration option to enable a legacy ISA
+ compatible I/O port.
+
+ To enable this backward compatibility option, invoke the AutoSCSI utility via
+ Ctrl-B at system startup and select "Adapter Configuration", "View/Modify
+ Configuration", and then change the "ISA Compatible Port" setting from
+ "Disable" to "Primary" or "Alternate". Once this driver has been installed,
+ the "ISA Compatible Port" option should be set back to "Disable" to avoid
+ possible future I/O port conflicts. The older BT-946C/956C/956CD also have
+ this configuration option, but the factory default setting is "Primary".
+
+o PCI Slot Scanning Order
+
+ In systems with multiple BusLogic PCI Host Adapters, the order in which the
+ PCI slots are scanned may appear reversed with the BT-948/958/958D as
+ compared to the BT-946C/956C/956CD. For booting from a SCSI disk to work
+ correctly, it is necessary that the host adapter's BIOS and the kernel agree
+ on which disk is the boot device, which requires that they recognize the PCI
+ host adapters in the same order. The motherboard's PCI BIOS provides a
+ standard way of enumerating the PCI host adapters, which is used by the Linux
+ kernel. Some PCI BIOS implementations enumerate the PCI slots in order of
+ increasing bus number and device number, while others do so in the opposite
+ direction.
+
+ Unfortunately, Microsoft decided that Windows 95 would always enumerate the
+ PCI slots in order of increasing bus number and device number regardless of
+ the PCI BIOS enumeration, and requires that their scheme be supported by the
+ host adapter's BIOS to receive Windows 95 certification. Therefore, the
+ factory default settings of the BT-948/958/958D enumerate the host adapters
+ by increasing bus number and device number. To disable this feature, invoke
+ the AutoSCSI utility via Ctrl-B at system startup and select "Adapter
+ Configuration", "View/Modify Configuration", press Ctrl-F10, and then change
+ the "Use Bus And Device # For PCI Scanning Seq." option to OFF.
+
+ This driver will interrogate the setting of the PCI Scanning Sequence option
+ so as to recognize the host adapters in the same order as they are enumerated
+ by the host adapter's BIOS.
+
+o Enabling UltraSCSI Transfers
+
+ The BT-948/958/958D ship with their configuration set to "Factory Default"
+ settings that are conservative and do not allow for UltraSCSI speed to be
+ negotiated. This results in fewer problems when these host adapters are
+ installed in systems with cabling or termination that is not sufficient for
+ UltraSCSI operation, or where existing SCSI devices do not properly respond
+ to synchronous transfer negotiation for UltraSCSI speed. AutoSCSI may be
+ used to load "Optimum Performance" settings which allow UltraSCSI speed to be
+ negotiated with all devices, or UltraSCSI speed can be enabled on an
+ individual basis. It is recommended that SCAM be manually disabled after the
+ "Optimum Performance" settings are loaded.
+
+
+ DRIVER OPTIONS
+
+BusLogic Driver Options may be specified either via the Linux Kernel Command
+Line or via the Loadable Kernel Module Installation Facility. Driver Options
+for multiple host adapters may be specified either by separating the option
+strings by a semicolon, or by specifying multiple "BusLogic=" strings on the
+command line. Individual option specifications for a single host adapter are
+separated by commas. The Probing and Debugging Options apply to all host
+adapters whereas the remaining options apply individually only to the
+selected host adapter.
+
+The BusLogic Driver Probing Options comprise the following:
+
+IO:<integer>
+
+ The "IO:" option specifies an ISA I/O Address to be probed for a non-PCI
+ MultiMaster Host Adapter. If neither "IO:" nor "NoProbeISA" options are
+ specified, then the standard list of BusLogic MultiMaster ISA I/O Addresses
+ will be probed (0x330, 0x334, 0x230, 0x234, 0x130, and 0x134). Multiple
+ "IO:" options may be specified to precisely determine the I/O Addresses to
+ be probed, but the probe order will always follow the standard list.
+
+NoProbe
+
+ The "NoProbe" option disables all probing and therefore no BusLogic Host
+ Adapters will be detected.
+
+NoProbeISA
+
+ The "NoProbeISA" option disables probing of the standard BusLogic ISA I/O
+ Addresses and therefore only PCI MultiMaster and FlashPoint Host Adapters
+ will be detected.
+
+NoProbePCI
+
+ The "NoProbePCI" options disables the interrogation of PCI Configuration
+ Space and therefore only ISA Multimaster Host Adapters will be detected, as
+ well as PCI Multimaster Host Adapters that have their ISA Compatible I/O
+ Port set to "Primary" or "Alternate".
+
+NoSortPCI
+
+ The "NoSortPCI" option forces PCI MultiMaster Host Adapters to be
+ enumerated in the order provided by the PCI BIOS, ignoring any setting of
+ the AutoSCSI "Use Bus And Device # For PCI Scanning Seq." option.
+
+MultiMasterFirst
+
+ The "MultiMasterFirst" option forces MultiMaster Host Adapters to be probed
+ before FlashPoint Host Adapters. By default, if both FlashPoint and PCI
+ MultiMaster Host Adapters are present, this driver will probe for
+ FlashPoint Host Adapters first unless the BIOS primary disk is controlled
+ by the first PCI MultiMaster Host Adapter, in which case MultiMaster Host
+ Adapters will be probed first.
+
+FlashPointFirst
+
+ The "FlashPointFirst" option forces FlashPoint Host Adapters to be probed
+ before MultiMaster Host Adapters.
+
+The BusLogic Driver Tagged Queuing Options allow for explicitly specifying
+the Queue Depth and whether Tagged Queuing is permitted for each Target
+Device (assuming that the Target Device supports Tagged Queuing). The Queue
+Depth is the number of SCSI Commands that are allowed to be concurrently
+presented for execution (either to the Host Adapter or Target Device). Note
+that explicitly enabling Tagged Queuing may lead to problems; the option to
+enable or disable Tagged Queuing is provided primarily to allow disabling
+Tagged Queuing on Target Devices that do not implement it correctly. The
+following options are available:
+
+QueueDepth:<integer>
+
+ The "QueueDepth:" or QD:" option specifies the Queue Depth to use for all
+ Target Devices that support Tagged Queuing, as well as the maximum Queue
+ Depth for devices that do not support Tagged Queuing. If no Queue Depth
+ option is provided, the Queue Depth will be determined automatically based
+ on the Host Adapter's Total Queue Depth and the number, type, speed, and
+ capabilities of the detected Target Devices. For Host Adapters that
+ require ISA Bounce Buffers, the Queue Depth is automatically set by default
+ to BusLogic_TaggedQueueDepthBB or BusLogic_UntaggedQueueDepthBB to avoid
+ excessive preallocation of DMA Bounce Buffer memory. Target Devices that
+ do not support Tagged Queuing always have their Queue Depth set to
+ BusLogic_UntaggedQueueDepth or BusLogic_UntaggedQueueDepthBB, unless a
+ lower Queue Depth option is provided. A Queue Depth of 1 automatically
+ disables Tagged Queuing.
+
+QueueDepth:[<integer>,<integer>...]
+
+ The "QueueDepth:[...]" or "QD:[...]" option specifies the Queue Depth
+ individually for each Target Device. If an <integer> is omitted, the
+ associated Target Device will have its Queue Depth selected automatically.
+
+TaggedQueuing:Default
+
+ The "TaggedQueuing:Default" or "TQ:Default" option permits Tagged Queuing
+ based on the firmware version of the BusLogic Host Adapter and based on
+ whether the Queue Depth allows queuing multiple commands.
+
+TaggedQueuing:Enable
+
+ The "TaggedQueuing:Enable" or "TQ:Enable" option enables Tagged Queuing for
+ all Target Devices on this Host Adapter, overriding any limitation that
+ would otherwise be imposed based on the Host Adapter firmware version.
+
+TaggedQueuing:Disable
+
+ The "TaggedQueuing:Disable" or "TQ:Disable" option disables Tagged Queuing
+ for all Target Devices on this Host Adapter.
+
+TaggedQueuing:<Target-Spec>
+
+ The "TaggedQueuing:<Target-Spec>" or "TQ:<Target-Spec>" option controls
+ Tagged Queuing individually for each Target Device. <Target-Spec> is a
+ sequence of "Y", "N", and "X" characters. "Y" enables Tagged Queuing, "N"
+ disables Tagged Queuing, and "X" accepts the default based on the firmware
+ version. The first character refers to Target Device 0, the second to
+ Target Device 1, and so on; if the sequence of "Y", "N", and "X" characters
+ does not cover all the Target Devices, unspecified characters are assumed
+ to be "X".
+
+The BusLogic Driver Miscellaneous Options comprise the following:
+
+BusSettleTime:<seconds>
+
+ The "BusSettleTime:" or "BST:" option specifies the Bus Settle Time in
+ seconds. The Bus Settle Time is the amount of time to wait between a Host
+ Adapter Hard Reset which initiates a SCSI Bus Reset and issuing any SCSI
+ Commands. If unspecified, it defaults to BusLogic_DefaultBusSettleTime.
+
+InhibitTargetInquiry
+
+ The "InhibitTargetInquiry" option inhibits the execution of an Inquire
+ Target Devices or Inquire Installed Devices command on MultiMaster Host
+ Adapters. This may be necessary with some older Target Devices that do not
+ respond correctly when Logical Units above 0 are addressed.
+
+The BusLogic Driver Debugging Options comprise the following:
+
+TraceProbe
+
+ The "TraceProbe" option enables tracing of Host Adapter Probing.
+
+TraceHardwareReset
+
+ The "TraceHardwareReset" option enables tracing of Host Adapter Hardware
+ Reset.
+
+TraceConfiguration
+
+ The "TraceConfiguration" option enables tracing of Host Adapter
+ Configuration.
+
+TraceErrors
+
+ The "TraceErrors" option enables tracing of SCSI Commands that return an
+ error from the Target Device. The CDB and Sense Data will be printed for
+ each SCSI Command that fails.
+
+Debug
+
+ The "Debug" option enables all debugging options.
+
+The following examples demonstrate setting the Queue Depth for Target Devices
+1 and 2 on the first host adapter to 7 and 15, the Queue Depth for all Target
+Devices on the second host adapter to 31, and the Bus Settle Time on the
+second host adapter to 30 seconds.
+
+Linux Kernel Command Line:
+
+ linux BusLogic=QueueDepth:[,7,15];QueueDepth:31,BusSettleTime:30
+
+LILO Linux Boot Loader (in /etc/lilo.conf):
+
+ append = "BusLogic=QueueDepth:[,7,15];QueueDepth:31,BusSettleTime:30"
+
+INSMOD Loadable Kernel Module Installation Facility:
+
+ insmod BusLogic.o \
+ 'BusLogic="QueueDepth:[,7,15];QueueDepth:31,BusSettleTime:30"'
+
+NOTE: Module Utilities 2.1.71 or later is required for correct parsing
+ of driver options containing commas.
+
+
+ DRIVER INSTALLATION
+
+This distribution was prepared for Linux kernel version 2.0.35, but should be
+compatible with 2.0.4 or any later 2.0 series kernel.
+
+To install the new BusLogic SCSI driver, you may use the following commands,
+replacing "/usr/src" with wherever you keep your Linux kernel source tree:
+
+ cd /usr/src
+ tar -xvzf BusLogic-2.0.15.tar.gz
+ mv README.* LICENSE.* BusLogic.[ch] FlashPoint.c linux/drivers/scsi
+ patch -p0 < BusLogic.patch (only for 2.0.33 and below)
+ cd linux
+ make config
+ make zImage
+
+Then install "arch/i386/boot/zImage" as your standard kernel, run lilo if
+appropriate, and reboot.
+
+
+ BUSLOGIC ANNOUNCEMENTS MAILING LIST
+
+The BusLogic Announcements Mailing List provides a forum for informing Linux
+users of new driver releases and other announcements regarding Linux support
+for BusLogic SCSI Host Adapters. To join the mailing list, send a message to
+"buslogic-announce-request@dandelion.com" with the line "subscribe" in the
+message body.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.1992-1997 b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.1992-1997
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..dc88ee2ab73d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.1992-1997
@@ -0,0 +1,2023 @@
+Sat Jan 18 15:51:45 1997 Richard Henderson <rth@tamu.edu>
+
+ * Don't play with usage_count directly, instead hand around
+ the module header and use the module macros.
+
+Fri May 17 00:00:00 1996 Leonard N. Zubkoff <lnz@dandelion.com>
+
+ * BusLogic Driver Version 2.0.3 Released.
+
+Tue Apr 16 21:00:00 1996 Leonard N. Zubkoff <lnz@dandelion.com>
+
+ * BusLogic Driver Version 1.3.2 Released.
+
+Sun Dec 31 23:26:00 1995 Leonard N. Zubkoff <lnz@dandelion.com>
+
+ * BusLogic Driver Version 1.3.1 Released.
+
+Fri Nov 10 15:29:49 1995 Leonard N. Zubkoff <lnz@dandelion.com>
+
+ * Released new BusLogic driver.
+
+Wed Aug 9 22:37:04 1995 Andries Brouwer <aeb@cwi.nl>
+
+ As a preparation for new device code, separated the various
+ functions the request->dev field had into the device proper,
+ request->rq_dev and a status field request->rq_status.
+
+ The 2nd argument of bios_param is now a kdev_t.
+
+Wed Jul 19 10:43:15 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_proc_info): /proc/scsi/scsi now also lists all
+ attached devices.
+
+ * scsi_proc.c (proc_print_scsidevice): Added. Used by scsi.c and
+ eata_dma_proc.c to produce some device info for /proc/scsi.
+
+ * eata_dma.c (eata_queue)(eata_int_handler)(eata_scsi_done):
+ Changed handling of internal SCSI commands send to the HBA.
+
+
+Wed Jul 19 10:09:17 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * Linux 1.3.11 released.
+
+ * eata_dma.c (eata_queue)(eata_int_handler): Added code to do
+ command latency measurements if requested by root through
+ /proc/scsi interface.
+ Throughout Use HZ constant for time references.
+
+ * eata_pio.c: Use HZ constant for time references.
+
+ * aic7xxx.c, aic7xxx.h, aic7xxx_asm.c: Changed copyright from BSD
+ to GNU style.
+
+ * scsi.h: Added READ_12 command opcode constant
+
+Wed Jul 19 09:25:30 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * Linux 1.3.10 released.
+
+ * scsi_proc.c (dispatch_scsi_info): Removed unused variable.
+
+Wed Jul 19 09:25:30 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * Linux 1.3.9 released.
+
+ * scsi.c Blacklist concept expanded to 'support' more device
+ deficiencies. blacklist[] renamed to device_list[]
+ (scan_scsis): Code cleanup.
+
+ * scsi_debug.c (scsi_debug_proc_info): Added support to control
+ device lockup simulation via /proc/scsi interface.
+
+
+Wed Jul 19 09:22:34 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * Linux 1.3.7 released.
+
+ * scsi_proc.c: Fixed a number of bugs in directory handling
+
+Wed Jul 19 09:18:28 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * Linux 1.3.5 released.
+
+ * Native wide, multichannel and /proc/scsi support now in official
+ kernel distribution.
+
+ * scsi.c/h, hosts.c/h et al reindented to increase readability
+ (especially on 80 column wide terminals).
+
+ * scsi.c, scsi_proc.c, ../../fs/proc/inode.c: Added
+ /proc/scsi/scsi which allows root to scan for hotplugged devices.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_proc_info): Added, to support /proc/scsi/scsi.
+ (scan_scsis): Added some 'spaghetti' code to allow scanning for
+ single devices.
+
+
+Thu Jun 20 15:20:27 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * proc.c: Renamed to scsi_proc.c
+
+Mon Jun 12 20:32:45 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * Linux 1.3.0 released.
+
+Mon May 15 19:33:14 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * scsi.c: Added native multichannel and wide scsi support.
+
+ * proc.c (dispatch_scsi_info) (build_proc_dir_hba_entries):
+ Updated /proc/scsi interface.
+
+Thu May 4 17:58:48 1995 Michael Neuffer <neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ * sd.c (requeue_sd_request): Zero out the scatterlist only if
+ scsi_malloc returned memory for it.
+
+ * eata_dma.c (register_HBA) (eata_queue): Add support for
+ large scatter/gather tables and set use_clustering accordingly
+
+ * hosts.c: Make use_clustering changeable in the Scsi_Host structure.
+
+Wed Apr 12 15:25:52 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.2.5 released.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Update to version 1.15 (From Leonard N. Zubkoff).
+ Fixed interrupt routine to avoid races when handling multiple
+ complete commands per interrupt. Seems to come up with faster
+ cards.
+
+ * eata_dma.c: Update to 2.3.5r. Modularize. Improved error handling
+ throughout and fixed bug interrupt routine which resulted in shifted
+ status bytes. Added blink LED state checks for ISA and EISA HBAs.
+ Memory management bug seems to have disappeared ==> increasing
+ C_P_L_CURRENT_MAX to 16 for now. Decreasing C_P_L_DIV to 3 for
+ performance reasons.
+
+ * scsi.c: If we get a FMK, EOM, or ILI when attempting to scan
+ the bus, assume that it was just noise on the bus, and ignore
+ the device.
+
+ * scsi.h: Update and add a bunch of missing commands which we
+ were never using.
+
+ * sd.c: Use restore_flags in do_sd_request - this may result in
+ latency conditions, but it gets rid of races and crashes.
+ Do not save flags again when searching for a second command to
+ queue.
+
+ * st.c: Use bytes, not STP->buffer->buffer_size when reading
+ from tape.
+
+
+Tue Apr 4 09:42:08 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.2.4 released.
+
+ * st.c: Fix typo - restoring wrong flags.
+
+Wed Mar 29 06:55:12 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.2.3 released.
+
+ * st.c: Perform some waiting operations with interrupts off.
+ Is this correct???
+
+Wed Mar 22 10:34:26 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.2.2 released.
+
+ * aha152x.c: Modularize. Add support for PCMCIA.
+
+ * eata.c: Update to version 2.0. Fixed bug preventing media
+ detection. If scsi_register_host returns NULL, fail gracefully.
+
+ * scsi.c: Detect as NEC (for photo-cd purposes) for the 84
+ and 25 models as "NEC_OLDCDR".
+
+ * scsi.h: Add define for NEC_OLDCDR
+
+ * sr.c: Add handling for NEC_OLDCDR. Treat as unknown.
+
+ * u14-34f.c: Update to version 2.0. Fixed same bug as in
+ eata.c.
+
+
+Mon Mar 6 11:11:20 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.2.0 released. Yeah!!!
+
+ * Minor spelling/punctuation changes throughout. Nothing
+ substantive.
+
+Mon Feb 20 21:33:03 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.95 released.
+
+ * qlogic.c: Update to version 0.41.
+
+ * seagate.c: Change some message to be more descriptive about what
+ we detected.
+
+ * sr.c: spelling/whitespace changes.
+
+Mon Feb 20 21:33:03 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.94 released.
+
+Mon Feb 20 08:57:17 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.93 released.
+
+ * hosts.h: Change io_port to long int from short.
+
+ * 53c7,8xx.c: crash on AEN fixed, SCSI reset is no longer a NOP,
+ NULL pointer panic on odd UDCs fixed, two bugs in diagnostic output
+ fixed, should initialize correctly if left running, now loadable,
+ new memory allocation, extraneous diagnostic output suppressed,
+ splx() replaced with save/restore flags. [ Drew ]
+
+ * hosts.c, hosts.h, scsi_ioctl.c, sd.c, sd_ioctl.c, sg.c, sr.c,
+ sr_ioctl.c: Add special junk at end that Emacs will use for
+ formatting the file.
+
+ * qlogic.c: Update to v0.40a. Improve parity handling.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add Hitachi DK312C to blacklist. Change "};" to "}" in
+ many places. Use scsi_init_malloc to get command block - may
+ need this to be dma compatible for some host adapters.
+ Restore interrupts after unregistering a host.
+
+ * sd.c: Use sti instead of restore flags - causes latency problems.
+
+ * seagate.c: Use controller_type to determine string used when
+ registering irq.
+
+ * sr.c: More photo-cd hacks to make sure we get the xa stuff right.
+ * sr.h, sr.c: Change is_xa to xa_flags field.
+
+ * st.c: Disable retries for write operations.
+
+Wed Feb 15 10:52:56 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.92 released.
+
+ * eata.c: Update to 1.17.
+
+ * eata_dma.c: Update to 2.31a. Add more support for /proc/scsi.
+ Continuing modularization. Less crashes because of the bug in the
+ memory management ==> increase C_P_L_CURRENT_MAX to 10
+ and decrease C_P_L_DIV to 4.
+
+ * hosts.c: If we remove last host registered, reuse host number.
+ When freeing memory from host being deregistered, free extra_bytes
+ too.
+
+ * scsi.c (scan_scsis): memset(SDpnt, 0) and set SCmd.device to SDpnt.
+ Change memory allocation to work around bugs in __get_dma_pages.
+ Do not free host if usage count is not zero (for modules).
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Increase IOCTL_TIMEOUT to 3000.
+
+ * st.c: Allow for ST_EXTRA_DEVS in st data structures.
+
+ * u14-34f.c: Update to 1.17.
+
+Thu Feb 9 10:11:16 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.91 released.
+
+ * eata.c: Update to 1.16. Use wish_block instead of host->block.
+
+ * hosts.c: Initialize wish_block to 0.
+
+ * hosts.h: Add wish_block.
+
+ * scsi.c: Use wish_block as indicator that the host should be added
+ to block list.
+
+ * sg.c: Add SG_EXTRA_DEVS to number of slots.
+
+ * u14-34f.c: Use wish_block.
+
+Tue Feb 7 11:46:04 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.90 released.
+
+ * eata.c: Change naming from eata_* to eata2x_*. Now at vers 1.15.
+ Update interrupt handler to take pt_regs as arg. Allow blocking
+ even if loaded as module. Initialize target_time_out array.
+ Do not put sti(); in timing loop.
+
+ * hosts.c: Do not reuse host numbers.
+ Use scsi_make_blocked_list to generate blocking list.
+
+ * script_asm.pl: Beats me. Don't know perl. Something to do with
+ phase index.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_make_blocked_list): New function - code copied from
+ hosts.c.
+
+ * scsi.c: Update code to disable photo CD for Toshiba cdroms.
+ Use just manufacturer name, not model number.
+
+ * sr.c: Fix setting density for Toshiba drives.
+
+ * u14-34f.c: Clear target_time_out array during reset.
+
+Wed Feb 1 09:20:45 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.89 released.
+
+ * Makefile, u14-34f.c: Modularize.
+
+ * Makefile, eata.c: Modularize. Now version 1.14
+
+ * NCR5380.c: Update interrupt handler with new arglist. Minor
+ cleanups.
+
+ * eata_dma.c: Begin to modularize. Add hooks for /proc/scsi.
+ New version 2.3.0a. Add code in interrupt handler to allow
+ certain CDROM drivers to be detected which return a
+ CHECK_CONDITION during SCSI bus scan. Add opcode check to get
+ all DATA IN and DATA OUT phases right. Utilize HBA_interpret flag.
+ Improvements in HBA identification. Various other minor stuff.
+
+ * hosts.c: Initialize ->dma_channel and ->io_port when registering
+ a new host.
+
+ * qlogic.c: Modularize and add PCMCIA support.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add Hitachi to blacklist.
+
+ * scsi.c: Change default to no lun scan (too many problem devices).
+
+ * scsi.h: Define QUEUE_FULL condition.
+
+ * sd.c: Do not check for non-existent partition until after
+ new media check.
+
+ * sg.c: Undo previous change which was wrong.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Increase IOCTL_TIMEOUT to 2000.
+
+ * st.c: Patches from Kai - improve filemark handling.
+
+Tue Jan 31 17:32:12 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.88 released.
+
+ * Throughout - spelling/grammar fixups.
+
+ * scsi.c: Make sure that all buffers are 16 byte aligned - some
+ drivers (buslogic) need this.
+
+ * scsi.c (scan_scsis): Remove message printed.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_init): Move message here.
+
+Mon Jan 30 06:40:25 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.87 released.
+
+ * sr.c: Photo-cd related changes. (Gerd Knorr??).
+
+ * st.c: Changes from Kai related to EOM detection.
+
+Mon Jan 23 23:53:10 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.86 released.
+
+ * 53c7,8xx.h: Change SG size to 127.
+
+ * eata_dma: Update to version 2.10i. Remove bug in the registration
+ of multiple HBAs and channels. Minor other improvements and stylistic
+ changes.
+
+ * scsi.c: Test for Toshiba XM-3401TA and exclude from detection
+ as toshiba drive - photo cd does not work with this drive.
+
+ * sr.c: Update photocd code.
+
+Mon Jan 23 23:53:10 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.85 released.
+
+ * st.c, st_ioctl.c, sg.c, sd_ioctl.c, scsi_ioctl.c, hosts.c:
+ include linux/mm.h
+
+ * qlogic.c, buslogic.c, aha1542.c: Include linux/module.h.
+
+Sun Jan 22 22:08:46 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.84 released.
+
+ * Makefile: Support for loadable QLOGIC boards.
+
+ * aha152x.c: Update to version 1.8 from Juergen.
+
+ * eata_dma.c: Update from Michael Neuffer.
+ Remove hard limit of 2 commands per lun and make it better
+ configurable. Improvements in HBA identification.
+
+ * in2000.c: Fix biosparam to support large disks.
+
+ * qlogic.c: Minor changes (change sti -> restore_flags).
+
+Wed Jan 18 23:33:09 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.83 released.
+
+ * aha1542.c(aha1542_intr_handle): Use arguments handed down to find
+ which irq.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Likewise.
+
+ * eata_dma.c: Use min of 2 cmd_per_lun for OCS_enabled boards.
+
+ * scsi.c: Make RECOVERED_ERROR a SUGGEST_IS_OK.
+
+ * sd.c: Fail if we are opening a non-existent partition.
+
+ * sr.c: Bump SR_TIMEOUT to 15000.
+ Do not probe for media size at boot time(hard on changers).
+ Flag device as needing sector size instead.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Remove CDROMMULTISESSION_SYS ioctl.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Fix bug in call to ultrastor_interrupt (wrong #args).
+
+Mon Jan 16 07:18:23 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.82 released.
+
+ Throughout.
+ - Change all interrupt handlers to accept new calling convention.
+ In particular, we now receive the irq number as one of the arguments.
+
+ * More minor spelling corrections in some of the new files.
+
+ * aha1542.c, buslogic.c: Clean up interrupt handler a little now
+ that we receive the irq as an arg.
+
+ * aha274x.c: s/snarf_region/request_region/
+
+ * eata.c: Update to version 1.12. Fix some comments and display a
+ message if we cannot reserve the port addresses.
+
+ * u14-34f.c: Update to version 1.13. Fix some comments and display a
+ message if we cannot reserve the port addresses.
+
+ * eata_dma.c: Define get_board_data function (send INQUIRY command).
+ Use to improve detection of variants of different DPT boards. Change
+ version subnumber to "0g".
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 5.26. Improve detection of some boards
+ repackaged by IBM.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_register_host): Change "name" to const char *.
+
+ * sr.c: Fix problem in set mode command for Toshiba drives.
+
+ * sr.c: Fix typo from patch 81.
+
+Fri Jan 13 12:54:46 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.81 released. Codefreeze for 1.2 release announced.
+
+ Big changes here.
+
+ * eata_dma.*: New files from Michael Neuffer.
+ (neuffer@goofy.zdv.uni-mainz.de). Should support
+ all eata/dpt cards.
+
+ * hosts.c, Makefile: Add eata_dma.
+
+ * README.st: Document MTEOM.
+
+ Patches from me (ERY) to finish support for low-level loadable scsi.
+ It now works, and is actually useful.
+
+ * Throughout - add new argument to scsi_init_malloc that takes an
+ additional parameter. This is used as a priority to kmalloc,
+ and you can specify the GFP_DMA flag if you need DMA-able memory.
+
+ * Makefile: For source files that are loadable, always add name
+ to SCSI_SRCS. Fill in modules: target.
+
+ * hosts.c: Change next_host to next_scsi_host, and make global.
+ Print hosts after we have identified all of them. Use info()
+ function if present, otherwise use name field.
+
+ * hosts.h: Change attach function to return int, not void.
+ Define number of device slots to allow for loadable devices.
+ Define tags to tell scsi module code what type of module we
+ are loading.
+
+ * scsi.c: Fix scan_scsis so that it can be run by a user process.
+ Do not use waiting loops - use up and down mechanism as long
+ as current != task[0].
+
+ * scsi.c(scan_scsis): Do not use stack variables for I/O - this
+ could be > 16Mb if we are loading a module at runtime (i.e. use
+ scsi_init_malloc to get some memory we know will be safe).
+
+ * scsi.c: Change dma freelist to be a set of pages. This allows
+ us to dynamically adjust the size of the list by adding more pages
+ to the pagelist. Fix scsi_malloc and scsi_free accordingly.
+
+ * scsi_module.c: Fix include.
+
+ * sd.c: Declare detach function. Increment/decrement module usage
+ count as required. Fix init functions to allow loaded devices.
+ Revalidate all new disks so we get the partition tables. Define
+ detach function.
+
+ * sr.c: Likewise.
+
+ * sg.c: Declare detach function. Allow attachment of devices on
+ loaded drivers.
+
+ * st.c: Declare detach function. Increment/decrement module usage
+ count as required.
+
+Tue Jan 10 10:09:58 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.79 released.
+
+ Patch from some undetermined individual who needs to get a life :-).
+
+ * sr.c: Attacked by spelling bee...
+
+ Patches from Gerd Knorr:
+
+ * sr.c: make printk messages for photoCD a little more informative.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Fix CDROMMULTISESSION_SYS ioctl.
+
+Mon Jan 9 10:01:37 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.78 released.
+
+ * Makefile: Add empty modules: target.
+
+ * Wheee. Now change register_iomem to request_region.
+
+ * in2000.c: Bugfix - apparently this is the fix that we have
+ all been waiting for. It fixes a problem whereby the driver
+ is not stable under heavy load. Race condition and all that.
+ Patch from Peter Lu.
+
+Wed Jan 4 21:17:40 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.77 released.
+
+ * 53c7,8xx.c: Fix from Linus - emulate splx.
+
+ Throughout:
+
+ Change "snarf_region" with "register_iomem".
+
+ * scsi_module.c: New file. Contains support for low-level loadable
+ scsi drivers. [ERY].
+
+ * sd.c: More s/int/long/ changes.
+
+ * seagate.c: Explicitly include linux/config.h
+
+ * sg.c: Increment/decrement module usage count on open/close.
+
+ * sg.c: Be a bit more careful about the user not supplying enough
+ information for a valid command. Pass correct size down to
+ scsi_do_cmd.
+
+ * sr.c: More changes for Photo-CD. This apparently breaks NEC drives.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Support CDROMMULTISESSION ioctl.
+
+
+Sun Jan 1 19:55:21 1995 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.76 released.
+
+ * constants.c: Add type cast in switch statement.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_free): Change datatype of "offset" to long.
+ (scsi_malloc): Change a few more variables to long. Who
+ did this and why was it important? 64 bit machines?
+
+
+ Lots of changes to use save_state/restore_state instead of cli/sti.
+ Files changed include:
+
+ * aha1542.c:
+ * aha1740.c:
+ * buslogic.c:
+ * in2000.c:
+ * scsi.c:
+ * scsi_debug.c:
+ * sd.c:
+ * sr.c:
+ * st.c:
+
+Wed Dec 28 16:38:29 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.75 released.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Spelling fix.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add HP C1790A and C2500A scanjet to blacklist.
+
+ * scsi.c: Spelling fixup.
+
+ * sd.c: Add support for sd_hardsizes (hard sector sizes).
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Use save_flags/restore_flags instead of cli/sti.
+
+Fri Dec 23 13:36:25 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.74 released.
+
+ * README.st: Update from Kai Makisara.
+
+ * eata.c: New version from Dario - version 1.11.
+ use scsicam bios_param routine. Add support for 2011
+ and 2021 boards.
+
+ * hosts.c: Add support for blocking. Linked list automatically
+ generated when shpnt->block is set.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add sankyo & HP scanjet to blacklist. Add support for
+ kicking things loose when we deadlock.
+
+ * scsi.c: Recognize scanners and processors in scan_scsis.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.h: Increase timeout to 9 seconds.
+
+ * st.c: New version from Kai - add better support for backspace.
+
+ * u14-34f.c: New version from Dario. Supports blocking.
+
+Wed Dec 14 14:46:30 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.73 released.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Update from Dave Gentzel. Version 1.14.
+ Add module related stuff. More fault tolerant if out of
+ DMA memory.
+
+ * fdomain.c: New version from Rik Faith - version 5.22. Add support
+ for ISA-200S SCSI adapter.
+
+ * hosts.c: Spelling.
+
+ * qlogic.c: Update to version 0.38a. Add more support for PCMCIA.
+
+ * scsi.c: Mask device type with 0x1f during scan_scsis.
+ Add support for deadlocking, err, make that getting out of
+ deadlock situations that are created when we allow the user
+ to limit requests to one host adapter at a time.
+
+ * scsi.c: Bugfix - pass pid, not SCpnt as second arg to
+ scsi_times_out.
+
+ * scsi.c: Restore interrupt state to previous value instead of using
+ cli/sti pairs.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add a bunch of module stuff (all commented out for now).
+
+ * scsi.c: Clean up scsi_dump_status.
+
+Tue Dec 6 12:34:20 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.72 released.
+
+ * sg.c: Bugfix - always use sg_free, since we might have big buff.
+
+Fri Dec 2 11:24:53 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.71 released.
+
+ * sg.c: Clear buff field when not in use. Only call scsi_free if
+ non-null.
+
+ * scsi.h: Call wake_up(&wait_for_request) when done with a
+ command.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_times_out): Pass pid down so that we can protect
+ against race conditions.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_abort): Zero timeout field if we get the
+ NOT_RUNNING message back from low-level driver.
+
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_done): Restore cmd_len, use_sg here.
+
+ * scsi.c (request_sense): Not here.
+
+ * hosts.h: Add new forbidden_addr, forbidden_size fields. Who
+ added these and why????
+
+ * hosts.c (scsi_mem_init): Mark pages as reserved if they fall in
+ the forbidden regions. I am not sure - I think this is so that
+ we can deal with boards that do incomplete decoding of their
+ address lines for the bios chips, but I am not entirely sure.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Set forbidden_addr stuff if using a buggy board.
+
+ * aha1740.c: Test for NULL pointer in SCtmp. This should not
+ occur, but a nice message is better than a kernel segfault.
+
+ * 53c7,8xx.c: Add new PCI chip ID for 815.
+
+Fri Dec 2 11:24:53 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.70 released.
+
+ * ChangeLog, st.c: Spelling.
+
+Tue Nov 29 18:48:42 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.69 released.
+
+ * u14-34f.h: Non-functional change. [Dario].
+
+ * u14-34f.c: Use block field in Scsi_Host to prevent commands from
+ being queued to more than one host at the same time (used when
+ motherboard does not deal with multiple bus-masters very well).
+ Only when SINGLE_HOST_OPERATIONS is defined.
+ Use new cmd_per_lun field. [Dario]
+
+ * eata.c: Likewise.
+
+ * st.c: More changes from Kai. Add ready flag to indicate drive
+ status.
+
+ * README.st: Document this.
+
+ * sr.c: Bugfix (do not subtract CD_BLOCK_OFFSET) for photo-cd
+ code.
+
+ * sg.c: Bugfix - fix problem where opcode is not correctly set up.
+
+ * seagate.[c,h]: Use #defines to set driver name.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: Zero buffer before executing command.
+
+ * scsi.c: Use new cmd_per_lun field in Scsi_Hosts as appropriate.
+ Add Sony CDU55S to blacklist.
+
+ * hosts.h: Add new cmd_per_lun field to Scsi_Hosts.
+
+ * hosts.c: Initialize cmd_per_lun in Scsi_Hosts from template.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Use cmd_per_lun field - initialize to different
+ values depending upon bus type (i.e. use 1 if ISA, so we do not
+ hog memory). Use other patches which got lost from 1.1.68.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Spelling.
+
+Tue Nov 29 15:43:50 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.aib.com)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.68 released.
+
+ Add support for 12 byte vendor specific commands in scsi-generics,
+ more (i.e. the last mandatory) low-level changes to support
+ loadable modules, plus a few other changes people have requested
+ lately. Changes by me (ERY) unless otherwise noted. Spelling
+ changes appear from some unknown corner of the universe.
+
+ * Throughout: Change COMMAND_SIZE() to use SCpnt->cmd_len.
+
+ * Throughout: Change info() low level function to take a Scsi_Host
+ pointer. This way the info function can return specific
+ information about the host in question, if desired.
+
+ * All low-level drivers: Add NULL in initializer for the
+ usage_count field added to Scsi_Host_Template.
+
+ * aha152x.[c,h]: Remove redundant info() function.
+
+ * aha1542.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * aha1740.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * aha274x.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * eata.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * pas16.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * scsi_debug.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * t128.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * u14-34f.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * ultrastor.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * wd7000.[c,h]: Likewise.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Add support for command line options with lilo to set
+ DMA parameters, I/O port. From Matt Aarnio.
+
+ * buslogic.[c,h]: New version (1.13) from Dave Gentzel.
+
+ * hosts.h: Add new field to Scsi_Hosts "block" to allow blocking
+ all I/O to certain other cards. Helps prevent problems with some
+ ISA motherboards.
+
+ * hosts.h: Add usage_count to Scsi_Host_Template.
+
+ * hosts.h: Add n_io_port to Scsi_Host (used when releasing module).
+
+ * hosts.c: Initialize block field.
+
+ * in2000.c: Remove "static" declarations from exported functions.
+
+ * in2000.h: Likewise.
+
+ * scsi.c: Correctly set cmd_len field as required. Save and
+ change setting when doing a request_sense, restore when done.
+ Move abort timeout message. Fix panic in request_queueable to
+ print correct function name.
+
+ * scsi.c: When incrementing usage count, walk block linked list
+ for host, and or in SCSI_HOST_BLOCK bit. When decrementing usage
+ count to 0, clear this bit to allow usage to continue, wake up
+ processes waiting.
+
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: If we have an info() function, call it, otherwise
+ if we have a "name" field, use it, else do nothing.
+
+ * sd.c, sr.c: Clear cmd_len field prior to each command we
+ generate.
+
+ * sd.h: Add "has_part_table" bit to rscsi_disks.
+
+ * sg.[c,h]: Add support for vendor specific 12 byte commands (i.e.
+ override command length in COMMAND_SIZE).
+
+ * sr.c: Bugfix from Gerd in photocd code.
+
+ * sr.c: Bugfix in get_sectorsize - always use scsi_malloc buffer -
+ we cannot guarantee that the stack is < 16Mb.
+
+Tue Nov 22 15:40:46 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.aib.com)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.67 released.
+
+ * sr.c: Change spelling of manufactor to manufacturer.
+
+ * scsi.h: Likewise.
+
+ * scsi.c: Likewise.
+
+ * qlogic.c: Spelling corrections.
+
+ * in2000.h: Spelling corrections.
+
+ * in2000.c: Update from Bill Earnest, change from
+ jshiffle@netcom.com. Support new bios versions.
+
+ * README.qlogic: Spelling correction.
+
+Tue Nov 22 15:40:46 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.aib.com)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.66 released.
+
+ * u14-34f.c: Spelling corrections.
+
+ * sr.[h,c]: Add support for multi-session CDs from Gerd Knorr.
+
+ * scsi.h: Add manufactor field for keeping track of device
+ manufacturer.
+
+ * scsi.c: More spelling corrections.
+
+ * qlogic.h, qlogic.c, README.qlogic: New driver from Tom Zerucha.
+
+ * in2000.c, in2000.h: New driver from Brad McLean/Bill Earnest.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Spelling correction.
+
+ * eata.c: Spelling correction.
+
+Fri Nov 18 15:22:44 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.aib.com)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.65 released.
+
+ * eata.h: Update version string to 1.08.00.
+
+ * eata.c: Set sg_tablesize correctly for DPT PM2012 boards.
+
+ * aha274x.seq: Spell checking.
+
+ * README.st: Likewise.
+
+ * README.aha274x: Likewise.
+
+ * ChangeLog: Likewise.
+
+Tue Nov 15 15:35:08 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.aib.com)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.64 released.
+
+ * u14-34f.h: Update version number to 1.10.01.
+
+ * u14-34f.c: Use Scsi_Host can_queue variable instead of one from template.
+
+ * eata.[c,h]: New driver for DPT boards from Dario Ballabio.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Use can_queue field.
+
+Wed Nov 30 12:09:09 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.aib.com)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.63 released.
+
+ * sd.c: Give I/O error if we attempt 512 byte I/O to a disk with
+ 1024 byte sectors.
+
+ * scsicam.c: Make sure we do read from whole disk (mask off
+ partition).
+
+ * scsi.c: Use can_queue in Scsi_Host structure.
+ Fix panic message about invalid host.
+
+ * hosts.c: Initialize can_queue from template.
+
+ * hosts.h: Add can_queue to Scsi_Host structure.
+
+ * aha1740.c: Print out warning about NULL ecbptr.
+
+Fri Nov 4 12:40:30 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.aib.com)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.62 released.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 5.20. (From Rik Faith). Support
+ BIOS version 3.5.
+
+ * st.h: Add ST_EOD symbol.
+
+ * st.c: Patches from Kai Makisara - support additional densities,
+ add support for MTFSS, MTBSS, MTWSM commands.
+
+ * README.st: Update to document new commands.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add Mediavision CDR-H93MV to blacklist.
+
+Sat Oct 29 20:57:36 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.aib.com)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.60 released.
+
+ * u14-34f.[c,h]: New driver from Dario Ballabio.
+
+ * aic7770.c, aha274x_seq.h, aha274x.seq, aha274x.h, aha274x.c,
+ README.aha274x: New files, new driver from John Aycock.
+
+
+Tue Oct 11 08:47:39 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.54 released.
+
+ * Add third PCI chip id. [Drew]
+
+ * buslogic.c: Set BUSLOGIC_CMDLUN back to 1 [Eric].
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Fix asm directives for new GCC.
+
+ * sr.c, sd.c: Use new end_scsi_request function.
+
+ * scsi.h(end_scsi_request): Return pointer to block if still
+ active, else return NULL if inactive. Fixes race condition.
+
+Sun Oct 9 20:23:14 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.53 released.
+
+ * scsi.c: Do not allocate dma bounce buffers if we have exactly
+ 16Mb.
+
+Fri Sep 9 05:35:30 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.51 released.
+
+ * aha152x.c: Add support for disabling the parity check. Update
+ to version 1.4. [Juergen].
+
+ * seagate.c: Tweak debugging message.
+
+Wed Aug 31 10:15:55 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.50 released.
+
+ * aha152x.c: Add eb800 for Vtech Platinum SMP boards. [Juergen].
+
+ * scsi.c: Add Quantum PD1225S to blacklist.
+
+Fri Aug 26 09:38:45 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.49 released.
+
+ * sd.c: Fix bug when we were deleting the wrong entry if we
+ get an unsupported sector size device.
+
+ * sr.c: Another spelling patch.
+
+Thu Aug 25 09:15:27 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.48 released.
+
+ * Throughout: Use new semantics for request_dma, as appropriate.
+
+ * sr.c: Print correct device number.
+
+Sun Aug 21 17:49:23 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.47 released.
+
+ * NCR5380.c: Add support for LIMIT_TRANSFERSIZE.
+
+ * constants.h: Add prototype for print_Scsi_Cmnd.
+
+ * pas16.c: Some more minor tweaks. Test for Mediavision board.
+ Allow for disks > 1Gb. [Drew??]
+
+ * sr.c: Set SCpnt->transfersize.
+
+Tue Aug 16 17:29:35 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.46 released.
+
+ * Throughout: More spelling fixups.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Add a few more fixups from Dave. Disk translation
+ mainly.
+
+ * pas16.c: Add a few patches (Drew?).
+
+
+Thu Aug 11 20:45:15 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.44 released.
+
+ * hosts.c: Add type casts for scsi_init_malloc.
+
+ * scsicam.c: Add type cast.
+
+Wed Aug 10 19:23:01 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.43 released.
+
+ * Throughout: Spelling cleanups. [??]
+
+ * aha152x.c, NCR53*.c, fdomain.c, g_NCR5380.c, pas16.c, seagate.c,
+ t128.c: Use request_irq, not irqaction. [??]
+
+ * aha1542.c: Move test for shost before we start to use shost.
+
+ * aha1542.c, aha1740.c, ultrastor.c, wd7000.c: Use new
+ calling sequence for request_irq.
+
+ * buslogic.c: Update from Dave Gentzel.
+
+Tue Aug 9 09:32:59 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.42 released.
+
+ * NCR5380.c: Change NCR5380_print_status to static.
+
+ * seagate.c: A few more bugfixes. Only Drew knows what they are
+ for.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Tweak some __asm__ directives so that it works
+ with newer compilers. [??]
+
+Sat Aug 6 21:29:36 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.40 released.
+
+ * NCR5380.c: Return SCSI_RESET_WAKEUP from reset function.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Reset mailbox status after a bus device reset.
+
+ * constants.c: Fix typo (;;).
+
+ * g_NCR5380.c:
+ * pas16.c: Correct usage of NCR5380_init.
+
+ * scsi.c: Remove redundant (and unused variables).
+
+ * sd.c: Use memset to clear all of rscsi_disks before we use it.
+
+ * sg.c: Ditto, except for scsi_generics.
+
+ * sr.c: Ditto, except for scsi_CDs.
+
+ * st.c: Initialize STp->device.
+
+ * seagate.c: Fix bug. [Drew]
+
+Thu Aug 4 08:47:27 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@andante)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.39 released.
+
+ * Makefile: Fix typo in NCR53C7xx.
+
+ * st.c: Print correct number for device.
+
+Tue Aug 2 11:29:14 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.38 released.
+
+ Lots of changes in 1.1.38. All from Drew unless otherwise noted.
+
+ * 53c7,8xx.c: New file from Drew. PCI driver.
+
+ * 53c7,8xx.h: Likewise.
+
+ * 53c7,8xx.scr: Likewise.
+
+ * 53c8xx_d.h, 53c8xx_u.h, script_asm.pl: Likewise.
+
+ * scsicam.c: New file from Drew. Read block 0 on the disk and
+ read the partition table. Attempt to deduce the geometry from
+ the partition table if possible. Only used by 53c[7,8]xx right
+ now, but could be used by any device for which we have no way
+ of identifying the geometry.
+
+ * sd.c: Use device letters instead of sd%d in a lot of messages.
+
+ * seagate.c: Fix bug that resulted in lockups with some devices.
+
+ * sr.c (sr_open): Return -EROFS, not -EACCES if we attempt to open
+ device for write.
+
+ * hosts.c, Makefile: Update for new driver.
+
+ * NCR5380.c, NCR5380.h, g_NCR5380.h: Update from Drew to support
+ 53C400 chip.
+
+ * constants.c: Define CONST_CMND and CONST_MSG. Other minor
+ cleanups along the way. Improve handling of CONST_MSG.
+
+ * fdomain.c, fdomain.h: New version from Rik Faith. Update to
+ 5.18. Should now support TMC-3260 PCI card with 18C30 chip.
+
+ * pas16.c: Update with new irq initialization.
+
+ * t128.c: Update with minor cleanups.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_pid): New variable - gives each command a unique
+ id. Add Quantum LPS5235S to blacklist. Change in_scan to
+ in_scan_scsis and make global.
+
+ * scsi.h: Add some defines for extended message handling,
+ INITIATE/RELEASE_RECOVERY. Add a few new fields to support sync
+ transfers.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.h: Add ioctl to request synchronous transfers.
+
+
+Tue Jul 26 21:36:58 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.37 released.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Always call aha1542_mbenable, use new udelay
+ mechanism so we do not wait a long time if the board does not
+ implement this command.
+
+ * g_NCR5380.c: Remove #include <linux/config.h> and #if
+ defined(CONFIG_SCSI_*).
+
+ * seagate.c: Likewise.
+
+ Next round of changes to support loadable modules. Getting closer
+ now, still not possible to do anything remotely usable.
+
+ hosts.c: Create a linked list of detected high level devices.
+ (scsi_register_device): New function to insert into this list.
+ (scsi_init): Call scsi_register_device for each of the known high
+ level drivers.
+
+ hosts.h: Add prototype for linked list header. Add structure
+ definition for device template structure which defines the linked
+ list.
+
+ scsi.c: (scan_scsis): Use linked list instead of knowledge about
+ existing high level device drivers.
+ (scsi_dev_init): Use init functions for drivers on linked list
+ instead of explicit list to initialize and attach devices to high
+ level drivers.
+
+ scsi.h: Add new field "attached" to scsi_device - count of number
+ of high level devices attached.
+
+ sd.c, sr.c, sg.c, st.c: Adjust init/attach functions to use new
+ scheme.
+
+Sat Jul 23 13:03:17 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.35 released.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Change constraint on asm() operand so that it works
+ with gcc 2.6.0.
+
+Thu Jul 21 10:37:39 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.33 released.
+
+ * sr.c(sr_open): Do not allow opens with write access.
+
+Mon Jul 18 09:51:22 1994 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.31 released.
+
+ * sd.c: Increase SD_TIMEOUT from 300 to 600.
+
+ * sr.c: Remove stray task_struct* variable that was no longer
+ used.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Fix typo in up() call.
+
+Sun Jul 17 16:25:29 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.30 released.
+
+ * scsi.c (scan_scsis): Fix detection of some Toshiba CDROM drives
+ that report themselves as disk drives.
+
+ * (Throughout): Use request.sem instead of request.waiting.
+ Should fix swap problem with fdomain.
+
+Thu Jul 14 10:51:42 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.29 released.
+
+ * scsi.c (scan_scsis): Add new devices to end of linked list, not
+ to the beginning.
+
+ * scsi.h (SCSI_SLEEP): Remove brain dead hack to try to save
+ the task state before sleeping.
+
+Sat Jul 9 15:01:03 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ More changes to eventually support loadable modules. Mainly
+ we want to use linked lists instead of arrays because it is easier
+ to dynamically add and remove things this way.
+
+ Quite a bit more work is needed before loadable modules are
+ possible (and usable) with scsi, but this is most of the grunge
+ work.
+
+ * Linux 1.1.28 released.
+
+ * scsi.c, scsi.h (allocate_device, request_queueable): Change
+ argument from index into scsi_devices to a pointer to the
+ Scsi_Device struct.
+
+ * Throughout: Change all calls to allocate_device,
+ request_queueable to use new calling sequence.
+
+ * Throughout: Use SCpnt->device instead of
+ scsi_devices[SCpnt->index]. Ugh - the pointer was there all along
+ - much cleaner this way.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_init_malloc, scsi_free_malloc): New functions -
+ allow us to pretend that we have a working malloc when we
+ initialize. Use this instead of passing memory_start, memory_end
+ around all over the place.
+
+ * scsi.h, st.c, sr.c, sd.c, sg.c: Change *_init1 functions to use
+ scsi_init_malloc, remove all arguments, no return value.
+
+ * scsi.h: Remove index field from Scsi_Device and Scsi_Cmnd
+ structs.
+
+ * scsi.c (scsi_dev_init): Set up for scsi_init_malloc.
+ (scan_scsis): Get SDpnt from scsi_init_malloc, and refresh
+ when we discover a device. Free pointer before returning.
+ Change scsi_devices into a linked list.
+
+ * scsi.c (scan_scsis): Change to only scan one host.
+ (scsi_dev_init): Loop over all detected hosts, and scan them.
+
+ * hosts.c (scsi_init_free): Change so that number of extra bytes
+ is stored in struct, and we do not have to pass it each time.
+
+ * hosts.h: Change Scsi_Host_Template struct to include "next" and
+ "release" functions. Initialize to NULL in all low level
+ adapters.
+
+ * hosts.c: Rename scsi_hosts to builtin_scsi_hosts, create linked
+ list scsi_hosts, linked together with the new "next" field.
+
+Wed Jul 6 05:45:02 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.25 released.
+
+ * aha152x.c: Changes from Juergen - cleanups and updates.
+
+ * sd.c, sr.c: Use new check_media_change and revalidate
+ file_operations fields.
+
+ * st.c, st.h: Add changes from Kai Makisara, dated Jun 22.
+
+ * hosts.h: Change SG_ALL back to 0xff. Apparently soft error
+ in /dev/brain resulted in having this bumped up.
+ Change first parameter in bios_param function to be Disk * instead
+ of index into rscsi_disks.
+
+ * sd_ioctl.c: Pass pointer to rscsi_disks element instead of index
+ to array.
+
+ * sd.h: Add struct name "scsi_disk" to typedef for Scsi_Disk.
+
+ * scsi.c: Remove redundant Maxtor XT8760S from blacklist.
+ In scsi_reset, add printk when DEBUG defined.
+
+ * All low level drivers: Modify definitions of bios_param in
+ appropriate way.
+
+Thu Jun 16 10:31:59 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.20 released.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: Only pass down the actual number of characters
+ required to scsi_do_cmd, not the one rounded up to a even number
+ of sectors.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Changes from Caleb Epstein for 24f cards. Support
+ larger SG lists.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Changes from me - use scsi_register to register
+ host. Add some consistency checking,
+
+Wed Jun 1 21:12:13 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.19 released.
+
+ * scsi.h: Add new return code for reset() function:
+ SCSI_RESET_PUNT.
+
+ * scsi.c: Make SCSI_RESET_PUNT the same as SCSI_RESET_WAKEUP for
+ now.
+
+ * aha1542.c: If the command responsible for the reset is not
+ pending, return SCSI_RESET_PUNT.
+
+ * aha1740.c, buslogic.c, wd7000.c, ultrastor.c: Return
+ SCSI_RESET_PUNT instead of SCSI_RESET_SNOOZE.
+
+Tue May 31 19:36:01 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * buslogic.c: Do not print out message about "must be Adaptec"
+ if we have detected a buslogic card. Print out a warning message
+ if we are configuring for >16Mb, since the 445S at board level
+ D or earlier does not work right. The "D" level board can be made
+ to work by flipping an undocumented switch, but this is too subtle.
+
+ Changes based upon patches in Yggdrasil distribution.
+
+ * sg.c, sg.h: Return sense data to user.
+
+ * aha1542.c, aha1740.c, buslogic.c: Do not panic if
+ sense buffer is wrong size.
+
+ * hosts.c: Test for ultrastor card before any of the others.
+
+ * scsi.c: Allow boot-time option for max_scsi_luns=? so that
+ buggy firmware has an easy work-around.
+
+Sun May 15 20:24:34 1994 Eric Youngdale (eric@esp22)
+
+ * Linux 1.1.15 released.
+
+ Post-codefreeze thaw...
+
+ * buslogic.[c,h]: New driver from David Gentzel.
+
+ * hosts.h: Add use_clustering field to explicitly say whether
+ clustering should be used for devices attached to this host
+ adapter. The buslogic board apparently supports large SG lists,
+ but it is apparently faster if sd.c condenses this into a smaller
+ list.
+
+ * sd.c: Use this field instead of heuristic.
+
+ * All host adapter include files: Add appropriate initializer for
+ use_clustering field.
+
+ * scsi.h: Add #defines for return codes for the abort and reset
+ functions. There are now a specific set of return codes to fully
+ specify all of the possible things that the low-level adapter
+ could do.
+
+ * scsi.c: Act based upon return codes from abort/reset functions.
+
+ * All host adapter abort/reset functions: Return new return code.
+
+ * Add code in scsi.c to help debug timeouts. Use #define
+ DEBUG_TIMEOUT to enable this.
+
+ * scsi.c: If the host->irq field is set, use
+ disable_irq/enable_irq before calling queuecommand if we
+ are not already in an interrupt. Reduce races, and we
+ can be sloppier about cli/sti in the interrupt routines now
+ (reduce interrupt latency).
+
+ * constants.c: Fix some things to eliminate warnings. Add some
+ sense descriptions that were omitted before.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Watch for SCRD from host adapter - if we see it, set
+ a flag. Currently we only print out the number of pending
+ commands that might need to be restarted.
+
+ * aha1542.c (aha1542_abort): Look for lost interrupts, OGMB still
+ full, and attempt to recover. Otherwise give up.
+
+ * aha1542.c (aha1542_reset): Try BUS DEVICE RESET, and then pass
+ DID_RESET back up to the upper level code for all commands running
+ on this target (even on different LUNs).
+
+Sat May 7 14:54:01 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.1.12 released.
+
+ * st.c, st.h: New version from Kai. Supports boot time
+ specification of number of buffers.
+
+ * wd7000.[c,h]: Updated driver from John Boyd. Now supports
+ more than one wd7000 board in machine at one time, among other things.
+
+Wed Apr 20 22:20:35 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.1.8 released.
+
+ * sd.c: Add a few type casts where scsi_malloc is called.
+
+Wed Apr 13 12:53:29 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.1.4 released.
+
+ * scsi.c: Clean up a few printks (use %p to print pointers).
+
+Wed Apr 13 11:33:02 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.1.3 released.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 5.16 (Handle different FIFO sizes
+ better).
+
+Fri Apr 8 08:57:19 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.1.2 released.
+
+ * Throughout: SCSI portion of cluster diffs added.
+
+Tue Apr 5 07:41:50 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.1 development tree initiated.
+
+ * The linux 1.0 development tree is now effectively frozen except
+ for obvious bugfixes.
+
+******************************************************************
+******************************************************************
+******************************************************************
+******************************************************************
+
+Sun Apr 17 00:17:39 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.0, patchlevel 9 released.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 5.16 (Handle different FIFO sizes
+ better).
+
+Thu Apr 7 08:36:20 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.0, patchlevel8 released.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 5.15 from 5.9. Handles 3.4 bios.
+
+Sun Apr 3 14:43:03 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.0, patchlevel6 released.
+
+ * wd7000.c: Make stab at fixing race condition.
+
+Sat Mar 26 14:14:50 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.0, patchlevel5 released.
+
+ * aha152x.c, Makefile: Fix a few bugs (too much data message).
+ Add a few more bios signatures. (Patches from Juergen).
+
+ * aha1542.c: Fix race condition in aha1542_out.
+
+Mon Mar 21 16:36:20 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.0, patchlevel3 released.
+
+ * sd.c, st.c, sr.c, sg.c: Return -ENXIO, not -ENODEV if we attempt
+ to open a non-existent device.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add Chinon cdrom to blacklist.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Check return status of verify_area.
+
+Sat Mar 6 16:06:19 1994
+
+ * Linux 1.0 released (technically a pre-release).
+
+ * scsi.c: Add IMS CDD521, Maxtor XT-8760S to blacklist.
+
+Tue Feb 15 10:58:20 1994
+
+ * pl15e released.
+
+ * aha1542.c: For 1542C, allow dynamic device scan with >1Gb turned
+ off.
+
+ * constants.c: Fix typo in definition of CONSTANTS.
+
+ * pl15d released.
+
+Fri Feb 11 10:10:16 1994
+
+ * pl15c released.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add Maxtor XT-3280 and Rodime RO3000S to blacklist.
+
+ * scsi.c: Allow tagged queueing for scsi 3 devices as well.
+ Some really old devices report a version number of 0. Disallow
+ LUN != 0 for these.
+
+Thu Feb 10 09:48:57 1994
+
+ * pl15b released.
+
+Sun Feb 6 12:19:46 1994
+
+ * pl15a released.
+
+Fri Feb 4 09:02:17 1994
+
+ * scsi.c: Add Teac cdrom to blacklist.
+
+Thu Feb 3 14:16:43 1994
+
+ * pl15 released.
+
+Tue Feb 1 15:47:43 1994
+
+ * pl14w released.
+
+ * wd7000.c (wd_bases): Fix typo in last change.
+
+Mon Jan 24 17:37:23 1994
+
+ * pl14u released.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Support 1542CF/extended bios. Different from 1542C
+
+ * wd7000.c: Allow bios at 0xd8000 as well.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Do not truncate cylinders to 1024.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 5.9 (add new bios signature).
+
+ * NCR5380.c: Update from Drew - should work a lot better now.
+
+Sat Jan 8 15:13:10 1994
+
+ * pl14o released.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Zero reserved field before trying to set audio volume.
+
+Wed Jan 5 13:21:10 1994
+
+ * pl14m released.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 5.8. No functional difference???
+
+Tue Jan 4 14:26:13 1994
+
+ * pl14l released.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Remove outl, inl functions (now provided elsewhere).
+
+Mon Jan 3 12:27:25 1994
+
+ * pl14k released.
+
+ * aha152x.c: Remove insw and outsw functions.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Ditto.
+
+Wed Dec 29 09:47:20 1993
+
+ * pl14i released.
+
+ * scsi.c: Support RECOVERED_ERROR for tape drives.
+
+ * st.c: Update of tape driver from Kai.
+
+Tue Dec 21 09:18:30 1993
+
+ * pl14g released.
+
+ * aha1542.[c,h]: Support extended BIOS stuff.
+
+ * scsi.c: Clean up messages about disks, so they are displayed as
+ sda, sdb, etc instead of sd0, sd1, etc.
+
+ * sr.c: Force reread of capacity if disk was changed.
+ Clear buffer before asking for capacity/sectorsize (some drives
+ do not report this properly). Set needs_sector_size flag if
+ drive did not return sensible sector size.
+
+Mon Dec 13 12:13:47 1993
+
+ * aha152x.c: Update to version .101 from Juergen.
+
+Mon Nov 29 03:03:00 1993
+
+ * linux 0.99.14 released.
+
+ * All scsi stuff moved from kernel/blk_drv/scsi to drivers/scsi.
+
+ * Throughout: Grammatical corrections to various comments.
+
+ * Makefile: fix so that we do not need to compile things we are
+ not going to use.
+
+ * NCR5380.c, NCR5380.h, g_NCR5380.c, g_NCR5380.h, pas16.c,
+ pas16.h, t128.c, t128.h: New files from Drew.
+
+ * aha152x.c, aha152x.h: New files from Juergen Fischer.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Support for more than one 1542 in the machine
+ at the same time. Make functions static that do not need
+ visibility.
+
+ * aha1740.c: Set NEEDS_JUMPSTART flag in reset function, so we
+ know to restart the command. Change prototype of aha1740_reset
+ to take a command pointer.
+
+ * constants.c: Clean up a few things.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 5.6. Move snarf_region. Allow
+ board to be set at different SCSI ids. Remove support for
+ reselection (did not work well). Set JUMPSTART flag in reset
+ code.
+
+ * hosts.c: Support new low-level adapters. Allow for more than
+ one adapter of a given type.
+
+ * hosts.h: Allow for more than one adapter of a given type.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add scsi_device_types array, if NEEDS_JUMPSTART is set
+ after a low-level reset, start the command again. Sort blacklist,
+ and add Maxtor MXT-1240S, XT-4170S, NEC CDROM 84, Seagate ST157N.
+
+ * scsi.h: Add constants for tagged queueing.
+
+ * Throughout: Use constants from major.h instead of hardcoded
+ numbers for major numbers.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: Fix bug in buffer length in ioctl_command. Use
+ verify_area in GET_IDLUN ioctl. Add new ioctls for
+ TAGGED_QUEUE_ENABLE, DISABLE. Only allow IOCTL_SEND_COMMAND by
+ superuser.
+
+ * sd.c: Only pay attention to UNIT_ATTENTION for removable disks.
+ Fix bug where sometimes portions of blocks would get lost
+ resulting in processes hanging. Add messages when we spin up a
+ disk, and fix a bug in the timing. Increase read-ahead for disks
+ that are on a scatter-gather capable host adapter.
+
+ * seagate.c: Fix so that some parameters can be set from the lilo
+ prompt. Supply jumpstart flag if we are resetting and need the
+ command restarted. Fix so that we return 1 if we detect a card
+ so that multiple card detection works correctly. Add yet another
+ signature for FD cards (950). Add another signature for ST0x.
+
+ * sg.c, sg.h: New files from Lawrence Foard for generic scsi
+ access.
+
+ * sr.c: Add type casts for (void*) so that we can do pointer
+ arithmetic. Works with GCC without this, but it is not strictly
+ correct. Same bugfix as was in sd.c. Increase read-ahead a la
+ disk driver.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Use scsi_malloc buffer instead of buffer from stack
+ since we cannot guarantee that the stack is < 16Mb.
+
+ ultrastor.c: Update to support 24f properly (JFC's driver).
+
+ wd7000.c: Supply jumpstart flag for reset. Do not round up
+ number of cylinders in biosparam function.
+
+Sat Sep 4 20:49:56 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl13 released.
+
+ * Throughout: Use check_region/snarf_region for all low-level
+ drivers.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Do hard reset instead of soft (some ethercard probes
+ screw us up).
+
+ * scsi.c: Add new flag ASKED_FOR_SENSE so that we can tell if we are
+ in a loop whereby the device returns null sense data.
+
+ * sd.c: Add code to spin up a drive if it is not already spinning.
+ Do this one at a time to make it easier on power supplies.
+
+ * sd_ioctl.c: Use sync_dev instead of fsync_dev in BLKFLSBUF ioctl.
+
+ * seagate.c: Switch around DATA/CONTROL lines.
+
+ * st.c: Change sense to unsigned.
+
+Thu Aug 5 11:59:18 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl12 released.
+
+ * constants.c, constants.h: New files with ascii descriptions of
+ various conditions.
+
+ * Makefile: Do not try to count the number of low-level drivers,
+ just generate the list of .o files.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Replace 16 with sizeof(SCpnt->sense_buffer). Add tests
+ for addresses > 16Mb, panic if we find one.
+
+ * aha1740.c: Ditto with sizeof().
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 3.18. Add new signature, register IRQ
+ with irqaction. Use ID 7 for new board. Be more intelligent about
+ obtaining the h/s/c numbers for biosparam.
+
+ * hosts.c: Do not depend upon Makefile generated count of the number
+ of low-level host adapters.
+
+ * scsi.c: Use array for scsi_command_size instead of a function. Add
+ Texel cdrom and Maxtor XT-4380S to blacklist. Allow compile time
+ option for no-multi lun scan. Add semaphore for possible problems
+ with handshaking, assume device is faulty until we know it not to be
+ the case. Add DEBUG_INIT symbol to dump info as we scan for devices.
+ Zero sense buffer so we can tell if we need to request it. When
+ examining sense information, request sense if buffer is all zero.
+ If RESET, request sense information to see what to do next.
+
+ * scsi_debug.c: Change some constants to use symbols like INT_MAX.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c (kernel_scsi_ioctl): New function -for making ioctl
+ calls from kernel space.
+
+ * sd.c: Increase timeout to 300. Use functions in constants.h to
+ display info. Use scsi_malloc buffer for READ_CAPACITY, since
+ we cannot guarantee that a stack based buffer is < 16Mb.
+
+ * sd_ioctl.c: Add BLKFLSBUF ioctl.
+
+ * seagate.c: Add new compile time options for ARBITRATE,
+ SLOW_HANDSHAKE, and SLOW_RATE. Update assembly loops for transferring
+ data. Use kernel_scsi_ioctl to request mode page with geometry.
+
+ * sr.c: Use functions in constants.c to display messages.
+
+ * st.c: Support for variable block size.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Do not use cache for tape drives. Set
+ unchecked_isa_dma flag, even though this may not be needed (gets set
+ later).
+
+Sat Jul 17 18:32:44 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl11 released. C++ compilable.
+
+ * Throughout: Add type casts all over the place, and use "ip" instead
+ of "info" in the various biosparam functions.
+
+ * Makefile: Compile seagate.c with C++ compiler.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Always set ccb pointer as this gets trashed somehow on
+ some systems. Add a few type casts. Update biosparam function a little.
+
+ * aha1740.c: Add a few type casts.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 3.17 from 3.6. Now works with
+ TMC-18C50.
+
+ * scsi.c: Minor changes here and there with datatypes. Save use_sg
+ when requesting sense information so that this can properly be
+ restored if we retry the command. Set aside dma buffers assuming each
+ block is 1 page, not 1Kb minix block.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: Add a few type casts. Other minor changes.
+
+ * sd.c: Correctly free all scsi_malloc'd memory if we run out of
+ dma_pool. Store blocksize information for each partition.
+
+ * seagate.c: Minor cleanups here and there.
+
+ * sr.c: Set up blocksize array for all discs. Fix bug in freeing
+ buffers if we run out of dma pool.
+
+Thu Jun 2 17:58:11 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl10 released.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Support for BT 445S (VL-bus board with no dma channel).
+
+ * fdomain.c: Upgrade to version 3.6. Preliminary support for TNC-18C50.
+
+ * scsi.c: First attempt to fix problem with old_use_sg. Change
+ NOT_READY to a SUGGEST_ABORT. Fix timeout race where time might
+ get decremented past zero.
+
+ * sd.c: Add block_fsync function to dispatch table.
+
+ * sr.c: Increase timeout to 500 from 250. Add entry for sync in
+ dispatch table (supply NULL). If we do not have a sectorsize,
+ try to get it in the sd_open function. Add new function just to
+ obtain sectorsize.
+
+ * sr.h: Add needs_sector_size semaphore.
+
+ * st.c: Add NULL for fsync in dispatch table.
+
+ * wd7000.c: Allow another condition for power on that are normal
+ and do not require a panic.
+
+Thu Apr 22 23:10:11 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl9 released.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Use (void) instead of () in setup_mailboxes.
+
+ * scsi.c: Initialize transfersize and underflow fields in SCmd to 0.
+ Do not panic for unsupported message bytes.
+
+ * scsi.h: Allocate 12 bytes instead of 10 for commands. Add
+ transfersize and underflow fields.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: Further bugfix to ioctl_probe.
+
+ * sd.c: Use long instead of int for last parameter in sd_ioctl.
+ Initialize transfersize and underflow fields.
+
+ * sd_ioctl.c: Ditto for sd_ioctl(,,,,);
+
+ * seagate.c: New version from Drew. Includes new signatures for FD
+ cards. Support for 0ws jumper. Correctly initialize
+ scsi_hosts[hostnum].this_id. Improved handing of
+ disconnect/reconnect, and support command linking. Use
+ transfersize and underflow fields. Support scatter-gather.
+
+ * sr.c, sr_ioctl.c: Use long instead of int for last parameter in sr_ioctl.
+ Use buffer and buflength in do_ioctl. Patches from Chris Newbold for
+ scsi-2 audio commands.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Comment out in_byte (compiler warning).
+
+ * wd7000.c: Change () to (void) in wd7000_enable_dma.
+
+Wed Mar 31 16:36:25 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl8 released.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Handle mailboxes better for 1542C.
+ Do not truncate number of cylinders at 1024 for biosparam call.
+
+ * aha1740.c: Fix a few minor bugs for multiple devices.
+ Same as above for biosparam.
+
+ * scsi.c: Add lockable semaphore for removable devices that can have
+ media removal prevented. Add another signature for flopticals.
+ (allocate_device): Fix race condition. Allow more space in dma pool
+ for blocksizes of up to 4Kb.
+
+ * scsi.h: Define COMMAND_SIZE. Define a SCSI specific version of
+ INIT_REQUEST that can run with interrupts off.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: Make ioctl_probe function more idiot-proof. If
+ a removable device says ILLEGAL REQUEST to a door-locking command,
+ clear lockable flag. Add SCSI_IOCTL_GET_IDLUN ioctl. Do not attempt
+ to lock door for devices that do not have lockable semaphore set.
+
+ * sd.c: Fix race condition for multiple disks. Use INIT_SCSI_REQUEST
+ instead of INIT_REQUEST. Allow sector sizes of 1024 and 256. For
+ removable disks that are not ready, mark them as having a media change
+ (some drives do not report this later).
+
+ * seagate.c: Use volatile keyword for memory-mapped register pointers.
+
+ * sr.c: Fix race condition, a la sd.c. Increase the number of retries
+ to 1. Use INIT_SCSI_REQUEST. Allow 512 byte sector sizes. Do a
+ read_capacity when we init the device so we know the size and
+ sectorsize.
+
+ * st.c: If ioctl not found in st.c, try scsi_ioctl for others.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Do not truncate number of cylinders at 1024 for
+ biosparam call.
+
+ * wd7000.c: Ditto.
+ Throughout: Use COMMAND_SIZE macro to determine length of scsi
+ command.
+
+
+
+Sat Mar 13 17:31:29 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl7 released.
+
+ Throughout: Improve punctuation in some messages, and use new
+ verify_area syntax.
+
+ * aha1542.c: Handle unexpected interrupts better.
+
+ * scsi.c: Ditto. Handle reset conditions a bit better, asking for
+ sense information and retrying if required.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: Allow for 12 byte scsi commands.
+
+ * ultrastor.c: Update to use scatter-gather.
+
+Sat Feb 20 17:57:15 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl6 released.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 3.5. Handle spurious interrupts
+ better.
+
+ * sd.c: Use register_blkdev function.
+
+ * sr.c: Ditto.
+
+ * st.c: Use register_chrdev function.
+
+ * wd7000.c: Undo previous change.
+
+Sat Feb 6 11:20:43 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl5 released.
+
+ * scsi.c: Fix bug in testing for UNIT_ATTENTION.
+
+ * wd7000.c: Check at more addresses for bios. Fix bug in biosparam
+ (heads & sectors turned around).
+
+Wed Jan 20 18:13:59 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl4 released.
+
+ * scsi.c: Ignore leading spaces when looking for blacklisted devices.
+
+ * seagate.c: Add a few new signatures for FD cards. Another patch
+ with SCint to fix race condition. Use recursion_depth to keep track
+ of how many times we have been recursively called, and do not start
+ another command unless we are on the outer level. Fixes bug
+ with Syquest cartridge drives (used to crash kernel), because
+ they do not disconnect with large data transfers.
+
+Tue Jan 12 14:33:36 1993
+
+ * 0.99pl3 released.
+
+ * fdomain.c: Update to version 3.3 (a few new signatures).
+
+ * scsi.c: Add CDU-541, Denon DRD-25X to blacklist.
+ (allocate_request, request_queueable): Init request.waiting to NULL if
+ non-buffer type of request.
+
+ * seagate.c: Allow controller to be overridden with CONTROLLER symbol.
+ Set SCint=NULL when we are done, to remove race condition.
+
+ * st.c: Changes from Kai.
+
+Wed Dec 30 20:03:47 1992
+
+ * 0.99pl2 released.
+
+ * scsi.c: Blacklist back in. Remove Newbury drive as other bugfix
+ eliminates need for it here.
+
+ * sd.c: Return ENODEV instead of EACCES if no such device available.
+ (sd_init) Init blkdev_fops earlier so that sd_open is available sooner.
+
+ * sr.c: Same as above for sd.c.
+
+ * st.c: Return ENODEV instead of ENXIO if no device. Init chrdev_fops
+ sooner, so that it is always there even if no tapes.
+
+ * seagate.c (controller_type): New variable to keep track of ST0x or
+ FD. Modify signatures list to indicate controller type, and init
+ controller_type once we find a match.
+
+ * wd7000.c (wd7000_set_sync): Remove redundant function.
+
+Sun Dec 20 16:26:24 1992
+
+ * 0.99pl1 released.
+
+ * scsi_ioctl.c: Bugfix - check dev->index, not dev->id against
+ NR_SCSI_DEVICES.
+
+ * sr_ioctl.c: Verify that device exists before allowing an ioctl.
+
+ * st.c: Patches from Kai - change timeout values, improve end of tape
+ handling.
+
+Sun Dec 13 18:15:23 1992
+
+ * 0.99 kernel released. Baseline for this ChangeLog.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.ips b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.ips
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..5019f5182bf4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.ips
@@ -0,0 +1,122 @@
+IBM ServeRAID driver Change Log
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+ 5.00.01 - Sarasota ( 5i ) adapters must always be scanned first
+ - Get rid on IOCTL_NEW_COMMAND code
+ - Add Extended DCDB Commands for Tape Support in 5I
+
+ 4.90.11 - Don't actually RESET unless it's physically required
+ - Remove unused compile options
+
+ 4.90.08 - Data Corruption if First Scatter Gather Element is > 64K
+
+ 4.90.08 - Increase Delays in Flashing ( Trombone Only - 4H )
+
+ 4.90.05 - Use New PCI Architecture to facilitate Hot Plug Development
+
+ 4.90.01 - Add ServeRAID Version Checking
+
+ 4.80.26 - Clean up potential code problems ( Arjan's recommendations )
+
+ 4.80.21 - Change memcpy() to copy_to_user() in NVRAM Page 5 IOCTL path
+
+ 4.80.20 - Set max_sectors in Scsi_Host structure ( if >= 2.4.7 kernel )
+ - 5 second delay needed after resetting an i960 adapter
+
+ 4.80.14 - Take all semaphores off stack
+ - Clean Up New_IOCTL path
+
+ 4.80.04 - Eliminate calls to strtok() if 2.4.x or greater
+ - Adjustments to Device Queue Depth
+
+ 4.80.00 - Make ia64 Safe
+
+ 4.72.01 - I/O Mapped Memory release ( so "insmod ips" does not Fail )
+ - Don't Issue Internal FFDC Command if there are Active Commands
+ - Close Window for getting too many IOCTL's active
+
+ 4.72.00 - Allow for a Scatter-Gather Element to exceed MAX_XFER Size
+
+ 4.71.00 - Change all memory allocations to not use GFP_DMA flag
+ - Code Clean-Up for 2.4.x kernel
+
+ 4.70.15 - Fix Breakup for very large ( non-SG ) requests
+
+ 4.70.13 - Don't release HA Lock in ips_next() until SC taken off queue
+ - Unregister SCSI device in ips_release()
+ - Don't Send CDB's if we already know the device is not present
+
+ 4.70.12 - Corrective actions for bad controller ( during initialization )
+
+ 4.70.09 - Use a Common ( Large Buffer ) for Flashing from the JCRM CD
+ - Add IPSSEND Flash Support
+ - Set Sense Data for Unknown SCSI Command
+ - Use Slot Number from NVRAM Page 5
+ - Restore caller's DCDB Structure
+
+ 4.20.14 - Update patch files for kernel 2.4.0-test5
+
+ 4.20.13 - Fix some failure cases / reset code
+ - Hook into the reboot_notifier to flush the controller
+ cache
+
+ 4.20.03 - Rename version to coincide with new release schedules
+ - Performance fixes
+ - Fix truncation of /proc files with cat
+ - Merge in changes through kernel 2.4.0test1ac21
+
+ 4.10.13 - Fix for dynamic unload and proc file system
+
+ 4.10.00 - Add support for ServeRAID 4M/4L
+
+ 4.00.06 - Fix timeout with initial FFDC command
+
+ 4.00.05 - Remove wish_block from init routine
+ - Use linux/spinlock.h instead of asm/spinlock.h for kernels
+ 2.3.18 and later
+ - Sync with other changes from the 2.3 kernels
+
+ 4.00.04 - Rename structures/constants to be prefixed with IPS_
+
+ 4.00.03 - Add alternative passthru interface
+ - Add ability to flash ServeRAID BIOS
+
+ 4.00.02 - Fix problem with PT DCDB with no buffer
+
+ 4.00.01 - Add support for First Failure Data Capture
+
+ 4.00.00 - Add support for ServeRAID 4
+
+ 3.60.02 - Make DCDB direction based on lookup table.
+ - Only allow one DCDB command to a SCSI ID at a time.
+
+ 3.60.01 - Remove bogus error check in passthru routine.
+
+ 3.60.00 - Bump max commands to 128 for use with ServeRAID
+ firmware 3.60.
+ - Change version to 3.60 to coincide with ServeRAID release
+ numbering.
+
+ 1.00.00 - Initial Public Release
+ - Functionally equivalent to 0.99.05
+
+ 0.99.05 - Fix an oops on certain passthru commands
+
+ 0.99.04 - Fix race condition in the passthru mechanism
+ -- this required the interface to the utilities to change
+ - Fix error recovery code
+
+ 0.99.03 - Make interrupt routine handle all completed request on the
+ adapter not just the first one
+ - Make sure passthru commands get woken up if we run out of
+ SCBs
+ - Send all of the commands on the queue at once rather than
+ one at a time since the card will support it.
+
+ 0.99.02 - Added some additional debug statements to print out
+ errors if an error occurs while trying to read/write
+ to a logical drive (IPS_DEBUG).
+
+ - Fixed read/write errors when the adapter is using an
+ 8K stripe size.
+
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..a9356c63b800
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.megaraid
@@ -0,0 +1,349 @@
+Release Date : Thu Feb 03 12:27:22 EST 2005 - Seokmann Ju <sju@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.4.5 (scsi module), 2.20.2.5 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.4.4 (scsi module), 2.20.2.4 (cmm module)
+
+1. Modified name of two attributes in scsi_host_template.
+ On Wed, 2005-02-02 at 10:56 -0500, Ju, Seokmann wrote:
+ > + .sdev_attrs = megaraid_device_attrs,
+ > + .shost_attrs = megaraid_class_device_attrs,
+
+ These are, perhaps, slightly confusing names.
+ The terms device and class_device have well defined meanings in the
+ generic device model, neither of which is what you mean here.
+ Why not simply megaraid_sdev_attrs and megaraid_shost_attrs?
+
+ Other than this, it looks fine to me too.
+
+Release Date : Thu Jan 27 00:01:03 EST 2005 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.4.4 (scsi module), 2.20.2.5 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.4.3 (scsi module), 2.20.2.4 (cmm module)
+
+1. Bump up the version of scsi module due to its conflict.
+
+Release Date : Thu Jan 21 00:01:03 EST 2005 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.4.3 (scsi module), 2.20.2.5 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.4.2 (scsi module), 2.20.2.4 (cmm module)
+
+1. Remove driver ioctl for logical drive to scsi address translation and
+ replace with the sysfs attribute. To remove drives and change
+ capacity, application shall now use the device attribute to get the
+ logical drive number for a scsi device. For adding newly created
+ logical drives, class device attribute would be required to uniquely
+ identify each controller.
+ - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+
+ "James, I've been thinking about this a little more, and you may be on
+ to something here. Let each driver add files as such:"
+
+ - Matt Domsch <Matt_Domsch@dell.com>, 12.15.2004
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+
+ "Then, if you simply publish your LD number as an extra parameter of
+ the device, you can look through /sys to find it."
+
+ - James Bottomley <James.Bottomley@SteelEye.com>, 01.03.2005
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+
+ "I don't see why not ... it's your driver, you can publish whatever
+ extra information you need as scsi_device attributes; that was one of
+ the designs of the extensible attribute system."
+
+ - James Bottomley <James.Bottomley@SteelEye.com>, 01.06.2005
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+2. Add AMI megaraid support - Brian King <brking@charter.net>
+ PCI_VENDOR_ID_AMI, PCI_DEVICE_ID_AMI_MEGARAID3,
+ PCI_VENDOR_ID_AMI, PCI_SUBSYS_ID_PERC3_DC,
+
+3. Make some code static - Adrian Bunk <bunk@stusta.de>
+ Date: Mon, 15 Nov 2004 03:14:57 +0100
+
+ The patch below makes some needlessly global code static.
+ -wait_queue_head_t wait_q;
+ +static wait_queue_head_t wait_q;
+
+ Signed-off-by: Adrian Bunk <bunk@stusta.de>
+
+4. Added NEC ROMB support - NEC MegaRAID PCI Express ROMB controller
+ PCI_VENDOR_ID_LSI_LOGIC, PCI_DEVICE_ID_MEGARAID_NEC_ROMB_2E,
+ PCI_SUBSYS_ID_NEC, PCI_SUBSYS_ID_MEGARAID_NEC_ROMB_2E,
+
+5. Fixed Tape drive issue : For any Direct CDB command to physical device
+ including tape, timeout value set by driver was 10 minutes. With this
+ value, most of command will return within timeout. However, for those
+ command like ERASE or FORMAT, it takes more than an hour depends on
+ capacity of the device and the command could be terminated before it
+ completes.
+ To address this issue, the 'timeout' field in the DCDB command will
+ have NO TIMEOUT (i.e., 4) value as its timeout on DCDB command.
+
+
+
+Release Date : Thu Dec 9 19:10:23 EST 2004
+ - Sreenivas Bagalkote <sreenib@lsil.com>
+
+Current Version : 2.20.4.2 (scsi module), 2.20.2.4 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.4.1 (scsi module), 2.20.2.3 (cmm module)
+
+i. Introduced driver ioctl that returns scsi address for a given ld.
+
+ "Why can't the existing sysfs interfaces be used to do this?"
+ - Brian King (brking@us.ibm.com)
+
+ "I've looked into solving this another way, but I cannot see how
+ to get this driver-private mapping of logical drive number-> HCTL
+ without putting code something like this into the driver."
+
+ "...and by providing a mapping a function to userspace, the driver
+ is free to change its mapping algorithm in the future if necessary .."
+ - Matt Domsch (Matt_Domsch@dell.com)
+
+Release Date : Thu Dec 9 19:02:14 EST 2004 - Sreenivas Bagalkote <sreenib@lsil.com>
+
+Current Version : 2.20.4.1 (scsi module), 2.20.2.3 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.4.1 (scsi module), 2.20.2.2 (cmm module)
+
+i. Fix a bug in kioc's dma buffer deallocation
+
+Release Date : Thu Nov 4 18:24:56 EST 2004 - Sreenivas Bagalkote <sreenib@lsil.com>
+
+Current Version : 2.20.4.1 (scsi module), 2.20.2.2 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.4.0 (scsi module), 2.20.2.1 (cmm module)
+
+i. Handle IOCTL cmd timeouts more properly.
+
+ii. pci_dma_sync_{sg,single}_for_cpu was introduced into megaraid_mbox
+ incorrectly (instead of _for_device). Changed to appropriate
+ pci_dma_sync_{sg,single}_for_device.
+
+Release Date : Wed Oct 06 11:15:29 EDT 2004 - Sreenivas Bagalkote <sreenib@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.4.0 (scsi module), 2.20.2.1 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.4.0 (scsi module), 2.20.2.0 (cmm module)
+
+i. Remove CONFIG_COMPAT around register_ioctl32_conversion
+
+Release Date : Mon Sep 27 22:15:07 EDT 2004 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.4.0 (scsi module), 2.20.2.0 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.3.1 (scsi module), 2.20.2.0 (cmm module)
+
+i. Fix data corruption. Because of a typo in the driver, the IO packets
+ were wrongly shared by the ioctl path. This causes a whole IO command
+ to be replaced by an incoming ioctl command.
+
+Release Date : Tue Aug 24 09:43:35 EDT 2004 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.3.1 (scsi module), 2.20.2.0 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.3.0 (scsi module), 2.20.2.0 (cmm module)
+
+i. Function reordering so that inline functions are defined before they
+ are actually used. It is now mandatory for GCC 3.4.1 (current stable)
+
+ Declare some heavy-weight functions to be non-inlined,
+ megaraid_mbox_build_cmd, megaraid_mbox_runpendq,
+ megaraid_mbox_prepare_pthru, megaraid_mbox_prepare_epthru,
+ megaraid_busywait_mbox
+
+ - Andrew Morton <akpm@osdl.org>, 08.19.2004
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+ "Something else to clean up after inclusion: every instance of an
+ inline function is actually rendered as a full function call, because
+ the function is always used before it is defined. Atul, please
+ re-arrange the code to eliminate the need for most (all) of the
+ function prototypes at the top of each file, and define (not just
+ declare with a prototype) each inline function before its first use"
+
+ - Matt Domsch <Matt_Domsch@dell.com>, 07.27.2004
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+
+ii. Display elapsed time (countdown) while waiting for FW to boot.
+
+iii. Module compilation reorder in Makefile so that unresolved symbols do
+ not occur when driver is compiled non-modular.
+
+ Patrick J. LoPresti <patl@users.sourceforge.net>, 8.22.2004
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+
+Release Date : Thu Aug 19 09:58:33 EDT 2004 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.3.0 (scsi module), 2.20.2.0 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.2.0 (scsi module), 2.20.1.0 (cmm module)
+
+i. When copying the mailbox packets, copy only first 14 bytes (for 32-bit
+ mailboxes) and only first 22 bytes (for 64-bit mailboxes). This is to
+ avoid getting the stale values for busy bit. We want to set the busy
+ bit just before issuing command to the FW.
+
+ii. In the reset handling, if the reseted command is not owned by the
+ driver, do not (wrongly) print information for the "attached" driver
+ packet.
+
+iii. Have extended wait when issuing command in synchronous mode. This is
+ required for the cases where the option ROM is disabled and there is
+ no BIOS to start the controller. The FW starts to boot after receiving
+ the first command from the driver. The current driver has 1 second
+ timeout for the synchronous commands, which is far less than what is
+ actually required. We now wait up to MBOX_RESET_TIME (180 seconds) for
+ FW boot process.
+
+iv. In megaraid_mbox_product_info, clear the mailbox contents completely
+ before preparing the command for inquiry3. This is to ensure that the
+ FW does not get junk values in the command.
+
+v. Do away with the redundant LSI_CONFIG_COMPAT redefinition for
+ CONFIG_COMPAT. Replace <asm/ioctl32.h> with <linux/ioctl32.h>
+
+ - James Bottomley <James.Bottomley@SteelEye.com>, 08.17.2004
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+vi. Add support for 64-bit applications. Current drivers assume only
+ 32-bit applications, even on 64-bit platforms. Use the "data" and
+ "buffer" fields of the mimd_t structure, instead of embedded 32-bit
+ addresses in application mailbox and passthru structures.
+
+vii. Move the function declarations for the management module from
+ megaraid_mm.h to megaraid_mm.c
+
+ - Andrew Morton <akpm@osdl.org>, 08.19.2004
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+viii. Change default values for MEGARAID_NEWGEN, MEGARAID_MM, and
+ MEGARAID_MAILBOX to 'n' in Kconfig.megaraid
+
+ - Andrew Morton <akpm@osdl.org>, 08.19.2004
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+ix. replace udelay with msleep
+
+x. Typos corrected in comments and whitespace adjustments, explicit
+ grouping of expressions.
+
+
+Release Date : Fri Jul 23 15:22:07 EDT 2004 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.2.0 (scsi module), 2.20.1.0 (cmm module)
+Older Version : 2.20.1.0 (scsi module), 2.20.0.0 (cmm module)
+
+i. Add PCI ids for Acer ROMB 2E solution
+
+ii. Add PCI ids for I4
+
+iii. Typo corrected for subsys id for megaraid sata 300-4x
+
+iv. Remove yield() while mailbox handshake in synchronous commands
+
+
+ "My other main gripe is things like this:
+
+ + // wait for maximum 1 second for status to post
+ + for (i = 0; i < 40000; i++) {
+ + if (mbox->numstatus != 0xFF) break;
+ + udelay(25); yield();
+ + }
+
+ which litter the driver. Use of yield() in drivers is deprecated."
+
+ - James Bottomley <James.Bottomley@SteelEye.com>, 07.14.2004
+ linux-scsi mailing list
+
+v. Remove redundant __megaraid_busywait_mbox routine
+
+vi. Fix bug in the managment module, which causes a system lockup when the
+ IO module is loaded and then unloaded, followed by executing any
+ management utility. The current version of management module does not
+ handle the adapter unregister properly.
+
+ Specifically, it still keeps a reference to the unregistered
+ controllers. To avoid this, the static array adapters has been
+ replaced by a dynamic list, which gets updated every time an adapter
+ is added or removed.
+
+ Also, during unregistration of the IO module, the resources are
+ now released in the exact reverse order of the allocation time
+ sequence.
+
+
+Release Date : Fri Jun 25 18:58:43 EDT 2004 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.1.0
+Older Version : megaraid 2.20.0.1
+
+i. Stale list pointer in adapter causes kernel panic when module
+ megaraid_mbox is unloaded
+
+
+Release Date : Thu Jun 24 20:37:11 EDT 2004 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.0.1
+Older Version : megaraid 2.20.0.00
+
+i. Modules are not 'y' by default, but depend on current definition of
+ SCSI & PCI.
+
+ii. Redundant structure mraid_driver_t removed.
+
+iii. Miscellaneous indentation and goto/label fixes.
+ - Christoph Hellwig <hch@infradead.org>, 06.24.2004 linux-scsi
+
+iv. scsi_host_put(), do just before completing HBA shutdown.
+
+
+
+Release Date : Mon Jun 21 19:53:54 EDT 2004 - Atul Mukker <atulm@lsil.com>
+Current Version : 2.20.0.0
+Older Version : megaraid 2.20.0.rc2 and 2.00.3
+
+i. Independent module to interact with userland applications and
+ multiplex command to low level RAID module(s).
+
+ "Shared code in a third module, a "library module", is an acceptable
+ solution. modprobe automatically loads dependent modules, so users
+ running "modprobe driver1" or "modprobe driver2" would automatically
+ load the shared library module."
+
+ - Jeff Garzik <jgarzik@pobox.com> 02.25.2004 LKML
+
+ "As Jeff hinted, if your userspace<->driver API is consistent between
+ your new MPT-based RAID controllers and your existing megaraid driver,
+ then perhaps you need a single small helper module (lsiioctl or some
+ better name), loaded by both mptraid and megaraid automatically, which
+ handles registering the /dev/megaraid node dynamically. In this case,
+ both mptraid and megaraid would register with lsiioctl for each
+ adapter discovered, and lsiioctl would essentially be a switch,
+ redirecting userspace tool ioctls to the appropriate driver."
+
+ - Matt Domsch <Matt_Domsch@dell.com> 02.25.2004 LKML
+
+ii. Remove C99 initializations from pci_device id.
+
+ "pci_id_table_g would be much more readable when not using C99
+ initializers.
+ PCI table doesn't change, there's lots of users that prefer the more
+ readable variant. And it's really far less and much easier to grok
+ lines without C99 initializers."
+
+ - Christoph Hellwig <hch@infradead.org>, 05.28.2004 linux-scsi
+
+iii. Many fixes as suggested by Christoph Hellwig <hch@infradead.org> on
+ linux-scsi, 05.28.2004
+
+iv. We now support up to 32 parallel ioctl commands instead of current 1.
+ There is a conscious effort to let memory allocation not fail for ioctl
+ commands.
+
+v. Do away with internal memory management. Use pci_pool_(create|alloc)
+ instead.
+
+vi. Kill tasklet when unloading the driver.
+
+vii. Do not use "host_lock', driver has fine-grain locks now to protect all
+ data structures.
+
+viii. Optimize the build scatter-gather list routine. The callers already
+ know the data transfer address and length.
+
+ix. Better implementation of error handling and recovery. Driver now
+ performs extended errors recovery for instances like scsi cable pull.
+
+x. Disassociate the management commands with an overlaid scsi command.
+ Driver now treats the management packets as special packets and has a
+ dedicated callback routine.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.ncr53c8xx b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.ncr53c8xx
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..7d03e9d5b5f7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.ncr53c8xx
@@ -0,0 +1,495 @@
+Sat May 12 12:00 2001 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version ncr53c8xx-3.4.3b
+ - Ensure LEDC bit in GPCNTL is cleared when reading the NVRAM.
+ Fix sent by Stig Telfer <stig@api-networks.com>.
+ - Define scsi_set_pci_device() as nil for kernel < 2.4.4.
+
+Mon Feb 12 22:30 2001 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version ncr53c8xx-3.4.3
+ - Call pci_enable_device() as AC wants this to be done.
+ - Get both the BAR cookies actual and PCI BAR values.
+ (see Changelog.sym53c8xx rev. 1.7.3 for details)
+ - Merge changes for linux-2.4 that declare the host template
+ in the driver object also when the driver is statically
+ linked with the kernel.
+
+Sun Sep 24 21:30 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version ncr53c8xx-3.4.2
+ - See Changelog.sym53c8xx, driver version 1.7.2.
+
+Wed Jul 26 23:30 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version ncr53c8xx-3.4.1
+ - Provide OpenFirmare path through the proc FS on PPC.
+ - Remove trailing argument #2 from a couple of #undefs.
+
+Sun Jul 09 16:30 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version ncr53c8xx-3.4.0
+ - Remove the PROFILE C and SCRIPTS code.
+ This facility was not this useful and thus was not longer
+ desirable given the increasing complexity of the driver code.
+ - Merges from FreeBSD sym-1.6.2 driver:
+ * Clarify memory barriers needed by the driver for architectures
+ that implement a weak memory ordering.
+ - General cleanup:
+ Move definitions for barriers and IO/MMIO operations to the
+ sym53c8xx_defs.h header files. They are now shared by the
+ both drivers.
+ Use SCSI_NCR_IOMAPPED instead of NCR_IOMAPPED.
+
+Thu May 11 12:30 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * revision 3.3b
+
+Mon Apr 24 12:00 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2i
+ - Return value 1 (instead of 0) from the driver setup routine.
+ - Let the driver also attach controllers that have been set to
+ OFF in the NVRAM as it did prior to revision 3.2g.
+
+Sat Apr 1 12:00 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2h
+ - Fix a compilation problem on Alpha introduced in version 3.2g.
+ (`port' changed to `base_io').
+ - Move from `sym' to this driver a tiny change for __sparc__ that
+ applies to cache line size (? Probably from David S Miller).
+ - Make sure no data transfer will happen for Scsi_Cmnd requests
+ that supply SCSI_DATA_NONE direction (this avoids some BUG()
+ statement in the PCI code when a data buffer is also supplied).
+
+Thu Mar 16 9:30 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * revision 3.3b-3
+ - Added exclusion for the 53C1010 and 53C1010_66 chips
+ to the driver (change to sym53c8xx_comm.h).
+
+Mon March 6 23:15 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2g
+ - Add the file sym53c8xx_comm.h that collects code that should
+ be shared by sym53c8xx and ncr53c8xx drivers. For now, it is
+ a header file that is only included by the ncr53c8xx driver,
+ but things will be cleaned up later. This code addresses
+ notably:
+ * Chip detection and PCI related initialisations
+ * NVRAM detection and reading
+ * DMA mapping
+ * Boot setup command
+ * And some other ...
+ - Add support for the new dynamic dma mapping kernel interface.
+ Requires Linux-2.3.47 (tested with pre-2.3.47-6).
+ - Get data transfer direction from the scsi command structure
+ (Scsi_Cmnd) when this information is available.
+
+Mon March 6 23:15 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2g
+ - Add the file sym53c8xx_comm.h that collects code that should
+ be shared by sym53c8xx and ncr53c8xx drivers. For now, it is
+ a header file that is only included by the ncr53c8xx driver,
+ but things will be cleaned up later. This code addresses
+ notably:
+ * Chip detection and PCI related initialisations
+ * NVRAM detection and reading
+ * DMA mapping
+ * Boot setup command
+ * And some other ...
+ - Add support for the new dynamic dma mapping kernel interface.
+ Requires Linux-2.3.47 (tested with pre-2.3.47-6).
+ - Get data transfer direction from the scsi command structure
+ (Scsi_Cmnd) when this information is available.
+
+Fri Jan 14 14:00 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * revision pre-3.3b-1
+ - Merge parallel driver series 3.31 and 3.2e
+
+Tue Jan 11 14:00 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * revision 3.31
+ - Added support for mounting disks on wide-narrow-wide
+ scsi configurations.
+ - Built off of version 3.30
+
+Mon Jan 10 13:30 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * revision 3.30
+ - Added capability to use the integrity checking code
+ in the kernel (optional).
+ - Disabled support for the 53C1010.
+ - Built off of version 3.2c
+
+Sat Jan 8 22:00 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2e
+ - Add year 2000 copyright.
+ - Display correctly bus signals when bus is detected wrong.
+ - Remove the dead code that broke driver 3.2d.
+
+Mon Dec 6 22:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2d
+ - Change messages written by the driver at initialisation and
+ through the /proc FS (rather cosmetic changes that consist in
+ printing out the PCI bus number and device/function).
+ - Get rid of the old PCI bios interface, but preserve kernel 2.0
+ compatibility from a simple wrapper.
+ - Remove the compilation condition about having to acquire the
+ io_request_lock since it seems to be a definite feature now.:)
+ - proc_dir structure no longer needed for kernel >= 2.3.27.
+ - Change the driver detection code by the sym53c8xx one, modulo
+ some minor changes. The driver can now attach any number of
+ controllers (>40) and does no longer hoger stack space at
+ initialisation.
+ - Definitely disable overlapped PCI arbitration for all dual
+ function chips, since I cannot make sure for what chip revisions
+ it is actually safe.
+ - Add support for the SYM53C1510D.
+ - Update the poor Tekram sync factor table.
+ - Remove the compilation condition about having to acquire the
+ io_request_lock since it seems to be a definite feature now.:)
+ - proc_dir structure no longer needed for kernel >= 2.3.27.
+
+Sat Sep 11 18:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2c
+ - Handle correctly (hopefully) jiffies wrap-around.
+ - Restore the entry used to detect 875 until revision 0xff.
+ (I removed it inadvertently, it seems :) )
+ - Replace __initfunc() which is deprecated stuff by __init which
+ is not yet so. ;-)
+ - Add support of some 'resource handling' for linux-2.3.13.
+ Basically the BARs have been changed to something more complex
+ in the pci_dev structure.
+ - Remove some deprecated code.
+
+Sat May 10 11:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision pre-3.2b-1
+ - Support for the 53C895A by Pamela Delaney <pam.delaney@lsil.com>
+ The 53C895A contains all of the features of the 896 but has only
+ one channel and has a 32 bit PCI bus. It does 64 bit PCI addressing
+ using dual cycle PCI data transfers.
+ - Miscellaneous minor fixes.
+ - Some additions to the README.ncr53c8xx file.
+
+Sun Apr 11 10:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2a
+ - Add 'hostid:#id' boot option. This option allows to change the
+ default SCSI id the driver uses for controllers.
+ - Remove nvram layouts and driver set-up structures from the C source,
+ and use the one defined in sym53c8xx_defs.h file.
+ (shared by both drivers).
+ - Set for now MAX LUNS to 16 (instead of 8).
+
+Thu Mar 11 23:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.2 (8xx-896 driver bundle)
+ - Only define the host template in ncr53c8xx.h and include the
+ sym53c8xx_defs.h file.
+ - Declare static all symbols that do not need to be visible from
+ outside the driver code.
+ - Add 'excl' boot command option that allows to pass to the driver
+ io address of devices not to attach.
+ - Add info() function called from the host template to print
+ driver/host information.
+ - Minor documentation additions.
+
+Sat Mar 6 11:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.1h
+ - Fix some oooold bug that hangs the bus if a device rejects a
+ negotiation. Btw, the corresponding stuff also needed some cleanup
+ and thus the change is a bit larger than it could have been.
+ - Still some typo that made compilation fail for 64 bit (trivial fix).
+
+Sun Feb 14:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.1g
+ - Deal correctly with 64 bit PCI address registers on Linux 2.2.
+ Pointed out by Leonard Zubkoff.
+ - Allow to tune request_irq() flags from the boot command line using
+ ncr53c8xx=irqm:??, as follows:
+ a) If bit 0x10 is set in irqm, SA_SHIRQ flag is not used.
+ b) If bit 0x20 is set in irqm, SA_INTERRUPT flag is not used.
+ By default the driver uses both SA_SHIRQ and SA_INTERRUPT.
+ Option 'ncr53c8xx=irqm:0x20' may be used when an IRQ is shared by
+ a 53C8XX adapter and a network board.
+ - Tiny mispelling fixed (ABORT instead of ABRT). Was fortunately
+ harmless.
+ - Negotiate SYNC data transfers with CCS devices.
+
+Sat Jan 16 17:30 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.1f
+ - Some PCI fix-ups not needed any more for PPC (from Cort).
+ - Cache line size set to 16 DWORDS for Sparc (from DSM).
+ - Waiting list look-up didn't work for the first command of the list.
+ - Remove 2 useless lines of code.
+
+Sun Dec 13 18:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.1e
+ - Same work-around as for the 53c876 rev <= 0x15 for 53c896 rev 1:
+ Disable overlapped arbitration. This will not make difference
+ since the chip has on-chip RAM.
+
+Thu Nov 26 22:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.1d
+ - The SISL RAID change requires now remap_pci_mem() stuff to be
+ compiled for __i386__ when normal IOs are used.
+ - Minor spelling fixes in doc files.
+
+Sat Nov 21 18:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.1c
+ - Ignore chips that are driven by SISL RAID (DAC 960).
+ Change sent by Leonard Zubkoff and slightly reworked.
+ - Still a buglet in the tags initial settings that needed to be fixed.
+ It was not possible to disable TGQ at system startup for devices
+ that claim TGQ support. The driver used at least 2 for the queue
+ depth but did'nt keep track of user settings for tags depth lower
+ than 2.
+
+Wed Nov 11 10:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.1b
+ - The driver was unhappy when configured with default_tags > MAX_TAGS
+ Hopefully doubly-fixed.
+ - Update the Configure.help driver section that speaks of TAGS.
+
+Wed Oct 21 21:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.1a
+ - Changes from Eddie Dost for Sparc and Alpha:
+ ioremap/iounmap support for Sparc.
+ pcivtophys changed to bus_dvma_to_phys.
+ - Add the 53c876 description to the chip table. This is only useful
+ for printing the right name of the controller.
+ - DEL-441 Item 2 work-around for the 53c876 rev <= 5 (0x15).
+ - Add additional checking of INQUIRY data:
+ Check INQUIRY data received length is at least 7. Byte 7 of
+ inquiry data contains device features bits and the driver might
+ be confused by garbage. Also check peripheral qualifier.
+ - Cleanup of the SCSI tasks management:
+ Remove the special case for 32 tags. Now the driver only uses the
+ scheme that allows up to 64 tags per LUN.
+ Merge some code from the 896 driver.
+ Use a 1,3,5,...MAXTAGS*2+1 tag numbering. Previous driver could
+ use any tag number from 1 to 253 and some non conformant devices
+ might have problems with large tag numbers.
+ - 'no_sync' changed to 'no_disc' in the README file. This is an old
+ and trivial mistake that seems to demonstrate the README file is
+ not often read. :)
+
+Sun Oct 4 14:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.0i
+ - Cosmetic changes for sparc (but not for the driver) that needs
+ __irq_itoa() to be used for printed IRQ value to be understandable.
+ - Some problems with the driver that didn't occur using driver 2.5f
+ were due to a SCSI selection problem triggered by a clearly
+ documented feature that in fact seems not to work: (53C8XX chips
+ are claimed by the manuals to be able to execute SCSI scripts just
+ after abitration while the SCSI core is performing SCSI selection).
+ This optimization is broken and has been removed.
+ - Some broken scsi devices are confused when a negotiation is started
+ on a LUN that does not correspond to a real device. According to
+ SCSI specs, this is a device firmware bug. This has been worked
+ around by only starting negotiation if the LUN has previously be
+ used for at least 1 successful SCSI command.
+ - The 'last message sent' printed out on M_REJECT message reception
+ was read from the SFBR i/o register after the previous message had
+ been sent.
+ This was not correct and affects all previous driver versions and
+ the original FreeBSD one as well. The SCSI scripts has been fixed
+ so that it now provides the right information to the C code.
+
+Sat Jul 18 13:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.0g
+ - Preliminary fixes for Big Endian (sent by Eddie C. Dost).
+ Big Endian architectures should work again with the driver.
+ Eddie's patch has been partially applied since current 2.1.109
+ does not have all the Sparc changes of the vger tree.
+ - Use of BITS_PER_LONG instead of (~0UL == 0xffffffffUL) has fixed
+ the problem observed when the driver was compiled using EGCS or
+ PGCC.
+
+Mon Jul 13 20:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.0f
+ - Some spelling fixes.
+ - linux/config.h misplaced in ncr53c8xx.h
+ - MODULE_PARM stuff added for linux 2.1.
+ - check INQUIRY response data format is exactly 2.
+ - use BITS_PER_LONG if defined.
+
+Sun Jun 28 12:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.0e
+ - Some cleanup, spelling fixes, version checks, documentations
+ changes, etc ...
+
+Sat Jun 20 20:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.0c
+ - Add a boot setup option that allows to set up device queue depths
+ at boot-up. This option is very useful since Linux does not
+ allow to change scsi device queue depth once the system has been
+ booted up.
+
+Sun Jun 15 23:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.0a
+ - Support for up to 64 TAGS per LUN.
+ - Rewrite the TARGET vs LUN capabilities management.
+ CmdQueue is now handled as a LUN capability as it shall be.
+ This also fixes a bug triggered when disabling tagged command
+ queuing for a device that had this feature enabled.
+ - Remove the ncr_opennings() stuff that was useless under Linux
+ and hard to understand to me.
+ - Add "setverbose" procfs driver command. It allows to tune
+ verbose level after boot-up. Setting this level to zero, for
+ example avoid flooding the syslog file.
+ - Add KERN_XXX to some printk's.
+
+Tue Jun 10 23:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 3.0
+ - Linux config changes for 2.0.34:
+ Remove NVRAM detection config option. This option is now enabled
+ by default but can be disabled by editing the driver header file.
+ Add a PROFILE config option.
+ - Update Configure.help
+ - Add calls to new function mdelay() for milli-seconds delay if
+ kernel version >= 2.1.105.
+ - Replace all printf(s) by printk(s). After all, the ncr53c8xx is
+ a driver for Linux.
+ - Perform auto-sense on COMMAND TERMINATED. Not sure it is useful.
+ - Some other minor changes.
+
+Tue Jun 4 23:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6n
+ - Code cleanup and simplification:
+ Remove kernel 1.2.X and 1.3.X support.
+ Remove the _old_ target capabilities table.
+ Remove the error recovery code that have'nt been really useful.
+ Use a single alignment boundary (CACHE_LINE_SIZE) for data
+ structures.
+ - Several aggressive SCRIPTS optimizations and changes:
+ Reselect SCRIPTS code rewritten.
+ Support for selection/reselection without ATN.
+ And some others.
+ - Miscallaneous changes in the C code:
+ Count actual number of CCB queued to the controller (future use).
+ Lots of other minor changes.
+
+Wed May 13 20:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6m
+ - Problem of missed SCSI bus reset with the 53C895 fixed by
+ Richard Waltham. The 53C895 needs about 650 us for the bus
+ mode to settle. Delays used while resetting the controller
+ and the bus have been adjusted. Thanks Richard!
+ - Some simplification for 64 bit arch done ccb address testing.
+ - Add a check of the MSG_OUT phase after Selection with ATN.
+ - The new tagged queue stuff seems ok, so some informationnal
+ message have been conditionned by verbose >= 3.
+ - Donnot reset if a SBMC interrupt reports the same bus mode.
+ - Print out the whole driver set-up. Some options were missing and
+ the print statement was misplaced for modules.
+ - Ignore a SCSI parity interrupt if the chip is not connected to
+ the SCSI bus.
+
+Sat May 1 16:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6l
+ - Add CCB done queue support for Alpha and perhaps some other
+ architectures.
+ - Add some barriers to enforce memory ordering for x86 and
+ Alpha architectures.
+ - Fix something that looks like an old bug in the nego SIR
+ interrupt code in case of negotiation failure.
+
+Sat Apr 25 21:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6k
+ - Remove all accesses to the on-chip RAM from the C code:
+ Use SCRIPTS to load the on-chip RAM.
+ Use SCRIPTS to repair the start queue on selection timeout.
+ Use the copy of script in main memory to calculate the chip
+ context on phase mismatch.
+ - The above allows now to use the on-chip RAM without requiring
+ to get access to the on-chip RAM from the C code. This makes
+ on-chip RAM useable for linux-1.2.13 and for Linux-Alpha for
+ instance.
+ - Some simplifications and cleanups in the SCRIPTS and C code.
+ - Buglet fixed in parity error recovery SCRIPTS (never tested).
+ - Minor updates in README.ncr53c8xx.
+
+Wed Apr 15 21:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6j
+ - Incorporate changes from linux-2.1.95 ncr53c8xx driver version.
+ - Add SMP support for linux-2.1.95 and above.
+ - Fix a bug when QUEUE FULL is returned and no commands are
+ disconnected. This happens with Atlas I / L912 and may happen
+ with Atlas II / LXY4.
+ - Nail another one on CHECK condition when requeuing the command
+ for auto-sense.
+ - Call scsi_done() for all completed commands after interrupt
+ handling.
+ - Increase the done queue to 24 entries.
+
+Sat Apr 4 20:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6i
+ - CTEST0 is used by the 53C885 for Power Management and
+ priority setting between the 2 functions.
+ Use SDID instead as actual target number. Just have had to
+ overwrite it with SSID on reselection.
+ - Split DATA_IN and DATA_OUT scripts into 2 sub-scripts.
+ 64 segments are moved from on-chip RAM scripts.
+ If more segments, a script in main memory is used for the
+ additional segments.
+ - Since the SCRIPTS processor continues SCRIPTS execution after
+ having won arbitration, do some stuff prior to testing any SCSI
+ phase on reselection. This should have the vertue to process
+ scripts in parallel with the SCSI core performing selection.
+ - Increase the done queue to 12 entries.
+
+Sun Mar 29 12:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6h
+ - Some fixes.
+
+Tue Mar 26 23:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6g
+ - New done queue. 8 entries by default (6 always useable).
+ Can be increased if needed.
+ - Resources management using doubly linked queues.
+ - New auto-sense and QUEUE FULL handling that does not need to
+ stall the NCR queue any more.
+ - New CCB starvation avoiding algorithm.
+ - Prepare CCBs for SCSI commands that cannot be queued, instead of
+ inserting these commands into the waiting list. The waiting list
+ is now only used while resetting and when memory for CCBs is not
+ yet available?
+
+Sun Feb 8 22:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6f
+ - Some fixes in order to really support the 53C895, at least with
+ FAST-20 devices.
+ - Heavy changes in the target/lun resources management to allow
+ the scripts to jump directly to the CCB on reselection instead
+ of walking on the lun CCBs list. Up to 32 tags per lun are now
+ supported without script processor and PCI traffic overhead.
+
+Sun Jan 11 22:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * revision 2.6d
+ - new (different ?) implementation of the start queue:
+ Use a simple CALL to a launch script in the CCB.
+ - implement a minimal done queue (1 entry :-) ).
+ this avoid scanning all CCBs on INT FLY (Only scan all CCBs, on
+ overflow). Hit ratio is better than 99.9 % on my system, so no
+ need to have a larger done queue.
+ - generalization of the restart of CCB on special condition as
+ Abort, QUEUE FULL, CHECK CONDITION.
+ This has been called 'silly scheduler'.
+ - make all the profiling code conditionned by a config option.
+ This spare some PCI traffic and C code when this feature is not
+ needed.
+ - handle more cleanly the situation where direction is unknown.
+ The pointers patching is now performed by the SCRIPTS processor.
+ - remove some useless scripts instructions.
+
+ Ported from driver 2.5 series:
+ ------------------------------
+ - Use FAST-5 instead of SLOW for slow scsi devices according to
+ new SPI-2 draft.
+ - Make some changes in order to accommodate with 875 rev <= 3
+ device errata listing 397. Minor consequences are:
+ . Leave use of PCI Write and Invalidate under user control.
+ Now, by default the driver does not enable PCI MWI and option
+ 'specf:y' is required in order to enable this feature.
+ . Memory Read Line is not enabled for 875 and 875-like chips.
+ . Programmed burst length set to 64 DWORDS (instead of 128).
+ (Note: SYMBIOS uses 32 DWORDS for the SDMS BIOS)
+ - Add 'buschk' boot option.
+ This option enables checking of SCSI BUS data lines after SCSI
+ RESET (set by default). (Submitted by Richard Waltham).
+ - Update the README file.
+ - Dispatch CONDITION MET and RESERVATION CONFLICT scsi status
+ as OK driver status.
+ - Update the README file and the Symbios NVRAM format definition
+ with removable media flags values (available with SDMS 4.09).
+ - Several PCI configuration registers fix-ups for powerpc.
+ (Patch sent by Cort).
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.sym53c8xx b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.sym53c8xx
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..ef985ec348e6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.sym53c8xx
@@ -0,0 +1,593 @@
+Sat May 12 12:00 2001 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.7.3c
+ - Ensure LEDC bit in GPCNTL is cleared when reading the NVRAM.
+ Fix sent by Stig Telfer <stig@api-networks.com>.
+ - Backport from SYM-2 the work-around that allows to support
+ hardwares that fail PCI parity checking.
+ - Check that we received at least 8 bytes of INQUIRY response
+ for byte 7, that contains device capabilities, to be valid.
+ - Define scsi_set_pci_device() as nil for kernel < 2.4.4.
+ - + A couple of minor changes.
+
+Sat Apr 7 19:30 2001 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.7.3b
+ - Fix an unaligned LOAD from scripts (was used as dummy read).
+ - In ncr_soft_reset(), only try to ABORT the current operation
+ for chips that support SRUN bit in ISTAT1 and if SCRIPTS are
+ currently running, as 896 and 1010 manuals suggest.
+ - In the CCB abort path, do not assume that the CCB is currently
+ queued to SCRIPTS. This is not always true, notably after a
+ QUEUE FULL status or when using untagged commands.
+
+Sun Mar 4 18:30 2001 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.7.3a
+ - Fix an issue in the ncr_int_udc() (unexpected disconnect)
+ handling. If the DSA didn't match a CCB, a bad write to
+ memory could happen.
+
+Mon Feb 12 22:30 2001 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.7.3
+ - Support for hppa.
+ Tiny patch sent to me by Robert Hirst.
+ - Tiny patch for ia64 sent to me by Pamela Delaney.
+
+Tue Feb 6 13:30 2001 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.7.3-pre1
+ - Call pci_enable_device() as AC wants this to be done.
+ - Get both the BAR cookies used by CPU and actual PCI BAR
+ values used from SCRIPTS. Recent PCI chips are able to
+ access themselves using internal cycles, but they compare
+ BAR values to destination address to make decision.
+ Earlier chips simply use PCI transactions to access IO
+ registers from SCRIPTS.
+ The bus_dvma_to_mem() interface that reverses the actual
+ PCI BAR value from the BAR cookie is now useless.
+ This point had been discussed at the list and the solution
+ got approved by PCI code maintainer (Martin Mares).
+ - Merge changes for linux-2.4 that declare the host template
+ in the driver object also when the driver is statically
+ linked with the kernel.
+ - Increase SCSI message size up to 12 bytes, given that 8
+ bytes was not enough for the PPR message (fix).
+ - Add field 'maxoffs_st' (max offset for ST data transfers).
+ The C1010 supports offset 62 in DT mode but only 31 in
+ ST mode, to 2 different values for the max SCSI offset
+ are needed. Replace the obviously wrong masking of the
+ offset against 0x1f for ST mode by a lowering to
+ maxoffs_st of the SCSI offset in ST mode.
+ - Refine a work-around for the C1010-66. Revision 1 does
+ not requires extra cycles in DT DATA OUT phase.
+ - Add a missing endian-ization (abrt_tbl.addr).
+ - Minor clean-up in the np structure for fields accessed
+ from SCRIPTS that requires special alignments.
+
+Sun Sep 24 21:30 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.7.2
+ - Remove the hack for PPC added in previous driver version.
+ - Add FE_DAC feature bit to distinguish between 64 bit PCI
+ addressing (FE_DAC) and 64 bit PCI interface (FE_64BIT).
+ - Get rid of the boot command line "ultra:" argument.
+ This parameter wasn't that clever since we can use "sync:"
+ for Ultra/Ultra2 settings, and for Ultra3 we may want to
+ pass PPR options (for now only DT clocking).
+ - Add FE_VARCLK feature bit that indicates that SCSI clock
+ frequency may vary depending on board design and thus,
+ the driver should try to evaluate the SCSI clock.
+ - Simplify the way the driver determine the SCSI clock:
+ ULTRA3 -> 160 MHz, ULTRA2 -> 80 MHz otherwise 40 MHz.
+ Measure the SCSI clock frequency if FE_VARCLK is set.
+ - Remove FE_CLK80 feature bit that got useless.
+ - Add support for the SYM53C875A (Pamela Delaney).
+
+Wed Jul 26 23:30 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.7.1
+ - Provide OpenFirmare path through the proc FS on PPC.
+ - Download of on-chip SRAM using memcpy_toio() doesn't work
+ on PPC. Restore previous method (MEMORY MOVE from SCRIPTS).
+ - Remove trailing argument #2 from a couple of #undefs.
+
+Sun Jul 09 16:30 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.7.0
+ - Remove the PROFILE C and SCRIPTS code.
+ This facility was not this useful and thus was not longer
+ desirable given the increasing complexity of the driver code.
+ - Merges from FreeBSD sym-1.6.2 driver:
+ * Clarify memory barriers needed by the driver for architectures
+ that implement a weak memory ordering.
+ * Simpler handling of illegal phases and data overrun from
+ SCRIPTS. These errors are now immediately reported to
+ the C code by an interrupt.
+ * Sync the residual handling code with sym-1.6.2 and now
+ report `resid' to user for linux version >= 2.3.99
+ - General cleanup:
+ Move definitions for barriers and IO/MMIO operations to the
+ sym53c8xx_defs.h header files. They are now shared by the
+ both drivers.
+ Remove unused options that claimed to optimize for the 896.
+ If fact, they were not this clever. :)
+ Use SCSI_NCR_IOMAPPED instead of NCR_IOMAPPED.
+ Remove a couple of unused fields from data structures.
+
+Thu May 11 12:40 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.6b
+ - Merged version.
+
+Mon Apr 24 12:00 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5m
+ - Return value 1 (instead of 0) from the driver setup routine.
+ - Do not enable PCI DAC cycles. This just broke support for
+ SYM534C896 on sparc64. Problem fixed by David S. Miller.
+
+Fri Apr 14 9:00 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.6b-9
+ - Added 53C1010_66 support.
+ - Small fix to integrity checking code.
+ - Removed requirement for integrity checking if want to run
+ at ultra 3.
+
+Sat Apr 1 12:00 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5l
+ - Tiny change for __sparc__ appeared in 2.3.99-pre4.1 that
+ applies to cache line size (? Probably from David S Miller).
+ - Make sure no data transfer will happen for Scsi_Cmnd requests
+ that supply SCSI_DATA_NONE direction (this avoids some BUG()
+ statement in the PCI code when a data buffer is also supplied).
+
+Sat Mar 11 12:00 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.6b-5
+ - Test against expected data transfer direction from SCRIPTS.
+ - Add support for the new dynamic dma mapping kernel interface.
+ Requires Linux-2.3.47 (tested with pre-2.3.47-6).
+ Many thanks to David S. Miller for his preliminary changes
+ that have been useful guidelines.
+ - Get data transfer direction from the scsi command structure
+ (Scsi_Cmnd) with kernels that provide this information.
+
+Mon Mar 6 23:30 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5k
+ - Test against expected data transfer direction from SCRIPTS.
+ - Revert the change in 'ncr_flush_done_cmds()' but unmap the
+ scsi dma buffer prior to queueing the command to our done
+ list.
+ - Miscellaneous (minor) fixes in the code added in driver
+ version 1.5j.
+
+Mon Feb 14 4:00 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * version sym53c8xx-pre-1.6b-2.
+ - Updated the SCRIPTS error handling of the SWIDE
+ condition - to remove any reads of the sbdl
+ register. Changes needed because the 896 and 1010
+ chips will check parity in some special circumstances.
+ This will cause a parity error interrupt if not in
+ data phase. Changes based on those made in the
+ FreeBSD driver version 1.3.2.
+
+Sun Feb 20 11:00 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5j
+ - Add support for the new dynamic dma mapping kernel interface.
+ Requires Linux-2.3.47 (tested with pre-2.3.47-6).
+ Many thanks to David S. Miller for his preliminary changes
+ that have been useful guidelines, for having reviewed the
+ code and having tested this driver version on Ultra-Sparc.
+ - 2 tiny bugs fixed in the PCI wrapper that provides support
+ for early kernels without pci device structure.
+ - Get data transfer direction from the scsi command structure
+ (Scsi_Cmnd) with kernels that provide this information.
+ - Fix an old bug that only affected 896 rev. 1 when driver
+ profile support option was set in kernel configuration.
+
+Fri Jan 14 14:00 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * version sym53c8xx-pre-1.6b-1.
+ - Merge parallel driver series 1.61 and 1.5e
+
+Tue Jan 11 14:00 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.61
+ - Added support for mounting disks on wide-narrow-wide
+ scsi configurations.
+ - Modified offset to be a maximum of 31 in ST mode,
+ 62 in DT mode.
+ - Based off of 1.60
+
+Mon Jan 10 10:00 2000 Pam Delaney (pam.delaney@lsil.com)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.60
+ - Added capability to use the integrity checking code
+ in the kernel (optional).
+ - Added PPR negotiation.
+ - Added support for 53C1010 Ultra 3 part.
+ - Based off of 1.5f
+
+Sat Jan 8 22:00 2000 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5h
+ - Add year 2000 copyright.
+ - Display correctly bus signals when bus is detected wrong.
+ - Some fix for Sparc from DSM that went directly to kernel tree.
+
+Mon Dec 6 22:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5g
+ - Change messages written by the driver at initialisation and
+ through the /proc FS (rather cosmetic changes that consist in
+ printing out the PCI bus number and PCI device/function).
+ - Ensure the SCRIPTS processor is stopped while calibrating the
+ SCSI clock (the initialisation code has been a bit reworked).
+ Change moved to the FreeBSD sym_hipd driver).
+ - Some fixes in the MODIFY_DP/IGN_RESIDUE code and residual
+ calculation (moved from FreeBSD sym_hipd driver).
+ - Add NVRAM support for Tekram boards that use 24C16 EEPROM.
+ Code moved from the FreeBSD sym_hipd driver, since it has
+ been that one that got this feature first.
+ - Definitely disable overlapped PCI arbitration for all dual
+ function chips, since I cannot make sure for what chip revisions
+ it is actually safe.
+ - Add support for the SYM53C1510D (also for ncr53c8xx).
+ - Fix up properly the PCI latency timer when needed or asked for.
+ - Get rid of the old PCI bios interface, but preserve kernel 2.0
+ compatibility from a simple wrapper.
+ - Update the poor Tekram sync factor table.
+ - Fix in a tiny 'printk' bug that may oops in case of extended
+ errors (unrecovered parity error, data overrun, etc ...)
+ (Sent by Pamela Delaney from LSILOGIC)
+ - Remove the compilation condition about having to acquire the
+ io_request_lock since it seems to be a definite feature now.:)
+ - Change get_pages by GetPages since Linux >= 2.3.27 now wants
+ get_pages to ever be used as a kernel symbol (from 2.3.27).
+ - proc_dir structure no longer needed for kernel >= 2.3.27.
+
+Sun Oct 3 19:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5f
+ - Change the way the driver checks the PCI clock frequency, so
+ that overclocked PCI BUS up to 48 MHz will not be refused.
+ The more the BUS is overclocked, the less the driver will
+ guarantee that its measure of the SCSI clock is correct.
+ - Backport some minor improvements of SCRIPTS from the sym_hipd
+ driver.
+ - Backport the code rewrite of the START QUEUE dequeuing (on
+ bad scsi status received) from the sym_hipd driver.
+
+Sat Sep 11 11:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5e
+ - New linux-2.3.13 __setup scheme support added.
+ - Cleanup of the extended error status handling:
+ Use 1 bit per error type.
+ - Also save the extended error status prior to auto-sense.
+ - Add the FE_DIFF chip feature bit to indicate support of
+ diff probing from GPIO3 (825/825A/876/875).
+ - Remove the quirk handling that has been useless since day one.
+ - Work-around PCI chips being reported twice on some platforms.
+ - Add some redundant PCI reads in order to deal with common
+ bridge misbehaviour regarding posted write flushing.
+ - Add some other conditionnal code for people who have to deal
+ with really broken bridges (they will have to edit a source
+ file to try these options).
+ - Handle correctly (hopefully) jiffies wrap-around.
+ - Restore the entry used to detect 875 until revision 0xff.
+ (I removed it inadvertently, it seems :) )
+ - Replace __initfunc() which is deprecated stuff by __init which
+ is not yet so. ;-)
+ - Rewrite the MESSAGE IN scripts more generic by using a MOVE
+ table indirect. Extended messages of any size are accepted now.
+ (Size is limited to 8 for now, but a constant is just to be
+ increased if necessary)
+ - Fix some bug in the fully untested MDP handling:) and share
+ some code between MDP handling and residual calculation.
+ - Calculate the data transfer residual as the 2's complement
+ integer (A positive value in returned on data overrun, and
+ a negative one on underrun).
+ - Add support of some 'resource handling' for linux-2.3.13.
+ Basically the BARs have been changed to something more complex
+ in the pci_dev structure.
+ - Remove some deprecated code.
+
+Sat Jun 5 11:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5c
+ - Do not negotiate on auto-sense if we are currently using 8 bit
+ async transfer for the target.
+ - Only check for SISL/RAID on i386 platforms.
+ (A problem has been reported on PPC with that code).
+ - On MSG REJECT for a negotiation, the driver attempted to restart
+ the SCRIPT processor when this one was already running.
+
+Sat May 29 12:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5b
+ - Force negotiation prior auto-sense.
+ This ensures that the driver will be able to grab the sense data
+ from a device that has received a BUS DEVICE RESET message from
+ another initiator.
+ - Complete all disconnected CCBs for a logical UNIT if we are told
+ about a UNIT ATTENTION for a RESET condition by this target.
+ - Add the control command 'cleardev' that allows to send a ABORT
+ message to a logical UNIT (for test purpose).
+
+Tue May 25 23:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5a
+ - Add support for task abort and bus device reset SCSI message
+ and implement proper synchonisation with SCRIPTS to handle
+ correctly task abortion without races.
+ - Send an ABORT message (if untagged) or ABORT TAG message (if tagged)
+ when the driver is told to abort a command that is disconnected and
+ complete the command with appropriate error.
+ If the aborted command is not yet started, remove it from the start
+ queue and complete it with error.
+ - Add the control command 'resetdev' that allows to send a BUS
+ DEVICE RESET message to a target (for test purpose).
+ - Clean-up some unused or useless code.
+
+Fri May 21 23:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.5
+ - Add support for CHMOV with Wide controllers.
+ - Handling of the SWIDE (low byte residue at the end of a CHMOV
+ in DATA IN phase with WIDE transfer when the byte count gets odd).
+ - Handling of the IGNORE WIDE RESIDUE message.
+ Handled from SCRIPTS as possible with some optimizations when both
+ a wide device and the controller are odd at the same time (SWIDE
+ present and IGNORE WIDE RESIDUE message on the BUS at the same time).
+ - Check against data OVERRUN/UNDERRUN condition at the end of a data
+ transfer, whatever a SWIDE is present (OVERRUN in DATA IN phase)
+ or the SODL is full (UNDERRUN in DATA out phase).
+ - Handling of the MODIFY DATA POINTER message.
+ This one cannot be handled from SCRIPTS, but hopefully it will not
+ happen very often. :)
+ - Large rewrite of the SCSI MESSAGE handling.
+
+Sun May 9 11:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.4
+ - Support for IMMEDIATE ARBITRATION.
+ See the README file for detailed information about this feature.
+ Requires both a compile option and a boot option.
+ - Minor SCRIPTS optimization in reselection pattern for LUN 0.
+ - Simpler algorithm to deal with SCSI command starvation.
+ Just use 2 tag counters in flip/flop and switch to the other
+ one every 3 seconds.
+ - Do some work in SCRIPTS after the SELECT instruction and prior
+ to testing for a PHASE. SYMBIOS say this feature is working fine.
+ (Btw, only problems with Toshiba 3401B had been reported).
+ - Measure the PCI clock speed and do not attach controllers if
+ result is greater than 37 MHz. Since the precision of the
+ algorithm (from Stefan Esser) is better than 2%, this should
+ be fine.
+ - Fix the misdetection of SYM53C875E (was detected as a 876).
+ - Fix the misdetection of SYM53C810 not A (was detected as a 810A).
+ - Support for up to 256 TAGS per LUN (CMD_PER_LUN).
+ Currently limited to 255 due to Linux limitation. :)
+ - Support for up to 508 active commands (CAN_QUEUE).
+ - Support for the 53C895A by Pamela Delaney <pam.delaney@lsil.com>
+ The 53C895A contains all of the features of the 896 but has only
+ one channel and has a 32 bit PCI bus. It does 64 bit PCI addressing
+ using dual cycle PCI data transfers.
+ - Miscellaneous minor fixes.
+ - Some additions to the README.ncr53c8xx file.
+
+Tue Apr 15 10:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.3e
+ - Support for any number of LUNs (64) (SPI2-compliant).
+ (Btw, this may only be ever useful under linux-2.2 ;-))
+
+Sun Apr 11 10:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.3d
+ - Add 'hostid:#id' boot option. This option allows to change the
+ default SCSI id the driver uses for controllers.
+ - Make SCRIPTS not use self-mastering for PCI.
+ There were still 2 places the driver used this feature of the
+ 53C8XX family.
+ - Move some data structures (nvram layouts and driver set-up) to
+ the sym53c8xx_defs.h file. So, the both drivers will share them.
+ - Set MAX LUNS to 16 (instead of 8).
+
+Sat Mar 20 21:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.3b
+ - Add support for NCR PQS PDS.
+ James Bottomley <James.Bottomley@columbiasc.ncr.com>
+ - Allow value 0 for host ID.
+ - Support more than 8 controllers (> 40 in fact :-) )
+ - Add 'excl=#ioaddr' boot option: exclude controller.
+ (Version 1.3a driver)
+
+Thu Mar 11 23:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.3 (8xx-896 driver bundle)
+ - Equivalent changes as ncr53c8xx-3.2 due to the driver bundle.
+ (See Changelog.ncr53c8xx)
+ - Do a normal soft reset as first chip reset, since aborting current
+ operation may raise an interrupt we are not able to handle since
+ the interrupt handler is not yet established.
+
+Sat Mar 6 11:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.2b
+ - Fix some oooold bug that hangs the bus if a device rejects a
+ negotiation. Btw, the corresponding stuff also needed some cleanup
+ and thus the change is a bit larger than it could have been.
+ - Still some typo that made compilation fail for 64 bit (trivial fix).
+
+Sun Feb 21 20:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.2a
+ - The rewrite of the interrupt handling broke the SBMC interrupt
+ handling due to a 1 bit mask tiny error. Hopefully fixed.
+ - If INQUIRY came from a scatter list, the driver looked into
+ the scatterlist instead of the data.:) Since this should never
+ happen, we just discard the data if use_sg is not zero.
+
+Fri Feb 12 23:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.2
+ - Major rewrite of the interrupt handling and recovery stuff for
+ the support of non compliant SCSI removal, insertion and all
+ kinds of screw-up that may happen on the SCSI BUS.
+ Hopefully, the driver is now unbreakable or may-be, it is just
+ quite brocken. :-)
+ Many thanks to Johnson Russel (Symbios) for having responded to
+ my questions and for his interesting advices and comments about
+ support of SCSI hot-plug.
+ - Add 'recovery' option to driver set-up.
+ - Negotiate SYNC data transfers with CCS devices.
+ - Deal correctly with 64 bit PCI address registers on Linux 2.2.
+ Pointed out by Leonard Zubkoff.
+
+Sun Jan 31 18:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.1a
+ - Some 896 chip revisions (all for now :-)), may hang-up if the
+ soft reset bit is set at the wrong time while SCRIPTS are running.
+ We need to first abort the current SCRIPTS operation prior to
+ resetting the chip. This fix has been sent to me by SYMBIOS/LSI
+ and I just translated it into ncr53c8xx syntax.
+ Must be considered 100 % trustable, unless I did some mistake
+ when translating it. :-)
+
+Sun Jan 24 18:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.1
+ - Major rewrite of the SCSI parity error handling.
+ The informations contained in the data manuals are incomplete about
+ this feature.
+ I asked SYMBIOS about and got in reply the explanations that are
+ _indeed_ missing in the data manuals.
+ - Allow to tune request_irq() flags from the boot command line using
+ ncr53c8xx=irqm:??, as follows:
+ a) If bit 0x10 is set in irqm, SA_SHIRQ flag is not used.
+ b) If bit 0x20 is set in irqm, SA_INTERRUPT flag is not used.
+ By default the driver uses both SA_SHIRQ and SA_INTERRUPT.
+ Option 'ncr53c8xx=irqm:0x20' may be used when an IRQ is shared by
+ a 53C8XX adapter and a network board.
+ - Fix for 64 bit PCI address register calculation. (Lance Robinson)
+ - Fix for big-endian in phase mismatch handling. (Michal Jaegermann)
+
+Fri Jan 1 20:00 1999 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.0a
+ - Waiting list look-up didn't work for the first command of the list.
+ Hopefully fixed, but tested on paper only. ;)
+ - Remove the most part of PPC specific code for Linux-2.2.
+ Thanks to Cort.
+ - Some other minors changes.
+
+Sat Dec 19 21:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version sym53c8xx-1.0
+ - Define some new IO registers for the 896 (istat1, mbox0, mbox1)
+ - Revamp slighly the Symbios NVRAM lay-out based on the excerpt of
+ the header file I received from Symbios.
+ - Check the PCI bus number for the boot order (Using a fast
+ PCI controller behing a PCI-PCI bridge seems sub-optimal).
+ - Disable overlapped PCI arbitration for the 896 revision 1.
+ - Reduce a bit the number of IO register reads for phase mismatch
+ by reading DWORDS at a time instead of BYTES.
+
+Thu Dec 3 24:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.18
+ - I received this afternoon a 896 from SYMBIOS and started testing
+ the driver with this beast. After having fixed 3 buglets, it worked
+ with all features enabled including the phase mismatch handling
+ from SCRIPTS. Since this feature is not yet tested enough, the
+ boot option 'ncr53c8xx=specf:1' is still required to enable the
+ driver to handle PM from SCRIPTS.
+
+Sun Nov 29 18:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.17
+ - The SISL RAID change requires now remap_pci_mem() stuff to be
+ compiled for __i386__ when normal IOs are used.
+ - The PCI memory read from SCRIPTS that should ensure ordering
+ was in fact misplaced. BTW, this may explain why broken PCI
+ device drivers regarding ordering are working so well. ;-)
+ - Rewrite ncr53c8xx_setup (boot command line options) since the
+ binary code was a bit too bloated in my opinion.
+ - Make the code simpler in the wakeup_done routine.
+
+Tue Nov 24 23:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.16
+ - Add SCSI_NCR_OPTIMIZE_896_1 compile option and 'optim' boot option.
+ When set, the driver unconditionnaly assumes that the interrupt
+ handler is called for command completion, then clears INTF, scans
+ the done queue and returns if some completed CCB is found. If no
+ completed CCB are found, interrupt handling will proceed normally.
+ With a 896 that handles MA from SCRIPTS, this can be a great win,
+ since the driver will never performs PCI read transactions, but
+ only PCI write transactions that may be posted.
+ If the driver haven't to also raise the SIGP this would be perfect.
+ Even with this penalty, I think that this will work great.
+ Obviously this optimization makes sense only if the IRQ is not
+ shared with another device.
+ - Still a buglet in the tags initial settings that needed to be fixed.
+ It was not possible to disable TGQ at system startup for devices
+ that claim TGQ support. The driver used at least 2 for the queue
+ depth but did'nt keep track of user settings for tags depth lower
+ than 2.
+
+Thu Nov 19 23:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.15
+ - Add support for hardware LED control of the 896.
+ - Ignore chips that are driven by SISL RAID (DAC 960).
+ Change sent by Leonard Zubkoff and slightly reworked.
+ - Prevent 810A rev 11 and 860 rev 1 from using cache line based
+ transactions since those early chip revisions may use such on
+ LOAD/STORE instructions (work-around).
+ - Remove some useless and bloat code from the pci init stuff.
+ - Do not use the readX()/writeX() kernel functions for __i386__,
+ since they perform useless masking operations in order to deal
+ with broken driver in 2.1.X kernel.
+
+Wed Nov 11 10:00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.14
+ - The driver was unhappy when configured with default_tags > MAX_TAGS
+ Hopefully doubly-fixed.
+ - Set PCI_PARITY in PCI_COMMAND register in not set (PCI fix-up).
+ - Print out some message if phase mismatch is handled from SCRIPTS.
+
+Sun Nov 1 14H00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.13
+ - Some rewrite of the device detection code. This code had been
+ patched too much and needed to be face-lifted a bit.
+ Remove all platform dependent fix-ups that was not needed or
+ conflicted with some other driver code as work-arounds.
+ Reread the NVRAM before the calling of ncr_attach(). This spares
+ stack space and so allows to handle more boards.
+ Handle 64 bit base addresses under linux-2.0.X.
+ Set MASTER bit in PCI COMMAND register if not set.
+
+Wed Oct 30 22H00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.12
+ - Damned! I just broke the driver for Alpha by leaving a stale
+ instruction in the source code. Hopefully fixed.
+ - Do not set PFEN when it is useless. Doing so we are sure that BOF
+ will be active, since the manual appears to be very unclear on what
+ feature is actually used by the chip when both PFEN and BOF are
+ set.
+
+Sat Oct 24 16H00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.11
+ - LOAD/STORE instructions were miscompiled for register offsets
+ beyond 0x7f. This broke accesses to 896' new registers.
+ - Disable by default Phase Mismatch handling from SCRIPTS, since
+ current 896 rev.1 seems not to operate safely with the driver
+ when this feature is enabled (and above LOAD/STORE fix applied).
+ I will change the default to 'enabled' when this problem will be
+ solved.
+ Using boot option 'ncr53c8xx=specf:1' enables this feature.
+ - Implement a work-around (DEL 472 - ITEM 5) that should allow the
+ driver to safely enable hardware phase mismatch with 896 rev. 1.
+
+Tue Oct 20 22H00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.10
+ - Add the 53c876 description to the chip table. This is only useful
+ for printing the right name of the controller.
+ - Add additional checking of INQUIRY data:
+ Check INQUIRY data received length is at least 7. Byte 7 of
+ inquiry data contains device features bits and the driver might
+ be confused by garbage. Also check peripheral qualifier.
+ - Use a 1,3,5,...MAXTAGS*2+1 tag numbering. Previous driver could
+ use any tag number from 1 to 253 and some non conformant devices
+ might have problems with large tag numbers.
+ - Use NAME53C and NAME53C8XX for chip name prefix chip family name.
+ Just give a try using "sym53c" and "sym53c8xx" instead of "ncr53c"
+ and "ncr53c8xx". :-)
+
+Sun Oct 11 17H00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.9
+ - DEL-441 Item 2 work-around for the 53c876 rev <= 5 (0x15).
+ - Break ncr_scatter() into 2 functions in order to guarantee best
+ possible code optimization for the case we get a scatter list.
+ - Add the code intended to support up to 1 tera-byte for 64 bit systems.
+ It is probably too early, but I wanted to complete the thing.
+
+Sat Oct 3 14H00 1998 Gerard Roudier (groudier@club-internet.fr)
+ * version pre-sym53c8xx-0.8
+ - Do some testing with io_mapped and fix what needed to be so.
+ - Wait for SCSI selection to complete or time-out immediately after
+ the chip won arbitration, since executing SCRIPTS while the SCSI
+ core is performing SCSI selection breaks the selection procedure
+ at least for some chip revisions.
+ - Interrupt the SCRIPTS if a device does not go to MSG OUT phase after
+ having been selected with ATN. Such a situation is not recoverable,
+ better to fail when we are stuck.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.sym53c8xx_2 b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.sym53c8xx_2
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..18a5d712a56a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ChangeLog.sym53c8xx_2
@@ -0,0 +1,144 @@
+Sat Dec 30 21:30 2000 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.0-20001230
+ - Initial release of SYM-2.
+
+Mon Jan 08 21:30 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.1-20010108
+ - Change a couple of defines containing ncr or NCR by their
+ equivalent containing sym or SYM instead.
+
+Sun Jan 14 22:30 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.2-20010114
+ - Fix a couple of printfs:
+ * Add the target number to the display of transfer parameters.
+ * Make the display of TCQ and queue depth clearer.
+
+Wed Jan 17 23:30 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.3-20010117
+ - Wrong residual values were returned in some situations.
+ This broke cdrecord with linux-2.4.0, for example.
+
+Sat Jan 20 18:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.4-20010120
+ - Add year 2001 to Copyright.
+ - A tiny bug in the dma memory freeing path has been fixed.
+ (Driver unload failed with a bad address reference).
+
+Wed Jan 24 21:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.5-20010124
+ - Make the driver work under Linux-2.4.x when statically linked
+ with the kernel.
+ - Check against memory allocation failure for SCRIPTZ and add the
+ missing free of this memory on instance detach.
+ - Check against GPIO3 pulled low for HVD controllers (driver did
+ just the opposite).
+ Misdetection of BUS mode was triggered on module reload only,
+ since BIOS settings were trusted instead on first load.
+
+Wed Feb 7 21:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.6-20010207
+ - Call pci_enable_device() as wished by kernel maintainers.
+ - Change the sym_queue_scsiio() interface.
+ This is intended to simplify portability.
+ - Move the code intended to deal with the dowloading of SCRIPTS
+ from SCRIPTS :) in the patch method (was wrongly placed in
+ the SCRIPTS setup method).
+ - Add a missing cpu_to_scr() (np->abort_tbl.addr)
+ - Remove a wrong cpu_to_scr() (np->targtbl_ba)
+ - Cleanup a bit the PPR failure recovery code.
+
+Sat Mar 3 21:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ - Add option SYM_OPT_ANNOUNCE_TRANSFER_RATE and move the
+ corresponding code to file sym_misc.c.
+ Also move the code that sniffes INQUIRY to sym_misc.c.
+ This allows to share the corresponding code with NetBSD
+ without polluating the core driver source (sym_hipd.c).
+ - Add optionnal code that handles IO timeouts from the driver.
+ (not used under Linux, but required for NetBSD)
+ - Donnot assume any longer that PAGE_SHIFT and PAGE_SIZE are
+ defined at compile time, as at least NetBSD uses variables
+ in memory for that.
+ - Refine a work-around for the C1010-33 that consists in
+ disabling internal LOAD/STORE. Was applied up to revision 1.
+ Is now only applied to revision 0.
+ - Some code reorganisations due to code moves between files.
+
+Tues Apr 10 21:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.9-20010412
+ - Reset 53C896 and 53C1010 chip according to the manual.
+ (i.e.: set the ABRT bit in ISTAT if SCRIPTS are running)
+ - Set #LUN in request sense only if scsi version <= 2 and
+ #LUN <= 7.
+ - Set busy_itl in LCB to 1 if the LCB is allocated and a
+ SCSI command is active. This is a simplification.
+ - In sym_hcb_free(), do not scan the free_ccbq if no CCBs
+ has been allocated. This fixes a panic if attach failed.
+ - Add DT/ST (double/simple transition) in the transfer
+ negotiation announce.
+ - Forces the max number of tasks per LUN to at least 64.
+ - Use pci_set_dma_mask() for linux-2.4.3 and above.
+ - A couple of comments fixes.
+
+Wed May 22:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.10-20010509
+ - Mask GPCNTL against 0x1c (was 0xfc) for the reading of the NVRAM.
+ This ensure LEDC bit will not be set on 896 and later chips.
+ Fix sent by Chip Salzenberg <chip@perlsupport.com>.
+ - Define the number of PQS BUSes supported.
+ Fix sent by Stig Telfer <stig@api-networks.com>
+ - Miscellaneous common code rearrangements due to NetBSD accel
+ ioctl support, without impact on Linux (hopefully).
+
+Mon July 2 12:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.11-20010702
+ - Add Tekram 390 U2B/U2W SCSI LED handling.
+ Submitted by Chip Salzenberg <chip@valinux.com>
+ - Add call to scsi_set_pci_device() for kernels >= 2.4.4.
+ - Check pci dma mapping failures and complete the IO with some
+ error when such mapping fails.
+ - Fill in instance->max_cmd_len for kernels > 2.4.0.
+ - A couple of tiny fixes ...
+
+Sun Sep 9 18:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.12-20010909
+ - Change my email address.
+ - Add infrastructure for the forthcoming 64 bit DMA addressing support.
+ (Based on PCI 64 bit patch from David S. Miller)
+ - Donnot use anymore vm_offset_t type.
+
+Sat Sep 15 20:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.13-20010916
+ - Add support for 64 bit DMA addressing using segment registers.
+ 16 registers for up to 4 GB x 16 -> 64 GB.
+
+Sat Sep 22 12:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.14-20010922
+ - Complete rewrite of the eh handling. The driver is now using a
+ semaphore in order to behave synchronously as required by the eh
+ threads. A timer is also used to prevent from waiting indefinitely.
+
+Sun Sep 30 17:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.15-20010930
+ - Include <linux/module.h> unconditionnaly as expected by latest
+ kernels.
+ - Use del_timer_sync() for recent kernels to kill the driver timer
+ on module release.
+
+Sun Oct 28 15:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.16-20011028
+ - Slightly simplify driver configuration.
+ - Prepare a new patch against linux-2.4.13.
+
+Sat Nov 17 10:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.17
+ - Fix a couple of gcc/gcc3 warnings.
+ - Allocate separately from the HCB the array for CCBs hashed by DSA.
+ All driver memory allocations are now not greater than 1 PAGE
+ even on PPC64 / 4KB PAGE surprising setup.
+
+Sat Dec 01 18:00 2001 Gerard Roudier
+ * version sym-2.1.17a
+ - Use u_long instead of U32 for the IO base cookie. This is more
+ consistent with what archs are expecting.
+ - Use MMIO per default for Power PC instead of some fake normal IO,
+ as Paul Mackerras stated that MMIO works fine now on this arch.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/FlashPoint.txt b/Documentation/scsi/FlashPoint.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..d5acaa300a46
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/FlashPoint.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,163 @@
+The BusLogic FlashPoint SCSI Host Adapters are now fully supported on Linux.
+The upgrade program described below has been officially terminated effective
+31 March 1997 since it is no longer needed.
+
+
+
+ MYLEX INTRODUCES LINUX OPERATING SYSTEM SUPPORT FOR ITS
+ BUSLOGIC FLASHPOINT LINE OF SCSI HOST ADAPTERS
+
+
+FREMONT, CA, -- October 8, 1996 -- Mylex Corporation has expanded Linux
+operating system support to its BusLogic brand of FlashPoint Ultra SCSI
+host adapters. All of BusLogic's other SCSI host adapters, including the
+MultiMaster line, currently support the Linux operating system. Linux
+drivers and information will be available on October 15th at
+http://www.dandelion.com/Linux/.
+
+"Mylex is committed to supporting the Linux community," says Peter Shambora,
+vice president of marketing for Mylex. "We have supported Linux driver
+development and provided technical support for our host adapters for several
+years, and are pleased to now make our FlashPoint products available to this
+user base."
+
+The Linux Operating System
+
+Linux is a freely-distributed implementation of UNIX for Intel x86, Sun
+SPARC, SGI MIPS, Motorola 68k, Digital Alpha AXP and Motorola PowerPC
+machines. It supports a wide range of software, including the X Window
+System, Emacs, and TCP/IP networking. Further information is available at
+http://www.linux.org and http://www.ssc.com/linux.
+
+FlashPoint Host Adapters
+
+The FlashPoint family of Ultra SCSI host adapters, designed for workstation
+and file server environments, are available in narrow, wide, dual channel,
+and dual channel wide versions. These adapters feature SeqEngine
+automation technology, which minimizes SCSI command overhead and reduces
+the number of interrupts generated to the CPU.
+
+About Mylex
+
+Mylex Corporation (NASDAQ/NM SYMBOL: MYLX), founded in 1983, is a leading
+producer of RAID technology and network management products. The company
+produces high performance disk array (RAID) controllers, and complementary
+computer products for network servers, mass storage systems, workstations
+and system boards. Through its wide range of RAID controllers and its
+BusLogic line of Ultra SCSI host adapter products, Mylex provides enabling
+intelligent I/O technologies that increase network management control,
+enhance CPU utilization, optimize I/O performance, and ensure data security
+and availability. Products are sold globally through a network of OEMs,
+major distributors, VARs, and system integrators. Mylex Corporation is
+headquartered at 34551 Ardenwood Blvd., Fremont, CA.
+
+ ####
+
+Contact:
+
+Peter Shambora
+Vice President of Marketing
+Mylex Corp.
+510/796-6100
+peters@mylex.com
+
+ ANNOUNCEMENT
+ BusLogic FlashPoint LT/BT-948 Upgrade Program
+ 1 February 1996
+
+ ADDITIONAL ANNOUNCEMENT
+ BusLogic FlashPoint LW/BT-958 Upgrade Program
+ 14 June 1996
+
+Ever since its introduction last October, the BusLogic FlashPoint LT has
+been problematic for members of the Linux community, in that no Linux
+drivers have been available for this new Ultra SCSI product. Despite it's
+officially being positioned as a desktop workstation product, and not being
+particularly well suited for a high performance multitasking operating
+system like Linux, the FlashPoint LT has been touted by computer system
+vendors as the latest thing, and has been sold even on many of their high
+end systems, to the exclusion of the older MultiMaster products. This has
+caused grief for many people who inadvertently purchased a system expecting
+that all BusLogic SCSI Host Adapters were supported by Linux, only to
+discover that the FlashPoint was not supported and would not be for quite
+some time, if ever.
+
+After this problem was identified, BusLogic contacted its major OEM
+customers to make sure the BT-946C/956C MultiMaster cards would still be
+made available, and that Linux users who mistakenly ordered systems with
+the FlashPoint would be able to upgrade to the BT-946C. While this helped
+many purchasers of new systems, it was only a partial solution to the
+overall problem of FlashPoint support for Linux users. It did nothing to
+assist the people who initially purchased a FlashPoint for a supported
+operating system and then later decided to run Linux, or those who had
+ended up with a FlashPoint LT, believing it was supported, and were unable
+to return it.
+
+In the middle of December, I asked to meet with BusLogic's senior
+management to discuss the issues related to Linux and free software support
+for the FlashPoint. Rumors of varying accuracy had been circulating
+publicly about BusLogic's attitude toward the Linux community, and I felt
+it was best that these issues be addressed directly. I sent an email
+message after 11pm one evening, and the meeting took place the next
+afternoon. Unfortunately, corporate wheels sometimes grind slowly,
+especially when a company is being acquired, and so it's taken until now
+before the details were completely determined and a public statement could
+be made.
+
+BusLogic is not prepared at this time to release the information necessary
+for third parties to write drivers for the FlashPoint. The only existing
+FlashPoint drivers have been written directly by BusLogic Engineering, and
+there is no FlashPoint documentation sufficiently detailed to allow outside
+developers to write a driver without substantial assistance. While there
+are people at BusLogic who would rather not release the details of the
+FlashPoint architecture at all, that debate has not yet been settled either
+way. In any event, even if documentation were available today it would
+take quite a while for a usable driver to be written, especially since I'm
+not convinced that the effort required would be worthwhile.
+
+However, BusLogic does remain committed to providing a high performance
+SCSI solution for the Linux community, and does not want to see anyone left
+unable to run Linux because they have a Flashpoint LT. Therefore, BusLogic
+has put in place a direct upgrade program to allow any Linux user worldwide
+to trade in their FlashPoint LT for the new BT-948 MultiMaster PCI Ultra
+SCSI Host Adapter. The BT-948 is the Ultra SCSI successor to the BT-946C
+and has all the best features of both the BT-946C and FlashPoint LT,
+including smart termination and a flash PROM for easy firmware updates, and
+is of course compatible with the present Linux driver. The price for this
+upgrade has been set at US $45 plus shipping and handling, and the upgrade
+program will be administered through BusLogic Technical Support, which can
+be reached by electronic mail at techsup@buslogic.com, by Voice at +1 408
+654-0760, or by FAX at +1 408 492-1542.
+
+As of 14 June 1996, the original BusLogic FlashPoint LT to BT-948 upgrade
+program has now been extended to encompass the FlashPoint LW Wide Ultra
+SCSI Host Adapter. Any Linux user worldwide may trade in their FlashPoint
+LW (BT-950) for a BT-958 MultiMaster PCI Ultra SCSI Host Adapter. The
+price for this upgrade has been set at US $65 plus shipping and handling.
+
+I was a beta test site for the BT-948/958, and versions 1.2.1 and 1.3.1 of
+my BusLogic driver already included latent support for the BT-948/958.
+Additional cosmetic support for the Ultra SCSI MultiMaster cards was added
+subsequent releases. As a result of this cooperative testing process,
+several firmware bugs were found and corrected. My heavily loaded Linux
+test system provided an ideal environment for testing error recovery
+processes that are much more rarely exercised in production systems, but
+are crucial to overall system stability. It was especially convenient
+being able to work directly with their firmware engineer in demonstrating
+the problems under control of the firmware debugging environment; things
+sure have come a long way since the last time I worked on firmware for an
+embedded system. I am presently working on some performance testing and
+expect to have some data to report in the not too distant future.
+
+BusLogic asked me to send this announcement since a large percentage of the
+questions regarding support for the FlashPoint have either been sent to me
+directly via email, or have appeared in the Linux newsgroups in which I
+participate. To summarize, BusLogic is offering Linux users an upgrade
+from the unsupported FlashPoint LT (BT-930) to the supported BT-948 for US
+$45 plus shipping and handling, or from the unsupported FlashPoint LW
+(BT-950) to the supported BT-958 for $65 plus shipping and handling.
+Contact BusLogic Technical Support at techsup@buslogic.com or +1 408
+654-0760 to take advantage of their offer.
+
+ Leonard N. Zubkoff
+ lnz@dandelion.com
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.FlashPoint b/Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.FlashPoint
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..ffd0fe226ee2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/LICENSE.FlashPoint
@@ -0,0 +1,60 @@
+ FlashPoint Driver Developer's Kit
+ Version 1.0
+
+ Copyright 1995-1996 by Mylex Corporation
+ All Rights Reserved
+
+This program is free software; you may redistribute and/or modify it under
+the terms of either:
+
+ a) the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
+ Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later version,
+
+ or
+
+ b) the "BSD-style License" included below.
+
+This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
+or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See either the GNU General Public
+License or the BSD-style License below for more details.
+
+You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
+with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
+675 Mass Ave, Cambridge, MA 02139, USA.
+
+The BSD-style License is as follows:
+
+Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are
+met:
+
+1. Redistributions of source code must retain this LICENSE.FlashPoint
+ file, without modification, this list of conditions, and the following
+ disclaimer. The following copyright notice must appear immediately at
+ the beginning of all source files:
+
+ Copyright 1995-1996 by Mylex Corporation. All Rights Reserved
+
+ This file is available under both the GNU General Public License
+ and a BSD-style copyright; see LICENSE.FlashPoint for details.
+
+2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+
+3. The name of Mylex Corporation may not be used to endorse or promote
+ products derived from this software without specific prior written
+ permission.
+
+THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY MYLEX CORP. ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
+IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
+OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN
+NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,
+INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
+(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
+SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
+CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+SUCH DAMAGE.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/Mylex.txt b/Documentation/scsi/Mylex.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..cdf69293f7d5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/Mylex.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+Please see the file README.BusLogic for information about Linux support for
+Mylex (formerly BusLogic) MultiMaster and FlashPoint SCSI Host Adapters.
+
+The Mylex DAC960 PCI RAID Controllers are now supported. Please consult
+http://www.dandelion.com/Linux/ for further information on the DAC960 driver.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/NinjaSCSI.txt b/Documentation/scsi/NinjaSCSI.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..041780f428ac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/NinjaSCSI.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,130 @@
+
+ WorkBiT NinjaSCSI-3/32Bi driver for Linux
+
+1. Comment
+ This is Workbit corp.'s(http://www.workbit.co.jp/) NinjaSCSI-3
+(http://www.workbit.co.jp/ts/z_nj3r.html) and NinjaSCSI-32Bi
+(http://www.workbit.co.jp/ts/z_njsc32bi.html) PCMCIA card driver module
+for Linux.
+
+2. My Linux environment
+Linux kernel: 2.4.7 / 2.2.19
+pcmcia-cs: 3.1.27
+gcc: gcc-2.95.4
+PC card: I-O data PCSC-F (NinjaSCSI-3)
+ I-O data CBSC-II in 16 bit mode (NinjaSCSI-32Bi)
+SCSI device: I-O data CDPS-PX24 (CD-ROM drive)
+ Media Intelligent MMO-640GT (Optical disk drive)
+
+3. Install
+[1] Check your PC card is true "NinjaSCSI-3" card.
+ If you installed pcmcia-cs already, pcmcia reports your card as UNKNOWN
+ card, and write ["WBT", "NinjaSCSI-3", "R1.0"] or some other string to
+ your console or log file.
+ You can also use "cardctl" program (this program is in pcmcia-cs source
+ code) to get more info.
+
+# cat /var/log/messgaes
+...
+Jan 2 03:45:06 lindberg cardmgr[78]: unsupported card in socket 1
+Jan 2 03:45:06 lindberg cardmgr[78]: product info: "WBT", "NinjaSCSI-3", "R1.0"
+...
+# cardctl ident
+Socket 0:
+ no product info available
+Socket 1:
+ product info: "IO DATA", "CBSC16 ", "1"
+
+
+[2] Get Linux kernel source, and extract it to /usr/src.
+ Because NinjaSCSI driver requiers some SCSI header files in Linux kernel
+ source.
+ I recomend rebuilding your kernel. This eliminate some versioning problem.
+$ cd /usr/src
+$ tar -zxvf linux-x.x.x.tar.gz
+$ cd linux
+$ make config
+...
+
+[3] If you use this driver with Kernel 2.2, Unpack pcmcia-cs in some directory
+ and make & install. This driver requies pcmcia-cs header file.
+$ cd /usr/src
+$ tar zxvf cs-pcmcia-cs-3.x.x.tar.gz
+...
+
+[4] Extract this driver's archive somewhere, and edit Makefile, then do make.
+$ tar -zxvf nsp_cs-x.x.tar.gz
+$ cd nsp_cs-x.x
+$ emacs Makefile
+...
+$ make
+
+[5] Copy nsp_cs.o to suitable plase, like /lib/modules/<Kernel version>/pcmcia/ .
+
+[6] Add these lines to /etc/pcmcia/config .
+ If you yse pcmcia-cs-3.1.8 or later, we can use "nsp_cs.conf" file.
+ So, you don't need to edit file. Just copy to /etc/pcmcia/ .
+
+-------------------------------------
+device "nsp_cs"
+ class "scsi" module "nsp_cs"
+
+card "WorkBit NinjaSCSI-3"
+ version "WBT", "NinjaSCSI-3", "R1.0"
+ bind "nsp_cs"
+
+card "WorkBit NinjaSCSI-32Bi (16bit)"
+ version "WORKBIT", "UltraNinja-16", "1"
+ bind "nsp_cs"
+
+# OEM
+card "WorkBit NinjaSCSI-32Bi (16bit) / IO-DATA"
+ version "IO DATA", "CBSC16 ", "1"
+ bind "nsp_cs"
+
+# OEM
+card "WorkBit NinjaSCSI-32Bi (16bit) / KME-1"
+ version "KME ", "SCSI-CARD-001", "1"
+ bind "nsp_cs"
+card "WorkBit NinjaSCSI-32Bi (16bit) / KME-2"
+ version "KME ", "SCSI-CARD-002", "1"
+ bind "nsp_cs"
+card "WorkBit NinjaSCSI-32Bi (16bit) / KME-3"
+ version "KME ", "SCSI-CARD-003", "1"
+ bind "nsp_cs"
+card "WorkBit NinjaSCSI-32Bi (16bit) / KME-4"
+ version "KME ", "SCSI-CARD-004", "1"
+ bind "nsp_cs"
+-------------------------------------
+
+[7] Start (or restart) pcmcia-cs.
+# /etc/rc.d/rc.pcmcia start (BSD style)
+or
+# /etc/init.d/pcmcia start (SYSV style)
+
+
+4. History
+See README.nin_cs .
+
+5. Caution
+ If you eject card when doing some operation for your SCSI device or suspend
+your computer, you encount some *BAD* error like disk crash.
+ It works good when I using this driver right way. But I'm not guarantee
+your data. Please backup your data when you use this driver.
+
+6. Known Bugs
+ In 2.4 kernel, you can't use 640MB Optical disk. This error comes from
+high level SCSI driver.
+
+7. Testing
+ Please send me some reports(bug reports etc..) of this software.
+When you send report, please tell me these or more.
+ card name
+ kernel version
+ your SCSI device name(hard drive, CD-ROM, etc...)
+
+8. Copyright
+ See GPL.
+
+
+2001/08/08 yokota@netlab.is.tsukuba.ac.jp <YOKOTA Hiroshi>
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/aha152x.txt b/Documentation/scsi/aha152x.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..2ce022cec9be
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/aha152x.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,183 @@
+$Id: README.aha152x,v 1.2 1999/12/25 15:32:30 fischer Exp fischer $
+Adaptec AHA-1520/1522 SCSI driver for Linux (aha152x)
+
+Copyright 1993-1999 Jürgen Fischer <fischer@norbit.de>
+TC1550 patches by Luuk van Dijk (ldz@xs4all.nl)
+
+
+In Revision 2 the driver was modified a lot (especially the
+bottom-half handler complete()).
+
+The driver is much cleaner now, has support for the new
+error handling code in 2.3, produced less cpu load (much
+less polling loops), has slightly higher throughput (at
+least on my ancient test box; a i486/33Mhz/20MB).
+
+
+CONFIGURATION ARGUMENTS:
+
+IOPORT base io address (0x340/0x140)
+IRQ interrupt level (9-12; default 11)
+SCSI_ID scsi id of controller (0-7; default 7)
+RECONNECT allow targets to disconnect from the bus (0/1; default 1 [on])
+PARITY enable parity checking (0/1; default 1 [on])
+SYNCHRONOUS enable synchronous transfers (0/1; default 1 [on])
+DELAY: bus reset delay (default 100)
+EXT_TRANS: enable extended translation (0/1: default 0 [off])
+ (see NOTES)
+
+COMPILE TIME CONFIGURATION (go into AHA152X in drivers/scsi/Makefile):
+
+-DAUTOCONF
+ use configuration the controller reports (AHA-152x only)
+
+-DSKIP_BIOSTEST
+ Don't test for BIOS signature (AHA-1510 or disabled BIOS)
+
+-DSETUP0="{ IOPORT, IRQ, SCSI_ID, RECONNECT, PARITY, SYNCHRONOUS, DELAY, EXT_TRANS }"
+ override for the first controller
+
+-DSETUP1="{ IOPORT, IRQ, SCSI_ID, RECONNECT, PARITY, SYNCHRONOUS, DELAY, EXT_TRANS }"
+ override for the second controller
+
+-DAHA152X_DEBUG
+ enable debugging output
+
+-DAHA152X_STAT
+ enable some statistics
+
+
+LILO COMMAND LINE OPTIONS:
+
+aha152x=<IOPORT>[,<IRQ>[,<SCSI-ID>[,<RECONNECT>[,<PARITY>[,<SYNCHRONOUS>[,<DELAY> [,<EXT_TRANS]]]]]]]
+
+ The normal configuration can be overridden by specifying a command line.
+ When you do this, the BIOS test is skipped. Entered values have to be
+ valid (known). Don't use values that aren't supported under normal
+ operation. If you think that you need other values: contact me.
+ For two controllers use the aha152x statement twice.
+
+
+SYMBOLS FOR MODULE CONFIGURATION:
+
+Choose from 2 alternatives:
+
+1. specify everything (old)
+
+aha152x=IOPORT,IRQ,SCSI_ID,RECONNECT,PARITY,SYNCHRONOUS,DELAY,EXT_TRANS
+ configuration override for first controller
+
+
+aha152x1=IOPORT,IRQ,SCSI_ID,RECONNECT,PARITY,SYNCHRONOUS,DELAY,EXT_TRANS
+ configuration override for second controller
+
+2. specify only what you need to (irq or io is required; new)
+
+io=IOPORT0[,IOPORT1]
+ IOPORT for first and second controller
+
+irq=IRQ0[,IRQ1]
+ IRQ for first and second controller
+
+scsiid=SCSIID0[,SCSIID1]
+ SCSIID for first and second controller
+
+reconnect=RECONNECT0[,RECONNECT1]
+ allow targets to disconnect for first and second controller
+
+parity=PAR0[PAR1]
+ use parity for first and second controller
+
+sync=SYNCHRONOUS0[,SYNCHRONOUS1]
+ enable synchronous transfers for first and second controller
+
+delay=DELAY0[,DELAY1]
+ reset DELAY for first and second controller
+
+exttrans=EXTTRANS0[,EXTTRANS1]
+ enable extended translation for first and second controller
+
+
+If you use both alternatives the first will be taken.
+
+
+NOTES ON EXT_TRANS:
+
+SCSI uses block numbers to address blocks/sectors on a device.
+The BIOS uses a cylinder/head/sector addressing scheme (C/H/S)
+scheme instead. DOS expects a BIOS or driver that understands this
+C/H/S addressing.
+
+The number of cylinders/heads/sectors is called geometry and is required
+as base for requests in C/H/S addressing. SCSI only knows about the
+total capacity of disks in blocks (sectors).
+
+Therefore the SCSI BIOS/DOS driver has to calculate a logical/virtual
+geometry just to be able to support that addressing scheme. The geometry
+returned by the SCSI BIOS is a pure calculation and has nothing to
+do with the real/physical geometry of the disk (which is usually
+irrelevant anyway).
+
+Basically this has no impact at all on Linux, because it also uses block
+instead of C/H/S addressing. Unfortunately C/H/S addressing is also used
+in the partition table and therefore every operating system has to know
+the right geometry to be able to interpret it.
+
+Moreover there are certain limitations to the C/H/S addressing scheme,
+namely the address space is limited to upto 255 heads, upto 63 sectors
+and a maximum of 1023 cylinders.
+
+The AHA-1522 BIOS calculates the geometry by fixing the number of heads
+to 64, the number of sectors to 32 and by calculating the number of
+cylinders by dividing the capacity reported by the disk by 64*32 (1 MB).
+This is considered to be the default translation.
+
+With respect to the limit of 1023 cylinders using C/H/S you can only
+address the first GB of your disk in the partition table. Therefore
+BIOSes of some newer controllers based on the AIC-6260/6360 support
+extended translation. This means that the BIOS uses 255 for heads,
+63 for sectors and then divides the capacity of the disk by 255*63
+(about 8 MB), as soon it sees a disk greater than 1 GB. That results
+in a maximum of about 8 GB addressable diskspace in the partition table
+(but there are already bigger disks out there today).
+
+To make it even more complicated the translation mode might/might
+not be configurable in certain BIOS setups.
+
+This driver does some more or less failsafe guessing to get the
+geometry right in most cases:
+
+- for disks<1GB: use default translation (C/32/64)
+
+- for disks>1GB:
+ - take current geometry from the partition table
+ (using scsicam_bios_param and accept only `valid' geometries,
+ ie. either (C/32/64) or (C/63/255)). This can be extended translation
+ even if it's not enabled in the driver.
+
+ - if that fails, take extended translation if enabled by override,
+ kernel or module parameter, otherwise take default translation and
+ ask the user for verification. This might on not yet partitioned
+ disks.
+
+
+REFERENCES USED:
+
+ "AIC-6260 SCSI Chip Specification", Adaptec Corporation.
+
+ "SCSI COMPUTER SYSTEM INTERFACE - 2 (SCSI-2)", X3T9.2/86-109 rev. 10h
+
+ "Writing a SCSI device driver for Linux", Rik Faith (faith@cs.unc.edu)
+
+ "Kernel Hacker's Guide", Michael K. Johnson (johnsonm@sunsite.unc.edu)
+
+ "Adaptec 1520/1522 User's Guide", Adaptec Corporation.
+
+ Michael K. Johnson (johnsonm@sunsite.unc.edu)
+
+ Drew Eckhardt (drew@cs.colorado.edu)
+
+ Eric Youngdale (eric@andante.org)
+
+ special thanks to Eric Youngdale for the free(!) supplying the
+ documentation on the chip.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/aic79xx.txt b/Documentation/scsi/aic79xx.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..0aeef740a95a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/aic79xx.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,516 @@
+====================================================================
+= Adaptec Ultra320 Family Manager Set v1.3.11 =
+= =
+= README for =
+= The Linux Operating System =
+====================================================================
+
+The following information is available in this file:
+
+ 1. Supported Hardware
+ 2. Version History
+ 3. Command Line Options
+ 4. Additional Notes
+ 5. Contacting Adaptec
+
+
+1. Supported Hardware
+
+ The following Adaptec SCSI Host Adapters are supported by this
+ driver set.
+
+ Ultra320 ASIC Description
+ ----------------------------------------------------------------
+ AIC-7901A Single Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to
+ Ultra320 SCSI ASIC
+ AIC-7901B Single Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to
+ Ultra320 SCSI ASIC with Retained Training
+ AIC-7902A4 Dual Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to
+ Ultra320 SCSI ASIC
+ AIC-7902B Dual Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to
+ Ultra320 SCSI ASIC with Retained Training
+
+ Ultra320 Adapters Description ASIC
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------------
+ Adaptec SCSI Card 39320 Dual Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to 7902A4/7902B
+ Ultra320 SCSI Card (one external
+ 68-pin, two internal 68-pin)
+ Adaptec SCSI Card 39320A Dual Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to 7902B
+ Ultra320 SCSI Card (one external
+ 68-pin, two internal 68-pin)
+ Adaptec SCSI Card 39320D Dual Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to 7902A4
+ Ultra320 SCSI Card (two external VHDC
+ and one internal 68-pin)
+ Adaptec SCSI Card 39320D Dual Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to 7902A4
+ Ultra320 SCSI Card (two external VHDC
+ and one internal 68-pin) based on the
+ AIC-7902B ASIC
+ Adaptec SCSI Card 29320 Single Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to 7901A
+ Ultra320 SCSI Card (one external
+ 68-pin, two internal 68-pin, one
+ internal 50-pin)
+ Adaptec SCSI Card 29320A Single Channel 64-bit PCI-X 133MHz to 7901B
+ Ultra320 SCSI Card (one external
+ 68-pin, two internal 68-pin, one
+ internal 50-pin)
+ Adaptec SCSI Card 29320LP Single Channel 64-bit Low Profile 7901A
+ PCI-X 133MHz to Ultra320 SCSI Card
+ (One external VHDC, one internal
+ 68-pin)
+ Adaptec SCSI Card 29320ALP Single Channel 64-bit Low Profile 7901B
+ PCI-X 133MHz to Ultra320 SCSI Card
+ (One external VHDC, one internal
+ 68-pin)
+2. Version History
+
+ 1.3.11 (July 11, 2003)
+ - Fix several deadlock issues.
+ - Add 29320ALP and 39320B Id's.
+
+ 1.3.10 (June 3rd, 2003)
+ - Align the SCB_TAG field on a 16byte boundary. This avoids
+ SCB corruption on some PCI-33 busses.
+ - Correct non-zero luns on Rev B. hardware.
+ - Update for change in 2.5.X SCSI proc FS interface.
+ - When negotiation async via an 8bit WDTR message, send
+ an SDTR with an offset of 0 to be sure the target
+ knows we are async. This works around a firmware defect
+ in the Quantum Atlas 10K.
+ - Implement controller susupend and resume.
+ - Clear PCI error state during driver attach so that we
+ don't disable memory mapped I/O due to a stray write
+ by some other driver probe that occurred before we
+ claimed the controller.
+
+ 1.3.9 (May 22nd, 2003)
+ - Fix compiler errors.
+ - Remove S/G splitting for segments that cross a 4GB boundary.
+ This is guaranteed not to happen in Linux.
+ - Add support for scsi_report_device_reset() found in
+ 2.5.X kernels.
+ - Add 7901B support.
+ - Simplify handling of the packtized lun Rev A workaround.
+ - Correct and simplify handling of the ignore wide residue
+ message. The previous code would fail to report a residual
+ if the transaction data length was even and we received
+ an IWR message.
+
+ 1.3.8 (April 29th, 2003)
+ - Fix types accessed via the command line interface code.
+ - Perform a few firmware optimizations.
+ - Fix "Unexpected PKT busfree" errors.
+ - Use a sequencer interrupt to notify the host of
+ commands with bad status. We defer the notification
+ until there are no outstanding selections to ensure
+ that the host is interrupted for as short a time as
+ possible.
+ - Remove pre-2.2.X support.
+ - Add support for new 2.5.X interrupt API.
+ - Correct big-endian architecture support.
+
+ 1.3.7 (April 16th, 2003)
+ - Use del_timer_sync() to ensure that no timeouts
+ are pending during controller shutdown.
+ - For pre-2.5.X kernels, carefully adjust our segment
+ list size to avoid SCSI malloc pool fragmentation.
+ - Cleanup channel display in our /proc output.
+ - Workaround duplicate device entries in the mid-layer
+ devlice list during add-single-device.
+
+ 1.3.6 (March 28th, 2003)
+ - Correct a double free in the Domain Validation code.
+ - Correct a reference to free'ed memory during controller
+ shutdown.
+ - Reset the bus on an SE->LVD change. This is required
+ to reset our transcievers.
+
+ 1.3.5 (March 24th, 2003)
+ - Fix a few register window mode bugs.
+ - Include read streaming in the PPR flags we display in
+ diagnostics as well as /proc.
+ - Add PCI hot plug support for 2.5.X kernels.
+ - Correct default precompensation value for RevA hardware.
+ - Fix Domain Validation thread shutdown.
+ - Add a firmware workaround to make the LED blink
+ brighter during packetized operations on the H2A4.
+ - Correct /proc display of user read streaming settings.
+ - Simplify driver locking by releasing the io_request_lock
+ upon driver entry from the mid-layer.
+ - Cleanup command line parsing and move much of this code
+ to aiclib.
+
+ 1.3.4 (February 28th, 2003)
+ - Correct a race condition in our error recovery handler.
+ - Allow Test Unit Ready commands to take a full 5 seconds
+ during Domain Validation.
+
+ 1.3.2 (February 19th, 2003)
+ - Correct a Rev B. regression due to the GEM318
+ compatibility fix included in 1.3.1.
+
+ 1.3.1 (February 11th, 2003)
+ - Add support for the 39320A.
+ - Improve recovery for certain PCI-X errors.
+ - Fix handling of LQ/DATA/LQ/DATA for the
+ same write transaction that can occur without
+ interveining training.
+ - Correct compatibility issues with the GEM318
+ enclosure services device.
+ - Correct data corruption issue that occurred under
+ high tag depth write loads.
+ - Adapt to a change in the 2.5.X daemonize() API.
+ - Correct a "Missing case in ahd_handle_scsiint" panic.
+
+ 1.3.0 (January 21st, 2003)
+ - Full regression testing for all U320 products completed.
+ - Added abort and target/lun reset error recovery handler and
+ interrupt coalessing.
+
+ 1.2.0 (November 14th, 2002)
+ - Added support for Domain Validation
+ - Add support for the Hewlett-Packard version of the 39320D
+ and AIC-7902 adapters.
+ Support for previous adapters has not been fully tested and should
+ only be used at the customer's own risk.
+
+ 1.1.1 (September 24th, 2002)
+ - Added support for the Linux 2.5.X kernel series
+
+ 1.1.0 (September 17th, 2002)
+ - Added support for four additional SCSI products:
+ ASC-39320, ASC-29320, ASC-29320LP, AIC-7901.
+
+ 1.0.0 (May 30th, 2002)
+ - Initial driver release.
+
+ 2.1. Software/Hardware Features
+ - Support for the SPI-4 "Ultra320" standard:
+ - 320MB/s transfer rates
+ - Packetized SCSI Protocol at 160MB/s and 320MB/s
+ - Quick Arbitration Selection (QAS)
+ - Retained Training Information (Rev B. ASIC only)
+ - Interrupt Coalessing
+ - Initiator Mode (target mode not currently
+ supported)
+ - Support for the PCI-X standard up to 133MHz
+ - Support for the PCI v2.2 standard
+ - Domain Validation
+
+ 2.2. Operating System Support:
+ - Redhat Linux 7.2, 7.3, 8.0, Advanced Server 2.1
+ - SuSE Linux 7.3, 8.0, 8.1, Enterprise Server 7
+ - only Intel and AMD x86 supported at this time
+ - >4GB memory configurations supported.
+
+ Refer to the User's Guide for more details on this.
+
+3. Command Line Options
+
+ WARNING: ALTERING OR ADDING THESE DRIVER PARAMETERS
+ INCORRECTLY CAN RENDER YOUR SYSTEM INOPERABLE.
+ USE THEM WITH CAUTION.
+
+ Edit the file "modprobe.conf" in the directory /etc and add/edit a
+ line containing 'options aic79xx aic79xx=[command[,command...]]' where
+ 'command' is one or more of the following:
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: verbose
+ Definition: enable additional informative messages during
+ driver operation.
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: debug:[value]
+ Definition: Enables various levels of debugging information
+ The bit definitions for the debugging mask can
+ be found in drivers/scsi/aic7xxx/aic79xx.h under
+ the "Debug" heading.
+ Possible Values: 0x0000 = no debugging, 0xffff = full debugging
+ Default Value: 0x0000
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: no_reset
+ Definition: Do not reset the bus during the initial probe
+ phase
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: extended
+ Definition: Force extended translation on the controller
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: periodic_otag
+ Definition: Send an ordered tag periodically to prevent
+ tag starvation. Needed for some older devices
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: reverse_scan
+ Definition: Probe the scsi bus in reverse order, starting
+ with target 15
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: global_tag_depth
+ Definition: Global tag depth for all targets on all busses.
+ This option sets the default tag depth which
+ may be selectively overridden vi the tag_info
+ option.
+ Possible Values: 1 - 253
+ Default Value: 32
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: tag_info:{{value[,value...]}[,{value[,value...]}...]}
+ Definition: Set the per-target tagged queue depth on a
+ per controller basis. Both controllers and targets
+ may be ommitted indicating that they should retain
+ the default tag depth.
+ Examples: tag_info:{{16,32,32,64,8,8,,32,32,32,32,32,32,32,32,32}
+ On Controller 0
+ specifies a tag depth of 16 for target 0
+ specifies a tag depth of 64 for target 3
+ specifies a tag depth of 8 for targets 4 and 5
+ leaves target 6 at the default
+ specifies a tag depth of 32 for targets 1,2,7-15
+ All other targets retain the default depth.
+
+ tag_info:{{},{32,,32}}
+ On Controller 1
+ specifies a tag depth of 32 for targets 0 and 2
+ All other targets retain the default depth.
+
+ Possible Values: 1 - 253
+ Default Value: 32
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: rd_strm: {rd_strm_bitmask[,rd_strm_bitmask...]}
+ Definition: Enable read streaming on a per target basis.
+ The rd_strm_bitmask is a 16 bit hex value in which
+ each bit represents a target. Setting the target's
+ bit to '1' enables read streaming for that
+ target. Controllers may be ommitted indicating that
+ they should retain the default read streaming setting.
+ Example: rd_strm:{0x0041}
+ On Controller 0
+ enables read streaming for targets 0 and 6.
+ disables read streaming for targets 1-5,7-15.
+ All other targets retain the default read
+ streaming setting.
+ Example: rd_strm:{0x0023,,0xFFFF}
+ On Controller 0
+ enables read streaming for targets 1,2, and 5.
+ disables read streaming for targets 3,4,6-15.
+ On Controller 2
+ enables read streaming for all targets.
+ All other targets retain the default read
+ streaming setting.
+
+ Possible Values: 0x0000 - 0xffff
+ Default Value: 0x0000
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: dv: {value[,value...]}
+ Definition: Set Domain Validation Policy on a per-controller basis.
+ Controllers may be ommitted indicating that
+ they should retain the default read streaming setting.
+ Example: dv:{-1,0,,1,1,0}
+ On Controller 0 leave DV at its default setting.
+ On Controller 1 disable DV.
+ Skip configuration on Controller 2.
+ On Controllers 3 and 4 enable DV.
+ On Controller 5 disable DV.
+
+ Possible Values: < 0 Use setting from serial EEPROM.
+ 0 Disable DV
+ > 0 Enable DV
+ Default Value: DV Serial EEPROM configuration setting.
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: seltime:[value]
+ Definition: Specifies the selection timeout value
+ Possible Values: 0 = 256ms, 1 = 128ms, 2 = 64ms, 3 = 32ms
+ Default Value: 0
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+
+ *** The following three options should only be changed at ***
+ *** the direction of a technical support representative. ***
+
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: precomp: {value[,value...]}
+ Definition: Set IO Cell precompensation value on a per-controller
+ basis.
+ Controllers may be ommitted indicating that
+ they should retain the default precompensation setting.
+ Example: precomp:{0x1}
+ On Controller 0 set precompensation to 1.
+ Example: precomp:{1,,7}
+ On Controller 0 set precompensation to 1.
+ On Controller 2 set precompensation to 8.
+
+ Possible Values: 0 - 7
+ Default Value: Varies based on chip revision
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: slewrate: {value[,value...]}
+ Definition: Set IO Cell slew rate on a per-controller basis.
+ Controllers may be ommitted indicating that
+ they should retain the default slew rate setting.
+ Example: slewrate:{0x1}
+ On Controller 0 set slew rate to 1.
+ Example: slewrate :{1,,8}
+ On Controller 0 set slew rate to 1.
+ On Controller 2 set slew rate to 8.
+
+ Possible Values: 0 - 15
+ Default Value: Varies based on chip revision
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: amplitude: {value[,value...]}
+ Definition: Set IO Cell signal amplitude on a per-controller basis.
+ Controllers may be ommitted indicating that
+ they should retain the default read streaming setting.
+ Example: amplitude:{0x1}
+ On Controller 0 set amplitude to 1.
+ Example: amplitude :{1,,7}
+ On Controller 0 set amplitude to 1.
+ On Controller 2 set amplitude to 7.
+
+ Possible Values: 1 - 7
+ Default Value: Varies based on chip revision
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+
+ Example: 'options aic79xx aic79xx=verbose,rd_strm:{{0x0041}}'
+ enables verbose output in the driver and turns read streaming on
+ for targets 0 and 6 of Controller 0.
+
+4. Additional Notes
+
+ 4.1. Known/Unresolved or FYI Issues
+
+ * Under SuSE Linux Enterprise 7, the driver may fail to operate
+ correctly due to a problem with PCI interrupt routing in the
+ Linux kernel. Please contact SuSE for an updated Linux
+ kernel.
+
+ 4.2. Third-Party Compatibility Issues
+
+ * Adaptec only supports Ultra320 hard drives running
+ the latest firmware available. Please check with
+ your hard drive manufacturer to ensure you have the
+ latest version.
+
+ 4.3. Operating System or Technology Limitations
+
+ * PCI Hot Plug is untested and may cause the operating system
+ to stop responding.
+ * Luns that are not numbered contiguously starting with 0 might not
+ be automatically probed during system startup. This is a limitation
+ of the OS. Please contact your Linux vendor for instructions on
+ manually probing non-contiguous luns.
+ * Using the Driver Update Disk version of this package during OS
+ installation under RedHat might result in two versions of this
+ driver being installed into the system module directory. This
+ might cause problems with the /sbin/mkinitrd program and/or
+ other RPM packages that try to install system modules. The best
+ way to correct this once the system is running is to install
+ the latest RPM package version of this driver, available from
+ http://www.adaptec.com.
+
+
+5. Contacting Adaptec
+
+ A Technical Support Identification (TSID) Number is required for
+ Adaptec technical support.
+ - The 12-digit TSID can be found on the white barcode-type label
+ included inside the box with your product. The TSID helps us
+ provide more efficient service by accurately identifying your
+ product and support status.
+ Support Options
+ - Search the Adaptec Support Knowledgebase (ASK) at
+ http://ask.adaptec.com for articles, troubleshooting tips, and
+ frequently asked questions for your product.
+ - For support via Email, submit your question to Adaptec's
+ Technical Support Specialists at http://ask.adaptec.com.
+
+ North America
+ - Visit our Web site at http://www.adaptec.com.
+ - To speak with a Fibre Channel/RAID/External Storage Technical
+ Support Specialist, call 1-321-207-2000,
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 3:00 A.M. to 5:00 P.M., PST.
+ (Not open on holidays)
+ - For Technical Support in all other technologies including
+ SCSI, call 1-408-934-7274,
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 6:00 A.M. to 5:00 P.M., PST.
+ (Not open on holidays)
+ - For after hours support, call 1-800-416-8066 ($99/call,
+ $149/call on holidays)
+ - To order Adaptec products including software and cables, call
+ 1-800-442-7274 or 1-408-957-7274. You can also visit our
+ online store at http://www.adaptecstore.com
+
+ Europe
+ - Visit our Web site at http://www.adaptec-europe.com.
+ - English and French: To speak with a Technical Support
+ Specialist, call one of the following numbers:
+ - English: +32-2-352-3470
+ - French: +32-2-352-3460
+ Hours: Monday-Thursday, 10:00 to 12:30, 13:30 to 17:30 CET
+ Friday, 10:00 to 12:30, 13:30 to 16:30 CET
+ - German: To speak with a Technical Support Specialist,
+ call +49-89-456-40660
+ Hours: Monday-Thursday, 09:30 to 12:30, 13:30 to 16:30 CET
+ Friday, 09:30 to 12:30, 13:30 to 15:00 CET
+ - To order Adaptec products, including accessories and cables:
+ - UK: +0800-96-65-26 or fax +0800-731-02-95
+ - Other European countries: +32-11-300-379
+
+ Australia and New Zealand
+ - Visit our Web site at http://www.adaptec.com.au.
+ - To speak with a Technical Support Specialist, call
+ +612-9416-0698
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 10:00 A.M. to 4:30 P.M., EAT
+ (Not open on holidays)
+
+ Japan
+ - To speak with a Technical Support Specialist, call
+ +81-3-5308-6120
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 9:00 a.m. to 12:00 p.m., 1:00 p.m. to
+ 6:00 p.m. TSC
+
+ Hong Kong and China
+ - To speak with a Technical Support Specialist, call
+ +852-2869-7200
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 10:00 to 17:00.
+ - Fax Technical Support at +852-2869-7100.
+
+ Singapore
+ - To speak with a Technical Support Specialist, call
+ +65-245-7470
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 10:00 to 17:00.
+ - Fax Technical Support at +852-2869-7100
+
+-------------------------------------------------------------------
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 2003 Adaptec Inc. 691 S. Milpitas Blvd., Milpitas CA 95035 USA.
+ * All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * You are permitted to redistribute, use and modify this README file in whole
+ * or in part in conjunction with redistribution of software governed by the
+ * General Public License, provided that the following conditions are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of README file must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions, and the following disclaimer,
+ * without modification.
+ * 2. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products
+ * derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
+ * 3. Modifications or new contributions must be attributed in a copyright
+ * notice identifying the author ("Contributor") and added below the
+ * original copyright notice. The copyright notice is for purposes of
+ * identifying contributors and should not be deemed as permission to alter
+ * the permissions given by Adaptec.
+ *
+ * THIS README FILE IS PROVIDED BY ADAPTEC AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, ANY
+ * WARRANTIES OF NON-INFRINGEMENT OR THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
+ * AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL
+ * ADAPTEC OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
+ * SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
+ * TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
+ * PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
+ * LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
+ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS README
+ * FILE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx.txt b/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..160e7354cd1e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,414 @@
+====================================================================
+= Adaptec Aic7xxx Fast -> Ultra160 Family Manager Set v6.2.28 =
+= README for =
+= The Linux Operating System =
+====================================================================
+
+The following information is available in this file:
+
+ 1. Supported Hardware
+ 2. Version History
+ 3. Command Line Options
+ 4. Contacting Adaptec
+
+1. Supported Hardware
+
+ The following Adaptec SCSI Chips and Host Adapters are supported by
+ the aic7xxx driver.
+
+ Chip MIPS Host Bus MaxSync MaxWidth SCBs Notes
+ ---------------------------------------------------------------
+ aic7770 10 EISA/VL 10MHz 16Bit 4 1
+ aic7850 10 PCI/32 10MHz 8Bit 3
+ aic7855 10 PCI/32 10MHz 8Bit 3
+ aic7856 10 PCI/32 10MHz 8Bit 3
+ aic7859 10 PCI/32 20MHz 8Bit 3
+ aic7860 10 PCI/32 20MHz 8Bit 3
+ aic7870 10 PCI/32 10MHz 16Bit 16
+ aic7880 10 PCI/32 20MHz 16Bit 16
+ aic7890 20 PCI/32 40MHz 16Bit 16 3 4 5 6 7 8
+ aic7891 20 PCI/64 40MHz 16Bit 16 3 4 5 6 7 8
+ aic7892 20 PCI/64-66 80MHz 16Bit 16 3 4 5 6 7 8
+ aic7895 15 PCI/32 20MHz 16Bit 16 2 3 4 5
+ aic7895C 15 PCI/32 20MHz 16Bit 16 2 3 4 5 8
+ aic7896 20 PCI/32 40MHz 16Bit 16 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+ aic7897 20 PCI/64 40MHz 16Bit 16 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+ aic7899 20 PCI/64-66 80MHz 16Bit 16 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+
+ 1. Multiplexed Twin Channel Device - One controller servicing two
+ busses.
+ 2. Multi-function Twin Channel Device - Two controllers on one chip.
+ 3. Command Channel Secondary DMA Engine - Allows scatter gather list
+ and SCB prefetch.
+ 4. 64 Byte SCB Support - Allows disconnected, unttagged request table
+ for all possible target/lun combinations.
+ 5. Block Move Instruction Support - Doubles the speed of certain
+ sequencer operations.
+ 6. `Bayonet' style Scatter Gather Engine - Improves S/G prefetch
+ performance.
+ 7. Queuing Registers - Allows queuing of new transactions without
+ pausing the sequencer.
+ 8. Multiple Target IDs - Allows the controller to respond to selection
+ as a target on multiple SCSI IDs.
+
+ Controller Chip Host-Bus Int-Connectors Ext-Connectors Notes
+ --------------------------------------------------------------------------
+ AHA-274X[A] aic7770 EISA SE-50M SE-HD50F
+ AHA-274X[A]W aic7770 EISA SE-HD68F SE-HD68F
+ SE-50M
+ AHA-274X[A]T aic7770 EISA 2 X SE-50M SE-HD50F
+ AHA-2842 aic7770 VL SE-50M SE-HD50F
+ AHA-2940AU aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M SE-HD50F
+ AVA-2902I aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AVA-2902E aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AVA-2906 aic7856 PCI/32 SE-50M SE-DB25F
+ APC-7850 aic7850 PCI/32 SE-50M 1
+ AVA-2940 aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AHA-2920B aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AHA-2930B aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AHA-2920C aic7856 PCI/32 SE-50M SE-HD50F
+ AHA-2930C aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AHA-2930C aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AHA-2910C aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AHA-2915C aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M
+ AHA-2940AU/CN aic7860 PCI/32 SE-50M SE-HD50F
+ AHA-2944W aic7870 PCI/32 HVD-HD68F HVD-HD68F
+ HVD-50M
+ AHA-3940W aic7870 PCI/32 2 X SE-HD68F SE-HD68F 2
+ AHA-2940UW aic7880 PCI/32 SE-HD68F
+ SE-50M SE-HD68F
+ AHA-2940U aic7880 PCI/32 SE-50M SE-HD50F
+ AHA-2940D aic7880 PCI/32
+ aHA-2940 A/T aic7880 PCI/32
+ AHA-2940D A/T aic7880 PCI/32
+ AHA-3940UW aic7880 PCI/32 2 X SE-HD68F SE-HD68F 3
+ AHA-3940UWD aic7880 PCI/32 2 X SE-HD68F 2 X SE-VHD68F 3
+ AHA-3940U aic7880 PCI/32 2 X SE-50M SE-HD50F 3
+ AHA-2944UW aic7880 PCI/32 HVD-HD68F HVD-HD68F
+ HVD-50M
+ AHA-3944UWD aic7880 PCI/32 2 X HVD-HD68F 2 X HVD-VHD68F 3
+ AHA-4944UW aic7880 PCI/32
+ AHA-2930UW aic7880 PCI/32
+ AHA-2940UW Pro aic7880 PCI/32 SE-HD68F SE-HD68F 4
+ SE-50M
+ AHA-2940UW/CN aic7880 PCI/32
+ AHA-2940UDual aic7895 PCI/32
+ AHA-2940UWDual aic7895 PCI/32
+ AHA-3940UWD aic7895 PCI/32
+ AHA-3940AUW aic7895 PCI/32
+ AHA-3940AUWD aic7895 PCI/32
+ AHA-3940AU aic7895 PCI/32
+ AHA-3944AUWD aic7895 PCI/32 2 X HVD-HD68F 2 X HVD-VHD68F
+ AHA-2940U2B aic7890 PCI/32 LVD-HD68F LVD-HD68F
+ AHA-2940U2 OEM aic7891 PCI/64
+ AHA-2940U2W aic7890 PCI/32 LVD-HD68F LVD-HD68F
+ SE-HD68F
+ SE-50M
+ AHA-2950U2B aic7891 PCI/64 LVD-HD68F LVD-HD68F
+ AHA-2930U2 aic7890 PCI/32 LVD-HD68F SE-HD50F
+ SE-50M
+ AHA-3950U2B aic7897 PCI/64
+ AHA-3950U2D aic7897 PCI/64
+ AHA-29160 aic7892 PCI/64-66
+ AHA-29160 CPQ aic7892 PCI/64-66
+ AHA-29160N aic7892 PCI/32 LVD-HD68F SE-HD50F
+ SE-50M
+ AHA-29160LP aic7892 PCI/64-66
+ AHA-19160 aic7892 PCI/64-66
+ AHA-29150LP aic7892 PCI/64-66
+ AHA-29130LP aic7892 PCI/64-66
+ AHA-3960D aic7899 PCI/64-66 2 X LVD-HD68F 2 X LVD-VHD68F
+ LVD-50M
+ AHA-3960D CPQ aic7899 PCI/64-66 2 X LVD-HD68F 2 X LVD-VHD68F
+ LVD-50M
+ AHA-39160 aic7899 PCI/64-66 2 X LVD-HD68F 2 X LVD-VHD68F
+ LVD-50M
+
+ 1. No BIOS support
+ 2. DEC21050 PCI-PCI bridge with multiple controller chips on secondary bus
+ 3. DEC2115X PCI-PCI bridge with multiple controller chips on secondary bus
+ 4. All three SCSI connectors may be used simultaneously without
+ SCSI "stub" effects.
+
+2. Version History
+ 6.2.36 (June 3rd, 2003)
+ - Correct code that disables PCI parity error checking.
+ - Correct and simplify handling of the ignore wide residue
+ message. The previous code would fail to report a residual
+ if the transaction data length was even and we received
+ an IWR message.
+ - Add support for the 2.5.X EISA framework.
+ - Update for change in 2.5.X SCSI proc FS interface.
+ - Correct Domain Validation command-line option parsing.
+ - When negotiation async via an 8bit WDTR message, send
+ an SDTR with an offset of 0 to be sure the target
+ knows we are async. This works around a firmware defect
+ in the Quantum Atlas 10K.
+ - Clear PCI error state during driver attach so that we
+ don't disable memory mapped I/O due to a stray write
+ by some other driver probe that occurred before we
+ claimed the controller.
+
+ 6.2.35 (May 14th, 2003)
+ - Fix a few GCC 3.3 compiler warnings.
+ - Correct operation on EISA Twin Channel controller.
+ - Add support for 2.5.X's scsi_report_device_reset().
+
+ 6.2.34 (May 5th, 2003)
+ - Fix locking regression instroduced in 6.2.29 that
+ could cuase a lock order reversal between the io_request_lock
+ and our per-softc lock. This was only possible on RH9,
+ SuSE, and kernel.org 2.4.X kernels.
+
+ 6.2.33 (April 30th, 2003)
+ - Dynamically disable PCI parity error reporting after
+ 10 errors are reported to the user. These errors are
+ the result of some other device issuing PCI transactions
+ with bad parity. Once the user has been informed of the
+ problem, continuing to report the errors just degrades
+ our performance.
+
+ 6.2.32 (March 28th, 2003)
+ - Dynamically sized S/G lists to avoid SCSI malloc
+ pool fragmentation and SCSI mid-layer deadlock.
+
+ 6.2.28 (January 20th, 2003)
+ - Domain Validation Fixes
+ - Add ability to disable PCI parity error checking.
+ - Enhanced Memory Mapped I/O probe
+
+ 6.2.20 (November 7th, 2002)
+ - Added Domain Validation.
+
+3. Command Line Options
+
+ WARNING: ALTERING OR ADDING THESE DRIVER PARAMETERS
+ INCORRECTLY CAN RENDER YOUR SYSTEM INOPERABLE.
+ USE THEM WITH CAUTION.
+
+ Edit the file "modprobe.conf" in the directory /etc and add/edit a
+ line containing 'options aic7xxx aic7xxx=[command[,command...]]' where
+ 'command' is one or more of the following:
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: verbose
+ Definition: enable additional informative messages during
+ driver operation.
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: debug:[value]
+ Definition: Enables various levels of debugging information
+ Possible Values: 0x0000 = no debugging, 0xffff = full debugging
+ Default Value: 0x0000
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: no_probe
+ Option: probe_eisa_vl
+ Definition: Do not probe for EISA/VLB controllers.
+ This is a toggle. If the driver is compiled
+ to not probe EISA/VLB controllers by default,
+ specifying "no_probe" will enable this probing.
+ If the driver is compiled to probe EISA/VLB
+ controllers by default, specifying "no_probe"
+ will disable this probing.
+ Possible Values: This option is a toggle
+ Default Value: EISA/VLB probing is disabled by default.
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: pci_parity
+ Definition: Toggles the detection of PCI parity errors.
+ On many motherboards with VIA chipsets,
+ PCI parity is not generated correctly on the
+ PCI bus. It is impossible for the hardware to
+ differentiate between these "spurious" parity
+ errors and real parity errors. The symptom of
+ this problem is a stream of the message:
+ "scsi0: Data Parity Error Detected during address or write data phase"
+ output by the driver.
+ Possible Values: This option is a toggle
+ Default Value: PCI Parity Error reporting is disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: no_reset
+ Definition: Do not reset the bus during the initial probe
+ phase
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: extended
+ Definition: Force extended translation on the controller
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: periodic_otag
+ Definition: Send an ordered tag periodically to prevent
+ tag starvation. Needed for some older devices
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: reverse_scan
+ Definition: Probe the scsi bus in reverse order, starting
+ with target 15
+ Possible Values: This option is a flag
+ Default Value: disabled
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: global_tag_depth:[value]
+ Definition: Global tag depth for all targets on all busses.
+ This option sets the default tag depth which
+ may be selectively overridden vi the tag_info
+ option.
+ Possible Values: 1 - 253
+ Default Value: 32
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: tag_info:{{value[,value...]}[,{value[,value...]}...]}
+ Definition: Set the per-target tagged queue depth on a
+ per controller basis. Both controllers and targets
+ may be ommitted indicating that they should retain
+ the default tag depth.
+ Examples: tag_info:{{16,32,32,64,8,8,,32,32,32,32,32,32,32,32,32}
+ On Controller 0
+ specifies a tag depth of 16 for target 0
+ specifies a tag depth of 64 for target 3
+ specifies a tag depth of 8 for targets 4 and 5
+ leaves target 6 at the default
+ specifies a tag depth of 32 for targets 1,2,7-15
+ All other targets retain the default depth.
+
+ tag_info:{{},{32,,32}}
+ On Controller 1
+ specifies a tag depth of 32 for targets 0 and 2
+ All other targets retain the default depth.
+
+ Possible Values: 1 - 253
+ Default Value: 32
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: seltime:[value]
+ Definition: Specifies the selection timeout value
+ Possible Values: 0 = 256ms, 1 = 128ms, 2 = 64ms, 3 = 32ms
+ Default Value: 0
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+ Option: dv: {value[,value...]}
+ Definition: Set Domain Validation Policy on a per-controller basis.
+ Controllers may be ommitted indicating that
+ they should retain the default read streaming setting.
+ Example: dv:{-1,0,,1,1,0}
+ On Controller 0 leave DV at its default setting.
+ On Controller 1 disable DV.
+ Skip configuration on Controller 2.
+ On Controllers 3 and 4 enable DV.
+ On Controller 5 disable DV.
+
+ Possible Values: < 0 Use setting from serial EEPROM.
+ 0 Disable DV
+ > 0 Enable DV
+
+ Default Value: SCSI-Select setting on controllers with a SCSI Select
+ option for DV. Otherwise, on for controllers supporting
+ U160 speeds and off for all other controller types.
+ -----------------------------------------------------------------
+
+ Example:
+ 'options aic7xxx aic7xxx=verbose,no_probe,tag_info:{{},{,,10}},seltime:1"
+ enables verbose logging, Disable EISA/VLB probing,
+ and set tag depth on Controller 1/Target 2 to 10 tags.
+
+3. Contacting Adaptec
+
+ A Technical Support Identification (TSID) Number is required for
+ Adaptec technical support.
+ - The 12-digit TSID can be found on the white barcode-type label
+ included inside the box with your product. The TSID helps us
+ provide more efficient service by accurately identifying your
+ product and support status.
+ Support Options
+ - Search the Adaptec Support Knowledgebase (ASK) at
+ http://ask.adaptec.com for articles, troubleshooting tips, and
+ frequently asked questions for your product.
+ - For support via Email, submit your question to Adaptec's
+ Technical Support Specialists at http://ask.adaptec.com.
+
+ North America
+ - Visit our Web site at http://www.adaptec.com.
+ - To speak with a Fibre Channel/RAID/External Storage Technical
+ Support Specialist, call 1-321-207-2000,
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 3:00 A.M. to 5:00 P.M., PST.
+ (Not open on holidays)
+ - For Technical Support in all other technologies including
+ SCSI, call 1-408-934-7274,
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 6:00 A.M. to 5:00 P.M., PST.
+ (Not open on holidays)
+ - For after hours support, call 1-800-416-8066 ($99/call,
+ $149/call on holidays)
+ - To order Adaptec products including software and cables, call
+ 1-800-442-7274 or 1-408-957-7274. You can also visit our
+ online store at http://www.adaptecstore.com
+
+ Europe
+ - Visit our Web site at http://www.adaptec-europe.com.
+ - English and French: To speak with a Technical Support
+ Specialist, call one of the following numbers:
+ - English: +32-2-352-3470
+ - French: +32-2-352-3460
+ Hours: Monday-Thursday, 10:00 to 12:30, 13:30 to 17:30 CET
+ Friday, 10:00 to 12:30, 13:30 to 16:30 CET
+ - German: To speak with a Technical Support Specialist,
+ call +49-89-456-40660
+ Hours: Monday-Thursday, 09:30 to 12:30, 13:30 to 16:30 CET
+ Friday, 09:30 to 12:30, 13:30 to 15:00 CET
+ - To order Adaptec products, including accessories and cables:
+ - UK: +0800-96-65-26 or fax +0800-731-02-95
+ - Other European countries: +32-11-300-379
+
+ Australia and New Zealand
+ - Visit our Web site at http://www.adaptec.com.au.
+ - To speak with a Technical Support Specialist, call
+ +612-9416-0698
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 10:00 A.M. to 4:30 P.M., EAT
+ (Not open on holidays)
+
+ Japan
+ - To speak with a Technical Support Specialist, call
+ +81-3-5308-6120
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 9:00 a.m. to 12:00 p.m., 1:00 p.m. to
+ 6:00 p.m. TSC
+
+ Hong Kong and China
+ - To speak with a Technical Support Specialist, call
+ +852-2869-7200
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 10:00 to 17:00.
+ - Fax Technical Support at +852-2869-7100.
+
+ Singapore
+ - To speak with a Technical Support Specialist, call
+ +65-245-7470
+ Hours: Monday-Friday, 10:00 to 17:00.
+ - Fax Technical Support at +852-2869-7100
+
+-------------------------------------------------------------------
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 2003 Adaptec Inc. 691 S. Milpitas Blvd., Milpitas CA 95035 USA.
+ * All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * You are permitted to redistribute, use and modify this README file in whole
+ * or in part in conjunction with redistribution of software governed by the
+ * General Public License, provided that the following conditions are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of README file must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions, and the following disclaimer,
+ * without modification.
+ * 2. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products
+ * derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
+ * 3. Modifications or new contributions must be attributed in a copyright
+ * notice identifying the author ("Contributor") and added below the
+ * original copyright notice. The copyright notice is for purposes of
+ * identifying contributors and should not be deemed as permission to alter
+ * the permissions given by Adaptec.
+ *
+ * THIS README FILE IS PROVIDED BY ADAPTEC AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, ANY
+ * WARRANTIES OF NON-INFRINGEMENT OR THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
+ * AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL
+ * ADAPTEC OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
+ * SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED
+ * TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
+ * PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
+ * LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
+ * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS README
+ * FILE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx_old.txt b/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx_old.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..79e5ac6cb6ff
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/aic7xxx_old.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,511 @@
+ AIC7xxx Driver for Linux
+
+Introduction
+----------------------------
+The AIC7xxx SCSI driver adds support for Adaptec (http://www.adaptec.com)
+SCSI controllers and chipsets. Major portions of the driver and driver
+development are shared between both Linux and FreeBSD. Support for the
+AIC-7xxx chipsets have been in the default Linux kernel since approximately
+linux-1.1.x and fairly stable since linux-1.2.x, and are also in FreeBSD
+2.1.0 or later.
+
+ Supported cards/chipsets
+ ----------------------------
+ Adaptec Cards
+ ----------------------------
+ AHA-274x
+ AHA-274xT
+ AHA-2842
+ AHA-2910B
+ AHA-2920C
+ AHA-2930
+ AHA-2930U
+ AHA-2930CU
+ AHA-2930U2
+ AHA-2940
+ AHA-2940W
+ AHA-2940U
+ AHA-2940UW
+ AHA-2940UW-PRO
+ AHA-2940AU
+ AHA-2940U2W
+ AHA-2940U2
+ AHA-2940U2B
+ AHA-2940U2BOEM
+ AHA-2944D
+ AHA-2944WD
+ AHA-2944UD
+ AHA-2944UWD
+ AHA-2950U2
+ AHA-2950U2W
+ AHA-2950U2B
+ AHA-29160M
+ AHA-3940
+ AHA-3940U
+ AHA-3940W
+ AHA-3940UW
+ AHA-3940AUW
+ AHA-3940U2W
+ AHA-3950U2B
+ AHA-3950U2D
+ AHA-3960D
+ AHA-39160M
+ AHA-3985
+ AHA-3985U
+ AHA-3985W
+ AHA-3985UW
+
+ Motherboard Chipsets
+ ----------------------------
+ AIC-777x
+ AIC-785x
+ AIC-786x
+ AIC-787x
+ AIC-788x
+ AIC-789x
+ AIC-3860
+
+ Bus Types
+ ----------------------------
+ W - Wide SCSI, SCSI-3, 16bit bus, 68pin connector, will also support
+ SCSI-1/SCSI-2 50pin devices, transfer rates up to 20MB/s.
+ U - Ultra SCSI, transfer rates up to 40MB/s.
+ U2- Ultra 2 SCSI, transfer rates up to 80MB/s.
+ D - Differential SCSI.
+ T - Twin Channel SCSI. Up to 14 SCSI devices.
+
+ AHA-274x - EISA SCSI controller
+ AHA-284x - VLB SCSI controller
+ AHA-29xx - PCI SCSI controller
+ AHA-394x - PCI controllers with two separate SCSI controllers on-board.
+ AHA-398x - PCI RAID controllers with three separate SCSI controllers
+ on-board.
+
+ Not Supported Devices
+ ------------------------------
+ Adaptec Cards
+ ----------------------------
+ AHA-2920 (Only the cards that use the Future Domain chipset are not
+ supported, any 2920 cards based on Adaptec AIC chipsets,
+ such as the 2920C, are supported)
+ AAA-13x Raid Adapters
+ AAA-113x Raid Port Card
+
+ Motherboard Chipsets
+ ----------------------------
+ AIC-7810
+
+ Bus Types
+ ----------------------------
+ R - Raid Port busses are not supported.
+
+ The hardware RAID devices sold by Adaptec are *NOT* supported by this
+ driver (and will people please stop emailing me about them, they are
+ a totally separate beast from the bare SCSI controllers and this driver
+ can not be retrofitted in any sane manner to support the hardware RAID
+ features on those cards - Doug Ledford).
+
+
+ People
+ ------------------------------
+ Justin T Gibbs gibbs@plutotech.com
+ (BSD Driver Author)
+ Dan Eischen deischen@iworks.InterWorks.org
+ (Original Linux Driver Co-maintainer)
+ Dean Gehnert deang@teleport.com
+ (Original Linux FTP/patch maintainer)
+ Jess Johnson jester@frenzy.com
+ (AIC7xxx FAQ author)
+ Doug Ledford dledford@redhat.com
+ (Current Linux aic7xxx-5.x.x Driver/Patch/FTP maintainer)
+
+ Special thanks go to John Aycock (aycock@cpsc.ucalgary.ca), the original
+ author of the driver. John has since retired from the project. Thanks
+ again for all his work!
+
+ Mailing list
+ ------------------------------
+ There is a mailing list available for users who want to track development
+ and converse with other users and developers. This list is for both
+ FreeBSD and Linux support of the AIC7xxx chipsets.
+
+ To subscribe to the AIC7xxx mailing list send mail to the list server,
+ with "subscribe AIC7xxx" in the body (no Subject: required):
+ To: majordomo@FreeBSD.ORG
+ ---
+ subscribe AIC7xxx
+
+ To unsubscribe from the list, send mail to the list server with:
+ To: majordomo@FreeBSD.ORG
+ ---
+ unsubscribe AIC7xxx
+
+ Send regular messages and replies to: AIC7xxx@FreeBSD.ORG
+
+ Boot Command line options
+ ------------------------------
+ "aic7xxx=no_reset" - Eliminate the SCSI bus reset during startup.
+ Some SCSI devices need the initial reset that this option disables
+ in order to work. If you have problems at bootup, please make sure
+ you aren't using this option.
+
+ "aic7xxx=reverse_scan" - Certain PCI motherboards scan for devices at
+ bootup by scanning from the highest numbered PCI device to the
+ lowest numbered PCI device, others do just the opposite and scan
+ from lowest to highest numbered PCI device. There is no reliable
+ way to autodetect this ordering. So, we default to the most common
+ order, which is lowest to highest. Then, in case your motherboard
+ scans from highest to lowest, we have this option. If your BIOS
+ finds the drives on controller A before controller B but the linux
+ kernel finds your drives on controller B before A, then you should
+ use this option.
+
+ "aic7xxx=extended" - Force the driver to detect extended drive translation
+ on your controller. This helps those people who have cards without
+ a SEEPROM make sure that linux and all other operating systems think
+ the same way about your hard drives.
+
+ "aic7xxx=scbram" - Some cards have external SCB RAM that can be used to
+ give the card more hardware SCB slots. This allows the driver to use
+ that SCB RAM. Without this option, the driver won't touch the SCB
+ RAM because it is known to cause problems on a few cards out there
+ (such as 3985 class cards).
+
+ "aic7xxx=irq_trigger:x" - Replace x with either 0 or 1 to force the kernel
+ to use the correct IRQ type for your card. This only applies to EISA
+ based controllers. On these controllers, 0 is for Edge triggered
+ interrupts, and 1 is for Level triggered interrupts. If you aren't
+ sure or don't know which IRQ trigger type your EISA card uses, then
+ let the kernel autodetect the trigger type.
+
+ "aic7xxx=verbose" - This option can be used in one of two ways. If you
+ simply specify aic7xxx=verbose, then the kernel will automatically
+ pick the default set of verbose messages for you to see.
+ Alternatively, you can specify the command as
+ "aic7xxx=verbose:0xXXXX" where the X entries are replaced with
+ hexadecimal digits. This option is a bit field type option. For
+ a full listing of the available options, search for the
+ #define VERBOSE_xxxxxx lines in the aic7xxx.c file. If you want
+ verbose messages, then it is recommended that you simply use the
+ aic7xxx=verbose variant of this command.
+
+ "aic7xxx=pci_parity:x" - This option controls whether or not the driver
+ enables PCI parity error checking on the PCI bus. By default, this
+ checking is disabled. To enable the checks, simply specify pci_parity
+ with no value afterwords. To reverse the parity from even to odd,
+ supply any number other than 0 or 255. In short:
+ pci_parity - Even parity checking (even is the normal PCI parity)
+ pci_parity:x - Where x > 0, Odd parity checking
+ pci_parity:0 - No check (default)
+ NOTE: In order to get Even PCI parity checking, you must use the
+ version of the option that does not include the : and a number at
+ the end (unless you want to enter exactly 2^32 - 1 as the number).
+
+ "aic7xxx=no_probe" - This option will disable the probing for any VLB
+ based 2842 controllers and any EISA based controllers. This is
+ needed on certain newer motherboards where the normal EISA I/O ranges
+ have been claimed by other PCI devices. Probing on those machines
+ will often result in the machine crashing or spontaneously rebooting
+ during startup. Examples of machines that need this are the
+ Dell PowerEdge 6300 machines.
+
+ "aic7xxx=seltime:2" - This option controls how long the card waits
+ during a device selection sequence for the device to respond.
+ The original SCSI spec says that this "should be" 256ms. This
+ is generally not required with modern devices. However, some
+ very old SCSI I devices need the full 256ms. Most modern devices
+ can run fine with only 64ms. The default for this option is
+ 64ms. If you need to change this option, then use the following
+ table to set the proper value in the example above:
+ 0 - 256ms
+ 1 - 128ms
+ 2 - 64ms
+ 3 - 32ms
+
+ "aic7xxx=panic_on_abort" - This option is for debugging and will cause
+ the driver to panic the linux kernel and freeze the system the first
+ time the drivers abort or reset routines are called. This is most
+ helpful when some problem causes infinite reset loops that scroll too
+ fast to see. By using this option, you can write down what the errors
+ actually are and send that information to me so it can be fixed.
+
+ "aic7xxx=dump_card" - This option will print out the *entire* set of
+ configuration registers on the card during the init sequence. This
+ is a debugging aid used to see exactly what state the card is in
+ when we finally finish our initialization routines. If you don't
+ have documentation on the chipsets, this will do you absolutely
+ no good unless you are simply trying to write all the information
+ down in order to send it to me.
+
+ "aic7xxx=dump_sequencer" - This is the same as the above options except
+ that instead of dumping the register contents on the card, this
+ option dumps the contents of the sequencer program RAM. This gives
+ the ability to verify that the instructions downloaded to the
+ card's sequencer are indeed what they are suppossed to be. Again,
+ unless you have documentation to tell you how to interpret these
+ numbers, then it is totally useless.
+
+ "aic7xxx=override_term:0xffffffff" - This option is used to force the
+ termination on your SCSI controllers to a particular setting. This
+ is a bit mask variable that applies for up to 8 aic7xxx SCSI channels.
+ Each channel gets 4 bits, divided as follows:
+ bit 3 2 1 0
+ | | | Enable/Disable Single Ended Low Byte Termination
+ | | En/Disable Single Ended High Byte Termination
+ | En/Disable Low Byte LVD Termination
+ En/Disable High Byte LVD Termination
+
+ The upper 2 bits that deal with LVD termination only apply to Ultra2
+ controllers. Futhermore, due to the current Ultra2 controller
+ designs, these bits are tied together such that setting either bit
+ enables both low and high byte LVD termination. It is not possible
+ to only set high or low byte LVD termination in this manner. This is
+ an artifact of the BIOS definition on Ultra2 controllers. For other
+ controllers, the only important bits are the two lowest bits. Setting
+ the higher bits on non-Ultra2 controllers has no effect. A few
+ examples of how to use this option:
+
+ Enable low and high byte termination on a non-ultra2 controller that
+ is the first aic7xxx controller (the correct bits are 0011),
+ aic7xxx=override_term:0x3
+
+ Enable all termination on the third aic7xxx controller, high byte
+ termination on the second aic7xxx controller, and low and high byte
+ SE termination on the first aic7xxx controller
+ (bits are 1111 0010 0011),
+ aic7xxx=override_term:0xf23
+
+ No attempt has been made to make this option non-cryptic. It really
+ shouldn't be used except in dire circumstances, and if that happens,
+ I'm probably going to be telling you what to set this to anyway :)
+
+ "aic7xxx=stpwlev:0xffffffff" - This option is used to control the STPWLEV
+ bit in the DEVCONFIG PCI register. Currently, this is one of the
+ very few registers that we have absolutely *no* way of detecting
+ what the variable should be. It depends entirely on how the chipset
+ and external terminators were coupled by the card/motherboard maker.
+ Further, a chip reset (at power up) always sets this bit to 0. If
+ there is no BIOS to run on the chipset/card (such as with a 2910C
+ or a motherboard controller with the BIOS totally disabled) then
+ the variable may not get set properly. Of course, if the proper
+ setting was 0, then that's what it would be after the reset, but if
+ the proper setting is actually 1.....you get the picture. Now, since
+ we can't detect this at all, I've added this option to force the
+ setting. If you have a BIOS on your controller then you should never
+ need to use this option. However, if you are having lots of SCSI
+ reset problems and can't seem to get them knocked out, this may help.
+
+ Here's a test to know for certain if you need this option. Make
+ a boot floppy that you can use to boot your computer up and that
+ will detect the aic7xxx controller. Next, power down your computer.
+ While it's down, unplug all SCSI cables from your Adaptec SCSI
+ controller. Boot the system back up to the Adaptec EZ-SCSI BIOS
+ and then make sure that termination is enabled on your adapter (if
+ you have an Adaptec BIOS of course). Next, boot up the floppy you
+ made and wait for it to detect the aic7xxx controller. If the kernel
+ finds the controller fine, says scsi : x hosts and then tries to
+ detect your devices like normal, up to the point where it fails to
+ mount your root file system and panics, then you're fine. If, on
+ the other hand, the system goes into an infinite reset loop, then
+ you need to use this option and/or the previous option to force the
+ proper termination settings on your controller. If this happens,
+ then you next need to figure out what your settings should be.
+
+ To find the correct settings, power your machine back down, connect
+ back up the SCSI cables, and boot back into your machine like normal.
+ However, boot with the aic7xxx=verbose:0x39 option. Record the
+ initial DEVCONFIG values for each of your aic7xxx controllers as
+ they are listed, and also record what the machine is detecting as
+ the proper termination on your controllers. NOTE: the order in
+ which the initial DEVCONFIG values are printed out is not gauranteed
+ to be the same order as the SCSI controllers are registered. The
+ above option and this option both work on the order of the SCSI
+ controllers as they are registered, so make sure you match the right
+ DEVCONFIG values with the right controllers if you have more than
+ one aic7xxx controller.
+
+ Once you have the detected termination settings and the initial
+ DEVCONFIG values for each controller, then figure out what the
+ termination on each of the controllers *should* be. Hopefully, that
+ part is correct, but it could possibly be wrong if there is
+ bogus cable detection logic on your controller or something similar.
+ If all the controllers have the correct termination settings, then
+ don't set the aic7xxx=override_term variable at all, leave it alone.
+ Next, on any controllers that go into an infinite reset loop when
+ you unplug all the SCSI cables, get the starting DEVCONFIG value.
+ If the initial DEVCONFIG value is divisible by 2, then the correct
+ setting for that controller is 0. If it's an odd number, then
+ the correct setting for that controller is 1. For any other
+ controllers that didn't have an infinite reset problem, then reverse
+ the above options. If DEVCONFIG was even, then the correct setting
+ is 1, if not then the correct setting is 0.
+
+ Now that you know what the correct setting was for each controller,
+ we need to encode that into the aic7xxx=stpwlev:0x... variable.
+ This variable is a bit field encoded variable. Bit 0 is for the first
+ aic7xxx controller, bit 1 for the next, etc. Put all these bits
+ together and you get a number. For example, if the third aic7xxx
+ needed a 1, but the second and first both needed a 0, then the bits
+ would be 100 in binary. This then translates to 0x04. You would
+ therefore set aic7xxx=stpwlev:0x04. This is fairly standard binary
+ to hexadecimal conversions here. If you aren't up to speed on the
+ binary->hex conversion then send an email to the aic7xxx mailing
+ list and someone can help you out.
+
+ "aic7xxx=tag_info:{{8,8..},{8,8..},..}" - This option is used to disable
+ or enable Tagged Command Queueing (TCQ) on specific devices. As of
+ driver version 5.1.11, TCQ is now either on or off by default
+ according to the setting you choose during the make config process.
+ In order to en/disable TCQ for certian devices at boot time, a user
+ may use this boot param. The driver will then parse this message out
+ and en/disable the specific device entries that are present based upon
+ the value given. The param line is parsed in the following manner:
+
+ { - first instance indicates the start of this parameter values
+ second instance is the start of entries for a particular
+ device entry
+ } - end the entries for a particular host adapter, or end the entire
+ set of parameter entries
+ , - move to next entry. Inside of a set of device entries, this
+ moves us to the next device on the list. Outside of device
+ entries, this moves us to the next host adapter
+ . - Same effect as , but is safe to use with insmod.
+ x - the number to enter into the array at this position.
+ 0 = Enable tagged queueing on this device and use the default
+ queue depth
+ 1-254 = Enable tagged queueing on this device and use this
+ number as the queue depth
+ 255 = Disable tagged queueing on this device.
+ Note: anything above 32 for an actual queue depth is wasteful
+ and not recommended.
+
+ A few examples of how this can be used:
+
+ tag_info:{{8,12,,0,,255,4}}
+ This line will only effect the first aic7xxx card registered. It
+ will set scsi id 0 to a queue depth of 8, id 1 to 12, leave id 2
+ at the default, set id 3 to tagged queueing enabled and use the
+ default queue depth, id 4 default, id 5 disabled, and id 6 to 4.
+ Any not specified entries stay at the default value, repeated
+ commas with no value specified will simply increment to the next id
+ without changing anything for the missing values.
+
+ tag_info:{,,,{,,,255}}
+ First, second, and third adapters at default values. Fourth
+ adapter, id 3 is disabled. Notice that leading commas simply
+ increment what the first number effects, and there are no need
+ for trailing commas. When you close out an adapter, or the
+ entire entry, anything not explicitly set stays at the default
+ value.
+
+ A final note on this option. The scanner I used for this isn't
+ perfect or highly robust. If you mess the line up, the worst that
+ should happen is that the line will get ignored. If you don't
+ close out the entire entry with the final bracket, then any other
+ aic7xxx options after this will get ignored. So, in general, be
+ sure of what you are entering, and after you have it right, just
+ add it to the lilo.conf file so there won't be any mistakes. As
+ a means of checking this parser, the entire tag_info array for
+ each card is now printed out in the /proc/scsi/aic7xxx/x file. You
+ can use that to verify that your options were parsed correctly.
+
+ Boot command line options may be combined to form the proper set of options
+ a user might need. For example, the following is valid:
+
+ aic7xxx=verbose,extended,irq_trigger:1
+
+ The only requirement is that individual options be separated by a comma or
+ a period on the command line.
+
+ Module Loading command options
+ ------------------------------
+ When loading the aic7xxx driver as a module, the exact same options are
+ available to the user. However, the syntax to specify the options changes
+ slightly. For insmod, you need to wrap the aic7xxx= argument in quotes
+ and replace all ',' with '.'. So, for example, a valid insmod line
+ would be:
+
+ insmod aic7xxx aic7xxx='verbose.irq_trigger:1.extended'
+
+ This line should result in the *exact* same behaviour as if you typed
+ it in at the lilo prompt and the driver was compiled into the kernel
+ instead of being a module. The reason for the single quote is so that
+ the shell won't try to interpret anything in the line, such as {.
+ Insmod assumes any options starting with a letter instead of a number
+ is a character string (which is what we want) and by switching all of
+ the commas to periods, insmod won't interpret this as more than one
+ string and write junk into our binary image. I consider it a bug in
+ the insmod program that even if you wrap your string in quotes (quotes
+ that pass the shell mind you and that insmod sees) it still treates
+ a comma inside of those quotes as starting a new variable, resulting
+ in memory scribbles if you don't switch the commas to periods.
+
+
+ Kernel Compile options
+ ------------------------------
+ The various kernel compile time options for this driver are now fairly
+ well documented in the file Documentation/Configure.help. In order to
+ see this documentation, you need to use one of the advanced configuration
+ programs (menuconfig and xconfig). If you are using the "make menuconfig"
+ method of configuring your kernel, then you would simply highlight the
+ option in question and hit the ? key. If you are using the "make xconfig"
+ method of configuring your kernel, then simply click on the help button
+ next to the option you have questions about. The help information from
+ the Configure.help file will then get automatically displayed.
+
+ /proc support
+ ------------------------------
+ The /proc support for the AIC7xxx can be found in the /proc/scsi/aic7xxx/
+ directory. That directory contains a file for each SCSI controller in
+ the system. Each file presents the current configuration and transfer
+ statistics (enabled with #define in aic7xxx.c) for each controller.
+
+ Thanks to Michael Neuffer for his upper-level SCSI help, and
+ Matthew Jacob for statistics support.
+
+ Debugging the driver
+ ------------------------------
+ Should you have problems with this driver, and would like some help in
+ getting them solved, there are a couple debugging items built into
+ the driver to facilitate getting the needed information from the system.
+ In general, I need a complete description of the problem, with as many
+ logs as possible concerning what happens. To help with this, there is
+ a command option aic7xxx=panic_on_abort. This option, when set, forces
+ the driver to panic the kernel on the first SCSI abort issued by the
+ mid level SCSI code. If your system is going to reset loops and you
+ can't read the screen, then this is what you need. Not only will it
+ stop the system, but it also prints out a large amount of state
+ information in the process. Second, if you specify the option
+ "aic7xxx=verbose:0x1ffff", the system will print out *SOOOO* much
+ information as it runs that you won't be able to see anything.
+ However, this can actually be very useful if your machine simply
+ locks up when trying to boot, since it will pin-point what was last
+ happening (in regards to the aic7xxx driver) immediately prior to
+ the lockup. This is really only useful if your machine simply can
+ not boot up successfully. If you can get your machine to run, then
+ this will produce far too much information.
+
+ FTP sites
+ ------------------------------
+ ftp://ftp.redhat.com/pub/aic/
+ - Out of date. I used to keep stuff here, but too many people
+ complained about having a hard time getting into Red Hat's ftp
+ server. So use the web site below instead.
+ ftp://ftp.pcnet.com/users/eischen/Linux/
+ - Dan Eischen's driver distribution area
+ ftp://ekf2.vsb.cz/pub/linux/kernel/aic7xxx/ftp.teleport.com/
+ - European Linux mirror of Teleport site
+
+ Web sites
+ ------------------------------
+ http://people.redhat.com/dledford/
+ - My web site, also the primary aic7xxx site with several related
+ pages.
+
+Dean W. Gehnert
+deang@teleport.com
+
+$Revision: 3.0 $
+
+Modified by Doug Ledford 1998-2000
+
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/cpqfc.txt b/Documentation/scsi/cpqfc.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..dd33e61c0645
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/cpqfc.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,272 @@
+Notes for CPQFCTS driver for Compaq Tachyon TS
+Fibre Channel Host Bus Adapter, PCI 64-bit, 66MHz
+for Linux (RH 6.1, 6.2 kernel 2.2.12-32, 2.2.14-5)
+SMP tested
+Tested in single and dual HBA configuration, 32 and 64bit busses,
+33 and 66MHz. Only supports FC-AL.
+SEST size 512 Exchanges (simultaneous I/Os) limited by module kmalloc()
+ max of 128k bytes contiguous.
+
+Ver 2.5.4 Oct 03, 2002
+ * fixed memcpy of sense buffer in ioctl to copy the smaller defined size
+Ver 2.5.3 Aug 01, 2002
+ * fix the passthru ioctl to handle the Scsi_Cmnd->request being a pointer
+Ver 2.5.1 Jul 30, 2002
+ * fix ioctl to pay attention to the specified LUN.
+Ver 2.5.0 Nov 29, 2001
+ * eliminated io_request_lock. This change makes the driver specific
+ to the 2.5.x kernels.
+ * silenced excessively noisy printks.
+
+Ver 2.1.2 July 23, 2002
+ * initialize DumCmnd->lun in cpqfcTS_ioctl (used in fcFindLoggedInPorts as LUN index)
+
+Ver 2.1.1 Oct 18, 2001
+ * reinitialize Cmnd->SCp.sent_command (used to identify commands as
+ passthrus) on calling scsi_done, since the scsi mid layer does not
+ use (or reinitialize) this field to prevent subsequent comands from
+ having it set incorrectly.
+
+Ver 2.1.0 Aug 27, 2001
+ * Revise driver to use new kernel 2.4.x PCI DMA API, instead of
+ virt_to_bus(). (enables driver to work w/ ia64 systems with >2Gb RAM.)
+ Rework main scatter-gather code to handle cases where SG element
+ lengths are larger than 0x7FFFF bytes and use as many scatter
+ gather pages as necessary. (Steve Cameron)
+ * Makefile changes to bring cpqfc into line w/ rest of SCSI drivers
+ (thanks to Keith Owens)
+
+Ver 2.0.5 Aug 06, 2001
+ * Reject non-existent luns in the driver rather than letting the
+ hardware do it. (some HW behaves differently than others in this area.)
+ * Changed Makefile to rely on "make dep" instead of explicit dependencies
+ * ifdef'ed out fibre channel analyzer triggering debug code
+ * fixed a jiffies wrapping issue
+
+Ver 2.0.4 Aug 01, 2001
+ * Incorporated fix for target device reset from Steeleye
+ * Fixed passthrough ioctl so it doesn't hang.
+ * Fixed hang in launch_FCworker_thread() that occurred on some machines.
+ * Avoid problem when number of volumes in a single cabinet > 8
+
+Ver 2.0.2 July 23, 2001
+ Changed the semiphore changes so the driver would compile in 2.4.7.
+ This version is for 2.4.7 and beyond.
+
+Ver 2.0.1 May 7, 2001
+ Merged version 1.3.6 fixes into version 2.0.0.
+
+Ver 2.0.0 May 7, 2001
+ Fixed problem so spinlock is being initialized to UNLOCKED.
+ Fixed updated driver so it compiles in the 2.4 tree.
+
+ Ver 1.3.6 Feb 27, 2001
+ Added Target_Device_Reset function for SCSI error handling
+ Fixed problem with not reseting addressing mode after implicit logout
+
+
+Ver 1.3.4 Sep 7, 2000
+ Added Modinfo information
+ Fixed problem with statically linking the driver
+
+Ver 1.3.3, Aug 23, 2000
+ Fixed device/function number in ioctl
+
+Ver 1.3.2, July 27, 2000
+ Add include for Alpha compile on 2.2.14 kernel (cpq*i2c.c)
+ Change logic for different FCP-RSP sense_buffer location for HSG80 target
+ And search for Agilent Tachyon XL2 HBAs (not finished! - in test)
+
+Tested with
+(storage):
+ Compaq RA-4x000, RAID firmware ver 2.40 - 2.54
+ Seagate FC drives model ST39102FC, rev 0006
+ Hitachi DK31CJ-72FC rev J8A8
+ IBM DDYF-T18350R rev F60K
+ Compaq FC-SCSI bridge w/ DLT 35/70 Gb DLT (tape)
+(servers):
+ Compaq PL-1850R
+ Compaq PL-6500 Xeon (400MHz)
+ Compaq PL-8500 (500MHz, 66MHz, 64bit PCI)
+ Compaq Alpha DS20 (RH 6.1)
+(hubs):
+ Vixel Rapport 1000 (7-port "dumb")
+ Gadzoox Gibralter (12-port "dumb")
+ Gadzoox Capellix 2000, 3000
+(switches):
+ Brocade 2010, 2400, 2800, rev 2.0.3a (& later)
+ Gadzoox 3210 (Fabric blade beta)
+ Vixel 7100 (Fabric beta firmare - known hot plug issues)
+using "qa_test" (esp. io_test script) suite modified from Unix tests.
+
+Installation:
+make menuconfig
+ (select SCSI low-level, Compaq FC HBA)
+make modules
+make modules_install
+
+e.g. insmod -f cpqfc
+
+Due to Fabric/switch delays, driver requires 4 seconds
+to initialize. If adapters are found, there will be a entries at
+/proc/scsi/cpqfcTS/*
+
+sample contents of startup messages
+
+*************************
+ scsi_register allocating 3596 bytes for CPQFCHBA
+ ioremap'd Membase: c887e600
+ HBA Tachyon RevId 1.2
+Allocating 119808 for 576 Exchanges @ c0dc0000
+Allocating 112904 for LinkQ @ c0c20000 (576 elements)
+Allocating 110600 for TachSEST for 512 Exchanges
+ cpqfcTS: writing IMQ BASE 7C0000h PI 7C4000h
+ cpqfcTS: SEST c0e40000(virt): Wrote base E40000h @ c887e740
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 0000E8h WWN: 500507650642499D SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/0
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 0000EFh WWN: 50000E100000D5A6 SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/1
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 0000E4h WWN: 21000020370097BB SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/2
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 0000E2h WWN: 2100002037009946 SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/3
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 0000E1h WWN: 21000020370098FE SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/4
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 0000E0h WWN: 21000020370097B2 SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/5
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 0000DCh WWN: 2100002037006CC1 SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/6
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 0000DAh WWN: 21000020370059F6 SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/7
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 00000Fh WWN: 500805F1FADB0E20 SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/8
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 000008h WWN: 500805F1FADB0EBA SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/9
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 000004h WWN: 500805F1FADB1EB9 SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/10
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 000002h WWN: 500805F1FADB1ADE SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/11
+cpqfcTS: New FC port 000001h WWN: 500805F1FADBA2CA SCSI Chan/Trgt 0/12
+scsi4 : Compaq FibreChannel HBA Tachyon TS HPFC-5166A/1.2: WWN 500508B200193F50
+ on PCI bus 0 device 0xa0fc irq 5 IObaseL 0x3400, MEMBASE 0xc6ef8600
+PCI bus width 32 bits, bus speed 33 MHz
+FCP-SCSI Driver v1.3.0
+GBIC detected: Short-wave. LPSM 0h Monitor
+scsi : 5 hosts.
+ Vendor: IBM Model: DDYF-T18350R Rev: F60K
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 03
+Detected scsi disk sdb at scsi4, channel 0, id 0, lun 0
+ Vendor: HITACHI Model: DK31CJ-72FC Rev: J8A8
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdc at scsi4, channel 0, id 1, lun 0
+ Vendor: SEAGATE Model: ST39102FC Rev: 0006
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdd at scsi4, channel 0, id 2, lun 0
+ Vendor: SEAGATE Model: ST39102FC Rev: 0006
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sde at scsi4, channel 0, id 3, lun 0
+ Vendor: SEAGATE Model: ST39102FC Rev: 0006
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdf at scsi4, channel 0, id 4, lun 0
+ Vendor: SEAGATE Model: ST39102FC Rev: 0006
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdg at scsi4, channel 0, id 5, lun 0
+ Vendor: SEAGATE Model: ST39102FC Rev: 0006
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdh at scsi4, channel 0, id 6, lun 0
+ Vendor: SEAGATE Model: ST39102FC Rev: 0006
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdi at scsi4, channel 0, id 7, lun 0
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.48
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdj at scsi4, channel 0, id 8, lun 0
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.48
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdk at scsi4, channel 0, id 8, lun 1
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.40
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdl at scsi4, channel 0, id 9, lun 0
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.40
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdm at scsi4, channel 0, id 9, lun 1
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.54
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdn at scsi4, channel 0, id 10, lun 0
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.54
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdo at scsi4, channel 0, id 11, lun 0
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.54
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdp at scsi4, channel 0, id 11, lun 1
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.54
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdq at scsi4, channel 0, id 12, lun 0
+ Vendor: COMPAQ Model: LOGICAL VOLUME Rev: 2.54
+ Type: Direct-Access ANSI SCSI revision: 02
+Detected scsi disk sdr at scsi4, channel 0, id 12, lun 1
+resize_dma_pool: unknown device type 12
+resize_dma_pool: unknown device type 12
+SCSI device sdb: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 35843670 [17501 MB] [17.5 GB]
+ sdb: sdb1
+SCSI device sdc: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 144410880 [70513 MB] [70.5 GB]
+ sdc: sdc1
+SCSI device sdd: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17783240 [8683 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdd: sdd1
+SCSI device sde: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17783240 [8683 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sde: sde1
+SCSI device sdf: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17783240 [8683 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdf: sdf1
+SCSI device sdg: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17783240 [8683 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdg: sdg1
+SCSI device sdh: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17783240 [8683 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdh: sdh1
+SCSI device sdi: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17783240 [8683 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdi: sdi1
+SCSI device sdj: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 2056160 [1003 MB] [1.0 GB]
+ sdj: sdj1
+SCSI device sdk: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 2052736 [1002 MB] [1.0 GB]
+ sdk: sdk1
+SCSI device sdl: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17764320 [8673 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdl: sdl1
+SCSI device sdm: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 8380320 [4091 MB] [4.1 GB]
+ sdm: sdm1
+SCSI device sdn: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17764320 [8673 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdn: sdn1
+SCSI device sdo: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17764320 [8673 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdo: sdo1
+SCSI device sdp: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 17764320 [8673 MB] [8.7 GB]
+ sdp: sdp1
+SCSI device sdq: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 2056160 [1003 MB] [1.0 GB]
+ sdq: sdq1
+SCSI device sdr: hdwr sector= 512 bytes. Sectors= 2052736 [1002 MB] [1.0 GB]
+ sdr: sdr1
+
+*************************
+
+If a GBIC of type Short-wave, Long-wave, or Copper is detected, it will
+print out; otherwise, "none" is displayed. If the cabling is correct
+and a loop circuit is completed, you should see "Monitor"; otherwise,
+"LoopFail" (on open circuit) or some LPSM number/state with bit 3 set.
+
+
+ERRATA:
+1. Normally, Linux Scsi queries FC devices with INQUIRY strings. All LUNs
+found according to INQUIRY should get READ commands at sector 0 to find
+partition table, etc. Older kernels only query the first 4 devices. Some
+Linux kernels only look for one LUN per target (i.e. FC device).
+
+2. Physically removing a device, or a malfunctioning system which hides a
+device, leads to a 30-second timeout and subsequent _abort call.
+In some process contexts, this will hang the kernel (crashing the system).
+Single bit errors in frames and virtually all hot plugging events are
+gracefully handled with internal driver timer and Abort processing.
+
+3. Some SCSI drives with error conditions will not handle the 7 second timeout
+in this software driver, leading to infinite retries on timed out SCSI commands.
+The 7 secs balances the need to quickly recover from lost frames (esp. on sequence
+initiatives) and time needed by older/slower/error-state drives in responding.
+This can be easily changed in "Exchanges[].timeOut".
+
+4. Due to the nature of FC soft addressing, there is no assurance that the
+same LUNs (drives) will have the same path (e.g. /dev/sdb1) from one boot to
+next. Dynamic soft address changes (i.e. 24-bit FC port_id) are
+supported during run time (e.g. due to hot plug event) by the use of WWN to
+SCSI Nexus (channel/target/LUN) mapping.
+
+5. Compaq RA4x00 firmware version 2.54 and later supports SSP (Selective
+Storage Presentation), which maps LUNs to a WWN. If RA4x00 firmware prior
+2.54 (e.g. older controller) is used, or the FC HBA is replaced (another WWN
+is used), logical volumes on the RA4x00 will no longer be visible.
+
+
+Send questions/comments to:
+Amy Vanzant-Hodge (fibrechannel@compaq.com)
+
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/dc395x.txt b/Documentation/scsi/dc395x.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..ae3b79a2d275
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/dc395x.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
+README file for the dc395x SCSI driver
+==========================================
+
+Status
+------
+The driver has been tested with CD-R and CD-R/W drives. These should
+be safe to use. Testing with hard disks has not been done to any
+great degree and caution should be exercised if you want to attempt
+to use this driver with hard disks.
+
+This is a 2.5 only driver. For a 2.4 driver please see the original
+driver (which this driver started from) at
+http://www.garloff.de/kurt/linux/dc395/
+
+Problems, questions and patches should be submitted to the mailing
+list. Details on the list, including archives, are available at
+http://lists.twibble.org/mailman/listinfo/dc395x/
+
+Parameters
+----------
+The driver uses the settings from the EEPROM set in the SCSI BIOS
+setup. If there is no EEPROM, the driver uses default values.
+Both can be overriden by command line parameters (module or kernel
+parameters).
+
+The following parameters are available:
+
+ - safe
+ Default: 0, Acceptable values: 0 or 1
+
+ If safe is set to 1 then the adapter will use conservative
+ ("safe") default settings. This sets:
+
+ shortcut for dc395x=7,4,9,15,2,10
+
+ - adapter_id
+ Default: 7, Acceptable values: 0 to 15
+
+ Sets the host adapter SCSI ID.
+
+ - max_speed
+ Default: 1, Acceptable value: 0 to 7
+ 0 = 20 Mhz
+ 1 = 12.2 Mhz
+ 2 = 10 Mhz
+ 3 = 8 Mhz
+ 4 = 6.7 Mhz
+ 5 = 5.8 Hhz
+ 6 = 5 Mhz
+ 7 = 4 Mhz
+
+ - dev_mode
+ Bitmap for device configuration
+
+ DevMode bit definition:
+ Bit Val(hex) Val(dec) Meaning
+ *0 0x01 1 Parity check
+ *1 0x02 2 Synchronous Negotiation
+ *2 0x04 4 Disconnection
+ *3 0x08 8 Send Start command on startup. (Not used)
+ *4 0x10 16 Tagged Command Queueing
+ *5 0x20 32 Wide Negotiation
+
+ - adapter_mode
+ Bitmap for adapter configuration
+
+ AdaptMode bit definition
+ Bit Val(hex) Val(dec) Meaning
+ *0 0x01 1 Support more than two drives. (Not used)
+ *1 0x02 2 Use DOS compatible mapping for HDs greater than 1GB.
+ *2 0x04 4 Reset SCSI Bus on startup.
+ *3 0x08 8 Active Negation: Improves SCSI Bus noise immunity.
+ 4 0x10 16 Immediate return on BIOS seek command. (Not used)
+ (*)5 0x20 32 Check for LUNs >= 1.
+
+ - tags
+ Default: 3, Acceptable values: 0-5
+
+ The number of tags is 1<<x, if x has been specified
+
+ - reset_delay
+ Default: 1, Acceptable values: 0-180
+
+ The seconds to not accept commands after a SCSI Reset
+
+
+For the built in driver the parameters should be prefixed with
+dc395x. (eg "dc395x.safe=1")
+
+
+Copyright
+---------
+The driver is free software. It is protected by the GNU General Public
+License (GPL). Please read it, before using this driver. It should be
+included in your kernel sources and with your distribution. It carries the
+filename COPYING. If you don't have it, please ask me to send you one by
+email.
+Note: The GNU GPL says also something about warranty and liability.
+Please be aware the following: While we do my best to provide a working and
+reliable driver, there is a chance, that it will kill your valuable data.
+We refuse to take any responsibility for that. The driver is provided as-is
+and YOU USE IT AT YOUR OWN RESPONSIBILITY.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/dpti.txt b/Documentation/scsi/dpti.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..6e45e70243e5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/dpti.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,83 @@
+ /* TERMS AND CONDITIONS OF USE
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source form, with or without modification, are
+ * permitted provided that redistributions of source code must retain the
+ * above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ *
+ * This software is provided `as is' by Adaptec and
+ * any express or implied warranties, including, but not limited to, the
+ * implied warranties of merchantability and fitness for a particular purpose,
+ * are disclaimed. In no event shall Adaptec be
+ * liable for any direct, indirect, incidental, special, exemplary or
+ * consequential damages (including, but not limited to, procurement of
+ * substitute goods or services; loss of use, data, or profits; or business
+ * interruptions) however caused and on any theory of liability, whether in
+ * contract, strict liability, or tort (including negligence or otherwise)
+ * arising in any way out of the use of this driver software, even if advised
+ * of the possibility of such damage.
+ *
+ ****************************************************************
+ * This driver supports the Adaptec I2O RAID and DPT SmartRAID V I2O boards.
+ *
+ * CREDITS:
+ * The original linux driver was ported to Linux by Karen White while at
+ * Dell Computer. It was ported from Bob Pasteur's (of DPT) original
+ * non-Linux driver. Mark Salyzyn and Bob Pasteur consulted on the original
+ * driver.
+ *
+ * 2.0 version of the driver by Deanna Bonds and Mark Salyzyn.
+ *
+ * HISTORY:
+ * The driver was originally ported to linux version 2.0.34
+ *
+ * V2.0 Rewrite of driver. Re-architectured based on i2o subsystem.
+ * This was the first full GPL version since the last version used
+ * i2osig headers which were not GPL. Developer Testing version.
+ * V2.1 Internal testing
+ * V2.2 First released version
+ *
+ * V2.3
+ * Changes:
+ * Added Raptor Support
+ * Fixed bug causing system to hang under extreme load with
+ * management utilities running (removed GFP_DMA from kmalloc flags)
+ *
+ *
+ * V2.4 First version ready to be submitted to be embedded in the kernel
+ * Changes:
+ * Implemented suggestions from Alan Cox
+ * Added calculation of resid for sg layer
+ * Better error handling
+ * Added checking underflow condtions
+ * Added DATAPROTECT checking
+ * Changed error return codes
+ * Fixed pointer bug in bus reset routine
+ * Enabled hba reset from ioctls (allows a FW flash to reboot and use the new
+ * FW without having to reboot)
+ * Changed proc output
+ *
+ * TODO:
+ * Add 64 bit Scatter Gather when compiled on 64 bit architectures
+ * Add sparse lun scanning
+ * Add code that checks if a device that had been taken offline is
+ * now online (at the FW level) when test unit ready or inquiry
+ * command from scsi-core
+ * Add proc read interface
+ * busrescan command
+ * rescan command
+ * Add code to rescan routine that notifies scsi-core about new devices
+ * Add support for C-PCI (hotplug stuff)
+ * Add ioctl passthru error recovery
+ *
+ * NOTES:
+ * The DPT card optimizes the order of processing commands. Consequently,
+ * a command may take up to 6 minutes to complete after it has been sent
+ * to the board.
+ *
+ * The files dpti_ioctl.h dptsig.h osd_defs.h osd_util.h sys_info.h are part of the
+ * interface files for Adaptec's management routines. These define the structures used
+ * in the ioctls. They are written to be portable. They are hard to read, but I need
+ * to use them 'as is' or I can miss changes in the interface.
+ *
+ */
+
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/dtc3x80.txt b/Documentation/scsi/dtc3x80.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..e8ae6230ab3e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/dtc3x80.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,43 @@
+README file for the Linux DTC3180/3280 scsi driver.
+by Ray Van Tassle (rayvt@comm.mot.com) March 1996
+Based on the generic & core NCR5380 code by Drew Eckhard
+
+SCSI device driver for the DTC 3180/3280.
+Data Technology Corp---a division of Qume.
+
+The 3280 has a standard floppy interface.
+
+The 3180 does not. Otherwise, they are identical.
+
+The DTC3x80 does not support DMA but it does have Pseudo-DMA which is
+supported by the driver.
+
+It's DTC406 scsi chip is supposedly compatible with the NCR 53C400.
+It is memory mapped, uses an IRQ, but no dma or io-port. There is
+internal DMA, between SCSI bus and an on-chip 128-byte buffer. Double
+buffering is done automagically by the chip. Data is transferred
+between the on-chip buffer and CPU/RAM via memory moves.
+
+The driver detects the possible memory addresses (jumper selectable):
+ CC00, DC00, C800, and D800
+The possible IRQ's (jumper selectable) are:
+ IRQ 10, 11, 12, 15
+Parity is supported by the chip, but not by this driver.
+Information can be obtained from /proc/scsi/dtc3c80/N.
+
+Note on interrupts:
+
+The documentation says that it can be set to interrupt whenever the
+on-chip buffer needs CPU attention. I couldn't get this to work. So
+the driver polls for data-ready in the pseudo-DMA transfer routine.
+The interrupt support routines in the NCR3280.c core modules handle
+scsi disconnect/reconnect, and this (mostly) works. However..... I
+have tested it with 4 totally different hard drives (both SCSI-1 and
+SCSI-2), and one CDROM drive. Interrupts works great for all but one
+specific hard drive. For this one, the driver will eventually hang in
+the transfer state. I have tested with: "dd bs=4k count=2k
+of=/dev/null if=/dev/sdb". It reads ok for a while, then hangs.
+After beating my head against this for a couple of weeks, getting
+nowhere, I give up. So.....This driver does NOT use interrupts, even
+if you have the card jumpered to an IRQ. Probably nobody will ever
+care.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/g_NCR5380.txt b/Documentation/scsi/g_NCR5380.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..3b80f567f818
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/g_NCR5380.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
+README file for the Linux g_NCR5380 driver.
+
+(c) 1993 Drew Eckhard
+NCR53c400 extensions (c) 1994,1995,1996 Kevin Lentin
+
+This file documents the NCR53c400 extensions by Kevin Lentin and some
+enhancements to the NCR5380 core.
+
+This driver supports both NCR5380 and NCR53c400 cards in port or memory
+mapped modes. Currently this driver can only support one of those mapping
+modes at a time but it does support both of these chips at the same time.
+The next release of this driver will support port & memory mapped cards at
+the same time. It should be able to handle multiple different cards in the
+same machine.
+
+The drivers/scsi/Makefile has an override in it for the most common
+NCR53c400 card, the Trantor T130B in its default configuration:
+ Port: 0x350
+ IRQ : 5
+
+The NCR53c400 does not support DMA but it does have Pseudo-DMA which is
+supported by the driver.
+
+If the default configuration does not work for you, you can use the kernel
+command lines (eg using the lilo append command):
+ ncr5380=port,irq,dma
+ ncr53c400=port,irq
+or
+ ncr5380=base,irq,dma
+ ncr53c400=base,irq
+
+The driver does not probe for any addresses or ports other than those in
+the OVERRIDE or given to the kernel as above.
+
+This driver provides some information on what it has detected in
+/proc/scsi/g_NCR5380/x where x is the scsi card number as detected at boot
+time. More info to come in the future.
+
+When NCR53c400 support is compiled in, BIOS parameters will be returned by
+the driver (the raw 5380 driver does not and I don't plan to fiddle with
+it!).
+
+This driver works as a module.
+When included as a module, parameters can be passed on the insmod/modprobe
+command line:
+ ncr_irq=xx the interrupt
+ ncr_addr=xx the port or base address (for port or memory
+ mapped, resp.)
+ ncr_dma=xx the DMA
+ ncr_5380=1 to set up for a NCR5380 board
+ ncr_53c400=1 to set up for a NCR53C400 board
+e.g.
+modprobe g_NCR5380 ncr_irq=5 ncr_addr=0x350 ncr_5380=1
+ for a port mapped NCR5380 board or
+modprobe g_NCR5380 ncr_irq=255 ncr_addr=0xc8000 ncr_53c400=1
+ for a memory mapped NCR53C400 board with interrupts disabled.
+
+(255 should be specified for no or DMA interrupt, 254 to autoprobe for an
+ IRQ line if overridden on the command line.)
+
+
+Kevin Lentin
+K.Lentin@cs.monash.edu.au
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ibmmca.txt b/Documentation/scsi/ibmmca.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..2814491600ff
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ibmmca.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,1402 @@
+
+ -=< The IBM Microchannel SCSI-Subsystem >=-
+
+ for the IBM PS/2 series
+
+ Low Level Software-Driver for Linux
+
+ Copyright (c) 1995 Strom Systems, Inc. under the terms of the GNU
+ General Public License. Originally written by Martin Kolinek, December 1995.
+ Officially modified and maintained by Michael Lang since January 1999.
+
+ Version 4.0a
+
+ Last update: January 3, 2001
+
+ Before you Start
+ ----------------
+ This is the common README.ibmmca file for all driver releases of the
+ IBM MCA SCSI driver for Linux. Please note, that driver releases 4.0
+ or newer do not work with kernel versions older than 2.4.0, while driver
+ versions older than 4.0 do not work with kernels 2.4.0 or later! If you
+ try to compile your kernel with the wrong driver source, the
+ compilation is aborted and you get a corresponding error message. This is
+ no bug in the driver. It prevents you from using the wrong sourcecode
+ with the wrong kernel version.
+
+ Authors of this Driver
+ ----------------------
+ - Chris Beauregard (improvement of the SCSI-device mapping by the driver)
+ - Martin Kolinek (origin, first release of this driver)
+ - Klaus Kudielka (multiple SCSI-host management/detection, adaption to
+ Linux Kernel 2.1.x, module support)
+ - Michael Lang (assigning original pun/lun mapping, dynamical ldn
+ assignment, rewritten adapter detection, this file,
+ patches, official driver maintenance and subsequent
+ debugging, related with the driver)
+
+ Table of Contents
+ -----------------
+ 1 Abstract
+ 2 Driver Description
+ 2.1 IBM SCSI-Subsystem Detection
+ 2.2 Physical Units, Logical Units, and Logical Devices
+ 2.3 SCSI-Device Recognition and dynamical ldn Assignment
+ 2.4 SCSI-Device Order
+ 2.5 Regular SCSI-Command-Processing
+ 2.6 Abort & Reset Commands
+ 2.7 Disk Geometry
+ 2.8 Kernel Boot Option
+ 2.9 Driver Module Support
+ 2.10 Multiple Hostadapter Support
+ 2.11 /proc/scsi-Filesystem Information
+ 2.12 /proc/mca-Filesystem Information
+ 2.13 Supported IBM SCSI-Subsystems
+ 2.14 Linux Kernel Versions
+ 3 Code History
+ 4 To do
+ 5 Users' Manual
+ 5.1 Commandline Parameters
+ 5.2 Troubleshooting
+ 5.3 Bugreports
+ 5.4 Support WWW-page
+ 6 References
+ 7 Credits to
+ 7.1 People
+ 7.2 Sponsors & Supporters
+ 8 Trademarks
+ 9 Disclaimer
+
+ * * *
+
+ 1 Abstract
+ ----------
+ This README-file describes the IBM SCSI-subsystem low level driver for
+ Linux. The descriptions which were formerly kept in the source-code have
+ been taken out to this file to easify the codes' readability. The driver
+ description has been updated, as most of the former description was already
+ quite outdated. The history of the driver development is also kept inside
+ here. Multiple historical developments have been summarized to shorten the
+ textsize a bit. At the end of this file you can find a small manual for
+ this driver and hints to get it running on your machine.
+
+ 2 Driver Description
+ --------------------
+ 2.1 IBM SCSI-Subsystem Detection
+ --------------------------------
+ This is done in the ibmmca_detect() function. It first checks, if the
+ Microchannel-bus support is enabled, as the IBM SCSI-subsystem needs the
+ Microchannel. In a next step, a free interrupt is chosen and the main
+ interrupt handler is connected to it to handle answers of the SCSI-
+ subsystem(s). If the F/W SCSI-adapter is forced by the BIOS to use IRQ11
+ instead of IRQ14, IRQ11 is used for the IBM SCSI-2 F/W adapter. In a
+ further step it is checked, if the adapter gets detected by force from
+ the kernel commandline, where the I/O port and the SCSI-subsystem id can
+ be specified. The next step checks if there is an integrated SCSI-subsystem
+ installed. This register area is fixed through all IBM PS/2 MCA-machines
+ and appears as something like a virtual slot 10 of the MCA-bus. On most
+ PS/2 machines, the POS registers of slot 10 are set to 0xff or 0x00 if not
+ integrated SCSI-controller is available. But on certain PS/2s, like model
+ 9595, this slot 10 is used to store other information which at earlier
+ stage confused the driver and resulted in the detection of some ghost-SCSI.
+ If POS-register 2 and 3 are not 0x00 and not 0xff, but all other POS
+ registers are either 0xff or 0x00, there must be an integrated SCSI-
+ subsystem present and it will be registered as IBM Integrated SCSI-
+ Subsystem. The next step checks, if there is a slot-adapter installed on
+ the MCA-bus. To get this, the first two POS-registers, that represent the
+ adapter ID are checked. If they fit to one of the ids, stored in the
+ adapter list, a SCSI-subsystem is assumed to be found in a slot and will be
+ registered. This check is done through all possible MCA-bus slots to allow
+ more than one SCSI-adapter to be present in the PS/2-system and this is
+ already the first point of problems. Looking into the technical reference
+ manual for the IBM PS/2 common interfaces, the POS2 register must have
+ different interpretation of its single bits to avoid overlapping I/O
+ regions. While one can assume, that the integrated subsystem has a fix
+ I/O-address at 0x3540 - 0x3547, further installed IBM SCSI-adapters must
+ use a different I/O-address. This is expressed by bit 1 to 3 of POS2
+ (multiplied by 8 + 0x3540). Bits 2 and 3 are reserved for the integrated
+ subsystem, but not for the adapters! The following list shows, how the
+ bits of POS2 and POS3 should be interpreted.
+
+ The POS2-register of all PS/2 models' integrated SCSI-subsystems has the
+ following interpretation of bits:
+ Bit 7 - 4 : Chip Revision ID (Release)
+ Bit 3 - 2 : Reserved
+ Bit 1 : 8k NVRAM Disabled
+ Bit 0 : Chip Enable (EN-Signal)
+ The POS3-register is interpreted as follows (for most IBM SCSI-subsys.):
+ Bit 7 - 5 : SCSI ID
+ Bit 4 - 0 : Reserved = 0
+ The slot-adapters have different interpretation of these bits. The IBM SCSI
+ adapter (w/Cache) and the IBM SCSI-2 F/W adapter use the following
+ interpretation of the POS2 register:
+ Bit 7 - 4 : ROM Segment Address Select
+ Bit 3 - 1 : Adapter I/O Address Select (*8+0x3540)
+ Bit 0 : Adapter Enable (EN-Signal)
+ and for the POS3 register:
+ Bit 7 - 5 : SCSI ID
+ Bit 4 : Fairness Enable (SCSI ID3 f. F/W)
+ Bit 3 - 0 : Arbitration Level
+ The most modern product of the series is the IBM SCSI-2 F/W adapter, it
+ allows dual-bus SCSI and SCSI-wide addressing, which means, PUNs may be
+ between 0 and 15. Here, Bit 4 is the high-order bit of the 4-bit wide
+ adapter PUN expression. In short words, this means, that IBM PS/2 machines
+ can only support 1 single integrated subsystem by default. Additional
+ slot-adapters get ports assigned by the automatic configuration tool.
+
+ One day I found a patch in ibmmca_detect(), forcing the I/O-address to be
+ 0x3540 for integrated SCSI-subsystems, there was a remark placed, that on
+ integrated IBM SCSI-subsystems of model 56, the POS2 register was showing 5.
+ This means, that really for these models, POS2 has to be interpreted
+ sticking to the technical reference guide. In this case, the bit 2 (4) is
+ a reserved bit and may not be interpreted. These differences between the
+ adapters and the integrated controllers are taken into account by the
+ detection routine of the driver on from version >3.0g.
+
+ Every time, a SCSI-subsystem is discovered, the ibmmca_register() function
+ is called. This function checks first, if the requested area for the I/O-
+ address of this SCSI-subsystem is still available and assigns this I/O-
+ area to the SCSI-subsystem. There are always 8 sequential I/O-addresses
+ taken for each individual SCSI-subsystem found, which are:
+
+ Offset Type Permissions
+ 0 Command Interface Register 1 Read/Write
+ 1 Command Interface Register 2 Read/Write
+ 2 Command Interface Register 3 Read/Write
+ 3 Command Interface Register 4 Read/Write
+ 4 Attention Register Read/Write
+ 5 Basic Control Register Read/Write
+ 6 Interrupt Status Register Read
+ 7 Basic Status Register Read
+
+ After the I/O-address range is assigned, the host-adapter is assigned
+ to a local structure which keeps all adapter information needed for the
+ driver itself and the mid- and higher-level SCSI-drivers. The SCSI pun/lun
+ and the adapters' ldn tables are initialized and get probed afterwards by
+ the check_devices() function. If no further adapters are found,
+ ibmmca_detect() quits.
+
+ 2.2 Physical Units, Logical Units, and Logical Devices
+ ------------------------------------------------------
+ There can be up to 56 devices on the SCSI bus (besides the adapter):
+ there are up to 7 "physical units" (each identified by physical unit
+ number or pun, also called the scsi id, this is the number you select
+ with hardware jumpers), and each physical unit can have up to 8
+ "logical units" (each identified by logical unit number, or lun,
+ between 0 and 7). The IBM SCSI-2 F/W adapter offers this on up to two
+ busses and provides support for 30 logical devices at the same time, where
+ in wide-addressing mode you can have 16 puns with 32 luns on each device.
+ This section dexribes you the handling of devices on non-F/W adapters.
+ Just imagine, that you can have 16 * 32 = 512 devices on a F/W adapter
+ which means a lot of possible devices for such a small machine.
+
+ Typically the adapter has pun=7, so puns of other physical units
+ are between 0 and 6(15). On a wide-adapter a pun higher than 7 is
+ possible, but is normally not used. Almost all physical units have only
+ one logical unit, with lun=0. A CD-ROM jukebox would be an example of a
+ physical unit with more than one logical unit.
+
+ The embedded microprocessor of the IBM SCSI-subsystem hides the complex
+ two-dimensional (pun,lun) organization from the operating system.
+ When the machine is powered-up (or rebooted), the embedded microprocessor
+ checks, on its own, all 56 possible (pun,lun) combinations, and the first
+ 15 devices found are assigned into a one-dimensional array of so-called
+ "logical devices", identified by "logical device numbers" or ldn. The last
+ ldn=15 is reserved for the subsystem itself. Wide adapters may have
+ to check up to 15 * 8 = 120 pun/lun combinations.
+
+ 2.3 SCSI-Device Recognition and Dynamical ldn Assignment
+ --------------------------------------------------------
+ One consequence of information hiding is that the real (pun,lun)
+ numbers are also hidden. The two possibilities to get around this problem
+ is to offer fake pun/lun combinations to the operating system or to
+ delete the whole mapping of the adapter and to reassign the ldns, using
+ the immediate assign command of the SCSI-subsystem for probing through
+ all possible pun/lun combinations. a ldn is a "logical device number"
+ which is used by IBM SCSI-subsystems to access some valid SCSI-device.
+ At the beginning of the development of this driver, the following approach
+ was used:
+
+ First, the driver checked the ldn's (0 to 6) to find out which ldn's
+ have devices assigned. This was done by the functions check_devices() and
+ device_exists(). The interrupt handler has a special paragraph of code
+ (see local_checking_phase_flag) to assist in the checking. Assume, for
+ example, that three logical devices were found assigned at ldn 0, 1, 2.
+ These are presented to the upper layer of Linux SCSI driver
+ as devices with bogus (pun, lun) equal to (0,0), (1,0), (2,0).
+ On the other hand, if the upper layer issues a command to device
+ say (4,0), this driver returns DID_NO_CONNECT error.
+
+ In a second step of the driver development, the following improvement has
+ been applied: The first approach limited the number of devices to 7, far
+ fewer than the 15 that it could usem then it just maped ldn ->
+ (ldn/8,ldn%8) for pun,lun. We ended up with a real mishmash of puns
+ and luns, but it all seemed to work.
+
+ The latest development, which is implemented from the driver version 3.0
+ and later, realizes the device recognition in the following way:
+ The physical SCSI-devices on the SCSI-bus are probed via immediate_assign-
+ and device_inquiry-commands, that is all implemented in a completely new
+ made check_devices() subroutine. This delivers an exact map of the physical
+ SCSI-world that is now stored in the get_scsi[][]-array. This means,
+ that the once hidden pun,lun assignment is now known to this driver.
+ It no longer believes in default-settings of the subsystem and maps all
+ ldns to existing pun,lun "by foot". This assures full control of the ldn
+ mapping and allows dynamical remapping of ldns to different pun,lun, if
+ there are more SCSI-devices installed than ldns available (n>15). The
+ ldns from 0 to 6 get 'hardwired' by this driver to puns 0 to 7 at lun=0,
+ excluding the pun of the subsystem. This assures, that at least simple
+ SCSI-installations have optimum access-speed and are not touched by
+ dynamical remapping. The ldns 7 to 14 are put to existing devices with
+ lun>0 or to non-existing devices, in order to satisfy the subsystem, if
+ there are less than 15 SCSI-devices connected. In the case of more than 15
+ devices, the dynamical mapping goes active. If the get_scsi[][] reports a
+ device to be existant, but it has no ldn assigned, it gets a ldn out of 7
+ to 14. The numbers are assigned in cyclic order. Therefore it takes 8
+ dynamical reassignments on the SCSI-devices, until a certain device
+ loses its ldn again. This assures, that dynamical remapping is avoided
+ during intense I/O between up to 15 SCSI-devices (means pun,lun
+ combinations). A further advantage of this method is, that people who
+ build their kernel without probing on all luns will get what they expect,
+ because the driver just won't assign everything with lun>0 when
+ multpile lun probing is inactive.
+
+ 2.4 SCSI-Device Order
+ ---------------------
+ Because of the now correct recognition of physical pun,lun, and
+ their report to mid-level- and higher-level-drivers, the new reported puns
+ can be different from the old, faked puns. Therefore, Linux will eventually
+ change /dev/sdXXX assignments and prompt you for corrupted superblock
+ repair on boottime. In this case DO NOT PANIC, YOUR DISKS ARE STILL OK!!!
+ You have to reboot (CTRL-D) with an old kernel and set the /etc/fstab-file
+ entries right. After that, the system should come up as errorfree as before.
+ If your boot-partition is not coming up, also edit the /etc/lilo.conf-file
+ in a Linux session booted on old kernel and run lilo before reboot. Check
+ lilo.conf anyway to get boot on other partitions with foreign OSes right
+ again. But there exists a feature of this driver that allows you to change
+ the assignment order of the SCSI-devices by flipping the PUN-assignment.
+ See the next paragraph for a description.
+
+ The problem for this is, that Linux does not assign the SCSI-devices in the
+ way as described in the ANSI-SCSI-standard. Linux assigns /dev/sda to
+ the device with at minimum id 0. But the first drive should be at id 6,
+ because for historical reasons, drive at id 6 has, by hardware, the highest
+ priority and a drive at id 0 the lowest. IBM was one of the rare producers,
+ where the BIOS assigns drives belonging to the ANSI-SCSI-standard. Most
+ other producers' BIOS does not (I think even Adaptec-BIOS). The
+ IBMMCA_SCSI_ORDER_STANDARD flag, which you set while configuring the
+ kernel enables to choose the preferred way of SCSI-device-assignment.
+ Defining this flag would result in Linux determining the devices in the
+ same order as DOS and OS/2 does on your MCA-machine. This is also standard
+ on most industrial computers and OSes, like e.g. OS-9. Leaving this flag
+ undefined will get your devices ordered in the default way of Linux. See
+ also the remarks of Chris Beauregard from Dec 15, 1997 and the followups
+ in section 3.
+
+ 2.5 Regular SCSI-Command-Processing
+ -----------------------------------
+ Only three functions get involved: ibmmca_queuecommand(), issue_cmd(),
+ and interrupt_handler().
+
+ The upper layer issues a scsi command by calling function
+ ibmmca_queuecommand(). This function fills a "subsystem control block"
+ (scb) and calls a local function issue_cmd(), which writes a scb
+ command into subsystem I/O ports. Once the scb command is carried out,
+ the interrupt_handler() is invoked. If a device is determined to be
+ existant and it has not assigned any ldn, it gets one dynamically.
+ For this, the whole stuff is done in ibmmca_queuecommand().
+
+ 2.6 Abort & Reset Commands
+ --------------------------
+ These are implemented with busy waiting for interrupt to arrive.
+ ibmmca_reset() and ibmmca_abort() do not work sufficently well
+ up to now and need still a lot of development work. But, this seems
+ to be even a problem with other SCSI-low level drivers, too. However,
+ this should be no excuse.
+
+ 2.7 Disk Geometry
+ -----------------
+ The ibmmca_biosparams() function should return the same disk geometry
+ as the bios. This is needed for fdisk, etc. The returned geometry is
+ certainly correct for disks smaller than 1 gigabyte. In the meantime,
+ it has been proved, that this works fine even with disks larger than
+ 1 gigabyte.
+
+ 2.8 Kernel Boot Option
+ ----------------------
+ The function ibmmca_scsi_setup() is called if option ibmmcascsi=n
+ is passed to the kernel. See file linux/init/main.c for details.
+
+ 2.9 Driver Module Support
+ -------------------------
+ Is implemented and tested by K. Kudielka. This could probably not work
+ on kernels <2.1.0.
+
+ 2.10 Multiple Hostadapter Support
+ ---------------------------------
+ This driver supports up to eight interfaces of type IBM-SCSI-Subsystem.
+ Integrated-, and MCA-adapters are automatically recognized. Unrecognizable
+ IBM-SCSI-Subsystem interfaces can be specified as kernel-parameters.
+
+ 2.11 /proc/scsi-Filesystem Information
+ --------------------------------------
+ Information about the driver condition is given in
+ /proc/scsi/ibmmca/<host_no>. ibmmca_proc_info() provides this information.
+
+ This table is quite informative for interested users. It shows the load
+ of commands on the subsystem and wether you are running the bypassed
+ (software) or integrated (hardware) SCSI-command set (see below). The
+ amount of accesses is shown. Read, write, modeselect is shown separately
+ in order to help debugging problems with CD-ROMs or tapedrives.
+
+ The following table shows the list of 15 logical device numbers, that are
+ used by the SCSI-subsystem. The load on each ldn is shown in the table,
+ again, read and write commands are split. The last column shows the amount
+ of reassignments, that have been applied to the ldns, if you have more than
+ 15 pun/lun combinations available on the SCSI-bus.
+
+ The last two tables show the pun/lun map and the positions of the ldns
+ on this pun/lun map. This may change during operation, when a ldn is
+ reassigned to another pun/lun combination. If the necessity for dynamical
+ assignments is set to 'no', the ldn structure keeps static.
+
+ 2.12 /proc/mca-Filesystem Information
+ -------------------------------------
+ The slot-file contains all default entries and in addition chip and I/O-
+ address information of the SCSI-subsystem. This information is provided
+ by ibmmca_getinfo().
+
+ 2.13 Supported IBM SCSI-Subsystems
+ ----------------------------------
+ The following IBM SCSI-subsystems are supported by this driver:
+
+ - IBM Fast/Wide SCSI-2 Adapter
+ - IBM 7568 Industrial Computer SCSI Adapter w/Cache
+ - IBM Expansion Unit SCSI Controller
+ - IBM SCSI Adapter w/Cache
+ - IBM SCSI Adapter
+ - IBM Integrated SCSI Controller
+ - All clones, 100% compatible with the chipset and subsystem command
+ system of IBM SCSI-adapters (forced detection)
+
+ 2.14 Linux Kernel Versions
+ --------------------------
+ The IBM SCSI-subsystem low level driver is prepared to be used with
+ all versions of Linux between 2.0.x and 2.4.x. The compatibility checks
+ are fully implemented up from version 3.1e of the driver. This means, that
+ you just need the latest ibmmca.h and ibmmca.c file and copy it in the
+ linux/drivers/scsi directory. The code is automatically adapted during
+ kernel compilation. This is different from kernel 2.4.0! Here version
+ 4.0 or later of the driver must be used for kernel 2.4.0 or later. Version
+ 4.0 or later does not work together with older kernels! Driver versions
+ older than 4.0 do not work together with kernel 2.4.0 or later. They work
+ on all older kernels.
+
+ 3 Code History
+ --------------
+ Jan 15 1996: First public release.
+ - Martin Kolinek
+
+ Jan 23 1996: Scrapped code which reassigned scsi devices to logical
+ device numbers. Instead, the existing assignment (created
+ when the machine is powered-up or rebooted) is used.
+ A side effect is that the upper layer of Linux SCSI
+ device driver gets bogus scsi ids (this is benign),
+ and also the hard disks are ordered under Linux the
+ same way as they are under dos (i.e., C: disk is sda,
+ D: disk is sdb, etc.).
+ - Martin Kolinek
+
+ I think that the CD-ROM is now detected only if a CD is
+ inside CD_ROM while Linux boots. This can be fixed later,
+ once the driver works on all types of PS/2's.
+ - Martin Kolinek
+
+ Feb 7 1996: Modified biosparam function. Fixed the CD-ROM detection.
+ For now, devices other than harddisk and CD_ROM are
+ ignored. Temporarily modified abort() function
+ to behave like reset().
+ - Martin Kolinek
+
+ Mar 31 1996: The integrated scsi subsystem is correctly found
+ in PS/2 models 56,57, but not in model 76. Therefore
+ the ibmmca_scsi_setup() function has been added today.
+ This function allows the user to force detection of
+ scsi subsystem. The kernel option has format
+ ibmmcascsi=n
+ where n is the scsi_id (pun) of the subsystem. Most likely, n is 7.
+ - Martin Kolinek
+
+ Aug 21 1996: Modified the code which maps ldns to (pun,0). It was
+ insufficient for those of us with CD-ROM changers.
+ - Chris Beauregard
+
+ Dec 14 1996: More improvements to the ldn mapping. See check_devices
+ for details. Did more fiddling with the integrated SCSI detection,
+ but I think it's ultimately hopeless without actually testing the
+ model of the machine. The 56, 57, 76 and 95 (ultimedia) all have
+ different integrated SCSI register configurations. However, the 56
+ and 57 are the only ones that have problems with forced detection.
+ - Chris Beauregard
+
+ Mar 8-16 1997: Modified driver to run as a module and to support
+ multiple adapters. A structure, called ibmmca_hostdata, is now
+ present, containing all the variables, that were once only
+ available for one single adapter. The find_subsystem-routine has vanished.
+ The hardware recognition is now done in ibmmca_detect directly.
+ This routine checks for presence of MCA-bus, checks the interrupt
+ level and continues with checking the installed hardware.
+ Certain PS/2-models do not recognize a SCSI-subsystem automatically.
+ Hence, the setup defined by command-line-parameters is checked first.
+ Thereafter, the routine probes for an integrated SCSI-subsystem.
+ Finally, adapters are checked. This method has the advantage to cover all
+ possible combinations of multiple SCSI-subsystems on one MCA-board. Up to
+ eight SCSI-subsystems can be recognized and announced to the upper-level
+ drivers with this improvement. A set of defines made changes to other
+ routines as small as possible.
+ - Klaus Kudielka
+
+ May 30 1997: (v1.5b)
+ 1) SCSI-command capability enlarged by the recognition of MODE_SELECT.
+ This needs the RD-Bit to be disabled on IM_OTHER_SCSI_CMD_CMD which
+ allows data to be written from the system to the device. It is a
+ necessary step to be allowed to set blocksize of SCSI-tape-drives and
+ the tape-speed, whithout confusing the SCSI-Subsystem.
+ 2) The recognition of a tape is included in the check_devices routine.
+ This is done by checking for TYPE_TAPE, that is already defined in
+ the kernel-scsi-environment. The markup of a tape is done in the
+ global ldn_is_tape[] array. If the entry on index ldn
+ is 1, there is a tapedrive connected.
+ 3) The ldn_is_tape[] array is necessary to distinguish between tape- and
+ other devices. Fixed blocklength devices should not cause a problem
+ with the SCB-command for read and write in the ibmmca_queuecommand
+ subroutine. Therefore, I only derivate the READ_XX, WRITE_XX for
+ the tape-devices, as recommended by IBM in this Technical Reference,
+ mentioned below. (IBM recommends to avoid using the read/write of the
+ subsystem, but the fact was, that read/write causes a command error from
+ the subsystem and this causes kernel-panic.)
+ 4) In addition, I propose to use the ldn instead of a fix char for the
+ display of PS2_DISK_LED_ON(). On 95, one can distinguish between the
+ devices that are accessed. It shows activity and easyfies debugging.
+ The tape-support has been tested with a SONY SDT-5200 and a HP DDS-2
+ (I do not know yet the type). Optimization and CD-ROM audio-support,
+ I am working on ...
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ June 19 1997: (v1.6b)
+ 1) Submitting the extra-array ldn_is_tape[] -> to the local ld[]
+ device-array.
+ 2) CD-ROM Audio-Play seems to work now.
+ 3) When using DDS-2 (120M) DAT-Tapes, mtst shows still density-code
+ 0x13 for ordinary DDS (61000 BPM) instead 0x24 for DDS-2. This appears
+ also on Adaptec 2940 adaptor in a PCI-System. Therefore, I assume that
+ the problem is independent of the low-level-driver/bus-architecture.
+ 4) Hexadecimal ldn on PS/2-95 LED-display.
+ 5) Fixing of the PS/2-LED on/off that it works right with tapedrives and
+ does not confuse the disk_rw_in_progress counter.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ June 21 1997: (v1.7b)
+ 1) Adding of a proc_info routine to inform in /proc/scsi/ibmmca/<host> the
+ outer-world about operational load statistics on the different ldns,
+ seen by the driver. Everybody that has more than one IBM-SCSI should
+ test this, because I only have one and cannot see what happens with more
+ than one IBM-SCSI hosts.
+ 2) Definition of a driver version-number to have a better recognition of
+ the source when there are existing too much releases that may confuse
+ the user, when reading about release-specific problems. Up to know,
+ I calculated the version-number to be 1.7. Because we are in BETA-test
+ yet, it is today 1.7b.
+ 3) Sorry for the heavy bug I programmed on June 19 1997! After that, the
+ CD-ROM did not work any more! The C7-command was a fake impression
+ I got while programming. Now, the READ and WRITE commands for CD-ROM are
+ no longer running over the subsystem, but just over
+ IM_OTHER_SCSI_CMD_CMD. On my observations (PS/2-95), now CD-ROM mounts
+ much faster(!) and hopefully all fancy multimedia-functions, like direct
+ digital recording from audio-CDs also work. (I tried it with cdda2wav
+ from the cdwtools-package and it filled up the harddisk immediately :-).)
+ To easify boolean logics, a further local device-type in ld[], called
+ is_cdrom has been included.
+ 4) If one uses a SCSI-device of unsupported type/commands, one
+ immediately runs into a kernel-panic caused by Command Error. To better
+ understand which SCSI-command caused the problem, I extended this
+ specific panic-message slightly.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ June 25 1997: (v1.8b)
+ 1) Some cosmetical changes for the handling of SCSI-device-types.
+ Now, also CD-Burners / WORMs and SCSI-scanners should work. For
+ MO-drives I have no experience, therefore not yet supported.
+ In logical_devices I changed from different type-variables to one
+ called 'device_type' where the values, corresponding to scsi.h,
+ of a SCSI-device are stored.
+ 2) There existed a small bug, that maps a device, coming after a SCSI-tape
+ wrong. Therefore, e.g. a CD-ROM changer would have been mapped wrong
+ -> problem removed.
+ 3) Extension of the logical_device structure. Now it contains also device,
+ vendor and revision-level of a SCSI-device for internal usage.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ June 26-29 1997: (v2.0b)
+ 1) The release number 2.0b is necessary because of the completely new done
+ recognition and handling of SCSI-devices with the adapter. As I got
+ from Chris the hint, that the subsystem can reassign ldns dynamically,
+ I remembered this immediate_assign-command, I found once in the handbook.
+ Now, the driver first kills all ldn assignments that are set by default
+ on the SCSI-subsystem. After that, it probes on all puns and luns for
+ devices by going through all combinations with immediate_assign and
+ probing for devices, using device_inquiry. The found physical(!) pun,lun
+ structure is stored in get_scsi[][] as device types. This is followed
+ by the assignment of all ldns to existing SCSI-devices. If more ldns
+ than devices are available, they are assigned to non existing pun,lun
+ combinations to satisfy the adapter. With this, the dynamical mapping
+ was possible to implement. (For further info see the text in the
+ source-code and in the description below. Read the description
+ below BEFORE installing this driver on your system!)
+ 2) Changed the name IBMMCA_DRIVER_VERSION to IBMMCA_SCSI_DRIVER_VERSION.
+ 3) The LED-display shows on PS/2-95 no longer the ldn, but the SCSI-ID
+ (pun) of the accessed SCSI-device. This is now senseful, because the
+ pun known within the driver is exactly the pun of the physical device
+ and no longer a fake one.
+ 4) The /proc/scsi/ibmmca/<host_no> consists now of the first part, where
+ hit-statistics of ldns is shown and a second part, where the maps of
+ physical and logical SCSI-devices are displayed. This could be very
+ interesting, when one is using more than 15 SCSI-devices in order to
+ follow the dynamical remapping of ldns.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ June 26-29 1997: (v2.0b-1)
+ 1) I forgot to switch the local_checking_phase_flag to 1 and back to 0
+ in the dynamical remapping part in ibmmca_queuecommand for the
+ device_exist routine. Sorry.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ July 1-13 1997: (v3.0b,c)
+ 1) Merging of the driver-developments of Klaus Kudielka and Michael Lang
+ in order to get a optimum and unified driver-release for the
+ IBM-SCSI-Subsystem-Adapter(s).
+ For people, using the Kernel-release >=2.1.0, module-support should
+ be no problem. For users, running under <2.1.0, module-support may not
+ work, because the methods have changed between 2.0.x and 2.1.x.
+ 2) Added some more effective statistics for /proc-output.
+ 3) Change typecasting at necessary points from (unsigned long) to
+ virt_to_bus().
+ 4) Included #if... at special points to have specific adaption of the
+ driver to kernel 2.0.x and 2.1.x. It should therefore also run with
+ later releases.
+ 5) Magneto-Optical drives and medium-changers are also recognized, now.
+ Therefore, we have a completely gapfree recognition of all SCSI-
+ device-types, that are known by Linux up to kernel 2.1.31.
+ 6) The flag SCSI_IBMMCA_DEV_RESET has been inserted. If it is set within
+ the configuration, each connected SCSI-device will get a reset command
+ during boottime. This can be necessary for some special SCSI-devices.
+ This flag should be included in Config.in.
+ (See also the new Config.in file.)
+ Probable next improvement: bad disk handler.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Sept 14 1997: (v3.0c)
+ 1) Some debugging and speed optimization applied.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Dec 15, 1997
+ - chrisb@truespectra.com
+ - made the front panel display thingy optional, specified from the
+ command-line via ibmmcascsi=display. Along the lines of the /LED
+ option for the OS/2 driver.
+ - fixed small bug in the LED display that would hang some machines.
+ - reversed ordering of the drives (using the
+ IBMMCA_SCSI_ORDER_STANDARD define). This is necessary for two main
+ reasons:
+ - users who've already installed Linux won't be screwed. Keep
+ in mind that not everyone is a kernel hacker.
+ - be consistent with the BIOS ordering of the drives. In the
+ BIOS, id 6 is C:, id 0 might be D:. With this scheme, they'd be
+ backwards. This confuses the crap out of those heathens who've
+ got a impure Linux installation (which, <wince>, I'm one of).
+ This whole problem arises because IBM is actually non-standard with
+ the id to BIOS mappings. You'll find, in fdomain.c, a similar
+ comment about a few FD BIOS revisions. The Linux (and apparently
+ industry) standard is that C: maps to scsi id (0,0). Let's stick
+ with that standard.
+ - Since this is technically a branch of my own, I changed the
+ version number to 3.0e-cpb.
+
+ Jan 17, 1998: (v3.0f)
+ 1) Addition of some statistical info for /proc in proc_info.
+ 2) Taking care of the SCSI-assignment problem, dealed by Chris at Dec 15
+ 1997. In fact, IBM is right, concerning the assignment of SCSI-devices
+ to driveletters. It is conform to the ANSI-definition of the SCSI-
+ standard to assign drive C: to SCSI-id 6, because it is the highest
+ hardware priority after the hostadapter (that has still today by
+ default everywhere id 7). Also realtime-operating systems that I use,
+ like LynxOS and OS9, which are quite industrial systems use top-down
+ numbering of the harddisks, that is also starting at id 6. Now, one
+ sits a bit between two chairs. On one hand side, using the define
+ IBMMCA_SCSI_ORDER_STANDARD makes Linux assigning disks conform to
+ the IBM- and ANSI-SCSI-standard and keeps this driver downward
+ compatible to older releases, on the other hand side, people is quite
+ habituated in believing that C: is assigned to (0,0) and much other
+ SCSI-BIOS do so. Therefore, I moved the IBMMCA_SCSI_ORDER_STANDARD
+ define out of the driver and put it into Config.in as subitem of
+ 'IBM SCSI support'. A help, added to Documentation/Configure.help
+ explains the differences between saying 'y' or 'n' to the user, when
+ IBMMCA_SCSI_ORDER_STANDARD prompts, so the ordinary user is enabled to
+ choose the way of assignment, depending on his own situation and gusto.
+ 3) Adapted SCSI_IBMMCA_DEV_RESET to the local naming convention, so it is
+ now called IBMMCA_SCSI_DEV_RESET.
+ 4) Optimization of proc_info and its subroutines.
+ 5) Added more in-source-comments and extended the driver description by
+ some explanation about the SCSI-device-assignment problem.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Jan 18, 1998: (v3.0g)
+ 1) Correcting names to be absolutely conform to the later 2.1.x releases.
+ This is necessary for
+ IBMMCA_SCSI_DEV_RESET -> CONFIG_IBMMCA_SCSI_DEV_RESET
+ IBMMCA_SCSI_ORDER_STANDARD -> CONFIG_IBMMCA_SCSI_ORDER_STANDARD
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Jan 18, 1999: (v3.1 MCA-team internal)
+ 1) The multiple hosts structure is accessed from every subroutine, so there
+ is no longer the address of the device structure passed from function
+ to function, but only the hostindex. A call by value, nothing more. This
+ should really be understood by the compiler and the subsystem should get
+ the right values and addresses.
+ 2) The SCSI-subsystem detection was not complete and quite hugely buggy up
+ to now, compared to the technical manual. The interpretation of the pos2
+ register is not as assumed by people before, therefore, I dropped a note
+ in the ibmmca_detect function to show the registers' interpretation.
+ The pos-registers of integrated SCSI-subsystems do not contain any
+ information concerning the IO-port offset, really. Instead, they contain
+ some info about the adapter, the chip, the NVRAM .... The I/O-port is
+ fixed to 0x3540 - 0x3547. There can be more than one adapters in the
+ slots and they get an offset for the I/O area in order to get their own
+ I/O-address area. See chapter 2 for detailed description. At least, the
+ detection should now work right, even on models other than 95. The 95ers
+ came happily around the bug, as their pos2 register contains always 0
+ in the critical area. Reserved bits are not allowed to be interpreted,
+ therefore, IBM is allowed to set those bits as they like and they may
+ really vary between different PS/2 models. So, now, no interpretation
+ of reserved bits - hopefully no trouble here anymore.
+ 3) The command error, which you may get on models 55, 56, 57, 70, 77 and
+ P70 may have been caused by the fact, that adapters of older design do
+ not like sending commands to non-existing SCSI-devices and will react
+ with a command error as a sign of protest. While this error is not
+ present on IBM SCSI Adapter w/cache, it appears on IBM Integrated SCSI
+ Adapters. Therefore, I implemented a workarround to forgive those
+ adapters their protests, but it is marked up in the statisctis, so
+ after a successful boot, you can see in /proc/scsi/ibmmca/<host_number>
+ how often the command errors have been forgiven to the SCSI-subsystem.
+ If the number is bigger than 0, you have a SCSI subsystem of older
+ design, what should no longer matter.
+ 4) ibmmca_getinfo() has been adapted very carefully, so it shows in the
+ slotn file really, what is senseful to be presented.
+ 5) ibmmca_register() has been extended in its parameter list in order to
+ pass the right name of the SCSI-adapter to Linux.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Feb 6, 1999: (v3.1)
+ 1) Finally, after some 3.1Beta-releases, the 3.1 release. Sorry, for
+ the delayed release, but it was not finished with the release of
+ Kernel 2.2.0.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Feb 10, 1999 (v3.1)
+ 1) Added a new commandline parameter called 'bypass' in order to bypass
+ every integrated subsystem SCSI-command consequently in case of
+ troubles.
+ 2) Concatenated read_capacity requests to the harddisks. It gave a lot
+ of troubles with some controllers and after I wanted to apply some
+ extensions, it jumped out in the same situation, on my w/cache, as like
+ on D. Weinehalls' Model 56, having integrated SCSI. This gave me the
+ descissive hint to move the code-part out and declare it global. Now,
+ it seems to work by far much better an more stable. Let us see, what
+ the world thinks of it...
+ 3) By the way, only Sony DAT-drives seem to show density code 0x13. A
+ test with a HP drive gave right results, so the problem is vendor-
+ specific and not a problem of the OS or the driver.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Feb 18, 1999 (v3.1d)
+ 1) The abort command and the reset function have been checked for
+ inconsistencies. From the logical point of thinking, they work
+ at their optimum, now, but as the subsystem does not answer with an
+ interrupt, abort never finishes, sigh...
+ 2) Everything, that is accessed by a busmaster request from the adapter
+ is now declared as global variable, even the return-buffer in the
+ local checking phase. This assures, that no accesses to undefined memory
+ areas are performed.
+ 3) In ibmmca.h, the line unchecked_isa_dma is added with 1 in order to
+ avoid memory-pointers for the areas higher than 16MByte in order to
+ be sure, it also works on 16-Bit Microchannel bus systems.
+ 4) A lot of small things have been found, but nothing that endangered the
+ driver operations. Just it should be more stable, now.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Feb 20, 1999 (v3.1e)
+ 1) I took the warning from the Linux Kernel Hackers Guide serious and
+ checked the cmd->result return value to the done-function very carefully.
+ It is obvious, that the IBM SCSI only delivers the tsb.dev_status, if
+ some error appeared, else it is undefined. Now, this is fixed. Before
+ any SCB command gets queued, the tsb.dev_status is set to 0, so the
+ cmd->result won't screw up Linux higher level drivers.
+ 2) The reset-function has slightly improved. This is still planed for
+ abort. During the abort and the reset function, no interrupts are
+ allowed. This is however quite hard to cope with, so the INT-status
+ register is read. When the interrupt gets queued, one can find its
+ status immediately on that register and is enabled to continue in the
+ reset function. I had no chance to test this really, only in a bogus
+ situation, I got this function running, but the situation was too much
+ worse for Linux :-(, so tests will continue.
+ 3) Buffers got now consistent. No open address mapping, as before and
+ therefore no further troubles with the unassigned memory segmentation
+ faults that scrambled probes on 95XX series and even on 85XX series,
+ when the kernel is done in a not so perfectly fitting way.
+ 4) Spontaneous interrupts from the subsystem, appearing without any
+ command previously queued are answered with a DID_BAD_INTR result.
+ 5) Taken into account ZP Gus' proposals to reverse the SCSI-device
+ scan order. As it does not work on Kernel 2.1.x or 2.2.x, as proposed
+ by him, I implemented it in a slightly derived way, which offers in
+ addition more flexibility.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ Apr 23, 2000 (v3.2pre1)
+ 1) During a very long time, I collected a huge amount of bugreports from
+ various people, trying really quite different things on their SCSI-
+ PS/2s. Today, all these bugreports are taken into account and should be
+ mostly solved. The major topics were:
+ - Driver crashes during boottime by no obvious reason.
+ - Driver panics while the midlevel-SCSI-driver is trying to inquire
+ the SCSI-device properties, even though hardware is in perfect state.
+ - Displayed info for the various slot-cards is interpreted wrong.
+ The main reasons for the crashes were two:
+ 1) The commands to check for device information like INQUIRY,
+ TEST_UNIT_READY, REQUEST_SENSE and MODE_SENSE cause the devices
+ to deliver information of up to 255 bytes. Midlevel drivers offer
+ 1024 bytes of space for the answer, but the IBM-SCSI-adapters do
+ not accept this, as they stick quite near to ANSI-SCSI and report
+ a COMMAND_ERROR message which causes the driver to panic. The main
+ problem was located around the INQUIRY command. Now, for all the
+ mentioned commands, the buffersize, sent to the adapter is at
+ maximum 255 which seems to be a quite reasonable solution.
+ TEST_UNIT_READY gets a buffersize of 0 to make sure, that no
+ data is transferred in order to avoid any possible command failure.
+ 2) On unsuccessful TEST_UNIT_READY, the midlevel-driver has to send
+ a REQUEST_SENSE in order to see, where the problem is located. This
+ REQUEST_SENSE may have various length in its answer-buffer. IBM
+ SCSI-subsystems report a command failure, if the returned buffersize
+ is different from the sent buffersize, but this can be supressed by
+ a special bit, which is now done and problems seem to be solved.
+ 2) Code adaption to all kernel-releases. Now, the 3.2 code compiles on
+ 2.0.x, 2.1.x, 2.2.x and 2.3.x kernel releases without any code-changes.
+ 3) Commandline-parameters are recognized again, even under Kernel 2.3.x or
+ higher.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ April 27, 2000 (v3.2pre2)
+ 1) Bypassed commands get read by the adapter by one cycle instead of two.
+ This increases SCSI-performance.
+ 2) Synchronous datatransfer is provided for sure to be 5 MHz on older
+ SCSI and 10 MHz on internal F/W SCSI-adapter.
+ 3) New commandline parameters allow to force the adapter to slow down while
+ in synchronous transfer. Could be helpful for very old devices.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ June 2, 2000 (v3.2pre5)
+ 1) Added Jim Shorney's contribution to make the activity indicator
+ flashing in addition to the LED-alphanumeric display-panel on
+ models 95A. To be enabled to choose this feature freely, a new
+ commandline parameter is added, called 'activity'.
+ 2) Added the READ_CONTROL bit for test_unit_ready SCSI-command.
+ 3) Added some suppress_exception bits to read_device_capacity and
+ all device_inquiry occurrences in the driver code.
+ 4) Complaints about the various KERNEL_VERSION implementations are
+ taken into account. Every local_LinuxKernelVersion occurrence is
+ now replaced by KERNEL_VERSION, defined in linux/version.h.
+ Corresponding changes were applied to ibmmca.h, too. This was a
+ contribution to all kernel-parts by Philipp Hahn.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ July 17, 2000 (v3.2pre8)
+ A long period of collecting bugreports from all corners of the world
+ now lead to the following corrections to the code:
+ 1) SCSI-2 F/W support crashed with a COMMAND ERROR. The reason for this
+ was, that it is possible to disbale Fast-SCSI for the external bus.
+ The feature-control command, where this crash appeared regularly tried
+ to set the maximum speed of 10MHz synchronous transfer speed and that
+ reports a COMMAND ERROR, if external bus Fast-SCSI is disabled. Now,
+ the feature-command probes down from maximum speed until the adapter
+ stops to complain, which is at the same time the maximum possible
+ speed selected in the reference program. So, F/W external can run at
+ 5 MHz (slow-) or 10 MHz (fast-SCSI). During feature probing, the
+ COMMAND ERROR message is used to detect if the adapter does not complain.
+ 2) Up to now, only combined busmode is supported, if you use external
+ SCSI-devices, attached to the F/W-controller. If dual bus is selected,
+ only the internal SCSI-devices get accessed by Linux. For most
+ applications, this should do fine.
+ 3) Wide-SCSI-addressing (16-Bit) is now possible for the internal F/W
+ bus on the F/W adapter. If F/W adapter is detected, the driver
+ automatically uses the extended PUN/LUN <-> LDN mapping tables, which
+ are now new from 3.2pre8. This allows PUNs between 0 and 15 and should
+ provide more fun with the F/W adapter.
+ 4) Several machines use the SCSI: POS registers for internal/undocumented
+ storage of system relevant info. This confused the driver, mainly on
+ models 9595, as it expected no onboard SCSI only, if all POS in
+ the integrated SCSI-area are set to 0x00 or 0xff. Now, the mechanism
+ to check for integrated SCSI is much more restrictive and these problems
+ should be history.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ July 18, 2000 (v3.2pre9)
+ This develop rather quickly at the moment. Two major things were still
+ missing in 3.2pre8:
+ 1) The adapter PUN for F/W adapters has 4-bits, while all other adapters
+ have 3-bits. This is now taken into account for F/W.
+ 2) When you select CONFIG_IBMMCA_SCSI_ORDER_STANDARD, you should
+ normally get the inverse probing order of your devices on the SCSI-bus.
+ The ANSI device order gets scrambled in version 3.2pre8!! Now, a new
+ and tested algorithm inverts the device-order on the SCSI-bus and
+ automatically avoids accidental access to whatever SCSI PUN the adapter
+ is set and works with SCSI- and Wide-SCSI-addressing.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ July 23, 2000 (v3.2pre10 unpublished)
+ 1) LED panel display supports wide-addressing in ibmmca=display mode.
+ 2) Adapter-information and autoadaption to address-space is done.
+ 3) Auto-probing for maximum synchronous SCSI transfer rate is working.
+ 4) Optimization to some embedded function calls is applied.
+ 5) Added some comment for the user to wait for SCSI-devices being probed.
+ 6) Finished version 3.2 for Kernel 2.4.0. It least, I thought it is but...
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ July 26, 2000 (v3.2pre11)
+ 1) I passed a horrible weekend getting mad with NMIs on kernel 2.2.14 and
+ a model 9595. Asking around in the community, nobody except of me has
+ seen such errors. Weired, but I am trying to recompile everything on
+ the model 9595. Maybe, as I use a specially modified gcc, that could
+ cause problems. But, it was not the reason. The true background was,
+ that the kernel was compiled for i386 and the 9595 has a 486DX-2.
+ Normally, no troubles should appear, but for this special machine,
+ only the right processor support is working fine!
+ 2) Previous problems with synchronous speed, slowing down from one adapter
+ to the next during probing are corrected. Now, local variables store
+ the synchronous bitmask for every single adapter found on the MCA bus.
+ 3) LED alphanumeric panel support for XX95 systems is now showing some
+ alive rotator during boottime. This makes sense, when no monitor is
+ connected to the system. You can get rid of all display activity, if
+ you do not use any parameter or just ibmmcascsi=activity, for the
+ harddrive activity LED, existant on all PS/2, except models 8595-XXX.
+ If no monitor is available, please use ibmmcascsi=display, which works
+ fine together with the linuxinfo utility for the LED-panel.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ July 29, 2000 (v3.2)
+ 1) Submission of this driver for kernel 2.4test-XX and 2.2.17.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ December 28, 2000 (v3.2d / v4.0)
+ 1) The interrupt handler had some wrong statement to wait for. This
+ was done due to experimental reasons during 3.2 development but it
+ has shown that this is not stable enough. Going back to wait for the
+ adapter to be not busy is best.
+ 2) Inquiry requests can be shorter than 255 bytes of return buffer. Due
+ to a bug in the ibmmca_queuecommand routine, this buffer was forced
+ to 255 at minimum. If the memory address, this return buffer is pointing
+ to does not offer more space, invalid memory accesses destabilized the
+ kernel.
+ 3) version 4.0 is only valid for kernel 2.4.0 or later. This is necessary
+ to remove old kernel version dependent waste from the driver. 3.2d is
+ only distributed with older kernels but keeps compatibility with older
+ kernel versions. 4.0 and higher versions cannot be used with older
+ kernels anymore!! You must have at least kernel 2.4.0!!
+ 4) The commandline argument 'bypass' and all its functionality got removed
+ in version 4.0. This was never really necessary, as all troubles were
+ based on non-command related reasons up to now, so bypassing commands
+ did not help to avoid any bugs. It is kept in 3.2X for debugging reasons.
+ 5) Dynamical reassignment of ldns was again verified and analyzed to be
+ completely inoperational. This is corrected and should work now.
+ 6) All commands that get sent to the SCSI adapter were verified and
+ completed in such a way, that they are now completely conform to the
+ demands in the technical description of IBM. Main candidates were the
+ DEVICE_INQUIRY, REQUEST_SENSE and DEVICE_CAPACITY commands. They must
+ be tranferred by bypassing the internal command buffer of the adapter
+ or else the response can be a random result. GET_POS_INFO would be more
+ safe in usage, if one could use the SUPRESS_EXCEPTION_SHORT, but this
+ is not allowed by the technical references of IBM. (Sorry, folks, the
+ model 80 problem is still a task to be solved in a different way.)
+ 7) v3.2d is still hold back for some days for testing, while 4.0 is
+ released.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ January 3, 2001 (v4.0a)
+ 1) A lot of complains after the 2.4.0-prerelease kernel came in about
+ the impossibility to compile the driver as a module. This problem is
+ solved. In combination with that problem, some unprecise declaration
+ of the function option_setup() gave some warnings during compilation.
+ This is solved, too by a forward declaration in ibmmca.c.
+ 2) #ifdef argument concerning CONFIG_SCSI_IBMMCA is no longer needed and
+ was entirely removed.
+ 3) Some switch statements got optimized in code, as some minor variables
+ in internal SCSI-command handlers.
+ - Michael Lang
+
+ 4 To do
+ -------
+ - IBM SCSI-2 F/W external SCSI bus support in separate mode!
+ - It seems that the handling of bad disks is really bad -
+ non-existent, in fact. However, a low-level driver cannot help
+ much, if such things happen.
+
+ 5 Users' Manual
+ ---------------
+ 5.1 Commandline Parameters
+ --------------------------
+ There exist several features for the IBM SCSI-subsystem driver.
+ The commandline parameter format is:
+
+ ibmmcascsi=<command1>,<command2>,<command3>,...
+
+ where commandN can be one of the following:
+
+ display Owners of a model 95 or other PS/2 systems with an
+ alphanumeric LED display may set this to have their
+ display showing the following output of the 8 digits:
+
+ ------DA
+
+ where '-' stays dark, 'D' shows the SCSI-device id
+ and 'A' shows the SCSI hostindex, being currently
+ accessed. During boottime, this will give the message
+
+ SCSIini*
+
+ on the LED-panel, where the * represents a rotator,
+ showing the activity during the probing phase of the
+ driver which can take up to two minutes per SCSI-adapter.
+ adisplay This works like display, but gives more optical overview
+ of the activities on the SCSI-bus. The display will have
+ the following output:
+
+ 6543210A
+
+ where the numbers 0 to 6 light up at the shown position,
+ when the SCSI-device is accessed. 'A' shows again the SCSI
+ hostindex. If display nor adisplay is set, the internal
+ PS/2 harddisk LED is used for media-activities. So, if
+ you really do not have a system with a LED-display, you
+ should not set display or adisplay. Keep in mind, that
+ display and adisplay can only be used alternatively. It
+ is not recommended to use this option, if you have some
+ wide-addressed devices e.g. at the SCSI-2 F/W adapter in
+ your system. In addition, the usage of the display for
+ other tasks in parallel, like the linuxinfo-utility makes
+ no sense with this option.
+ activity This enables the PS/2 harddisk LED activity indicator.
+ Most PS/2 have no alphanumeric LED display, but some
+ indicator. So you should use this parameter to activate it.
+ If you own model 9595 (Server95), you can have both, the
+ LED panel and the activity indicator in parallel. However,
+ some PS/2s, like the 8595 do not have any harddisk LED
+ activity indicator, which means, that you must use the
+ alphanumeric LED display if you want to monitor SCSI-
+ activity.
+ bypass This is obsolete from driver version 4.0, as the adapters
+ got that far understood, that the selection between
+ integrated and bypassed commands should now work completely
+ correct! For historical reasons, the old description is
+ kept here:
+ This commandline parameter forces the driver never to use
+ SCSI-subsystems' integrated SCSI-command set. Except of
+ the immediate assign, which is of vital importance for
+ every IBM SCSI-subsystem to set its ldns right. Instead,
+ the ordinary ANSI-SCSI-commands are used and passed by the
+ controller to the SCSI-devices, therefore 'bypass'. The
+ effort, done by the subsystem is quite bogus and at a
+ minimum and therefore it should work everywhere. This
+ could maybe solve troubles with old or integrated SCSI-
+ controllers and nasty harddisks. Keep in mind, that using
+ this flag will slow-down SCSI-accesses slightly, as the
+ software generated commands are always slower than the
+ hardware. Non-harddisk devices always get read/write-
+ commands in bypass mode. On the most recent releases of
+ the Linux IBM-SCSI-driver, the bypass command should be
+ no longer a necessary thing, if you are sure about your
+ SCSI-hardware!
+ normal This is the parameter, introduced on the 2.0.x development
+ rail by ZP Gu. This parameter defines the SCSI-device
+ scan order in the new industry standard. This means, that
+ the first SCSI-device is the one with the lowest pun.
+ E.g. harddisk at pun=0 is scanned before harddisk at
+ pun=6, which means, that harddisk at pun=0 gets sda
+ and the one at pun=6 gets sdb.
+ ansi The ANSI-standard for the right scan order, as done by
+ IBM, Microware and Microsoft, scans SCSI-devices starting
+ at the highest pun, which means, that e.g. harddisk at
+ pun=6 gets sda and a harddisk at pun=0 gets sdb. If you
+ like to have the same SCSI-device order, as in DOS, OS-9
+ or OS/2, just use this parameter.
+ fast SCSI-I/O in synchronous mode is done at 5 MHz for IBM-
+ SCSI-devices. SCSI-2 Fast/Wide Adapter/A external bus
+ should then run at 10 MHz if Fast-SCSI is enabled,
+ and at 5 MHz if Fast-SCSI is disabled on the external
+ bus. This is the default setting when nothing is
+ specified here.
+ medium Synchronous rate is at 50% approximately, which means
+ 2.5 MHz for IBM SCSI-adapters and 5.0 MHz for F/W ext.
+ SCSI-bus (when Fast-SCSI speed enabled on external bus).
+ slow The slowest possible synchronous transfer rate is set.
+ This means 1.82 MHz for IBM SCSI-adapters and 2.0 MHz
+ for F/W external bus at Fast-SCSI speed on the external
+ bus.
+
+ A further option is that you can force the SCSI-driver to accept a SCSI-
+ subsystem at a certain I/O-address with a predefined adapter PUN. This
+ is done by entering
+
+ commandN = I/O-base
+ commandN+1 = adapter PUN
+
+ e.g. ibmmcascsi=0x3540,7 will force the driver to detect a SCSI-subsystem
+ at I/O-address 0x3540 with adapter PUN 7. Please only use this method, if
+ the driver does really not recognize your SCSI-adapter! With driver version
+ 3.2, this recognition of various adapters was hugely improved and you
+ should try first to remove your commandline arguments of such type with a
+ newer driver. I bet, it will be recognized correctly. Even multiple and
+ different types of IBM SCSI-adapters should be recognized correctly, too.
+ Use the forced detection method only as last solution!
+
+ Examples:
+
+ ibmmcascsi=adisplay
+
+ This will use the advanced display mode for the model 95 LED alphanumeric
+ display.
+
+ ibmmcascsi=display,0x3558,7
+
+ This will activate the default display mode for the model 95 LED display
+ and will force the driver to accept a SCSI-subsystem at I/O-base 0x3558
+ with adapter PUN 7.
+
+ 5.2 Troubleshooting
+ -------------------
+ The following FAQs should help you to solve some major problems with this
+ driver.
+
+ Q: "Reset SCSI-devices at boottime" halts the system at boottime, why?
+ A: This is only tested with the IBM SCSI Adapter w/cache. It is not
+ yet prooved to run on other adapters, however you may be lucky.
+ In version 3.1d this has been hugely improved and should work better,
+ now. Normally you really won't need to activate this flag in the
+ kernel configuration, as all post 1989 SCSI-devices should accept
+ the reset-signal, when the computer is switched on. The SCSI-
+ subsystem generates this reset while being initialized. This flag
+ is really reserved for users with very old, very strange or self-made
+ SCSI-devices.
+ Q: Why is the SCSI-order of my drives mirrored to the device-order
+ seen from OS/2 or DOS ?
+ A: It depends on the operating system, if it looks at the devices in
+ ANSI-SCSI-standard (starting from pun 6 and going down to pun 0) or
+ if it just starts at pun 0 and counts up. If you want to be conform
+ with OS/2 and DOS, you have to activate this flag in the kernel
+ configuration or you should set 'ansi' as parameter for the kernel.
+ The parameter 'normal' sets the new industry standard, starting
+ from pun 0, scanning up to pun 6. This allows you to change your
+ opinion still after having already compiled the kernel.
+ Q: Why I cannot find the IBM MCA SCSI support in the config menue?
+ A: You have to activate MCA bus support, first.
+ Q: Where can I find the latest info about this driver?
+ A: See the file MAINTAINERS for the current WWW-address, which offers
+ updates, info and Q/A lists. At this files' origin, the webaddress
+ was: http://www.uni-mainz.de/~langm000/linux.html
+ Q: My SCSI-adapter is not recognized by the driver, what can I do?
+ A: Just force it to be recognized by kernel parameters. See section 5.1.
+ If this really happens, do also send e-mail to the maintainer, as
+ forced detection should be never necessary. Forced detection is in
+ principal some flaw of the driver adapter detection and goes into
+ bugreports.
+ Q: The driver screws up, if it starts to probe SCSI-devices, is there
+ some way out of it?
+ A: Yes, that was some recognition problem of the correct SCSI-adapter
+ and its I/O base addresses. Upgrade your driver to the latest release
+ and it should be fine again.
+ Q: I get a message: panic IBM MCA SCSI: command error .... , what can
+ I do against this?
+ A: Previously, I followed the way by ignoring command errors by using
+ ibmmcascsi=forgiveall, but this command no longer exists and is
+ obsolete. If such a problem appears, it is caused by some segmentation
+ fault of the driver, which maps to some unallowed area. The latest
+ version of the driver should be ok, as most bugs have been solved.
+ Q: There are still kernel panics, even after having set
+ ibmmcascsi=forgiveall. Are there other possibilities to prevent
+ such panics?
+ A: No, get just the latest release of the driver and it should work
+ better and better with increasing version number. Forget about this
+ ibmmcascsi=forgiveall, as also ignorecmd are obsolete.!
+ Q: Linux panics or stops without any comment, but it is probable, that my
+ harddisk(s) have bad blocks.
+ A: Sorry, the bad-block handling is still a feeble point of this driver,
+ but is on the schedule for development in the near future.
+ Q: Linux panics while dynamically assigning SCSI-ids or ldns.
+ A: If you disconnect a SCSI-device from the machine, while Linux is up
+ and the driver uses dynamical reassignment of logical device numbers
+ (ldn), it really gets "angry" if it won't find devices, that were still
+ present at boottime and stops Linux.
+ Q: The system does not recover after an abort-command has been generated.
+ A: This is regrettably true, as it is not yet understood, why the
+ SCSI-adapter does really NOT generate any interrupt at the end of
+ the abort-command. As no interrupt is generated, the abort command
+ cannot get finished and the system hangs, sorry, but checks are
+ running to hunt down this problem. If there is a real pending command,
+ the interrupt MUST get generated after abort. In this case, it
+ should finish well.
+ Q: The system gets in bad shape after a SCSI-reset, is this known?
+ A: Yes, as there are a lot of prescriptions (see the Linux Hackers'
+ Guide) what has to be done for reset, we still share the bad shape of
+ the reset functions with all other low level SCSI-drivers.
+ Astonishingly, reset works in most cases quite ok, but the harddisks
+ won't run in synchonous mode anymore after a reset, until you reboot.
+ Q: Why does my XXX w/Cache adapter not use read-prefetch?
+ A: Ok, that is not completely possible. If a cache is present, the
+ adapter tries to use it internally. Explicitly, one can use the cache
+ with a read prefetch command, maybe in future, but this requires
+ some major overhead of SCSI-commands that risks the performance to
+ go down more than it gets improved. Tests with that are running.
+ Q: I have a IBM SCSI-2 Fast/Wide adapter, it boots in some way and hangs.
+ A: Yes, that is understood, as for sure, your SCSI-2 Fast/Wide adapter
+ was in such a case recognized as integrated SCSI-adapter or something
+ else, but not as the correct adapter. As the I/O-ports get assigned
+ wrongly by that reason, the system should crash in most cases. You
+ should upgrade to the latest release of the SCSI-driver. The
+ recommended version is 3.2 or later. Here, the F/W support is in
+ a stable and reliable condition. Wide-addressing is in addition
+ supported.
+ Q: I get a Ooops message and something like "killing interrupt".
+ A: The reason for this is that the IBM SCSI-subsystem only sends a
+ termination status back, if some error appeared. In former releases
+ of the driver, it was not checked, if the termination status block
+ is NULL. From version 3.2, it is taken care of this.
+ Q: I have a F/W adapter and the driver sees my internal SCSI-devices,
+ but ignores the external ones.
+ A: Select combined busmode in the IBM config-program and check for that
+ no SCSI-id on the external devices appears on internal devices.
+ Reboot afterwards. Dual busmode is supported, but works only for the
+ internal bus, yet. External bus is still ignored. Take care for your
+ SCSI-ids. If combined bus-mode is activated, on some adapters,
+ the wide-addressing is not possible, so devices with ids between 8
+ and 15 get ignored by the driver & adapter!
+ Q: I have a 9595 and I get a NMI during heavy SCSI I/O e.g. during fsck.
+ A COMMAND ERROR is reported and characters on the screen are missing.
+ Warm reboot is not possible. Things look like quite weired.
+ A: Check the processor type of your 9595. If you have an 80486 or 486DX-2
+ processor complex on your mainboard and you compiled a kernel that
+ supports 80386 processors, it is possible, that the kernel cannot
+ keep track of the PS/2 interrupt handling and stops on an NMI. Just
+ compile a kernel for the correct processor type of your PS/2 and
+ everything should be fine. This is necessary even if one assumes,
+ that some 80486 system should be downward compatible to 80386
+ software.
+ Q: Some commands hang and interrupts block the machine. After some
+ timeout, the syslog reports that it tries to call abort, but the
+ machine is frozen.
+ A: This can be a busy wait bug in the interrupt handler of driver
+ version 3.2. You should at least upgrade to 3.2c if you use
+ kernel < 2.4.0 and driver version 4.0 if you use kernel 2.4.0 or
+ later (including all test releases).
+ Q: I have a PS/2 model 80 and more than 16 MBytes of RAM. The driver
+ completely refuses to work, reports NMIs, COMMAND ERRORs or other
+ ambiguous stuff. When reducing the RAM size down below 16 MB,
+ everything is running smoothly.
+ A: No real answer, yet. In any case, one should force the kernel to
+ present SCBs only below the 16 MBytes barrier. Maybe this solves the
+ problem. Not yet tried, but guessing that it could work. To get this,
+ set unchecked_isa_dma argument of ibmmca.h from 0 to 1.
+
+ 5.3 Bugreports
+ --------------
+ If you really find bugs in the sourcecode or the driver will successfully
+ refuse to work on your machine, you should send a bug report to me. The
+ best for this is to follow the instructions on the WWW-page for this
+ driver. Fill out the bug-report form, placed on the WWW-page and ship it,
+ so the bugs can be taken into account with maximum efforts. But, please
+ do not send bug reports about this driver to Linus Torvalds or Leonard
+ Zubkoff, as Linus is burried in E-Mail and Leonard is supervising all
+ SCSI-drivers and won't have the time left to look inside every single
+ driver to fix a bug and especially DO NOT send modified code to Linus
+ Torvalds or Alan J. Cox which has not been checked here!!! They are both
+ quite burried in E-mail (as me, sometimes, too) and one should first check
+ for problems on my local teststand. Recently, I got a lot of
+ bugreports for errors in the ibmmca.c code, which I could not imagine, but
+ a look inside some Linux-distribution showed me quite often some modified
+ code, which did no longer work on most other machines than the one of the
+ modifier. Ok, so now that there is maintenance service available for this
+ driver, please use this address first in order to keep the level of
+ confusion low. Thank you!
+
+ When you get a SCSI-error message that panics your system, a list of
+ register-entries of the SCSI-subsystem is shown (from Version 3.1d). With
+ this list, it is very easy for the maintainer to localize the problem in
+ the driver or in the configuration of the user. Please write down all the
+ values from this report and send them to the maintainer. This would really
+ help a lot and makes life easier concerning misunderstandings.
+
+ Use the bug-report form (see 5.4 for its address) to send all the bug-
+ stuff to the maintainer or write e-mail with the values from the table.
+
+ 5.4 Support WWW-page
+ --------------------
+ The address of the IBM SCSI-subsystem supporting WWW-page is:
+
+ http://www.uni-mainz.de/~langm000/linux.html
+
+ Here you can find info about the background of this driver, patches,
+ troubleshooting support, news and a bugreport form. Please check that
+ WWW-page regularly for latest hints. If ever this URL changes, please
+ refer to the MAINTAINERS file in order to get the latest address.
+
+ For the bugreport, please fill out the formular on the corresponding
+ WWW-page. Read the dedicated instructions and write as much as you
+ know about your problem. If you do not like such formulars, please send
+ some e-mail directly, but at least with the same information as required by
+ the formular.
+
+ If you have extensive bugreports, including Ooops messages and
+ screen-shots, please feel free to send it directly to the address
+ of the maintainer, too. The current address of the maintainer is:
+
+ Michael Lang <langa2@kph.uni-mainz.de>
+
+ 6 References
+ ------------
+ IBM Corp., "Update for the PS/2 Hardware Interface Technical Reference,
+ Common Interfaces", Armonk, September 1991, PN 04G3281,
+ (available in the U.S. for $21.75 at 1-800-IBM-PCTB or in Germany for
+ around 40,-DM at "Hallo IBM").
+
+ IBM Corp., "Personal System/2 Micro Channel SCSI
+ Adapter with Cache Technical Reference", Armonk, March 1990, PN 68X2365.
+
+ IBM Corp., "Personal System/2 Micro Channel SCSI
+ Adapter Technical Reference", Armonk, March 1990, PN 68X2397.
+
+ IBM Corp., "SCSI-2 Fast/Wide Adapter/A Technical Reference - Dual Bus",
+ Armonk, March 1994, PN 83G7545.
+
+ Friedhelm Schmidt, "SCSI-Bus und IDE-Schnittstelle - Moderne Peripherie-
+ Schnittstellen: Hardware, Protokollbeschreibung und Anwendung", 2. Aufl.
+ Addison Wesley, 1996.
+
+ Michael K. Johnson, "The Linux Kernel Hackers' Guide", Version 0.6, Chapel
+ Hill - North Carolina, 1995
+
+ Andreas Kaiser, "SCSI TAPE BACKUP for OS/2 2.0", Version 2.12, Stuttgart
+ 1993
+
+ Helmut Rompel, "IBM Computerwelt GUIDE", What is what bei IBM., Systeme *
+ Programme * Begriffe, IWT-Verlag GmbH - Muenchen, 1988
+
+ 7 Credits to
+ ------------
+ 7.1 People
+ ----------
+ Klaus Grimm
+ who already a long time ago gave me the old code from the
+ SCSI-driver in order to get it running for some old machine
+ in our institute.
+ Martin Kolinek
+ who wrote the first release of the IBM SCSI-subsystem driver.
+ Chris Beauregard
+ who for a long time maintained MCA-Linux and the SCSI-driver
+ in the beginning. Chris, wherever you are: Cheers to you!
+ Klaus Kudielka
+ with whom in the 2.1.x times, I had a quite fruitful
+ cooperation to get the driver running as a module and to get
+ it running with multiple SCSI-adapters.
+ David Weinehall
+ for his excellent maintenance of the MCA-stuff and the quite
+ detailed bug reports and ideas for this driver (and his
+ patience ;-)).
+ Alan J. Cox
+ for his bugreports and his bold activities in cross-checking
+ the driver-code with his teststand.
+
+ 7.2 Sponsors & Supporters
+ -------------------------
+ "Hallo IBM",
+ IBM-Deutschland GmbH
+ the service of IBM-Deutschland for customers. Their E-Mail
+ service is unbeatable. Whatever old stuff I asked for, I
+ always got some helpful answers.
+ Karl-Otto Reimers,
+ IBM Klub - Sparte IBM Geschichte, Sindelfingen
+ for sending me a copy of the w/Cache manual from the
+ IBM-Deutschland archives.
+ Harald Staiger
+ for his extensive hardware donations which allows me today
+ still to test the driver in various constellations.
+ Erich Fritscher
+ for his very kind sponsoring.
+ Louis Ohland,
+ Charles Lasitter
+ for support by shipping me an IBM SCSI-2 Fast/Wide manual.
+ In addition, the contribution of various hardware is quite
+ decessive and will make it possible to add FWSR (RAID)
+ adapter support to the driver in the near future! So,
+ complaints about no RAID support won't remain forever.
+ Yes, folks, that is no joke, RAID support is going to rise!
+ Erik Weber
+ for the great deal we made about a model 9595 and the nice
+ surrounding equipment and the cool trip to Mannheim
+ second-hand computer market. In addition, I would like
+ to thank him for his exhaustive SCSI-driver testing on his
+ 95er PS/2 park.
+ Anthony Hogbin
+ for his direct shipment of a SCSI F/W adapter, which allowed
+ me immediately on the first stage to try it on model 8557
+ together with onboard SCSI adapter and some SCSI w/Cache.
+ Andreas Hotz
+ for his support by memory and an IBM SCSI-adapter. Collecting
+ all this together now allows me to try really things with
+ the driver at maximum load and variety on various models in
+ a very quick and efficient way.
+ Peter Jennewein
+ for his model 30, which serves me as part of my teststand
+ and his cool remark about how you make an ordinary diskette
+ drive working and how to connect it to an IBM-diskette port.
+ Johannes Gutenberg-Universitaet, Mainz &
+ Institut fuer Kernphysik, Mainz Microtron (MAMI)
+ for the offered space, the link, placed on the central
+ homepage and the space to store and offer the driver and
+ related material and the free working times, which allow
+ me to answer all your e-mail.
+
+ 8 Trademarks
+ ------------
+ IBM, PS/2, OS/2, Microchannel are registered trademarks of International
+ Business Machines Corporation
+
+ MS-DOS is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation
+
+ Microware, OS-9 are registered trademarks of Microware Systems
+
+ 9 Disclaimer
+ ------------
+ Beside the GNU General Public License and the dependent disclaimers and disclaimers
+ concerning the Linux-kernel in special, this SCSI-driver comes without any
+ warranty. Its functionality is tested as good as possible on certain
+ machines and combinations of computer hardware, which does not exclude,
+ that dataloss or severe damage of hardware is possible while using this
+ part of software on some arbitrary computer hardware or in combination
+ with other software packages. It is highly recommended to make backup
+ copies of your data before using this software. Furthermore, personal
+ injuries by hardware defects, that could be caused by this SCSI-driver are
+ not excluded and it is highly recommended to handle this driver with a
+ maximum of carefulness.
+
+ This driver supports hardware, produced by International Business Machines
+ Corporation (IBM).
+
+------
+Michael Lang
+(langa2@kph.uni-mainz.de)
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/in2000.txt b/Documentation/scsi/in2000.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..80f104042645
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/in2000.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,202 @@
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.33 - 26 Aug 98
+
+ Interrupt management in this driver has become, over
+ time, increasingly odd and difficult to explain - this
+ has been mostly due to my own mental inadequacies. In
+ recent kernels, it has failed to function at all when
+ compiled for SMP. I've fixed that problem, and after
+ taking a fresh look at interrupts in general, greatly
+ reduced the number of places where they're fiddled
+ with. Done some heavy testing and it looks very good.
+ The driver now makes use of the __initfunc() and
+ __initdata macros to save about 4k of kernel memory.
+ Once again, the same code works for both 2.0.xx and
+ 2.1.xx kernels.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.32 - 28 Mar 98
+
+ Removed the check for legal IN2000 hardware versions:
+ It appears that the driver works fine with serial
+ EPROMs (the 8-pin chip that defines hardware rev) as
+ old as 2.1, so we'll assume that all cards are OK.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.31 - 6 Jul 97
+
+ Fixed a bug that caused incorrect SCSI status bytes to be
+ returned from commands sent to LUN's greater than 0. This
+ means that CDROM changers work now! Fixed a bug in the
+ handling of command-line arguments when loaded as a module.
+ Also put all the header data in in2000.h where it belongs.
+ There are no longer any differences between this driver in
+ the 2.1.xx source tree and the 2.0.xx tree, as of 2.0.31
+ and 2.1.45 (or is it .46?) - this makes things much easier
+ for me...
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.30 - 14 Oct 96
+
+ Fixed a bug in the code that sets the transfer direction
+ bit (DESTID_DPD in the WD_DESTINATION_ID register). There
+ are quite a few SCSI commands that do a write-to-device;
+ now we deal with all of them correctly. Thanks to Joerg
+ Dorchain for catching this one.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.29 - 24 Sep 96
+
+ The memory-mapped hardware on the card is now accessed via
+ the 'readb()' and 'readl()' macros - required by the new
+ memory management scheme in the 2.1.x kernel series.
+ As suggested by Andries Brouwer, 'bios_param()' no longer
+ forces an artificial 1023 track limit on drives. Also
+ removed some kludge-code left over from struggles with
+ older (buggy) compilers.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.28 - 07 May 96
+
+ Tightened up the "interrupts enabled/disabled" discipline
+ in 'in2000_queuecommand()' and maybe 1 or 2 other places.
+ I _think_ it may have been a little too lax, causing an
+ occasional crash during full moon. A fully functional
+ /proc interface is now in place - if you want to play
+ with it, start by doing 'cat /proc/scsi/in2000/0'. You
+ can also use it to change a few run-time parameters on
+ the fly, but it's mostly for debugging. The curious
+ should take a good look at 'in2000_proc_info()' in the
+ in2000.c file to get an understanding of what it's all
+ about; I figure that people who are really into it will
+ want to add features suited to their own needs...
+ Also, sync is now DISABLED by default.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.27 - 10 Apr 96
+
+ Fixed a well-hidden bug in the adaptive-disconnect code
+ that would show up every now and then during extreme
+ heavy loads involving 2 or more simultaneously active
+ devices. Thanks to Joe Mack for keeping my nose to the
+ grindstone on this one.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.26 - 07 Mar 96
+
+ 1.25 had a nasty bug that bit people with swap partitions
+ and tape drives. Also, in my attempt to guess my way
+ through Intel assembly language, I made an error in the
+ inline code for IO writes. Made a few other changes and
+ repairs - this version (fingers crossed) should work well.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.25 - 05 Mar 96
+
+ Kernel 1.3.70 interrupt mods added; old kernels still OK.
+ Big help from Bill Earnest and David Willmore on speed
+ testing and optimizing: I think there's a real improvement
+ in this area.
+ New! User-friendly command-line interface for LILO and
+ module loading - the old method is gone, so you'll need
+ to read the comments for 'setup_strings' near the top
+ of in2000.c. For people with CDROM's or other devices
+ that have a tough time with sync negotiation, you can
+ now selectively disable sync on individual devices -
+ search for the 'nosync' keyword in the command-line
+ comments. Some of you disable the BIOS on the card, which
+ caused the auto-detect function to fail; there is now a
+ command-line option to force detection of a ROM-less card.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.24a - 24 Feb 96
+
+ There was a bug in the synchronous transfer code. Only
+ a few people downloaded before I caught it - could have
+ been worse.
+
+UPDATE NEWS: version 1.24 - 23 Feb 96
+
+ Lots of good changes. Advice from Bill Earnest resulted
+ in much better detection of cards, more efficient usage
+ of the fifo, and (hopefully) faster data transfers. The
+ jury is still out on speed - I hope it's improved some.
+ One nifty new feature is a cool way of doing disconnect/
+ reselect. The driver defaults to what I'm calling
+ 'adaptive disconnect' - meaning that each command is
+ evaluated individually as to whether or not it should be
+ run with the option to disconnect/reselect (if the device
+ chooses), or as a "SCSI-bus-hog". When several devices
+ are operating simultaneously, disconnects are usually an
+ advantage. In a single device system, or if only 1 device
+ is being accessed, transfers usually go faster if disconnects
+ are not allowed.
+
+
+
+The default arguments (you get these when you don't give an 'in2000'
+command-line argument, or you give a blank argument) will cause
+the driver to do adaptive disconnect, synchronous transfers, and a
+minimum of debug messages. If you want to fool with the options,
+search for 'setup_strings' near the top of the in2000.c file and
+check the 'hostdata->args' section in in2000.h - but be warned! Not
+everything is working yet (some things will never work, probably).
+I believe that disabling disconnects (DIS_NEVER) will allow you
+to choose a LEVEL2 value higher than 'L2_BASIC', but I haven't
+spent a lot of time testing this. You might try 'ENABLE_CLUSTERING'
+to see what happens: my tests showed little difference either way.
+There's also a define called 'DEFAULT_SX_PER'; this sets the data
+transfer speed for the asynchronous mode. I've put it at 500 ns
+despite the fact that the card could handle settings of 376 or
+252, because higher speeds may be a problem with poor quality
+cables or improper termination; 500 ns is a compromise. You can
+choose your own default through the command-line with the
+'period' keyword.
+
+
+------------------------------------------------
+*********** DIP switch settings **************
+------------------------------------------------
+
+ sw1-1 sw1-2 BIOS address (hex)
+ -----------------------------------------
+ off off C8000 - CBFF0
+ on off D8000 - DBFF0
+ off on D0000 - D3FF0
+ on on BIOS disabled
+
+ sw1-3 sw1-4 IO port address (hex)
+ ------------------------------------
+ off off 220 - 22F
+ on off 200 - 20F
+ off on 110 - 11F
+ on on 100 - 10F
+
+ sw1-5 sw1-6 sw1-7 Interrupt
+ ------------------------------
+ off off off 15
+ off on off 14
+ off off on 11
+ off on on 10
+ on - - disabled
+
+ sw1-8 function depends on BIOS version. In earlier versions this
+ controlled synchronous data transfer support for MSDOS:
+ off = disabled
+ on = enabled
+ In later ROMs (starting with 01.3 in April 1994) sw1-8 controls
+ the "greater than 2 disk drive" feature that first appeared in
+ MSDOS 5.0 (ignored by Linux):
+ off = 2 drives maximum
+ on = 7 drives maximum
+
+ sw1-9 Floppy controller
+ --------------------------
+ off disabled
+ on enabled
+
+------------------------------------------------
+
+ I should mention that Drew Eckhardt's 'Generic NCR5380' sources
+ were my main inspiration, with lots of reference to the IN2000
+ driver currently distributed in the kernel source. I also owe
+ much to a driver written by Hamish Macdonald for Linux-m68k(!).
+ And to Eric Wright for being an ALPHA guinea pig. And to Bill
+ Earnest for 2 tons of great input and information. And to David
+ Willmore for extensive 'bonnie' testing. And to Joe Mack for
+ continual testing and feedback.
+
+
+ John Shifflett jshiffle@netcom.com
+
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/megaraid.txt b/Documentation/scsi/megaraid.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..ff864c0f494c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/megaraid.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
+ Notes on Management Module
+ ~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+Overview:
+--------
+
+Different classes of controllers from LSI Logic, accept and respond to the
+user applications in a similar way. They understand the same firmware control
+commands. Furthermore, the applications also can treat different classes of
+the controllers uniformly. Hence it is logical to have a single module that
+interefaces with the applications on one side and all the low level drivers
+on the other.
+
+The advantages, though obvious, are listed for completeness:
+
+ i. Avoid duplicate code from the low level drivers.
+ ii. Unburden the low level drivers from having to export the
+ character node device and related handling.
+ iii. Implement any policy mechanisms in one place.
+ iv. Applications have to interface with only module instead of
+ multiple low level drivers.
+
+Currently this module (called Common Management Module) is used only to issue
+ioctl commands. But this module is envisioned to handle all user space level
+interactions. So any 'proc', 'sysfs' implementations will be localized in this
+common module.
+
+Credits:
+-------
+
+"Shared code in a third module, a "library module", is an acceptable
+solution. modprobe automatically loads dependent modules, so users
+running "modprobe driver1" or "modprobe driver2" would automatically
+load the shared library module."
+
+ - Jeff Garzik (jgarzik@pobox.com), 02.25.2004 LKML
+
+"As Jeff hinted, if your userspace<->driver API is consistent between
+your new MPT-based RAID controllers and your existing megaraid driver,
+then perhaps you need a single small helper module (lsiioctl or some
+better name), loaded by both mptraid and megaraid automatically, which
+handles registering the /dev/megaraid node dynamically. In this case,
+both mptraid and megaraid would register with lsiioctl for each
+adapter discovered, and lsiioctl would essentially be a switch,
+redirecting userspace tool ioctls to the appropriate driver."
+
+ - Matt Domsch, (Matt_Domsch@dell.com), 02.25.2004 LKML
+
+Design:
+------
+
+The Common Management Module is implemented in megaraid_mm.[ch] files. This
+module acts as a registry for low level hba drivers. The low level drivers
+(currently only megaraid) register each controller with the common module.
+
+The applications interface with the common module via the character device
+node exported by the module.
+
+The lower level drivers now understand only a new improved ioctl packet called
+uioc_t. The management module converts the older ioctl packets from the older
+applications into uioc_t. After driver handles the uioc_t, the common module
+will convert that back into the old format before returning to applications.
+
+As new applications evolve and replace the old ones, the old packet format
+will be retired.
+
+Common module dedicates one uioc_t packet to each controller registered. This
+can easily be more than one. But since megaraid is the only low level driver
+today, and it can handle only one ioctl, there is no reason to have more. But
+as new controller classes get added, this will be tuned appropriately.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c7xx.txt b/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c7xx.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..91e9552d63e5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c7xx.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
+README for WarpEngine/A4000T/A4091 SCSI kernels.
+
+Use the following options to disable options in the SCSI driver.
+
+Using amiboot for example.....
+
+To disable Synchronous Negotiation....
+
+ amiboot -k kernel 53c7xx=nosync:0
+
+To disable Disconnection....
+
+ amiboot -k kernel 53c7xx=nodisconnect:0
+
+To disable certain SCSI devices...
+
+ amiboot -k kernel 53c7xx=validids:0x3F
+
+ this allows only device ID's 0,1,2,3,4 and 5 for linux to handle.
+ (this is a bitmasked field - i.e. each bit represents a SCSI ID)
+
+These commands work on a per controller basis and use the option 'next' to
+move to the next controller in the system.
+
+e.g.
+ amiboot -k kernel 53c7xx=nodisconnect:0,next,nosync:0
+
+ this uses No Disconnection on the first controller and Asynchronous
+ SCSI on the second controller.
+
+Known Issues:
+
+Two devices are known not to function with the default settings of using
+synchronous SCSI. These are the Archive Viper 150 Tape Drive and the
+SyQuest SQ555 removeable hard drive. When using these devices on a controller
+use the 'nosync:0' option.
+
+Please try these options and post any problems/successes to me.
+
+Alan Hourihane <alanh@fairlite.demon.co.uk>
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c8xx.txt b/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c8xx.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..822d2aca3700
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ncr53c8xx.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,1854 @@
+The Linux NCR53C8XX/SYM53C8XX drivers README file
+
+Written by Gerard Roudier <groudier@free.fr>
+21 Rue Carnot
+95170 DEUIL LA BARRE - FRANCE
+
+29 May 1999
+===============================================================================
+
+1. Introduction
+2. Supported chips and SCSI features
+3. Advantages of the enhanced 896 driver
+ 3.1 Optimized SCSI SCRIPTS
+ 3.2 New features of the SYM53C896 (64 bit PCI dual LVD SCSI controller)
+4. Memory mapped I/O versus normal I/O
+5. Tagged command queueing
+6. Parity checking
+7. Profiling information
+8. Control commands
+ 8.1 Set minimum synchronous period
+ 8.2 Set wide size
+ 8.3 Set maximum number of concurrent tagged commands
+ 8.4 Set order type for tagged command
+ 8.5 Set debug mode
+ 8.6 Clear profile counters
+ 8.7 Set flag (no_disc)
+ 8.8 Set verbose level
+ 8.9 Reset all logical units of a target
+ 8.10 Abort all tasks of all logical units of a target
+9. Configuration parameters
+10. Boot setup commands
+ 10.1 Syntax
+ 10.2 Available arguments
+ 10.2.1 Master parity checking
+ 10.2.2 Scsi parity checking
+ 10.2.3 Scsi disconnections
+ 10.2.4 Special features
+ 10.2.5 Ultra SCSI support
+ 10.2.6 Default number of tagged commands
+ 10.2.7 Default synchronous period factor
+ 10.2.8 Negotiate synchronous with all devices
+ 10.2.9 Verbosity level
+ 10.2.10 Debug mode
+ 10.2.11 Burst max
+ 10.2.12 LED support
+ 10.2.13 Max wide
+ 10.2.14 Differential mode
+ 10.2.15 IRQ mode
+ 10.2.16 Reverse probe
+ 10.2.17 Fix up PCI configuration space
+ 10.2.18 Serial NVRAM
+ 10.2.19 Check SCSI BUS
+ 10.2.20 Exclude a host from being attached
+ 10.2.21 Suggest a default SCSI id for hosts
+ 10.2.22 Enable use of IMMEDIATE ARBITRATION
+ 10.3 Advised boot setup commands
+ 10.4 PCI configuration fix-up boot option
+ 10.5 Serial NVRAM support boot option
+ 10.6 SCSI BUS checking boot option
+ 10.7 IMMEDIATE ARBITRATION boot option
+11. Some constants and flags of the ncr53c8xx.h header file
+12. Installation
+13. Architecture dependent features
+14. Known problems
+ 14.1 Tagged commands with Iomega Jaz device
+ 14.2 Device names change when another controller is added
+ 14.3 Using only 8 bit devices with a WIDE SCSI controller.
+ 14.4 Possible data corruption during a Memory Write and Invalidate
+ 14.5 IRQ sharing problems
+15. SCSI problem troubleshooting
+ 15.1 Problem tracking
+ 15.2 Understanding hardware error reports
+16. Synchonous transfer negotiation tables
+ 16.1 Synchronous timings for 53C875 and 53C860 Ultra-SCSI controllers
+ 16.2 Synchronous timings for fast SCSI-2 53C8XX controllers
+17. Serial NVRAM support (by Richard Waltham)
+ 17.1 Features
+ 17.2 Symbios NVRAM layout
+ 17.3 Tekram NVRAM layout
+18. Support for Big Endian
+ 18.1 Big Endian CPU
+ 18.2 NCR chip in Big Endian mode of operations
+
+===============================================================================
+
+1. Introduction
+
+The initial Linux ncr53c8xx driver has been a port of the ncr driver from
+FreeBSD that has been achieved in November 1995 by:
+ Gerard Roudier <groudier@free.fr>
+
+The original driver has been written for 386bsd and FreeBSD by:
+ Wolfgang Stanglmeier <wolf@cologne.de>
+ Stefan Esser <se@mi.Uni-Koeln.de>
+
+It is now available as a bundle of 2 drivers:
+
+- ncr53c8xx generic driver that supports all the SYM53C8XX family including
+ the ealiest 810 rev. 1, the latest 896 (2 channel LVD SCSI controller) and
+ the new 895A (1 channel LVD SCSI controller).
+- sym53c8xx enhanced driver (a.k.a. 896 drivers) that drops support of oldest
+ chips in order to gain advantage of new features, as LOAD/STORE intructions
+ available since the 810A and hardware phase mismatch available with the
+ 896 and the 895A.
+
+You can find technical information about the NCR 8xx family in the
+PCI-HOWTO written by Michael Will and in the SCSI-HOWTO written by
+Drew Eckhardt.
+
+Information about new chips is available at LSILOGIC web server:
+
+ http://www.lsilogic.com/
+
+SCSI standard documentations are available at SYMBIOS ftp server:
+
+ ftp://ftp.symbios.com/
+
+Usefull SCSI tools written by Eric Youngdale are available at tsx-11:
+
+ ftp://tsx-11.mit.edu/pub/linux/ALPHA/scsi/scsiinfo-X.Y.tar.gz
+ ftp://tsx-11.mit.edu/pub/linux/ALPHA/scsi/scsidev-X.Y.tar.gz
+
+These tools are not ALPHA but quite clean and work quite well.
+It is essential you have the 'scsiinfo' package.
+
+This short documentation describes the features of the generic and enhanced
+drivers, configuration parameters and control commands available through
+the proc SCSI file system read / write operations.
+
+This driver has been tested OK with linux/i386, Linux/Alpha and Linux/PPC.
+
+Latest driver version and patches are available at:
+
+ ftp://ftp.tux.org/pub/people/gerard-roudier
+or
+ ftp://ftp.symbios.com/mirror/ftp.tux.org/pub/tux/roudier/drivers
+
+I am not a native speaker of English and there are probably lots of
+mistakes in this README file. Any help will be welcome.
+
+
+2. Supported chips and SCSI features
+
+The following features are supported for all chips:
+
+ Synchronous negotiation
+ Disconnection
+ Tagged command queuing
+ SCSI parity checking
+ Master parity checking
+
+"Wide negotiation" is supported for chips that allow it. The
+following table shows some characteristics of NCR 8xx family chips
+and what drivers support them.
+
+ Supported by Supported by
+ On board the generic the enhanced
+Chip SDMS BIOS Wide SCSI std. Max. sync driver driver
+---- --------- ---- --------- ---------- ------------ -------------
+810 N N FAST10 10 MB/s Y N
+810A N N FAST10 10 MB/s Y Y
+815 Y N FAST10 10 MB/s Y N
+825 Y Y FAST10 20 MB/s Y N
+825A Y Y FAST10 20 MB/s Y Y
+860 N N FAST20 20 MB/s Y Y
+875 Y Y FAST20 40 MB/s Y Y
+876 Y Y FAST20 40 MB/s Y Y
+895 Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+895A Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+896 Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+897 Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+1510D Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+1010 Y Y FAST80 160 MB/s N Y
+1010_66* Y Y FAST80 160 MB/s N Y
+
+* Chip supports 33MHz and 66MHz PCI buses.
+
+
+Summary of other supported features:
+
+Module: allow to load the driver
+Memory mapped I/O: increases performance
+Profiling information: read operations from the proc SCSI file system
+Control commands: write operations to the proc SCSI file system
+Debugging information: written to syslog (expert only)
+Scatter / gather
+Shared interrupt
+Boot setup commands
+Serial NVRAM: Symbios and Tekram formats
+
+
+3. Advantages of the enhanced 896 driver
+
+3.1 Optimized SCSI SCRIPTS.
+
+The 810A, 825A, 875, 895, 896 and 895A support new SCSI SCRIPTS instructions
+named LOAD and STORE that allow to move up to 1 DWORD from/to an IO register
+to/from memory much faster that the MOVE MEMORY instruction that is supported
+by the 53c7xx and 53c8xx family.
+The LOAD/STORE instructions support absolute and DSA relative addressing
+modes. The SCSI SCRIPTS had been entirely rewritten using LOAD/STORE instead
+of MOVE MEMORY instructions.
+
+3.2 New features of the SYM53C896 (64 bit PCI dual LVD SCSI controller)
+
+The 896 and the 895A allows handling of the phase mismatch context from
+SCRIPTS (avoids the phase mismatch interrupt that stops the SCSI processor
+until the C code has saved the context of the transfer).
+Implementing this without using LOAD/STORE instructions would be painfull
+and I did'nt even want to try it.
+
+The 896 chip supports 64 bit PCI transactions and addressing, while the
+895A supports 32 bit PCI transactions and 64 bit addressing.
+The SCRIPTS processor of these chips is not true 64 bit, but uses segment
+registers for bit 32-63. Another interesting feature is that LOAD/STORE
+instructions that address the on-chip RAM (8k) remain internal to the chip.
+
+Due to the use of LOAD/STORE SCRIPTS instructions, this driver does not
+support the following chips:
+- SYM53C810 revision < 0x10 (16)
+- SYM53C815 all revisions
+- SYM53C825 revision < 0x10 (16)
+
+4. Memory mapped I/O versus normal I/O
+
+Memory mapped I/O has less latency than normal I/O. Since
+linux-1.3.x, memory mapped I/O is used rather than normal I/O. Memory
+mapped I/O seems to work fine on most hardware configurations, but
+some poorly designed motherboards may break this feature.
+
+The configuration option CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_IOMAPPED forces the
+driver to use normal I/O in all cases.
+
+
+5. Tagged command queueing
+
+Queuing more than 1 command at a time to a device allows it to perform
+optimizations based on actual head positions and its mechanical
+characteristics. This feature may also reduce average command latency.
+In order to really gain advantage of this feature, devices must have
+a reasonable cache size (No miracle is to be expected for a low-end
+hard disk with 128 KB or less).
+Some kown SCSI devices do not properly support tagged command queuing.
+Generally, firmware revisions that fix this kind of problems are available
+at respective vendor web/ftp sites.
+All I can say is that the hard disks I use on my machines behave well with
+this driver with tagged command queuing enabled:
+
+- IBM S12 0662
+- Conner 1080S
+- Quantum Atlas I
+- Quantum Atlas II
+
+If your controller has NVRAM, you can configure this feature per target
+from the user setup tool. The Tekram Setup program allows to tune the
+maximum number of queued commands up to 32. The Symbios Setup only allows
+to enable or disable this feature.
+
+The maximum number of simultaneous tagged commands queued to a device
+is currently set to 8 by default. This value is suitable for most SCSI
+disks. With large SCSI disks (>= 2GB, cache >= 512KB, average seek time
+<= 10 ms), using a larger value may give better performances.
+
+The sym53c8xx driver supports up to 255 commands per device, and the
+generic ncr53c8xx driver supports up to 64, but using more than 32 is
+generally not worth-while, unless you are using a very large disk or disk
+array. It is noticeable that most of recent hard disks seem not to accept
+more than 64 simultaneous commands. So, using more than 64 queued commands
+is probably just resource wasting.
+
+If your controller does not have NVRAM or if it is managed by the SDMS
+BIOS/SETUP, you can configure tagged queueing feature and device queue
+depths from the boot command-line. For example:
+
+ ncr53c8xx=tags:4/t2t3q15-t4q7/t1u0q32
+
+will set tagged commands queue depths as follow:
+
+- target 2 all luns on controller 0 --> 15
+- target 3 all luns on controller 0 --> 15
+- target 4 all luns on controller 0 --> 7
+- target 1 lun 0 on controller 1 --> 32
+- all other target/lun --> 4
+
+In some special conditions, some SCSI disk firmwares may return a
+QUEUE FULL status for a SCSI command. This behaviour is managed by the
+driver using the following heuristic:
+
+- Each time a QUEUE FULL status is returned, tagged queue depth is reduced
+ to the actual number of disconnected commands.
+
+- Every 1000 successfully completed SCSI commands, if allowed by the
+ current limit, the maximum number of queueable commands is incremented.
+
+Since QUEUE FULL status reception and handling is resource wasting, the
+driver notifies by default this problem to user by indicating the actual
+number of commands used and their status, as well as its decision on the
+device queue depth change.
+The heuristic used by the driver in handling QUEUE FULL ensures that the
+impact on performances is not too bad. You can get rid of the messages by
+setting verbose level to zero, as follow:
+
+1st method: boot your system using 'ncr53c8xx=verb:0' option.
+2nd method: apply "setverbose 0" control command to the proc fs entry
+ corresponding to your controller after boot-up.
+
+6. Parity checking
+
+The driver supports SCSI parity checking and PCI bus master parity
+checking. These features must be enabled in order to ensure safe data
+transfers. However, some flawed devices or mother boards will have
+problems with parity. You can disable either PCI parity or SCSI parity
+checking by entering appropriate options from the boot command line.
+(See 10: Boot setup commands).
+
+7. Profiling information
+
+Profiling information is available through the proc SCSI file system.
+Since gathering profiling information may impact performances, this
+feature is disabled by default and requires a compilation configuration
+option to be set to Y.
+
+The device associated with a host has the following pathname:
+
+ /proc/scsi/ncr53c8xx/N (N=0,1,2 ....)
+
+Generally, only 1 board is used on hardware configuration, and that device is:
+ /proc/scsi/ncr53c8xx/0
+
+However, if the driver has been made as module, the number of the
+hosts is incremented each time the driver is loaded.
+
+In order to display profiling information, just enter:
+
+ cat /proc/scsi/ncr53c8xx/0
+
+and you will get something like the following text:
+
+-------------------------------------------------------
+General information:
+ Chip NCR53C810, device id 0x1, revision id 0x2
+ IO port address 0x6000, IRQ number 10
+ Using memory mapped IO at virtual address 0x282c000
+ Synchronous transfer period 25, max commands per lun 4
+Profiling information:
+ num_trans = 18014
+ num_kbytes = 671314
+ num_disc = 25763
+ num_break = 1673
+ num_int = 1685
+ num_fly = 18038
+ ms_setup = 4940
+ ms_data = 369940
+ ms_disc = 183090
+ ms_post = 1320
+-------------------------------------------------------
+
+General information is easy to understand. The device ID and the
+revision ID identify the SCSI chip as follows:
+
+Chip Device id Revision Id
+---- --------- -----------
+810 0x1 < 0x10
+810A 0x1 >= 0x10
+815 0x4
+825 0x3 < 0x10
+860 0x6
+825A 0x3 >= 0x10
+875 0xf
+895 0xc
+
+The profiling information is updated upon completion of SCSI commands.
+A data structure is allocated and zeroed when the host adapter is
+attached. So, if the driver is a module, the profile counters are
+cleared each time the driver is loaded. The "clearprof" command
+allows you to clear these counters at any time.
+
+The following counters are available:
+
+("num" prefix means "number of",
+"ms" means milli-seconds)
+
+num_trans
+ Number of completed commands
+ Example above: 18014 completed commands
+
+num_kbytes
+ Number of kbytes transferred
+ Example above: 671 MB transferred
+
+num_disc
+ Number of SCSI disconnections
+ Example above: 25763 SCSI disconnections
+
+num_break
+ number of script interruptions (phase mismatch)
+ Example above: 1673 script interruptions
+
+num_int
+ Number of interrupts other than "on the fly"
+ Example above: 1685 interruptions not "on the fly"
+
+num_fly
+ Number of interrupts "on the fly"
+ Example above: 18038 interruptions "on the fly"
+
+ms_setup
+ Elapsed time for SCSI commands setups
+ Example above: 4.94 seconds
+
+ms_data
+ Elapsed time for data transfers
+ Example above: 369.94 seconds spent for data transfer
+
+ms_disc
+ Elapsed time for SCSI disconnections
+ Example above: 183.09 seconds spent disconnected
+
+ms_post
+ Elapsed time for command post processing
+ (time from SCSI status get to command completion call)
+ Example above: 1.32 seconds spent for post processing
+
+Due to the 1/100 second tick of the system clock, "ms_post" time may
+be wrong.
+
+In the example above, we got 18038 interrupts "on the fly" and only
+1673 script breaks generally due to disconnections inside a segment
+of the scatter list.
+
+
+8. Control commands
+
+Control commands can be sent to the driver with write operations to
+the proc SCSI file system. The generic command syntax is the
+following:
+
+ echo "<verb> <parameters>" >/proc/scsi/ncr53c8xx/0
+ (assumes controller number is 0)
+
+Using "all" for "<target>" parameter with the commands below will
+apply to all targets of the SCSI chain (except the controller).
+
+Available commands:
+
+8.1 Set minimum synchronous period factor
+
+ setsync <target> <period factor>
+
+ target: target number
+ period: minimum synchronous period.
+ Maximum speed = 1000/(4*period factor) except for special
+ cases below.
+
+ Specify a period of 255, to force asynchronous transfer mode.
+
+ 10 means 25 nano-seconds synchronous period
+ 11 means 30 nano-seconds synchronous period
+ 12 means 50 nano-seconds synchronous period
+
+8.2 Set wide size
+
+ setwide <target> <size>
+
+ target: target number
+ size: 0=8 bits, 1=16bits
+
+8.3 Set maximum number of concurrent tagged commands
+
+ settags <target> <tags>
+
+ target: target number
+ tags: number of concurrent tagged commands
+ must not be greater than SCSI_NCR_MAX_TAGS (default: 8)
+
+8.4 Set order type for tagged command
+
+ setorder <order>
+
+ order: 3 possible values:
+ simple: use SIMPLE TAG for all operations (read and write)
+ ordered: use ORDERED TAG for all operations
+ default: use default tag type,
+ SIMPLE TAG for read operations
+ ORDERED TAG for write operations
+
+
+8.5 Set debug mode
+
+ setdebug <list of debug flags>
+
+ Available debug flags:
+ alloc: print info about memory allocations (ccb, lcb)
+ queue: print info about insertions into the command start queue
+ result: print sense data on CHECK CONDITION status
+ scatter: print info about the scatter process
+ scripts: print info about the script binding process
+ tiny: print minimal debugging information
+ timing: print timing information of the NCR chip
+ nego: print information about SCSI negotiations
+ phase: print information on script interruptions
+
+ Use "setdebug" with no argument to reset debug flags.
+
+
+8.6 Clear profile counters
+
+ clearprof
+
+ The profile counters are automatically cleared when the amount of
+ data transferred reaches 1000 GB in order to avoid overflow.
+ The "clearprof" command allows you to clear these counters at any time.
+
+
+8.7 Set flag (no_disc)
+
+ setflag <target> <flag>
+
+ target: target number
+
+ For the moment, only one flag is available:
+
+ no_disc: not allow target to disconnect.
+
+ Do not specify any flag in order to reset the flag. For example:
+ - setflag 4
+ will reset no_disc flag for target 4, so will allow it disconnections.
+ - setflag all
+ will allow disconnection for all devices on the SCSI bus.
+
+
+8.8 Set verbose level
+
+ setverbose #level
+
+ The driver default verbose level is 1. This command allows to change
+ th driver verbose level after boot-up.
+
+8.9 Reset all logical units of a target
+
+ resetdev <target>
+
+ target: target number
+ The driver will try to send a BUS DEVICE RESET message to the target.
+ (Only supported by the SYM53C8XX driver and provided for test purpose)
+
+8.10 Abort all tasks of all logical units of a target
+
+ cleardev <target>
+
+ target: target number
+ The driver will try to send a ABORT message to all the logical units
+ of the target.
+ (Only supported by the SYM53C8XX driver and provided for test purpose)
+
+
+9. Configuration parameters
+
+If the firmware of all your devices is perfect enough, all the
+features supported by the driver can be enabled at start-up. However,
+if only one has a flaw for some SCSI feature, you can disable the
+support by the driver of this feature at linux start-up and enable
+this feature after boot-up only for devices that support it safely.
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_PROFILE_SUPPORT (default answer: n)
+ This option must be set for profiling information to be gathered
+ and printed out through the proc file system. This features may
+ impact performances.
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_IOMAPPED (default answer: n)
+ Answer "y" if you suspect your mother board to not allow memory mapped I/O.
+ May slow down performance a little. This option is required by
+ Linux/PPC and is used no matter what you select here. Linux/PPC
+ suffers no performance loss with this option since all IO is memory
+ mapped anyway.
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_DEFAULT_TAGS (default answer: 8)
+ Default tagged command queue depth.
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_MAX_TAGS (default answer: 8)
+ This option allows you to specify the maximum number of tagged commands
+ that can be queued to a device. The maximum supported value is 32.
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_SYNC (default answer: 5)
+ This option allows you to specify the frequency in MHz the driver
+ will use at boot time for synchronous data transfer negotiations.
+ This frequency can be changed later with the "setsync" control command.
+ 0 means "asynchronous data transfers".
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_FORCE_SYNC_NEGO (default answer: n)
+ Force synchronous negotiation for all SCSI-2 devices.
+ Some SCSI-2 devices do not report this feature in byte 7 of inquiry
+ response but do support it properly (TAMARACK scanners for example).
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_NO_DISCONNECT (default and only reasonable answer: n)
+ If you suspect a device of yours does not properly support disconnections,
+ you can answer "y". Then, all SCSI devices will never disconnect the bus
+ even while performing long SCSI operations.
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_SYMBIOS_COMPAT
+ Genuine SYMBIOS boards use GPIO0 in output for controller LED and GPIO3
+ bit as a flag indicating singled-ended/differential interface.
+ If all the boards of your system are genuine SYMBIOS boards or use
+ BIOS and drivers from SYMBIOS, you would want to enable this option.
+ This option must NOT be enabled if your system has at least one 53C8XX
+ based scsi board with a vendor-specific BIOS.
+ For example, Tekram DC-390/U, DC-390/W and DC-390/F scsi controllers
+ use a vendor-specific BIOS and are known to not use SYMBIOS compatible
+ GPIO wiring. So, this option must not be enabled if your system has
+ such a board installed.
+
+CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_NVRAM_DETECT
+ Enable support for reading the serial NVRAM data on Symbios and
+ some Symbios compatible cards, and Tekram DC390W/U/F cards. Useful for
+ systems with more than one Symbios compatible controller where at least
+ one has a serial NVRAM, or for a system with a mixture of Symbios and
+ Tekram cards. Enables setting the boot order of host adaptors
+ to something other than the default order or "reverse probe" order.
+ Also enables Symbios and Tekram cards to be distinguished so
+ CONFIG_SCSI_NCR53C8XX_SYMBIOS_COMPAT may be set in a system with a
+ mixture of Symbios and Tekram cards so the Symbios cards can make use of
+ the full range of Symbios features, differential, led pin, without
+ causing problems for the Tekram card(s).
+
+10. Boot setup commands
+
+10.1 Syntax
+
+Setup commands can be passed to the driver either at boot time or as a
+string variable using 'insmod'.
+
+A boot setup command for the ncr53c8xx (sym53c8xx) driver begins with the
+driver name "ncr53c8xx="(sym53c8xx). The kernel syntax parser then expects
+an optionnal list of integers separated with comma followed by an optional
+list of comma-separated strings. Example of boot setup command under lilo
+prompt:
+
+lilo: linux root=/dev/hda2 ncr53c8xx=tags:4,sync:10,debug:0x200
+
+- enable tagged commands, up to 4 tagged commands queued.
+- set synchronous negotiation speed to 10 Mega-transfers / second.
+- set DEBUG_NEGO flag.
+
+Since comma seems not to be allowed when defining a string variable using
+'insmod', the driver also accepts <space> as option separator.
+The following command will install driver module with the same options as
+above.
+
+ insmod ncr53c8xx.o ncr53c8xx="tags:4 sync:10 debug:0x200"
+
+For the moment, the integer list of arguments is discarded by the driver.
+It will be used in the future in order to allow a per controller setup.
+
+Each string argument must be specified as "keyword:value". Only lower-case
+characters and digits are allowed.
+
+In a system that contains multiple 53C8xx adapters insmod will install the
+specified driver on each adapter. To exclude a chip use the 'excl' keyword.
+
+The sequence of commands,
+
+ insmod sym53c8xx sym53c8xx=excl:0x1400
+ insmod ncr53c8xx
+
+installs the sym53c8xx driver on all adapters except the one at IO port
+address 0x1400 and then installs the ncr53c8xx driver to the adapter at IO
+port address 0x1400.
+
+
+10.2 Available arguments
+
+10.2.1 Master parity checking
+ mpar:y enabled
+ mpar:n disabled
+
+10.2.2 Scsi parity checking
+ spar:y enabled
+ spar:n disabled
+
+10.2.3 Scsi disconnections
+ disc:y enabled
+ disc:n disabled
+
+10.2.4 Special features
+ Only apply to 810A, 825A, 860, 875 and 895 controllers.
+ Have no effect with other ones.
+ specf:y (or 1) enabled
+ specf:n (or 0) disabled
+ specf:3 enabled except Memory Write And Invalidate
+ The default driver setup is 'specf:3'. As a consequence, option 'specf:y'
+ must be specified in the boot setup command to enable Memory Write And
+ Invalidate.
+
+10.2.5 Ultra SCSI support
+ Only apply to 860, 875, 895, 895a, 896, 1010 and 1010_66 controllers.
+ Have no effect with other ones.
+ ultra:n All ultra speeds enabled
+ ultra:2 Ultra2 enabled
+ ultra:1 Ultra enabled
+ ultra:0 Ultra speeds disabled
+
+10.2.6 Default number of tagged commands
+ tags:0 (or tags:1 ) tagged command queuing disabled
+ tags:#tags (#tags > 1) tagged command queuing enabled
+ #tags will be truncated to the max queued commands configuration parameter.
+ This option also allows to specify a command queue depth for each device
+ that support tagged command queueing.
+ Example:
+ ncr53c8xx=tags:10/t2t3q16-t5q24/t1u2q32
+ will set devices queue depth as follow:
+ - controller #0 target #2 and target #3 -> 16 commands,
+ - controller #0 target #5 -> 24 commands,
+ - controller #1 target #1 logical unit #2 -> 32 commands,
+ - all other logical units (all targets, all controllers) -> 10 commands.
+
+10.2.7 Default synchronous period factor
+ sync:255 disabled (asynchronous transfer mode)
+ sync:#factor
+ #factor = 10 Ultra-2 SCSI 40 Mega-transfers / second
+ #factor = 11 Ultra-2 SCSI 33 Mega-transfers / second
+ #factor < 25 Ultra SCSI 20 Mega-transfers / second
+ #factor < 50 Fast SCSI-2
+
+ In all cases, the driver will use the minimum transfer period supported by
+ controllers according to NCR53C8XX chip type.
+
+10.2.8 Negotiate synchronous with all devices
+ (force sync nego)
+ fsn:y enabled
+ fsn:n disabled
+
+10.2.9 Verbosity level
+ verb:0 minimal
+ verb:1 normal
+ verb:2 too much
+
+10.2.10 Debug mode
+ debug:0 clear debug flags
+ debug:#x set debug flags
+ #x is an integer value combining the following power-of-2 values:
+ DEBUG_ALLOC 0x1
+ DEBUG_PHASE 0x2
+ DEBUG_POLL 0x4
+ DEBUG_QUEUE 0x8
+ DEBUG_RESULT 0x10
+ DEBUG_SCATTER 0x20
+ DEBUG_SCRIPT 0x40
+ DEBUG_TINY 0x80
+ DEBUG_TIMING 0x100
+ DEBUG_NEGO 0x200
+ DEBUG_TAGS 0x400
+ DEBUG_FREEZE 0x800
+ DEBUG_RESTART 0x1000
+
+ You can play safely with DEBUG_NEGO. However, some of these flags may
+ generate bunches of syslog messages.
+
+10.2.11 Burst max
+ burst:0 burst disabled
+ burst:255 get burst length from initial IO register settings.
+ burst:#x burst enabled (1<<#x burst transfers max)
+ #x is an integer value which is log base 2 of the burst transfers max.
+ The NCR53C875 and NCR53C825A support up to 128 burst transfers (#x = 7).
+ Other chips only support up to 16 (#x = 4).
+ This is a maximum value. The driver set the burst length according to chip
+ and revision ids. By default the driver uses the maximum value supported
+ by the chip.
+
+10.2.12 LED support
+ led:1 enable LED support
+ led:0 disable LED support
+ Donnot enable LED support if your scsi board does not use SDMS BIOS.
+ (See 'Configuration parameters')
+
+10.2.13 Max wide
+ wide:1 wide scsi enabled
+ wide:0 wide scsi disabled
+ Some scsi boards use a 875 (ultra wide) and only supply narrow connectors.
+ If you have connected a wide device with a 50 pins to 68 pins cable
+ converter, any accepted wide negotiation will break further data transfers.
+ In such a case, using "wide:0" in the bootup command will be helpfull.
+
+10.2.14 Differential mode
+ diff:0 never set up diff mode
+ diff:1 set up diff mode if BIOS set it
+ diff:2 always set up diff mode
+ diff:3 set diff mode if GPIO3 is not set
+
+10.2.15 IRQ mode
+ irqm:0 always open drain
+ irqm:1 same as initial settings (assumed BIOS settings)
+ irqm:2 always totem pole
+ irqm:0x10 driver will not use SA_SHIRQ flag when requesting irq
+ irqm:0x20 driver will not use SA_INTERRUPT flag when requesting irq
+
+ (Bits 0x10 and 0x20 can be combined with hardware irq mode option)
+
+10.2.16 Reverse probe
+ revprob:n probe chip ids from the PCI configuration in this order:
+ 810, 815, 820, 860, 875, 885, 895, 896
+ revprob:y probe chip ids in the reverse order.
+
+10.2.17 Fix up PCI configuration space
+ pcifix:<option bits>
+
+ Available option bits:
+ 0x0: No attempt to fix PCI configuration space registers values.
+ 0x1: Set PCI cache-line size register if not set.
+ 0x2: Set write and invalidate bit in PCI command register.
+ 0x4: Increase if necessary PCI latency timer according to burst max.
+
+ Use 'pcifix:7' in order to allow the driver to fix up all PCI features.
+
+10.2.18 Serial NVRAM
+ nvram:n do not look for serial NVRAM
+ nvram:y test controllers for onboard serial NVRAM
+ (alternate binary form)
+ mvram=<bits options>
+ 0x01 look for NVRAM (equivalent to nvram=y)
+ 0x02 ignore NVRAM "Synchronous negotiation" parameters for all devices
+ 0x04 ignore NVRAM "Wide negotiation" parameter for all devices
+ 0x08 ignore NVRAM "Scan at boot time" parameter for all devices
+ 0x80 also attach controllers set to OFF in the NVRAM (sym53c8xx only)
+
+10.2.19 Check SCSI BUS
+ buschk:<option bits>
+
+ Available option bits:
+ 0x0: No check.
+ 0x1: Check and do not attach the controller on error.
+ 0x2: Check and just warn on error.
+ 0x4: Disable SCSI bus integrity checking.
+
+10.2.20 Exclude a host from being attached
+ excl=<io_address>
+
+ Prevent host at a given io address from being attached.
+ For example 'ncr53c8xx=excl:0xb400,excl:0xc000' indicate to the
+ ncr53c8xx driver not to attach hosts at address 0xb400 and 0xc000.
+
+10.2.21 Suggest a default SCSI id for hosts
+ hostid:255 no id suggested.
+ hostid:#x (0 < x < 7) x suggested for hosts SCSI id.
+
+ If a host SCSI id is available from the NVRAM, the driver will ignore
+ any value suggested as boot option. Otherwise, if a suggested value
+ different from 255 has been supplied, it will use it. Otherwise, it will
+ try to deduce the value previously set in the hardware and use value
+ 7 if the hardware value is zero.
+
+10.2.22 Enable use of IMMEDIATE ARBITRATION
+ (only supported by the sym53c8xx driver. See 10.7 for more details)
+ iarb:0 do not use this feature.
+ iarb:#x use this feature according to bit fields as follow:
+
+ bit 0 (1) : enable IARB each time the initiator has been reselected
+ when it arbitrated for the SCSI BUS.
+ (#x >> 4) : maximum number of successive settings of IARB if the initiator
+ win arbitration and it has other commands to send to a device.
+
+Boot fail safe
+ safe:y load the following assumed fail safe initial setup
+
+ master parity disabled mpar:n
+ scsi parity enabled spar:y
+ disconnections not allowed disc:n
+ special features disabled specf:n
+ ultra scsi disabled ultra:n
+ force sync negotiation disabled fsn:n
+ reverse probe disabled revprob:n
+ PCI fix up disabled pcifix:0
+ serial NVRAM enabled nvram:y
+ verbosity level 2 verb:2
+ tagged command queuing disabled tags:0
+ synchronous negotiation disabled sync:255
+ debug flags none debug:0
+ burst length from BIOS settings burst:255
+ LED support disabled led:0
+ wide support disabled wide:0
+ settle time 10 seconds settle:10
+ differential support from BIOS settings diff:1
+ irq mode from BIOS settings irqm:1
+ SCSI BUS check do not attach on error buschk:1
+ immediate arbitration disabled iarb:0
+
+10.3 Advised boot setup commands
+
+If the driver has been configured with default options, the equivalent
+boot setup is:
+
+ ncr53c8xx=mpar:y,spar:y,disc:y,specf:3,fsn:n,ultra:2,fsn:n,revprob:n,verb:1\
+ tags:0,sync:50,debug:0,burst:7,led:0,wide:1,settle:2,diff:0,irqm:0
+
+For an installation diskette or a safe but not fast system,
+boot setup can be:
+
+ ncr53c8xx=safe:y,mpar:y,disc:y
+ ncr53c8xx=safe:y,disc:y
+ ncr53c8xx=safe:y,mpar:y
+ ncr53c8xx=safe:y
+
+My personnal system works flawlessly with the following equivalent setup:
+
+ ncr53c8xx=mpar:y,spar:y,disc:y,specf:1,fsn:n,ultra:2,fsn:n,revprob:n,verb:1\
+ tags:32,sync:12,debug:0,burst:7,led:1,wide:1,settle:2,diff:0,irqm:0
+
+The driver prints its actual setup when verbosity level is 2. You can try
+"ncr53c8xx=verb:2" to get the "static" setup of the driver, or add "verb:2"
+to your boot setup command in order to check the actual setup the driver is
+using.
+
+10.4 PCI configuration fix-up boot option
+
+pcifix:<option bits>
+
+Available option bits:
+ 0x1: Set PCI cache-line size register if not set.
+ 0x2: Set write and invalidate bit in PCI command register.
+
+Use 'pcifix:3' in order to allow the driver to fix both PCI features.
+
+These options only apply to new SYMBIOS chips 810A, 825A, 860, 875
+and 895 and are only supported for Pentium and 486 class processors.
+Recent SYMBIOS 53C8XX scsi processors are able to use PCI read multiple
+and PCI write and invalidate commands. These features require the
+cache line size register to be properly set in the PCI configuration
+space of the chips. On the other hand, chips will use PCI write and
+invalidate commands only if the corresponding bit is set to 1 in the
+PCI command register.
+
+Not all PCI bioses set the PCI cache line register and the PCI write and
+invalidate bit in the PCI configuration space of 53C8XX chips.
+Optimized PCI accesses may be broken for some PCI/memory controllers or
+make problems with some PCI boards.
+
+This fix-up worked flawlessly on my previous system.
+(MB Triton HX / 53C875 / 53C810A)
+I use these options at my own risks as you will do if you decide to
+use them too.
+
+
+10.5 Serial NVRAM support boot option
+
+nvram:n do not look for serial NVRAM
+nvram:y test controllers for onboard serial NVRAM
+
+This option can also been entered as an hexadecimal value that allows
+to control what information the driver will get from the NVRAM and what
+information it will ignore.
+For details see '17. Serial NVRAM support'.
+
+When this option is enabled, the driver tries to detect all boards using
+a Serial NVRAM. This memory is used to hold user set up parameters.
+
+The parameters the driver is able to get from the NVRAM depend on the
+data format used, as follow:
+
+ Tekram format Symbios format
+General and host parameters
+ Boot order N Y
+ Host SCSI ID Y Y
+ SCSI parity checking Y Y
+ Verbose boot messages N Y
+SCSI devices parameters
+ Synchronous transfer speed Y Y
+ Wide 16 / Narrow Y Y
+ Tagged Command Queuing enabled Y Y
+ Disconnections enabled Y Y
+ Scan at boot time N Y
+
+In order to speed up the system boot, for each device configured without
+the "scan at boot time" option, the driver forces an error on the
+first TEST UNIT READY command received for this device.
+
+Some SDMS BIOS revisions seem to be unable to boot cleanly with very fast
+hard disks. In such a situation you cannot configure the NVRAM with
+optimized parameters value.
+
+The 'nvram' boot option can be entered in hexadecimal form in order
+to ignore some options configured in the NVRAM, as follow:
+
+mvram=<bits options>
+ 0x01 look for NVRAM (equivalent to nvram=y)
+ 0x02 ignore NVRAM "Synchronous negotiation" parameters for all devices
+ 0x04 ignore NVRAM "Wide negotiation" parameter for all devices
+ 0x08 ignore NVRAM "Scan at boot time" parameter for all devices
+ 0x80 also attach controllers set to OFF in the NVRAM (sym53c8xx only)
+
+Option 0x80 is only supported by the sym53c8xx driver and is disabled by
+default. Result is that, by default (option not set), the sym53c8xx driver
+will not attach controllers set to OFF in the NVRAM.
+
+The ncr53c8xx always tries to attach all the controllers. Option 0x80 has
+not been added to the ncr53c8xx driver, since it has been reported to
+confuse users who use this driver since a long time. If you desire a
+controller not to be attached by the ncr53c8xx driver at Linux boot, you
+must use the 'excl' driver boot option.
+
+10.6 SCSI BUS checking boot option.
+
+When this option is set to a non-zero value, the driver checks SCSI lines
+logic state, 100 micro-seconds after having asserted the SCSI RESET line.
+The driver just reads SCSI lines and checks all lines read FALSE except RESET.
+Since SCSI devices shall release the BUS at most 800 nano-seconds after SCSI
+RESET has been asserted, any signal to TRUE may indicate a SCSI BUS problem.
+Unfortunately, the following common SCSI BUS problems are not detected:
+- Only 1 terminator installed.
+- Misplaced terminators.
+- Bad quality terminators.
+On the other hand, either bad cabling, broken devices, not conformant
+devices, ... may cause a SCSI signal to be wrong when te driver reads it.
+
+10.7 IMMEDIATE ARBITRATION boot option
+
+This option is only supported by the SYM53C8XX driver (not by the NCR53C8XX).
+
+SYMBIOS 53C8XX chips are able to arbitrate for the SCSI BUS as soon as they
+have detected an expected disconnection (BUS FREE PHASE). For this process
+to be started, bit 1 of SCNTL1 IO register must be set when the chip is
+connected to the SCSI BUS.
+
+When this feature has been enabled for the current connection, the chip has
+every chance to win arbitration if only devices with lower priority are
+competing for the SCSI BUS. By the way, when the chip is using SCSI id 7,
+then it will for sure win the next SCSI BUS arbitration.
+
+Since, there is no way to know what devices are trying to arbitrate for the
+BUS, using this feature can be extremely unfair. So, you are not advised
+to enable it, or at most enable this feature for the case the chip lost
+the previous arbitration (boot option 'iarb:1').
+
+This feature has the following advantages:
+
+a) Allow the initiator with ID 7 to win arbitration when it wants so.
+b) Overlap at least 4 micro-seconds of arbitration time with the execution
+ of SCRIPTS that deal with the end of the current connection and that
+ starts the next job.
+
+Hmmm... But (a) may just prevent other devices from reselecting the initiator,
+and delay data transfers or status/completions, and (b) may just waste
+SCSI BUS bandwidth if the SCRIPTS execution lasts more than 4 micro-seconds.
+
+The use of IARB needs the SCSI_NCR_IARB_SUPPORT option to have been defined
+at compile time and the 'iarb' boot option to have been set to a non zero
+value at boot time. It is not that useful for real work, but can be used
+to stress SCSI devices or for some applications that can gain advantage of
+it. By the way, if you experience badnesses like 'unexpected disconnections',
+'bad reselections', etc... when using IARB on heavy IO load, you should not
+be surprised, because force-feeding anything and blocking its arse at the
+same time cannot work for a long time. :-))
+
+
+11. Some constants and flags of the ncr53c8xx.h header file
+
+Some of these are defined from the configuration parameters. To
+change other "defines", you must edit the header file. Do that only
+if you know what you are doing.
+
+SCSI_NCR_SETUP_SPECIAL_FEATURES (default: defined)
+ If defined, the driver will enable some special features according
+ to chip and revision id.
+ For 810A, 860, 825A, 875 and 895 scsi chips, this option enables
+ support of features that reduce load of PCI bus and memory accesses
+ during scsi transfer processing: burst op-code fetch, read multiple,
+ read line, prefetch, cache line, write and invalidate,
+ burst 128 (875 only), large dma fifo (875 only), offset 16 (875 only).
+ Can be changed by the following boot setup command:
+ ncr53c8xx=specf:n
+
+SCSI_NCR_IOMAPPED (default: not defined)
+ If defined, normal I/O is forced.
+
+SCSI_NCR_SHARE_IRQ (default: defined)
+ If defined, request shared IRQ.
+
+SCSI_NCR_MAX_TAGS (default: 8)
+ Maximum number of simultaneous tagged commands to a device.
+ Can be changed by "settags <target> <maxtags>"
+
+SCSI_NCR_SETUP_DEFAULT_SYNC (default: 50)
+ Transfer period factor the driver will use at boot time for synchronous
+ negotiation. 0 means asynchronous.
+ Can be changed by "setsync <target> <period factor>"
+
+SCSI_NCR_SETUP_DEFAULT_TAGS (default: 8)
+ Default number of simultaneous tagged commands to a device.
+ < 1 means tagged command queuing disabled at start-up.
+
+SCSI_NCR_ALWAYS_SIMPLE_TAG (default: defined)
+ Use SIMPLE TAG for read and write commands.
+ Can be changed by "setorder <ordered|simple|default>"
+
+SCSI_NCR_SETUP_DISCONNECTION (default: defined)
+ If defined, targets are allowed to disconnect.
+
+SCSI_NCR_SETUP_FORCE_SYNC_NEGO (default: not defined)
+ If defined, synchronous negotiation is tried for all SCSI-2 devices.
+ Can be changed by "setsync <target> <period>"
+
+SCSI_NCR_SETUP_MASTER_PARITY (default: defined)
+ If defined, master parity checking is enabled.
+
+SCSI_NCR_SETUP_MASTER_PARITY (default: defined)
+ If defined, SCSI parity checking is enabled.
+
+SCSI_NCR_PROFILE_SUPPORT (default: not defined)
+ If defined, profiling information is gathered.
+
+SCSI_NCR_MAX_SCATTER (default: 128)
+ Scatter list size of the driver ccb.
+
+SCSI_NCR_MAX_TARGET (default: 16)
+ Max number of targets per host.
+
+SCSI_NCR_MAX_HOST (default: 2)
+ Max number of host controllers.
+
+SCSI_NCR_SETTLE_TIME (default: 2)
+ Number of seconds the driver will wait after reset.
+
+SCSI_NCR_TIMEOUT_ALERT (default: 3)
+ If a pending command will time out after this amount of seconds,
+ an ordered tag is used for the next command.
+ Avoids timeouts for unordered tagged commands.
+
+SCSI_NCR_CAN_QUEUE (default: 7*SCSI_NCR_MAX_TAGS)
+ Max number of commands that can be queued to a host.
+
+SCSI_NCR_CMD_PER_LUN (default: SCSI_NCR_MAX_TAGS)
+ Max number of commands queued to a host for a device.
+
+SCSI_NCR_SG_TABLESIZE (default: SCSI_NCR_MAX_SCATTER-1)
+ Max size of the Linux scatter/gather list.
+
+SCSI_NCR_MAX_LUN (default: 8)
+ Max number of LUNs per target.
+
+
+12. Installation
+
+This driver is part of the linux kernel distribution.
+Driver files are located in the sub-directory "drivers/scsi" of the
+kernel source tree.
+
+Driver files:
+
+ README.ncr53c8xx : this file
+ ChangeLog.ncr53c8xx : change log
+ ncr53c8xx.h : definitions
+ ncr53c8xx.c : the driver code
+
+New driver versions are made available separately in order to allow testing
+changes and new features prior to including them into the linux kernel
+distribution. The following URL provides informations on latest avalaible
+patches:
+
+ ftp://ftp.tux.org/pub/people/gerard-roudier/README
+
+
+13. Architecture dependent features.
+
+<Not yet written>
+
+
+14. Known problems
+
+14.1 Tagged commands with Iomega Jaz device
+
+I have not tried this device, however it has been reported to me the
+following: This device is capable of Tagged command queuing. However
+while spinning up, it rejects Tagged commands. This behaviour is
+conforms to 6.8.2 of SCSI-2 specifications. The current behaviour of
+the driver in that situation is not satisfying. So do not enable
+Tagged command queuing for devices that are able to spin down. The
+other problem that may appear is timeouts. The only way to avoid
+timeouts seems to edit linux/drivers/scsi/sd.c and to increase the
+current timeout values.
+
+14.2 Device names change when another controller is added.
+
+When you add a new NCR53C8XX chip based controller to a system that already
+has one or more controllers of this family, it may happen that the order
+the driver registers them to the kernel causes problems due to device
+name changes.
+When at least one controller uses NvRAM, SDMS BIOS version 4 allows you to
+define the order the BIOS will scan the scsi boards. The driver attaches
+controllers according to BIOS information if NvRAM detect option is set.
+
+If your controllers do not have NvRAM, you can:
+
+- Ask the driver to probe chip ids in reverse order from the boot command
+ line: ncr53c8xx=revprob:y
+- Make appropriate changes in the fstab.
+- Use the 'scsidev' tool from Eric Youngdale.
+
+14.3 Using only 8 bit devices with a WIDE SCSI controller.
+
+When only 8 bit NARROW devices are connected to a 16 bit WIDE SCSI controller,
+you must ensure that lines of the wide part of the SCSI BUS are pulled-up.
+This can be achieved by ENABLING the WIDE TERMINATOR portion of the SCSI
+controller card.
+The TYAN 1365 documentation revision 1.2 is not correct about such settings.
+(page 10, figure 3.3).
+
+14.4 Possible data corruption during a Memory Write and Invalidate
+
+This problem is described in SYMBIOS DEL 397, Part Number 69-039241, ITEM 4.
+
+In some complex situations, 53C875 chips revision <= 3 may start a PCI
+Write and Invalidate Command at a not cache-line-aligned 4 DWORDS boundary.
+This is only possible when Cache Line Size is 8 DWORDS or greater.
+Pentium systems use a 8 DWORDS cache line size and so are concerned by
+this chip bug, unlike i486 systems that use a 4 DWORDS cache line size.
+
+When this situation occurs, the chip may complete the Write and Invalidate
+command after having only filled part of the last cache line involved in
+the transfer, leaving to data corruption the remainder of this cache line.
+
+Not using Write And Invalidate obviously gets rid of this chip bug, and so
+it is now the default setting of the driver.
+However, for people like me who want to enable this feature, I have added
+part of a work-around suggested by SYMBIOS. This work-around resets the
+addressing logic when the DATA IN phase is entered and so prevents the bug
+from being triggered for the first SCSI MOVE of the phase. This work-around
+should be enough according to the following:
+
+The only driver internal data structure that is greater than 8 DWORDS and
+that is moved by the SCRIPTS processor is the 'CCB header' that contains
+the context of the SCSI transfer. This data structure is aligned on 8 DWORDS
+boundary (Pentium Cache Line Size), and so is immune to this chip bug, at
+least on Pentium systems.
+But the conditions of this bug can be met when a SCSI read command is
+performed using a buffer that is 4 DWORDS but not cache-line aligned.
+This cannot happen under Linux when scatter/gather lists are used since
+they only refer to system buffers that are well aligned. So, a work around
+may only be needed under Linux when a scatter/gather list is not used and
+when the SCSI DATA IN phase is reentered after a phase mismatch.
+
+14.5 IRQ sharing problems
+
+When an IRQ is shared by devices that are handled by different drivers, it
+may happen that one driver complains about the request of the IRQ having
+failed. Inder Linux-2.0, this may be due to one driver having requested the
+IRQ using the SA_INTERRUPT flag but some other having requested the same IRQ
+without this flag. Under both Linux-2.0 and linux-2.2, this may be caused by
+one driver not having requested the IRQ with the SA_SHIRQ flag.
+
+By default, the ncr53c8xx and sym53c8xx drivers request IRQs with both the
+SA_INTERRUPT and the SA_SHIRQ flag under Linux-2.0 and with only the SA_SHIRQ
+flag under Linux-2.2.
+
+Under Linux-2.0, you can disable use of SA_INTERRUPT flag from the boot
+command line by using the following option:
+
+ ncr53c8xx=irqm:0x20 (for the generic ncr53c8xx driver)
+ sym53c8xx=irqm:0x20 (for the sym53c8xx driver)
+
+If this does not fix the problem, then you may want to check how all other
+drivers are requesting the IRQ and report the problem. Note that if at least
+a single driver does not request the IRQ with the SA_SHIRQ flag (share IRQ),
+then the request of the IRQ obviously will not succeed for all the drivers.
+
+15. SCSI problem troubleshooting
+
+15.1 Problem tracking
+
+Most SCSI problems are due to a non conformant SCSI bus or to buggy
+devices. If infortunately you have SCSI problems, you can check the
+following things:
+
+- SCSI bus cables
+- terminations at both end of the SCSI chain
+- linux syslog messages (some of them may help you)
+
+If you do not find the source of problems, you can configure the
+driver with no features enabled.
+
+- only asynchronous data transfers
+- tagged commands disabled
+- disconnections not allowed
+
+Now, if your SCSI bus is ok, your system have every chance to work
+with this safe configuration but performances will not be optimal.
+
+If it still fails, then you can send your problem description to
+appropriate mailing lists or news-groups. Send me a copy in order to
+be sure I will receive it. Obviously, a bug in the driver code is
+possible.
+
+ My email address: Gerard Roudier <groudier@free.fr>
+
+Allowing disconnections is important if you use several devices on
+your SCSI bus but often causes problems with buggy devices.
+Synchronous data transfers increases throughput of fast devices like
+hard disks. Good SCSI hard disks with a large cache gain advantage of
+tagged commands queuing.
+
+Try to enable one feature at a time with control commands. For example:
+
+- echo "setsync all 25" >/proc/scsi/ncr53c8xx/0
+ Will enable fast synchronous data transfer negotiation for all targets.
+
+- echo "setflag 3" >/proc/scsi/ncr53c8xx/0
+ Will reset flags (no_disc) for target 3, and so will allow it to disconnect
+ the SCSI Bus.
+
+- echo "settags 3 8" >/proc/scsi/ncr53c8xx/0
+ Will enable tagged command queuing for target 3 if that device supports it.
+
+Once you have found the device and the feature that cause problems, just
+disable that feature for that device.
+
+15.2 Understanding hardware error reports
+
+When the driver detects an unexpected error condition, it may display a
+message of the following pattern.
+
+sym53c876-0:1: ERROR (0:48) (1-21-65) (f/95) @ (script 7c0:19000000).
+sym53c876-0: script cmd = 19000000
+sym53c876-0: regdump: da 10 80 95 47 0f 01 07 75 01 81 21 80 01 09 00.
+
+Some fields in such a message may help you understand the cause of the
+problem, as follows:
+
+sym53c876-0:1: ERROR (0:48) (1-21-65) (f/95) @ (script 7c0:19000000).
+............A.........B.C....D.E..F....G.H.......I.....J...K.......
+
+Field A : target number.
+ SCSI ID of the device the controller was talking with at the moment the
+ error occurs.
+
+Field B : DSTAT io register (DMA STATUS)
+ Bit 0x40 : MDPE Master Data Parity Error
+ Data parity error detected on the PCI BUS.
+ Bit 0x20 : BF Bus Fault
+ PCI bus fault condition detected
+ Bit 0x01 : IID Illegal Instruction Detected
+ Set by the chip when it detects an Illegal Instruction format
+ on some condition that makes an instruction illegal.
+ Bit 0x80 : DFE Dma Fifo Empty
+ Pure status bit that does not indicate an error.
+ If the reported DSTAT value contains a combination of MDPE (0x40),
+ BF (0x20), then the cause may be likely due to a PCI BUS problem.
+
+Field C : SIST io register (SCSI Interrupt Status)
+ Bit 0x08 : SGE SCSI GROSS ERROR
+ Indicates that the chip detected a severe error condition
+ on the SCSI BUS that prevents the SCSI protocol from functioning
+ properly.
+ Bit 0x04 : UDC Unexpected Disconnection
+ Indicates that the device released the SCSI BUS when the chip
+ was not expecting this to happen. A device may behave so to
+ indicate the SCSI initiator that an error condition not reportable using the SCSI protocol has occurred.
+ Bit 0x02 : RST SCSI BUS Reset
+ Generally SCSI targets do not reset the SCSI BUS, although any
+ device on the BUS can reset it at any time.
+ Bit 0x01 : PAR Parity
+ SCSI parity error detected.
+ On a faulty SCSI BUS, any error condition among SGE (0x08), UDC (0x04) and
+ PAR (0x01) may be detected by the chip. If your SCSI system sometimes
+ encounters such error conditions, especially SCSI GROSS ERROR, then a SCSI
+ BUS problem is likely the cause of these errors.
+
+For fields D,E,F,G and H, you may look into the sym53c8xx_defs.h file
+that contains some minimal comments on IO register bits.
+Field D : SOCL Scsi Output Control Latch
+ This register reflects the state of the SCSI control lines the
+ chip want to drive or compare against.
+Field E : SBCL Scsi Bus Control Lines
+ Actual value of control lines on the SCSI BUS.
+Field F : SBDL Scsi Bus Data Lines
+ Actual value of data lines on the SCSI BUS.
+Field G : SXFER SCSI Transfer
+ Contains the setting of the Synchronous Period for output and
+ the current Synchronous offset (offset 0 means asynchronous).
+Field H : SCNTL3 Scsi Control Register 3
+ Contains the setting of timing values for both asynchronous and
+ synchronous data transfers.
+
+Understanding Fields I, J, K and dumps requires to have good knowledge of
+SCSI standards, chip cores functionnals and internal driver data structures.
+You are not required to decode and understand them, unless you want to help
+maintain the driver code.
+
+16. Synchonous transfer negotiation tables
+
+Tables below have been created by calling the routine the driver uses
+for synchronisation negotiation timing calculation and chip setting.
+The first table corresponds to Ultra chips 53875 and 53C860 with 80 MHz
+clock and 5 clock divisors.
+The second one has been calculated by setting the scsi clock to 40 Mhz
+and using 4 clock divisors and so applies to all NCR53C8XX chips in fast
+SCSI-2 mode.
+
+Periods are in nano-seconds and speeds are in Mega-transfers per second.
+1 Mega-transfers/second means 1 MB/s with 8 bits SCSI and 2 MB/s with
+Wide16 SCSI.
+
+16.1 Synchronous timings for 53C895, 53C875 and 53C860 SCSI controllers
+
+ ----------------------------------------------
+ Negotiated NCR settings
+ Factor Period Speed Period Speed
+ ------ ------ ------ ------ ------
+ 10 25 40.000 25 40.000 (53C895 only)
+ 11 30.2 33.112 31.25 32.000 (53C895 only)
+ 12 50 20.000 50 20.000
+ 13 52 19.230 62 16.000
+ 14 56 17.857 62 16.000
+ 15 60 16.666 62 16.000
+ 16 64 15.625 75 13.333
+ 17 68 14.705 75 13.333
+ 18 72 13.888 75 13.333
+ 19 76 13.157 87 11.428
+ 20 80 12.500 87 11.428
+ 21 84 11.904 87 11.428
+ 22 88 11.363 93 10.666
+ 23 92 10.869 93 10.666
+ 24 96 10.416 100 10.000
+ 25 100 10.000 100 10.000
+ 26 104 9.615 112 8.888
+ 27 108 9.259 112 8.888
+ 28 112 8.928 112 8.888
+ 29 116 8.620 125 8.000
+ 30 120 8.333 125 8.000
+ 31 124 8.064 125 8.000
+ 32 128 7.812 131 7.619
+ 33 132 7.575 150 6.666
+ 34 136 7.352 150 6.666
+ 35 140 7.142 150 6.666
+ 36 144 6.944 150 6.666
+ 37 148 6.756 150 6.666
+ 38 152 6.578 175 5.714
+ 39 156 6.410 175 5.714
+ 40 160 6.250 175 5.714
+ 41 164 6.097 175 5.714
+ 42 168 5.952 175 5.714
+ 43 172 5.813 175 5.714
+ 44 176 5.681 187 5.333
+ 45 180 5.555 187 5.333
+ 46 184 5.434 187 5.333
+ 47 188 5.319 200 5.000
+ 48 192 5.208 200 5.000
+ 49 196 5.102 200 5.000
+
+
+16.2 Synchronous timings for fast SCSI-2 53C8XX controllers
+
+ ----------------------------------------------
+ Negotiated NCR settings
+ Factor Period Speed Period Speed
+ ------ ------ ------ ------ ------
+ 25 100 10.000 100 10.000
+ 26 104 9.615 125 8.000
+ 27 108 9.259 125 8.000
+ 28 112 8.928 125 8.000
+ 29 116 8.620 125 8.000
+ 30 120 8.333 125 8.000
+ 31 124 8.064 125 8.000
+ 32 128 7.812 131 7.619
+ 33 132 7.575 150 6.666
+ 34 136 7.352 150 6.666
+ 35 140 7.142 150 6.666
+ 36 144 6.944 150 6.666
+ 37 148 6.756 150 6.666
+ 38 152 6.578 175 5.714
+ 39 156 6.410 175 5.714
+ 40 160 6.250 175 5.714
+ 41 164 6.097 175 5.714
+ 42 168 5.952 175 5.714
+ 43 172 5.813 175 5.714
+ 44 176 5.681 187 5.333
+ 45 180 5.555 187 5.333
+ 46 184 5.434 187 5.333
+ 47 188 5.319 200 5.000
+ 48 192 5.208 200 5.000
+ 49 196 5.102 200 5.000
+
+
+17. Serial NVRAM (added by Richard Waltham: dormouse@farsrobt.demon.co.uk)
+
+17.1 Features
+
+Enabling serial NVRAM support enables detection of the serial NVRAM included
+on Symbios and some Symbios compatible host adaptors, and Tekram boards. The
+serial NVRAM is used by Symbios and Tekram to hold set up parameters for the
+host adaptor and it's attached drives.
+
+The Symbios NVRAM also holds data on the boot order of host adaptors in a
+system with more than one host adaptor. This enables the order of scanning
+the cards for drives to be changed from the default used during host adaptor
+detection.
+
+This can be done to a limited extent at the moment using "reverse probe" but
+this only changes the order of detection of different types of cards. The
+NVRAM boot order settings can do this as well as change the order the same
+types of cards are scanned in, something "reverse probe" cannot do.
+
+Tekram boards using Symbios chips, DC390W/F/U, which have NVRAM are detected
+and this is used to distinguish between Symbios compatible and Tekram host
+adaptors. This is used to disable the Symbios compatible "diff" setting
+incorrectly set on Tekram boards if the CONFIG_SCSI_53C8XX_SYMBIOS_COMPAT
+configuration parameter is set enabling both Symbios and Tekram boards to be
+used together with the Symbios cards using all their features, including
+"diff" support. ("led pin" support for Symbios compatible cards can remain
+enabled when using Tekram cards. It does nothing useful for Tekram host
+adaptors but does not cause problems either.)
+
+
+17.2 Symbios NVRAM layout
+
+typical data at NVRAM address 0x100 (53c810a NVRAM)
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+00 00
+64 01
+8e 0b
+
+00 30 00 00 00 00 07 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 07 04 10 04 00 00
+
+04 00 0f 00 00 10 00 50 00 00 01 00 00 62
+04 00 03 00 00 10 00 58 00 00 01 00 00 63
+04 00 01 00 00 10 00 48 00 00 01 00 00 61
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+fe fe
+00 00
+00 00
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+NVRAM layout details
+
+NVRAM Address 0x000-0x0ff not used
+ 0x100-0x26f initialised data
+ 0x270-0x7ff not used
+
+general layout
+
+ header - 6 bytes,
+ data - 356 bytes (checksum is byte sum of this data)
+ trailer - 6 bytes
+ ---
+ total 368 bytes
+
+data area layout
+
+ controller set up - 20 bytes
+ boot configuration - 56 bytes (4x14 bytes)
+ device set up - 128 bytes (16x8 bytes)
+ unused (spare?) - 152 bytes (19x8 bytes)
+ ---
+ total 356 bytes
+
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+header
+
+00 00 - ?? start marker
+64 01 - byte count (lsb/msb excludes header/trailer)
+8e 0b - checksum (lsb/msb excludes header/trailer)
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+controller set up
+
+00 30 00 00 00 00 07 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 07 04 10 04 00 00
+ | | | |
+ | | | -- host ID
+ | | |
+ | | --Removable Media Support
+ | | 0x00 = none
+ | | 0x01 = Bootable Device
+ | | 0x02 = All with Media
+ | |
+ | --flag bits 2
+ | 0x00000001= scan order hi->low
+ | (default 0x00 - scan low->hi)
+ --flag bits 1
+ 0x00000001 scam enable
+ 0x00000010 parity enable
+ 0x00000100 verbose boot msgs
+
+remaining bytes unknown - they do not appear to change in my
+current set up for any of the controllers.
+
+default set up is identical for 53c810a and 53c875 NVRAM
+(Removable Media added Symbios BIOS version 4.09)
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+boot configuration
+
+boot order set by order of the devices in this table
+
+04 00 0f 00 00 10 00 50 00 00 01 00 00 62 -- 1st controller
+04 00 03 00 00 10 00 58 00 00 01 00 00 63 2nd controller
+04 00 01 00 00 10 00 48 00 00 01 00 00 61 3rd controller
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 4th controller
+ | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | ---- PCI io port adr
+ | | | | | --0x01 init/scan at boot time
+ | | | | --PCI device/function number (0xdddddfff)
+ | | ----- ?? PCI vendor ID (lsb/msb)
+ ----PCI device ID (lsb/msb)
+
+?? use of this data is a guess but seems reasonable
+
+remaining bytes unknown - they do not appear to change in my
+current set up
+
+default set up is identical for 53c810a and 53c875 NVRAM
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+device set up (up to 16 devices - includes controller)
+
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00 - id 0
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00 - id 15
+ | | | | | |
+ | | | | ----timeout (lsb/msb)
+ | | | --synch period (0x?? 40 Mtrans/sec- fast 40) (probably 0x28)
+ | | | (0x30 20 Mtrans/sec- fast 20)
+ | | | (0x64 10 Mtrans/sec- fast )
+ | | | (0xc8 5 Mtrans/sec)
+ | | | (0x00 asynchronous)
+ | | -- ?? max sync offset (0x08 in NVRAM on 53c810a)
+ | | (0x10 in NVRAM on 53c875)
+ | --device bus width (0x08 narrow)
+ | (0x10 16 bit wide)
+ --flag bits
+ 0x00000001 - disconnect enabled
+ 0x00000010 - scan at boot time
+ 0x00000100 - scan luns
+ 0x00001000 - queue tags enabled
+
+remaining bytes unknown - they do not appear to change in my
+current set up
+
+?? use of this data is a guess but seems reasonable
+(but it could be max bus width)
+
+default set up for 53c810a NVRAM
+default set up for 53c875 NVRAM - bus width - 0x10
+ - sync offset ? - 0x10
+ - sync period - 0x30
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+?? spare device space (32 bit bus ??)
+
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 (19x8bytes)
+.
+.
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+default set up is identical for 53c810a and 53c875 NVRAM
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+trailer
+
+fe fe - ? end marker ?
+00 00
+00 00
+
+default set up is identical for 53c810a and 53c875 NVRAM
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+
+17.3 Tekram NVRAM layout
+
+nvram 64x16 (1024 bit)
+
+Drive settings
+
+Drive ID 0-15 (addr 0x0yyyy0 = device setup, yyyy = ID)
+ (addr 0x0yyyy1 = 0x0000)
+
+ x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x
+ | | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | | | ----- parity check 0 - off
+ | | | | | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | | ------- sync neg 0 - off
+ | | | | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | --------- disconnect 0 - off
+ | | | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | | | |
+ | | | | | ----------- start cmd 0 - off
+ | | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | | |
+ | | | | -------------- tagged cmds 0 - off
+ | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | |
+ | | | ---------------- wide neg 0 - off
+ | | | 1 - on
+ | | |
+ --------------------------- sync rate 0 - 10.0 Mtrans/sec
+ 1 - 8.0
+ 2 - 6.6
+ 3 - 5.7
+ 4 - 5.0
+ 5 - 4.0
+ 6 - 3.0
+ 7 - 2.0
+ 7 - 2.0
+ 8 - 20.0
+ 9 - 16.7
+ a - 13.9
+ b - 11.9
+
+Global settings
+
+Host flags 0 (addr 0x100000, 32)
+
+ x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x
+ | | | | | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | | | ----------- host ID 0x00 - 0x0f
+ | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | | ----------------------- support for 0 - off
+ | | | | | | | > 2 drives 1 - on
+ | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | ------------------------- support drives 0 - off
+ | | | | | | > 1Gbytes 1 - on
+ | | | | | |
+ | | | | | --------------------------- bus reset on 0 - off
+ | | | | | power on 1 - on
+ | | | | |
+ | | | | ----------------------------- active neg 0 - off
+ | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | |
+ | | | -------------------------------- imm seek 0 - off
+ | | | 1 - on
+ | | |
+ | | ---------------------------------- scan luns 0 - off
+ | | 1 - on
+ | |
+ -------------------------------------- removable 0 - disable
+ as BIOS dev 1 - boot device
+ 2 - all
+
+Host flags 1 (addr 0x100001, 33)
+
+ x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x
+ | | | | | |
+ | | | --------- boot delay 0 - 3 sec
+ | | | 1 - 5
+ | | | 2 - 10
+ | | | 3 - 20
+ | | | 4 - 30
+ | | | 5 - 60
+ | | | 6 - 120
+ | | |
+ --------------------------- max tag cmds 0 - 2
+ 1 - 4
+ 2 - 8
+ 3 - 16
+ 4 - 32
+
+Host flags 2 (addr 0x100010, 34)
+
+ x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x
+ |
+ ----- F2/F6 enable 0 - off ???
+ 1 - on ???
+
+checksum (addr 0x111111)
+
+checksum = 0x1234 - (sum addr 0-63)
+
+----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+default nvram data:
+
+0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000
+0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000
+0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000
+0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000
+
+0x0f07 0x0400 0x0001 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000
+0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000
+0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000
+0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0xfbbc
+
+
+18. Support for Big Endian
+
+The PCI local bus has been primarily designed for x86 architecture.
+As a consequence, PCI devices generally expect DWORDS using little endian
+byte ordering.
+
+18.1 Big Endian CPU
+
+In order to support NCR chips on a Big Endian architecture the driver has to
+perform byte reordering each time it is needed. This feature has been
+added to the driver by Cort <cort@cs.nmt.edu> and is available in driver
+version 2.5 and later ones. For the moment Big Endian support has only
+been tested on Linux/PPC (PowerPC).
+
+18.2 NCR chip in Big Endian mode of operations
+
+It can be read in SYMBIOS documentation that some chips support a special
+Big Endian mode, on paper: 53C815, 53C825A, 53C875, 53C875N, 53C895.
+This mode of operations is not software-selectable, but needs pin named
+BigLit to be pulled-up. Using this mode, most of byte reorderings should
+be avoided when the driver is running on a Big Endian CPU.
+Driver version 2.5 is also, in theory, ready for this feature.
+
+===============================================================================
+End of NCR53C8XX driver README file
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/osst.txt b/Documentation/scsi/osst.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..ce574e7791ab
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/osst.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,219 @@
+README file for the osst driver
+===============================
+(w) Kurt Garloff <garloff@suse.de> 12/2000
+
+This file describes the osst driver as of version 0.8.x/0.9.x, the released
+version of the osst driver.
+It is intended to help advanced users to understand the role of osst and to
+get them started using (and maybe debugging) it.
+It won't address issues like "How do I compile a kernel?" or "How do I load
+a module?", as these are too basic.
+Once the OnStream got merged into the official kernel, the distro makers
+will provide the OnStream support for those who are not familiar with
+hacking their kernels.
+
+
+Purpose
+-------
+The osst driver was developed, because the standard SCSI tape driver in
+Linux, st, does not support the OnStream SC-x0 SCSI tape. The st is not to
+blame for that, as the OnStream tape drives do not support the standard SCSI
+command set for Serial Access Storage Devices (SASDs), which basically
+corresponds to the QIC-157 spec.
+Nevertheless, the OnStream tapes are nice pieces of hardware and therefore
+the osst driver has been written to make these tape devs supported by Linux.
+The driver is free software. It's released under the GNU GPL and planned to
+be integrated into the mainstream kernel.
+
+
+Implementation
+--------------
+The osst is a new high-level SCSI driver, just like st, sr, sd and sg. It
+can be compiled into the kernel or loaded as a module.
+As it represents a new device, it got assigned a new device node: /dev/osstX
+are character devices with major no 206 and minor numbers like the /dev/stX
+devices. If those are not present, you may create them by calling
+Makedevs.sh as root (see below).
+The driver started being a copy of st and as such, the osst devices'
+behavior looks very much the same as st to the userspace applications.
+
+
+History
+-------
+In the first place, osst shared it's identity very much with st. That meant
+that it used the same kernel structures and the same device node as st.
+So you could only have either of them being present in the kernel. This has
+been fixed by registering an own device, now.
+st and osst can coexist, each only accessing the devices it can support by
+themselves.
+
+
+Installation
+------------
+osst got integrated into the linux kernel. Select it during kernel
+configuration as module or compile statically into the kernel.
+Compile your kernel and install the modules.
+
+Now, your osst driver is inside the kernel or available as a module,
+depending on your choice during kernel config. You may still need to create
+the device nodes by calling the Makedevs.sh script (see below) manually,
+unless you use a devfs kernel, where this won't be needed.
+
+To load your module, you may use the command
+modprobe osst
+as root. dmesg should show you, whether your OnStream tapes have been
+recognized.
+
+If you want to have the module autoloaded on access to /dev/osst, you may
+add something like
+alias char-major-206 osst
+to your /etc/modprobe.conf (before 2.6: modules.conf).
+
+You may find it convenient to create a symbolic link
+ln -s nosst0 /dev/tape
+to make programs assuming a default name of /dev/tape more convenient to
+use.
+
+The device nodes for osst have to be created. Use the Makedevs.sh script
+attached to this file.
+
+
+Using it
+--------
+You may use the OnStream tape driver with your standard backup software,
+which may be tar, cpio, amanda, arkeia, BRU, Lone Tar, ...
+by specifying /dev/(n)osst0 as the tape device to use or using the above
+symlink trick. The IOCTLs to control tape operation are also mostly
+supported and you may try the mt (or mt_st) program to jump between
+filemarks, eject the tape, ...
+
+There's one limitation: You need to use a block size of 32kB.
+
+(This limitation is worked on and will be fixed in version 0.8.8 of
+ this driver.)
+
+If you just want to get started with standard software, here is an example
+for creating and restoring a full backup:
+# Backup
+tar cvf - / --exclude /proc | buffer -s 32k -m 24M -B -t -o /dev/nosst0
+# Restore
+buffer -s 32k -m 8M -B -t -i /dev/osst0 | tar xvf - -C /
+
+The buffer command has been used to buffer the data before it goes to the
+tape (or the file system) in order to smooth out the data stream and prevent
+the tape from needing to stop and rewind. The OnStream does have an internal
+buffer and a variable speed which help this, but especially on writing, the
+buffering still proves useful in most cases. It also pads the data to
+guarantees the block size of 32k. (Otherwise you may pass the -b64 option to
+tar.)
+Expect something like 1.8MB/s for the SC-x0 drives and 0.9MB/s for the DI-30.
+The USB drive will give you about 0.7MB/s.
+On a fast machine, you may profit from software data compression (z flag for
+tar).
+
+
+USB and IDE
+-----------
+Via the SCSI emulation layers usb-storage and ide-scsi, you can also use the
+osst driver to drive the USB-30 and the DI-30 drives. (Unfortunately, there
+is no such layer for the parallel port, otherwise the DP-30 would work as
+well.) For the USB support, you need the latest 2.4.0-test kernels and the
+latest usb-storage driver from
+http://www.linux-usb.org/
+http://sourceforge.net/cvs/?group_id=3581
+
+Note that the ide-tape driver as of 1.16f uses a slightly outdated on-tape
+format and therefore is not completely interoperable with osst tapes.
+
+The ADR-x0 line is fully SCSI-2 compliant and is supported by st, not osst.
+The on-tape format is supposed to be compatible with the one used by osst.
+
+
+Feedback and updates
+--------------------
+The driver development is coordinated through a mailing list
+<osst@linux1.onstream.nl>
+a CVS repository and some web pages.
+The tester's pages which contain recent news and updated drivers to download
+can be found on
+http://linux1.onstream.nl/test/
+
+If you find any problems, please have a look at the tester's page in order
+to see whether the problem is already known and solved. Otherwise, please
+report it to the mailing list. Your feedback is welcome. (This holds also
+for reports of successful usage, of course.)
+In case of trouble, please do always provide the following info:
+* driver and kernel version used (see syslog)
+* driver messages (syslog)
+* SCSI config and OnStream Firmware (/proc/scsi/scsi)
+* description of error. Is it reproducible?
+* software and commands used
+
+You may subscribe to the mailing list, BTW, it's a majordomo list.
+
+
+Status
+------
+0.8.0 was the first widespread BETA release. Since then a lot of reports
+have been sent, but mostly reported success or only minor trouble.
+All the issues have been addressed.
+Check the web pages for more info about the current developments.
+0.9.x is the tree for the 2.3/2.4 kernel.
+
+
+Acknowledgments
+----------------
+The driver has been started by making a copy of Kai Makisara's st driver.
+Most of the development has been done by Willem Riede. The presence of the
+userspace program osg (onstreamsg) from Terry Hardie has been rather
+helpful. The same holds for Gadi Oxman's ide-tape support for the DI-30.
+I did add some patches to those drivers as well and coordinated things a
+little bit.
+Note that most of them did mostly spend their spare time for the creation of
+this driver.
+The people from OnStream, especially Jack Bombeeck did support this project
+and always tried to answer HW or FW related questions. Furthermore, he
+pushed the FW developers to do the right things.
+SuSE did support this project by allowing me to work on it during my working
+time for them and by integrating the driver into their distro.
+
+More people did help by sending useful comments. Sorry to those who have
+been forgotten. Thanks to all the GNU/FSF and Linux developers who made this
+platform such an interesting, nice and stable platform.
+Thanks go to those who tested the drivers and did send useful reports. Your
+help is needed!
+
+
+Makedevs.sh
+-----------
+#!/bin/sh
+# Script to create OnStream SC-x0 device nodes (major 206)
+# Usage: Makedevs.sh [nos [path to dev]]
+# $Id: README.osst.kernel,v 1.4 2000/12/20 14:13:15 garloff Exp $
+major=206
+nrs=4
+dir=/dev
+test -z "$1" || nrs=$1
+test -z "$2" || dir=$2
+declare -i nr
+nr=0
+test -d $dir || mkdir -p $dir
+while test $nr -lt $nrs; do
+ mknod $dir/osst$nr c $major $nr
+ chown 0.disk $dir/osst$nr; chmod 660 $dir/osst$nr;
+ mknod $dir/nosst$nr c $major $[nr+128]
+ chown 0.disk $dir/nosst$nr; chmod 660 $dir/nosst$nr;
+ mknod $dir/osst${nr}l c $major $[nr+32]
+ chown 0.disk $dir/osst${nr}l; chmod 660 $dir/osst${nr}l;
+ mknod $dir/nosst${nr}l c $major $[nr+160]
+ chown 0.disk $dir/nosst${nr}l; chmod 660 $dir/nosst${nr}l;
+ mknod $dir/osst${nr}m c $major $[nr+64]
+ chown 0.disk $dir/osst${nr}m; chmod 660 $dir/osst${nr}m;
+ mknod $dir/nosst${nr}m c $major $[nr+192]
+ chown 0.disk $dir/nosst${nr}m; chmod 660 $dir/nosst${nr}m;
+ mknod $dir/osst${nr}a c $major $[nr+96]
+ chown 0.disk $dir/osst${nr}a; chmod 660 $dir/osst${nr}a;
+ mknod $dir/nosst${nr}a c $major $[nr+224]
+ chown 0.disk $dir/nosst${nr}a; chmod 660 $dir/nosst${nr}a;
+ let nr+=1
+done
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/ppa.txt b/Documentation/scsi/ppa.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..0dac88d86d87
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/ppa.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,16 @@
+-------- Terse where to get ZIP Drive help info --------
+
+General Iomega ZIP drive page for Linux:
+http://www.torque.net/~campbell/
+
+Driver achive for old drivers:
+http://www.torque.net/~campbell/ppa/
+
+Linux Parport page (parallel port)
+http://www.torque.net/parport/
+
+Email list for Linux Parport
+linux-parport@torque.net
+
+Email for problems with ZIP or ZIP Plus drivers
+campbell@torque.net
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/qla2xxx.revision.notes b/Documentation/scsi/qla2xxx.revision.notes
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..290cdaf84f8f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/qla2xxx.revision.notes
@@ -0,0 +1,457 @@
+/*
+ * QLogic ISP2200 and ISP2300 Linux Driver Revision List File.
+ *
+ ********************************************************************
+ *
+ * Revision History
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b8 December 5, 2003 AV
+ * - Instruct mid-layer to perform initial scan.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b7 December 5, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.6.0-test11.
+ * - Add basic NVRAM parser (extras/qla_nvr).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b7-pre11 December 3, 2003 AV
+ * - Sanitize the scsi_qla_host structure:
+ * - Purge unused elements.
+ * - Reorganize high-priority members (cache coherency).
+ * - Add support for NVRAM access via a sysfs binary attribute:
+ * - Consolidate semaphore locking access.
+ * - Fix more PCI posting issues.
+ * - Add extras directory for dump/NVRAM tools.
+ * - Remove unused qla_vendor.c file.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b7-pre11 November 26, 2003 DG/AV
+ * - Merge several patches from Christoph Hellwig [hch@lst.de]:
+ * - in Linux 2.6 both pci and the scsi layer use the generic
+ * dma direction bits, use them directly instead of the scsi
+ * and pci variants and the (noop) conversion routines.
+ * - Fix _IOXX_BAD() usage for external IOCTL interface.
+ * - Use atomic construct for HA loop_state member.
+ * - Add generic model description text for HBA types.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b7-pre5 November 17, 2003 AV
+ * - Merge several patches from Christoph Hellwig [hch@lst.de]:
+ * - patch to split the driver into a common qla2xxx.ko and a
+ * qla2?00.ko for each HBA type - the latter modules are
+ * only very small wrappers, mostly for the firmware
+ * images, all the meat is in the common qla2xxx.ko.
+ * - make the failover code optional.
+ * - kill useless lock_kernel in dpc thread startup.
+ * - no need for modversions hacks in 2.6 (or 2.4).
+ * - kill qla2x00_register_with_Linux.
+ * - simplify EH code, cmd or it's hostdata can't be NULL, no
+ * need to search whether the host it's ours, the midlayer
+ * makes sure it won't call into a driver for some else
+ * host.
+ * - Merge several patches from Jes Sorensen
+ * [jes@wildopensource.com]:
+ * - Call qla2x00_config_dma_addressing() before performing
+ * any consistent allocations. This is required since the
+ * dma mask settings will affect the memory
+ * pci_alloc_consistent() will return.
+ * - Call pci_set_consistent_dma_mask() to allow for 64 bit
+ * consistent allocations, required on some platforms such
+ * as the SN2.
+ * - Wait 20 usecs (not sure how long is really necessary,
+ * but this seems safe) after setting CSR_ISP_SOFT_RESET in
+ * the ctrl_status register as the card doesn't respond to
+ * PCI reads while in reset state. This causes a machine
+ * check on some architectures.
+ * - Flush PCI writes before calling udelay() to ensure the
+ * write is not sitting idle in-flight for a while before
+ * hitting the hardware.
+ * - Include linux/vmalloc.h in qla_os.c since it uses
+ * vmalloc().
+ * - Use auto-negotiate link speed when using default
+ * parameters rather than NVRAM settings. Disable NVRAM
+ * reading on SN2 since it's not possible to execute the
+ * HBA's BIOS on an SN2. I suggest doing something similar
+ * for all architectures that do not provide x86 BIOS
+ * emulation.
+ * - Clean-up slab-cache allocations:
+ * - locking.
+ * - mempool allocations in case of low-memory situations.
+ * - Fallback to GA_NXT scan if GID_PT call returns more than
+ * MAX_FIBRE_DEVICES.
+ * - Preserve iterating port ID across GA_NXT calls in
+ * qla2x00_find_all_fabric_devs().
+ * - Pre-calculate ASCII firmware dump length as to not incur the
+ * cost-to-calculate at each invocation of a read().
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b6 November 4, 2003 AV
+ * - Add new 2300 TPX firmware (3.02.18).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b6-pre25 October 20, 2003 RA/AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.6.0-test9.
+ * - Rework firmware dump process:
+ * - Use binary attribute within sysfs tree.
+ * - Add user-space tool (gdump.sh) to retrieve formatted
+ * buffer.
+ * - Add ISP2100 support.
+ * - Use a slab cache for SRB allocations to reduce memory
+ * pressure.
+ * - Initial conversion of driver logging methods to a new
+ * qla_printk() function which uses dev_printk (Daniel
+ * Stekloff, IBM).
+ * - Further reduce stack usage in qla2x00_configure_local_loop()
+ * and qla2x00_find_all_fabric_devs().
+ * - Separate port state used for routing of I/O's from port
+ * mgmt-login retry etc.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b6-pre19 October 13, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.6.0-test7-bk5.
+ * - Add intelligent RSCN event handling:
+ * - reduce scan time during 'port' RSCN events by only
+ * querying specified port ids.
+ * - Available on ISP23xx cards only.
+ * - Increase maximum number of recognizable targets from 256
+ * to 512.
+ * - Backend changes were previously added to support TPX
+ * (2K logins) firmware. Mid-layer can now scan for targets
+ * (H, B, T, L) where 512 < T >= 0.
+ * - Remove IP support from driver.
+ * - Switch firmware types from IP->TP for ISP22xx and
+ * IPX->TPX for ISP23xx cards.
+ * - Remove files qla_ip.[ch].
+ * - Remove type designations from firmware filenames.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b6-pre11 September 15, 2003 DG/AV
+ * - Resync with 6.06.00.
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.6.0-test5-bk3.
+ * - Add new 2300 IPX firmware (3.02.15).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b5 July 31, 2003 AV
+ * - Always create an fc_lun_t entry for lun 0 - as the mid-
+ * layer requires access to this lun for discovery to occur.
+ * - General sanitizing:
+ * - Add generic firmware option definitions.
+ * - Generalize retrieval/update of firmware options.
+ * - Fix compile errors which occur with extended debug.
+ * - Handle failure cases for scsi_add_host() and
+ * down_interruptible().
+ * - Host template updates:
+ * - Use standard bios_param callback function.
+ * - Disable clustering.
+ * - Remove unchecked_is_dma entry.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b5-pre5 July 29, 2003 DG/AV
+ * - Resync with 6.06.00b13.
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.6.0-test2.
+ * - Pass the complete loop_id, not the masked (0xff) value
+ * while issuing mailbox commands (qla_mbx.c/qla_fo.c/
+ * qla_iocb.c/qla_init.c).
+ * - Properly handle zero-length return status for an RLC CDB.
+ * - Create an fclun_t structure for 'disconnected' luns,
+ * peripheral-qualifier of 001b.
+ * - Remove unused LIP-sequence register access during AE 8010.
+ * - Generalize qla2x00_mark_device_lost() to handle forced
+ * login request -- modify all direct/indirect invocations
+ * with proper flag.
+ * - Save RSCN notification (AE 8015h) data in a proper and
+ * consistent format (domain, area, al_pa).
+ * - General sanitizing:
+ * - scsi_qla_host structure member reordering for cache-line
+ * coherency.
+ * - Remove unused SCSI opcodes, endian-swap definitions.
+ * - Remove CMD_* pre-processor defines.
+ * - Remove unused SCSIFCHOTSWAP/GAMAP/MULTIHOST codes.
+ * - Backout patch which added a per-scsi_qla_host scsi host
+ * spinlock, since mid-layer already defines one.
+ * - Add new 2300 IPX firmware (3.02.15).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4 July 14, 2003 RA/DG/AV
+ * - Resync with 6.06.00b12.
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.6.0-test1.
+ * - Remove IOCB throttling code -- originally #if'd.
+ * - Remove apidev_*() routines since proc_mknod() has been
+ * removed -- need alternate IOCTL interface.
+ * - Merge several performance/fix patches from Arjan van de
+ * Ven:
+ * - Undefined operation >> 32.
+ * - No need to acquire mid-layer lock during command
+ * callback.
+ * - Use a per-HBA mid-layer lock.
+ * - Use a non-locked cycle for setting the count of the
+ * newly allocated sp (qla2x00_get_new_sp()).
+ * - Modify semantic behavior of qla2x00_queuecommand():
+ * - Reduce cacheline bouncing by having I/Os submitted
+ * by the IRQ handler.
+ * - Remove extraneous calls to qla2x00_next() during I/O
+ * queuing.
+ * - Use list_splice_init() during qla2x00_done() handling
+ * of commands to reduce list_lock contention.
+ * - RIO mode support for ISP2200:
+ * - Implementation differs slightly from original patch.
+ * - Do not use bottom-half handler (tasklet/work queue)
+ * for qla2x00_done() processing.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4-pre22 July 12, 2003 AV
+ * - Check for 'Process Response Queue' requests early during
+ * the Host Status check.
+ * - General sanitizing:
+ * - srb_t structure rewrite, removal of unused members.
+ * - Remove unused fcdev array, fabricid, and PORT_*
+ * definitions.
+ * - Remove unused config_reg_t PCI definitions.
+ * - Add new 2200 IP firmware (2.02.06).
+ * - Add new 2300 IPX firmware (3.02.14).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4-pre19 June 30, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.73-bk8.
+ * - Rework IOCB command queuing methods:
+ * - Upper-layer driver *MUST* properly set the direction
+ * bit of SCSI commands.
+ * - Generalize 32bit/64bit queuing path functions.
+ * - Remove costly page-boundary cross check when using
+ * 64bit address capable IOCBs.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4-pre15 June 19, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with 6.06.00b11.
+ * - Continue fcport list consolidation work:
+ * - Updated IOCTL implementations to use new fcports
+ * list.
+ * - Modified product ID check to not verify ISP chip
+ * revision -- ISP2312 v3 (qla2x00_chip_diag()).
+ * - Add new 2300 IPX firmware (3.02.13):
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4-pre13 June 19, 2003 AV
+ * - Fix build process for qla2100 driver -- no support
+ * for IP.
+ * - SCSI host template modifications:
+ * - Set sg_tablesize based on the derived DMA mask.
+ * - Increase max_sectors since only limit within RISC
+ * is transfer of (((2^32) - 1) >> 9) sectors.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4-pre12 June 18, 2003 RA, DG, RL, AV
+ * - Resync with 6.06.00b10.
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.72.
+ * - Initial fcport list consolidation work:
+ * - fcports/fcinitiators/fcdev/fc_ip --> ha->fcports
+ * list.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4-pre7 June 05, 2003 AV
+ * - Properly release PCI resouces in init-failure case.
+ * - Reconcile disparite function return code definitions.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4-pre4 June 03, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.70-bk8:
+ * - SHT proc_info() changes.
+ * - Restructure SNS Generic Services routines:
+ * - Add qla_gs.c file to driver distribution.
+ * - Configure PCI latency timer for ISP23xx.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b4-pre3 June 02, 2003 RA, DG, RL, AV
+ * - Resync with 6.06.00b5.
+ * - Rework (again) PCI I/O space configuration
+ * (Anton Blanchard):
+ * - Use pci_set_mwi() routine;
+ * - Remove uneeded qla2x00_set_cache_line() function.
+ * - Remove extraneous modification of PCI_COMMAND word.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b3 May 29, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.70.
+ * - Move RISC paused check from ISR fast-path.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b3-pre8 May 26, 2003 AV
+ * - Add new 2300 IPX firmware (3.02.12):
+ * - Rework PCI I/O space configuration.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b3-pre6 May 22, 2003 RA, DG, RL, AV
+ * - Resync with 6.06.00b3.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b3-pre4 May 21 2003 AV
+ * - Add new 2300 IPX firmware (3.02.11):
+ * - Remove 2300 TPX firmware from distribution.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b3-pre3 May 21 2003 AV
+ * - Properly setup PCI configuation space during
+ * initialization:
+ * - Properly configure Memory-Mapped I/O during early
+ * configuration stage.
+ * - Rework IP functionality to support 2k logins.
+ * - Add new 2300 IPX firmware (3.02.11):
+ * - Remove 2300 TPX firmware from distribution.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b3-pre2 May ??, 2003 RA, DG, RL, AV
+ * - Resync with 6.06.00b1.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b3-pre1 May ??, 2003 RA, DG, RL, AV
+ * - Resync with 6.05.00.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b2 May 19, 2003 AV
+ * - Simplify dma_addr_t handling during command queuing given
+ * new block-layer defined restrictions:
+ * - Physical addresses not spanning 4GB boundaries.
+ * - Firmware versions: 2100 TP (1.19.24), 2200 IP (2.02.05),
+ * 2300 TPX (3.02.10).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b2-pre1 May 13, 2003 AV
+ * - Add support for new 'Hotplug initialization' model.
+ * - Simplify host template by removing unused callbacks.
+ * - Use scsicam facilities to determine geometry.
+ * - Fix compilation issues for non-ISP23xx builds:
+ * - Correct register references in qla_dbg.c.
+ * - Correct Makefile build process.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1 May 05, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.69.
+ * - Firmware versions: 2100 TP (1.19.24), 2200 TP (2.02.05),
+ * 2300 TPX (3.02.10).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre45 April ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.68-bk11:
+ * - Fix improper return-code assignment during fabric
+ * discovery.
+ * - Remove additional extraneous #defines from
+ * qla_settings.h.
+ * - USE_PORTNAME -- FO will always use portname.
+ * - Default queue depth size set to 64.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre42 April ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Convert bottom-half tasklet to a work_queue.
+ * - Initial basic coding of dynamic queue depth handling
+ * during QUEUE FULL statuses.
+ * - Fix mailbox interface problem with
+ * qla2x00_get_retry_cnt().
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre41 April ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Convert build defines qla2[1|2|3]00 macros to
+ * qla2[1|2|3]xx due to module name stringification clashes.
+ * - Add additional ISP2322 checks during board configuration.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre40 April ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.68-bk8:
+ * - Updated IRQ handler interface.
+ * - Add ISP dump code (stub) in case of SYSTEM_ERROR on
+ * ISP2100.
+ * - Add new 2200 IP firmware (2.02.05).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre39 April ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.68.
+ * - Add simple build.sh script to aid in external compilation.
+ * - Clean-break with Kernel 2.4 compatibility.
+ * - Rework DPC routine -- completion routines for signaling.
+ * - Re-add HBAAPI character device node for IOCTL support.
+ * - Remove residual QLA2X_PERFORMANCE defines.
+ * - Allocate SP pool via __get_free_pages() rather than
+ * individual kmalloc()'s.
+ * - Inform SCSI mid-layer of 16-byte CDB support
+ * (host->max_cmd_len):
+ * - Remove unecessary 'more_cdb' handling code from
+ * qla_iocb.c and qla_xioct.c.
+ * - Reduce duplicate code in fabric scanning logic (MS IOCB
+ * preparation).
+ * - Add ISP dump code in case of SYSTEM_ERROR.
+ * - Remove 2300 VIX firmware from distribution:
+ * - Add initial code for IPX support.
+ * - Add new 2300 TPX firmware (3.02.10).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre34 April ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with Linux Kernel 2.5.67.
+ * - Use domain/area/al_pa fields when displaying PortID
+ * values -- addresses endianess issues.
+ * - Rework large case statement to check 'common' CDB commands
+ * early in qla2x00_get_cmd_direction().
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre31 April ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Update makefile to support PPC64 build.
+ * - Retool NVRAM configuration routine and structures:
+ * - Consoldate ISP21xx/ISP22xx/ISP23xx configuration
+ * (struct nvram_t).
+ * - Remove big/little endian support structures in favor of
+ * simplified bit-operations within byte fields.
+ * - Fix long-standing 'static' buffer sharing problem in
+ * qla2x00_configure_fabric().
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre30 April ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Complete implementation of GID_PT scan.
+ * - Use consistent MS IOCB invocation method to query SNS:
+ * - Add RNN_ID and RSNN_NN registrations in a fabric.
+ * - Remove unused Mailbox Command 6Eh (Send SNS) support
+ * structures.
+ * - Use 64bit safe IOCBs while issuing INQUIRY and RLC during
+ * topology scan.
+ * - Until reimplementation of fcdev_t/fcport list
+ * consolidation, valid loop_id ranges are still limited from
+ * 0x00 through 0xFF -- enforce this within the code.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre27 March ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with 6.05.00b9.
+ * - Retool HBA PCI configuration -- qla2x00_pci_config().
+ * - Remove inconsistent use of delay routines (UDELAY/SYS*).
+ * - Continue to teardown/clean/add comments and debug
+ * routines.
+ * - Properly swap bytes of the device's nodename in
+ * qla2x00_configure_local_loop().
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre25 March ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with 6.05.00b8.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre23 March ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Remove (#define) IOCB usage throttling.
+ * - Abstract interrupt polling with qla2x00_poll().
+ * - Modify lun scanning logic:
+ * - If the device does not support the SCSI Report Luns
+ * command, the driver will now only scan from 0 to the
+ * max#-luns as defined in the NVRAM (BIOS), rather than
+ * blindly scanning from 0 to 255 -- which could result in
+ * an increase in startup time when running against slow
+ * (JBOD) devices.
+ * - Rework reset logic in qla2x00_reset_chip() (spec).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre22 March ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with 6.05.00b7.
+ * - Cleanup (rewrite) ISR handler.
+ * - Rename kmem_zalloc --> qla2x00_kmem_zalloc():
+ * - This function will eventually be removed.
+ * - Add new 2300 VIX firmware (3.02.09):
+ * - Support for Tape, Fabric, 2K logins, IP, and VI.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre18 March ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Support 232x type ISPs.
+ * - Support single firmware for each ISP type:
+ * - Restructure brd_info/fw_info methods.
+ * - Streamline firmware load process.
+ * - Properly query firmware for version information.
+ * - Remove extraneous scsi_qla_host members:
+ * - device_id ==> pdev->device
+ * - Fix fc4 features (RFF_ID) registration.
+ * - Convert kmem_zalloc --> qla2x00_kmem_zalloc().
+ * - Remove unused/extraneous #defines (USE_PORTNAME).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre14 March ??, 2003 AV
+ * - Resync with 6.05.00b6.
+ * - Initial source-code restructuring effort.
+ * - Build procedure.
+ * - Source file layout -- intuitive component layout.
+ * - Remove unused #defines (*PERFORMANCE, WORD_FW_LOAD, etc).
+ * - Add support for 2K logins (TPX -- firmware).
+ * - Add module parameter ql2xsuspendcount.
+ * - Add new 2200 IP/TP firmware (2.02.04).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre9 March ??, 2003 RL/DG/RA/AV
+ * - Use kernel struct list_head for fcport and fclun lists.
+ * - Remove extraneous (L|M)S_64BITS() and QL21_64*() defines.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre8 February 28, 2003 RL/DG/RA/AV
+ * - Resync with 6.05.00b3.
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre7 February 23, 2003 RL/DG/RA/AV
+ * - Add alternate fabric scanning logic (GID_PT/GNN_ID/GPN_ID).
+ * - Remove use of deprecated function check_region().
+ * - Add new 2300 IP/TP firmware (3.02.08).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre5 January 28, 2003 RL/DG/RA/AV
+ * - Resync with 6.05.00b3.
+ * - Consolidate device_reg structure definitions for ISP types.
+ * - Add support for new queue-depth selection.
+ * - Add new 2300 IP/TP firmware (3.02.07).
+ *
+ * Rev 8.00.00b1-pre1 January 17, 2003 AV
+ * - Initial branch from 6.04.00b8 driver.
+ * - Remove VMWARE specific code.
+ * - Add support for pci_driver interface.
+ *
+ ********************************************************************/
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/qlogicfas.txt b/Documentation/scsi/qlogicfas.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..398f99168077
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/qlogicfas.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,79 @@
+
+This driver supports the Qlogic FASXXX family of chips. This driver
+only works with the ISA, VLB, and PCMCIA versions of the Qlogic
+FastSCSI! cards as well as any other card based on the FASXX chip
+(including the Control Concepts SCSI/IDE/SIO/PIO/FDC cards).
+
+This driver does NOT support the PCI version. Support for these PCI
+Qlogic boards:
+
+ * IQ-PCI
+ * IQ-PCI-10
+ * IQ-PCI-D
+
+is provided by the qlogicisp.c driver. Check README.qlogicisp for
+details.
+
+Nor does it support the PCI-Basic, which is supported by the
+'am53c974' driver.
+
+PCMCIA SUPPORT
+
+This currently only works if the card is enabled first from DOS. This
+means you will have to load your socket and card services, and
+QL41DOS.SYS and QL40ENBL.SYS. These are a minimum, but loading the
+rest of the modules won't interfere with the operation. The next
+thing to do is load the kernel without resetting the hardware, which
+can be a simple ctrl-alt-delete with a boot floppy, or by using
+loadlin with the kernel image accessible from DOS. If you are using
+the Linux PCMCIA driver, you will have to adjust it or otherwise stop
+it from configuring the card.
+
+I am working with the PCMCIA group to make it more flexible, but that
+may take a while.
+
+ALL CARDS
+
+The top of the qlogic.c file has a number of defines that controls
+configuration. As shipped, it provides a balance between speed and
+function. If there are any problems, try setting SLOW_CABLE to 1, and
+then try changing USE_IRQ and TURBO_PDMA to zero. If you are familiar
+with SCSI, there are other settings which can tune the bus.
+
+It may be a good idea to enable RESET_AT_START, especially if the
+devices may not have been just powered up, or if you are restarting
+after a crash, since they may be busy trying to complete the last
+command or something. It comes up faster if this is set to zero, and
+if you have reliable hardware and connections it may be more useful to
+not reset things.
+
+SOME TROUBLESHOOTING TIPS
+
+Make sure it works properly under DOS. You should also do an initial FDISK
+on a new drive if you want partitions.
+
+Don't enable all the speedups first. If anything is wrong, they will make
+any problem worse.
+
+IMPORTANT
+
+The best way to test if your cables, termination, etc. are good is to
+copy a very big file (e.g. a doublespace container file, or a very
+large executable or archive). It should be at least 5 megabytes, but
+you can do multiple tests on smaller files. Then do a COMP to verify
+that the file copied properly. (Turn off all caching when doing these
+tests, otherwise you will test your RAM and not the files). Then do
+10 COMPs, comparing the same file on the SCSI hard drive, i.e. "COMP
+realbig.doc realbig.doc". Then do it after the computer gets warm.
+
+I noticed my system which seems to work 100% would fail this test if
+the computer was left on for a few hours. It was worse with longer
+cables, and more devices on the SCSI bus. What seems to happen is
+that it gets a false ACK causing an extra byte to be inserted into the
+stream (and this is not detected). This can be caused by bad
+termination (the ACK can be reflected), or by noise when the chips
+work less well because of the heat, or when cables get too long for
+the speed.
+
+Remember, if it doesn't work under DOS, it probably won't work under
+Linux.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/qlogicisp.txt b/Documentation/scsi/qlogicisp.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..6920f6c76a9f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/qlogicisp.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,30 @@
+Notes for the QLogic ISP1020 PCI SCSI Driver:
+
+This driver works well in practice, but does not support disconnect/
+reconnect, which makes using it with tape drives impractical.
+
+It should work for most host adaptors with the ISP1020 chip. The
+QLogic Corporation produces several PCI SCSI adapters which should
+work:
+
+ * IQ-PCI
+ * IQ-PCI-10
+ * IQ-PCI-D
+
+This driver may work with boards containing the ISP1020A or ISP1040A
+chips, but that has not been tested.
+
+This driver will NOT work with:
+
+ * ISA or VL Bus Qlogic cards (they use the 'qlogicfas' driver)
+ * PCI-basic (it uses the 'am53c974' driver)
+
+Much thanks to QLogic's tech support for providing the latest ISP1020
+firmware, and for taking the time to review my code.
+
+Erik Moe
+ehm@cris.com
+
+Revised:
+Michael A. Griffith
+grif@cs.ucr.edu
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt b/Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..c38e2b3648e4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/scsi-generic.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
+ Notes on Linux SCSI Generic (sg) driver
+ ---------------------------------------
+ 20020126
+Introduction
+============
+The SCSI Generic driver (sg) is one of the four "high level" SCSI device
+drivers along with sd, st and sr (disk, tape and CDROM respectively). Sg
+is more generalized (but lower level) than its siblings and tends to be
+used on SCSI devices that don't fit into the already serviced categories.
+Thus sg is used for scanners, CD writers and reading audio CDs digitally
+amongst other things.
+
+Rather than document the driver's interface here, version information
+is provided plus pointers (i.e. URLs) where to find documentation
+and examples.
+
+
+Major versions of the sg driver
+===============================
+There are three major versions of sg found in the linux kernel (lk):
+ - sg version 1 (original) from 1992 to early 1999 (lk 2.2.5) .
+ It is based in the sg_header interface structure.
+ - sg version 2 from lk 2.2.6 in the 2.2 series. It is based on
+ an extended version of the sg_header interface structure.
+ - sg version 3 found in the lk 2.4 series (and the lk 2.5 series).
+ It adds the sg_io_hdr interface structure.
+
+
+Sg driver documentation
+=======================
+The most recent documentation of the sg driver is kept at the Linux
+Documentation Project's (LDP) site:
+http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/SCSI-Generic-HOWTO
+This describes the sg version 3 driver found in the lk 2.4 series.
+The LDP renders documents in single and multiple page HTML, postscript
+and pdf. This document can also be found at:
+http://www.torque.net/sg/p/sg_v3_ho.html
+
+Documentation for the version 2 sg driver found in the lk 2.2 series can
+be found at http://www.torque.net/sg/p/scsi-generic.txt . A larger version
+is at: http://www.torque.net/sg/p/scsi-generic_long.txt .
+
+The original documentation for the sg driver (prior to lk 2.2.6) can be
+found at http://www.torque.net/sg/p/original/SCSI-Programming-HOWTO.txt
+and in the LDP archives.
+
+A changelog with brief notes can be found in the
+/usr/src/linux/include/scsi/sg.h file. Note that the glibc maintainers copy
+and edit this file (removing its changelog for example) before placing it
+in /usr/include/scsi/sg.h . Driver debugging information and other notes
+can be found at the top of the /usr/src/linux/drivers/scsi/sg.c file.
+
+A more general description of the Linux SCSI subsystem of which sg is a
+part can be found at http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/SCSI-2.4-HOWTO .
+
+
+Example code and utilities
+==========================
+There are two packages of sg utilities:
+ - sg3_utils for the sg version 3 driver found in lk 2.4
+ - sg_utils for the sg version 2 (and original) driver found in lk 2.2
+ and earlier
+Both packages will work in the lk 2.4 series however sg3_utils offers more
+capabilities. They can be found at: http://www.torque.net/sg and
+freshmeat.net
+
+Another approach is to look at the applications that use the sg driver.
+These include cdrecord, cdparanoia, SANE and cdrdao.
+
+
+Mapping of Linux kernel versions to sg driver versions
+======================================================
+Here is a list of linux kernels in the 2.4 series that had new version
+of the sg driver:
+ lk 2.4.0 : sg version 3.1.17
+ lk 2.4.7 : sg version 3.1.19
+ lk 2.4.10 : sg version 3.1.20 **
+ lk 2.4.17 : sg version 3.1.22
+
+** There were 3 changes to sg version 3.1.20 by third parties in the
+ next six linux kernel versions.
+
+For reference here is a list of linux kernels in the 2.2 series that had
+new version of the sg driver:
+ lk 2.2.0 : original sg version [with no version number]
+ lk 2.2.6 : sg version 2.1.31
+ lk 2.2.8 : sg version 2.1.32
+ lk 2.2.10 : sg version 2.1.34 [SG_GET_VERSION_NUM ioctl first appeared]
+ lk 2.2.14 : sg version 2.1.36
+ lk 2.2.16 : sg version 2.1.38
+ lk 2.2.17 : sg version 2.1.39
+ lk 2.2.20 : sg version 2.1.40
+
+The lk 2.5 development series has recently commenced and it currently
+contains sg version 3.5.23 which is functionally equivalent to sg
+version 3.1.22 found in lk 2.4.17 .
+
+
+Douglas Gilbert
+26th January 2002
+dgilbert@interlog.com
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/scsi.txt b/Documentation/scsi/scsi.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..dd1bbf4e98e3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/scsi.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+SCSI subsystem documentation
+============================
+The Linux Documentation Project (LDP) maintains a document describing
+the SCSI subsystem in the Linux kernel (lk) 2.4 series. See:
+http://www.tldp.org/HOWTO/SCSI-2.4-HOWTO . The LDP has single
+and multiple page HTML renderings as well as postscript and pdf.
+It can also be found at http://www.torque.net/scsi/SCSI-2.4-HOWTO .
+
+
+Notes on using modules in the SCSI subsystem
+============================================
+The scsi support in the linux kernel can be modularized in a number of
+different ways depending upon the needs of the end user. To understand
+your options, we should first define a few terms.
+
+The scsi-core (also known as the "mid level") contains the core of scsi
+support. Without it you can do nothing with any of the other scsi drivers.
+The scsi core support can be a module (scsi_mod.o), or it can be built into
+the kernel. If the core is a module, it must be the first scsi module
+loaded, and if you unload the modules, it will have to be the last one
+unloaded. In practice the modprobe and rmmod commands (and "autoclean")
+will enforce the correct ordering of loading and unloading modules in
+the SCSI subsystem.
+
+The individual upper and lower level drivers can be loaded in any order
+once the scsi core is present in the kernel (either compiled in or loaded
+as a module). The disk driver (sd_mod.o), cdrom driver (sr_mod.o),
+tape driver ** (st.o) and scsi generics driver (sg.o) represent the upper
+level drivers to support the various assorted devices which can be
+controlled. You can for example load the tape driver to use the tape drive,
+and then unload it once you have no further need for the driver (and release
+the associated memory).
+
+The lower level drivers are the ones that support the individual cards that
+are supported for the hardware platform that you are running under. Those
+individual cards are often called Host Bus Adapters (HBAs). For example the
+aic7xxx.o driver is used to control all recent SCSI controller cards from
+Adaptec. Almost all lower level drivers can be built either as modules or
+built into the kernel.
+
+
+** There is a variant of the st driver for controlling OnStream tape
+ devices. Its module name is osst.o .
+
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/scsi_mid_low_api.txt b/Documentation/scsi/scsi_mid_low_api.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..1f24129a3099
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/scsi_mid_low_api.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,1546 @@
+ Linux Kernel 2.6 series
+ SCSI mid_level - lower_level driver interface
+ =============================================
+
+Introduction
+============
+This document outlines the interface between the Linux SCSI mid level and
+SCSI lower level drivers. Lower level drivers (LLDs) are variously called
+host bus adapter (HBA) drivers and host drivers (HD). A "host" in this
+context is a bridge between a computer IO bus (e.g. PCI or ISA) and a
+single SCSI initiator port on a SCSI transport. An "initiator" port
+(SCSI terminology, see SAM-3 at http://www.t10.org) sends SCSI commands
+to "target" SCSI ports (e.g. disks). There can be many LLDs in a running
+system, but only one per hardware type. Most LLDs can control one or more
+SCSI HBAs. Some HBAs contain multiple hosts.
+
+In some cases the SCSI transport is an external bus that already has
+its own subsystem in Linux (e.g. USB and ieee1394). In such cases the
+SCSI subsystem LLD is a software bridge to the other driver subsystem.
+Examples are the usb-storage driver (found in the drivers/usb/storage
+directory) and the ieee1394/sbp2 driver (found in the drivers/ieee1394
+directory).
+
+For example, the aic7xxx LLD controls Adaptec SCSI parallel interface
+(SPI) controllers based on that company's 7xxx chip series. The aic7xxx
+LLD can be built into the kernel or loaded as a module. There can only be
+one aic7xxx LLD running in a Linux system but it may be controlling many
+HBAs. These HBAs might be either on PCI daughter-boards or built into
+the motherboard (or both). Some aic7xxx based HBAs are dual controllers
+and thus represent two hosts. Like most modern HBAs, each aic7xxx host
+has its own PCI device address. [The one-to-one correspondence between
+a SCSI host and a PCI device is common but not required (e.g. with
+ISA or MCA adapters).]
+
+The SCSI mid level isolates an LLD from other layers such as the SCSI
+upper layer drivers and the block layer.
+
+This version of the document roughly matches linux kernel version 2.6.8 .
+
+Documentation
+=============
+There is a SCSI documentation directory within the kernel source tree,
+typically Documentation/scsi . Most documents are in plain
+(i.e. ASCII) text. This file is named scsi_mid_low_api.txt and can be
+found in that directory. A more recent copy of this document may be found
+at http://www.torque.net/scsi/scsi_mid_low_api.txt.gz .
+Many LLDs are documented there (e.g. aic7xxx.txt). The SCSI mid-level is
+briefly described in scsi.txt which contains a url to a document
+describing the SCSI subsystem in the lk 2.4 series. Two upper level
+drivers have documents in that directory: st.txt (SCSI tape driver) and
+scsi-generic.txt (for the sg driver).
+
+Some documentation (or urls) for LLDs may be found in the C source code
+or in the same directory as the C source code. For example to find a url
+about the USB mass storage driver see the
+/usr/src/linux/drivers/usb/storage directory.
+
+The Linux kernel source Documentation/DocBook/scsidrivers.tmpl file
+refers to this file. With the appropriate DocBook tool-set, this permits
+users to generate html, ps and pdf renderings of information within this
+file (e.g. the interface functions).
+
+Driver structure
+================
+Traditionally an LLD for the SCSI subsystem has been at least two files in
+the drivers/scsi directory. For example, a driver called "xyz" has a header
+file "xyz.h" and a source file "xyz.c". [Actually there is no good reason
+why this couldn't all be in one file; the header file is superfluous.] Some
+drivers that have been ported to several operating systems have more than
+two files. For example the aic7xxx driver has separate files for generic
+and OS-specific code (e.g. FreeBSD and Linux). Such drivers tend to have
+their own directory under the drivers/scsi directory.
+
+When a new LLD is being added to Linux, the following files (found in the
+drivers/scsi directory) will need some attention: Makefile and Kconfig .
+It is probably best to study how existing LLDs are organized.
+
+As the 2.5 series development kernels evolve into the 2.6 series
+production series, changes are being introduced into this interface. An
+example of this is driver initialization code where there are now 2 models
+available. The older one, similar to what was found in the lk 2.4 series,
+is based on hosts that are detected at HBA driver load time. This will be
+referred to the "passive" initialization model. The newer model allows HBAs
+to be hot plugged (and unplugged) during the lifetime of the LLD and will
+be referred to as the "hotplug" initialization model. The newer model is
+preferred as it can handle both traditional SCSI equipment that is
+permanently connected as well as modern "SCSI" devices (e.g. USB or
+IEEE 1394 connected digital cameras) that are hotplugged. Both
+initialization models are discussed in the following sections.
+
+An LLD interfaces to the SCSI subsystem several ways:
+ a) directly invoking functions supplied by the mid level
+ b) passing a set of function pointers to a registration function
+ supplied by the mid level. The mid level will then invoke these
+ functions at some point in the future. The LLD will supply
+ implementations of these functions.
+ c) direct access to instances of well known data structures maintained
+ by the mid level
+
+Those functions in group a) are listed in a section entitled "Mid level
+supplied functions" below.
+
+Those functions in group b) are listed in a section entitled "Interface
+functions" below. Their function pointers are placed in the members of
+"struct scsi_host_template", an instance of which is passed to
+scsi_host_alloc() ** . Those interface functions that the LLD does not
+wish to supply should have NULL placed in the corresponding member of
+struct scsi_host_template. Defining an instance of struct
+scsi_host_template at file scope will cause NULL to be placed in function
+ pointer members not explicitly initialized.
+
+Those usages in group c) should be handled with care, especially in a
+"hotplug" environment. LLDs should be aware of the lifetime of instances
+that are shared with the mid level and other layers.
+
+All functions defined within an LLD and all data defined at file scope
+should be static. For example the slave_alloc() function in an LLD
+called "xxx" could be defined as
+"static int xxx_slave_alloc(struct scsi_device * sdev) { /* code */ }"
+
+** the scsi_host_alloc() function is a replacement for the rather vaguely
+named scsi_register() function in most situations. The scsi_register()
+and scsi_unregister() functions remain to support legacy LLDs that use
+the passive initialization model.
+
+
+Hotplug initialization model
+============================
+In this model an LLD controls when SCSI hosts are introduced and removed
+from the SCSI subsystem. Hosts can be introduced as early as driver
+initialization and removed as late as driver shutdown. Typically a driver
+will respond to a sysfs probe() callback that indicates an HBA has been
+detected. After confirming that the new device is one that the LLD wants
+to control, the LLD will initialize the HBA and then register a new host
+with the SCSI mid level.
+
+During LLD initialization the driver should register itself with the
+appropriate IO bus on which it expects to find HBA(s) (e.g. the PCI bus).
+This can probably be done via sysfs. Any driver parameters (especially
+those that are writable after the driver is loaded) could also be
+registered with sysfs at this point. The SCSI mid level first becomes
+aware of an LLD when that LLD registers its first HBA.
+
+At some later time, the LLD becomes aware of an HBA and what follows
+is a typical sequence of calls between the LLD and the mid level.
+This example shows the mid level scanning the newly introduced HBA for 3
+scsi devices of which only the first 2 respond:
+
+ HBA PROBE: assume 2 SCSI devices found in scan
+LLD mid level LLD
+===-------------------=========--------------------===------
+scsi_host_alloc() -->
+scsi_add_host() --------+
+ |
+ slave_alloc()
+ slave_configure() --> scsi_adjust_queue_depth()
+ |
+ slave_alloc()
+ slave_configure()
+ |
+ slave_alloc() ***
+ slave_destroy() ***
+------------------------------------------------------------
+
+If the LLD wants to adjust the default queue settings, it can invoke
+scsi_adjust_queue_depth() in its slave_configure() routine.
+
+*** For scsi devices that the mid level tries to scan but do not
+ respond, a slave_alloc(), slave_destroy() pair is called.
+
+When an HBA is being removed it could be as part of an orderly shutdown
+associated with the LLD module being unloaded (e.g. with the "rmmod"
+command) or in response to a "hot unplug" indicated by sysfs()'s
+remove() callback being invoked. In either case, the sequence is the
+same:
+
+ HBA REMOVE: assume 2 SCSI devices attached
+LLD mid level LLD
+===----------------------=========-----------------===------
+scsi_remove_host() ---------+
+ |
+ slave_destroy()
+ slave_destroy()
+scsi_host_put()
+------------------------------------------------------------
+
+It may be useful for a LLD to keep track of struct Scsi_Host instances
+(a pointer is returned by scsi_host_alloc()). Such instances are "owned"
+by the mid-level. struct Scsi_Host instances are freed from
+scsi_host_put() when the reference count hits zero.
+
+Hot unplugging an HBA that controls a disk which is processing SCSI
+commands on a mounted file system is an interesting situation. Reference
+counting logic is being introduced into the mid level to cope with many
+of the issues involved. See the section on reference counting below.
+
+
+The hotplug concept may be extended to SCSI devices. Currently, when an
+HBA is added, the scsi_add_host() function causes a scan for SCSI devices
+attached to the HBA's SCSI transport. On newer SCSI transports the HBA
+may become aware of a new SCSI device _after_ the scan has completed.
+An LLD can use this sequence to make the mid level aware of a SCSI device:
+
+ SCSI DEVICE hotplug
+LLD mid level LLD
+===-------------------=========--------------------===------
+scsi_add_device() ------+
+ |
+ slave_alloc()
+ slave_configure() [--> scsi_adjust_queue_depth()]
+------------------------------------------------------------
+
+In a similar fashion, an LLD may become aware that a SCSI device has been
+removed (unplugged) or the connection to it has been interrupted. Some
+existing SCSI transports (e.g. SPI) may not become aware that a SCSI
+device has been removed until a subsequent SCSI command fails which will
+probably cause that device to be set offline by the mid level. An LLD that
+detects the removal of a SCSI device can instigate its removal from
+upper layers with this sequence:
+
+ SCSI DEVICE hot unplug
+LLD mid level LLD
+===----------------------=========-----------------===------
+scsi_remove_device() -------+
+ |
+ slave_destroy()
+------------------------------------------------------------
+
+It may be useful for an LLD to keep track of struct scsi_device instances
+(a pointer is passed as the parameter to slave_alloc() and
+slave_configure() callbacks). Such instances are "owned" by the mid-level.
+struct scsi_device instances are freed after slave_destroy().
+
+
+Passive initialization model
+============================
+These older LLDs include a file called "scsi_module.c" [yes the ".c" is a
+little surprising] in their source code. For that file to work an
+instance of struct scsi_host_template with the name "driver_template"
+needs to be defined. Here is a typical code sequence used in this model:
+ static struct scsi_host_template driver_template = {
+ ...
+ };
+ #include "scsi_module.c"
+
+The scsi_module.c file contains two functions:
+ - init_this_scsi_driver() which is executed when the LLD is
+ initialized (i.e. boot time or module load time)
+ - exit_this_scsi_driver() which is executed when the LLD is shut
+ down (i.e. module unload time)
+Note: since these functions are tagged with __init and __exit qualifiers
+an LLD should not call them explicitly (since the kernel does that).
+
+Here is an example of an initialization sequence when two hosts are
+detected (so detect() returns 2) and the SCSI bus scan on each host
+finds 1 SCSI device (and a second device does not respond).
+
+LLD mid level LLD
+===----------------------=========-----------------===------
+init_this_scsi_driver() ----+
+ |
+ detect() -----------------+
+ | |
+ | scsi_register()
+ | scsi_register()
+ |
+ slave_alloc()
+ slave_configure() --> scsi_adjust_queue_depth()
+ slave_alloc() ***
+ slave_destroy() ***
+ |
+ slave_alloc()
+ slave_configure()
+ slave_alloc() ***
+ slave_destroy() ***
+------------------------------------------------------------
+
+The mid level invokes scsi_adjust_queue_depth() with tagged queuing off and
+"cmd_per_lun" for that host as the queue length. These settings can be
+overridden by a slave_configure() supplied by the LLD.
+
+*** For scsi devices that the mid level tries to scan but do not
+ respond, a slave_alloc(), slave_destroy() pair is called.
+
+Here is an LLD shutdown sequence:
+
+LLD mid level LLD
+===----------------------=========-----------------===------
+exit_this_scsi_driver() ----+
+ |
+ slave_destroy()
+ release() --> scsi_unregister()
+ |
+ slave_destroy()
+ release() --> scsi_unregister()
+------------------------------------------------------------
+
+An LLD need not define slave_destroy() (i.e. it is optional).
+
+The shortcoming of the "passive initialization model" is that host
+registration and de-registration are (typically) tied to LLD initialization
+and shutdown. Once the LLD is initialized then a new host that appears
+(e.g. via hotplugging) cannot easily be added without a redundant
+driver shutdown and re-initialization. It may be possible to write an LLD
+that uses both initialization models.
+
+
+Reference Counting
+==================
+The Scsi_Host structure has had reference counting infrastructure added.
+This effectively spreads the ownership of struct Scsi_Host instances
+across the various SCSI layers which use them. Previously such instances
+were exclusively owned by the mid level. LLDs would not usually need to
+directly manipulate these reference counts but there may be some cases
+where they do.
+
+There are 3 reference counting functions of interest associated with
+struct Scsi_Host:
+ - scsi_host_alloc(): returns a pointer to new instance of struct
+ Scsi_Host which has its reference count ^^ set to 1
+ - scsi_host_get(): adds 1 to the reference count of the given instance
+ - scsi_host_put(): decrements 1 from the reference count of the given
+ instance. If the reference count reaches 0 then the given instance
+ is freed
+
+The Scsi_device structure has had reference counting infrastructure added.
+This effectively spreads the ownership of struct Scsi_device instances
+across the various SCSI layers which use them. Previously such instances
+were exclusively owned by the mid level. See the access functions declared
+towards the end of include/scsi/scsi_device.h . If an LLD wants to keep
+a copy of a pointer to a Scsi_device instance it should use scsi_device_get()
+to bump its reference count. When it is finished with the pointer it can
+use scsi_device_put() to decrement its reference count (and potentially
+delete it).
+
+^^ struct Scsi_Host actually has 2 reference counts which are manipulated
+in parallel by these functions.
+
+
+Conventions
+===========
+First, Linus Torvalds's thoughts on C coding style can be found in the
+Documentation/CodingStyle file.
+
+Next, there is a movement to "outlaw" typedefs introducing synonyms for
+struct tags. Both can be still found in the SCSI subsystem, but
+the typedefs have been moved to a single file, scsi_typedefs.h to
+make their future removal easier, for example:
+"typedef struct scsi_host_template Scsi_Host_Template;"
+
+Also, most C99 enhancements are encouraged to the extent they are supported
+by the relevant gcc compilers. So C99 style structure and array
+initializers are encouraged where appropriate. Don't go too far,
+VLAs are not properly supported yet. An exception to this is the use of
+"//" style comments; /*...*/ comments are still preferred in Linux.
+
+Well written, tested and documented code, need not be re-formatted to
+comply with the above conventions. For example, the aic7xxx driver
+comes to Linux from FreeBSD and Adaptec's own labs. No doubt FreeBSD
+and Adaptec have their own coding conventions.
+
+
+Mid level supplied functions
+============================
+These functions are supplied by the SCSI mid level for use by LLDs.
+The names (i.e. entry points) of these functions are exported
+so an LLD that is a module can access them. The kernel will
+arrange for the SCSI mid level to be loaded and initialized before any LLD
+is initialized. The functions below are listed alphabetically and their
+names all start with "scsi_".
+
+Summary:
+ scsi_activate_tcq - turn on tag command queueing
+ scsi_add_device - creates new scsi device (lu) instance
+ scsi_add_host - perform sysfs registration and SCSI bus scan.
+ scsi_add_timer - (re-)start timer on a SCSI command.
+ scsi_adjust_queue_depth - change the queue depth on a SCSI device
+ scsi_assign_lock - replace default host_lock with given lock
+ scsi_bios_ptable - return copy of block device's partition table
+ scsi_block_requests - prevent further commands being queued to given host
+ scsi_deactivate_tcq - turn off tag command queueing
+ scsi_delete_timer - cancel timer on a SCSI command.
+ scsi_host_alloc - return a new scsi_host instance whose refcount==1
+ scsi_host_get - increments Scsi_Host instance's refcount
+ scsi_host_put - decrements Scsi_Host instance's refcount (free if 0)
+ scsi_partsize - parse partition table into cylinders, heads + sectors
+ scsi_register - create and register a scsi host adapter instance.
+ scsi_remove_device - detach and remove a SCSI device
+ scsi_remove_host - detach and remove all SCSI devices owned by host
+ scsi_report_bus_reset - report scsi _bus_ reset observed
+ scsi_set_device - place device reference in host structure
+ scsi_to_pci_dma_dir - convert SCSI subsystem direction flag to PCI
+ scsi_to_sbus_dma_dir - convert SCSI subsystem direction flag to SBUS
+ scsi_track_queue_full - track successive QUEUE_FULL events
+ scsi_unblock_requests - allow further commands to be queued to given host
+ scsi_unregister - [calls scsi_host_put()]
+
+
+Details:
+
+/**
+ * scsi_activate_tcq - turn on tag command queueing ("ordered" task attribute)
+ * @sdev: device to turn on TCQ for
+ * @depth: queue depth
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: Eventually, it is hoped depth would be the maximum depth
+ * the device could cope with and the real queue depth
+ * would be adjustable from 0 to depth.
+ *
+ * Defined (inline) in: include/scsi/scsi_tcq.h
+ **/
+void scsi_activate_tcq(struct scsi_device *sdev, int depth)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_add_device - creates new scsi device (lu) instance
+ * @shost: pointer to scsi host instance
+ * @channel: channel number (rarely other than 0)
+ * @id: target id number
+ * @lun: logical unit number
+ *
+ * Returns pointer to new struct scsi_device instance or
+ * ERR_PTR(-ENODEV) (or some other bent pointer) if something is
+ * wrong (e.g. no lu responds at given address)
+ *
+ * Might block: yes
+ *
+ * Notes: This call is usually performed internally during a scsi
+ * bus scan when an HBA is added (i.e. scsi_add_host()). So it
+ * should only be called if the HBA becomes aware of a new scsi
+ * device (lu) after scsi_add_host() has completed. If successful
+ * this call we lead to slave_alloc() and slave_configure() callbacks
+ * into the LLD.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi_scan.c
+ **/
+struct scsi_device * scsi_add_device(struct Scsi_Host *shost,
+ unsigned int channel,
+ unsigned int id, unsigned int lun)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_add_host - perform sysfs registration and SCSI bus scan.
+ * @shost: pointer to scsi host instance
+ * @dev: pointer to struct device of type scsi class
+ *
+ * Returns 0 on success, negative errno of failure (e.g. -ENOMEM)
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: Only required in "hotplug initialization model" after a
+ * successful call to scsi_host_alloc().
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/hosts.c
+ **/
+int scsi_add_host(struct Scsi_Host *shost, struct device * dev)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_add_timer - (re-)start timer on a SCSI command.
+ * @scmd: pointer to scsi command instance
+ * @timeout: duration of timeout in "jiffies"
+ * @complete: pointer to function to call if timeout expires
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: Each scsi command has its own timer, and as it is added
+ * to the queue, we set up the timer. When the command completes,
+ * we cancel the timer. An LLD can use this function to change
+ * the existing timeout value.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi_error.c
+ **/
+void scsi_add_timer(struct scsi_cmnd *scmd, int timeout,
+ void (*complete)(struct scsi_cmnd *))
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_adjust_queue_depth - allow LLD to change queue depth on a SCSI device
+ * @sdev: pointer to SCSI device to change queue depth on
+ * @tagged: 0 - no tagged queuing
+ * MSG_SIMPLE_TAG - simple tagged queuing
+ * MSG_ORDERED_TAG - ordered tagged queuing
+ * @tags Number of tags allowed if tagged queuing enabled,
+ * or number of commands the LLD can queue up
+ * in non-tagged mode (as per cmd_per_lun).
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: Can be invoked any time on a SCSI device controlled by this
+ * LLD. [Specifically during and after slave_configure() and prior to
+ * slave_destroy().] Can safely be invoked from interrupt code. Actual
+ * queue depth change may be delayed until the next command is being
+ * processed. See also scsi_activate_tcq() and scsi_deactivate_tcq().
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi.c [see source code for more notes]
+ *
+ **/
+void scsi_adjust_queue_depth(struct scsi_device * sdev, int tagged,
+ int tags)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_assign_lock - replace default host_lock with given lock
+ * @shost: a pointer to a scsi host instance
+ * @lock: pointer to lock to replace host_lock for this host
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Defined in: include/scsi/scsi_host.h .
+ **/
+void scsi_assign_lock(struct Scsi_Host *shost, spinlock_t *lock)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_bios_ptable - return copy of block device's partition table
+ * @dev: pointer to block device
+ *
+ * Returns pointer to partition table, or NULL for failure
+ *
+ * Might block: yes
+ *
+ * Notes: Caller owns memory returned (free with kfree() )
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsicam.c
+ **/
+unsigned char *scsi_bios_ptable(struct block_device *dev)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_block_requests - prevent further commands being queued to given host
+ *
+ * @shost: pointer to host to block commands on
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: There is no timer nor any other means by which the requests
+ * get unblocked other than the LLD calling scsi_unblock_requests().
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi_lib.c
+**/
+void scsi_block_requests(struct Scsi_Host * shost)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_deactivate_tcq - turn off tag command queueing
+ * @sdev: device to turn off TCQ for
+ * @depth: queue depth (stored in sdev)
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Defined (inline) in: include/scsi/scsi_tcq.h
+ **/
+void scsi_deactivate_tcq(struct scsi_device *sdev, int depth)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_delete_timer - cancel timer on a SCSI command.
+ * @scmd: pointer to scsi command instance
+ *
+ * Returns 1 if able to cancel timer else 0 (i.e. too late or already
+ * cancelled).
+ *
+ * Might block: no [may in the future if it invokes del_timer_sync()]
+ *
+ * Notes: All commands issued by upper levels already have a timeout
+ * associated with them. An LLD can use this function to cancel the
+ * timer.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi_error.c
+ **/
+int scsi_delete_timer(struct scsi_cmnd *scmd)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_host_alloc - create a scsi host adapter instance and perform basic
+ * initialization.
+ * @sht: pointer to scsi host template
+ * @privsize: extra bytes to allocate in hostdata array (which is the
+ * last member of the returned Scsi_Host instance)
+ *
+ * Returns pointer to new Scsi_Host instance or NULL on failure
+ *
+ * Might block: yes
+ *
+ * Notes: When this call returns to the LLD, the SCSI bus scan on
+ * this host has _not_ yet been done.
+ * The hostdata array (by default zero length) is a per host scratch
+ * area for the LLD's exclusive use.
+ * Both associated refcounting objects have their refcount set to 1.
+ * Full registration (in sysfs) and a bus scan are performed later when
+ * scsi_add_host() is called.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/hosts.c .
+ **/
+struct Scsi_Host * scsi_host_alloc(struct scsi_host_template * sht,
+ int privsize)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_host_get - increment Scsi_Host instance refcount
+ * @shost: pointer to struct Scsi_Host instance
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: currently may block but may be changed to not block
+ *
+ * Notes: Actually increments the counts in two sub-objects
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/hosts.c
+ **/
+void scsi_host_get(struct Scsi_Host *shost)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_host_put - decrement Scsi_Host instance refcount, free if 0
+ * @shost: pointer to struct Scsi_Host instance
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: currently may block but may be changed to not block
+ *
+ * Notes: Actually decrements the counts in two sub-objects. If the
+ * latter refcount reaches 0, the Scsi_Host instance is freed.
+ * The LLD need not worry exactly when the Scsi_Host instance is
+ * freed, it just shouldn't access the instance after it has balanced
+ * out its refcount usage.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/hosts.c
+ **/
+void scsi_host_put(struct Scsi_Host *shost)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_partsize - parse partition table into cylinders, heads + sectors
+ * @buf: pointer to partition table
+ * @capacity: size of (total) disk in 512 byte sectors
+ * @cyls: outputs number of cylinders calculated via this pointer
+ * @hds: outputs number of heads calculated via this pointer
+ * @secs: outputs number of sectors calculated via this pointer
+ *
+ * Returns 0 on success, -1 on failure
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: Caller owns memory returned (free with kfree() )
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsicam.c
+ **/
+int scsi_partsize(unsigned char *buf, unsigned long capacity,
+ unsigned int *cyls, unsigned int *hds, unsigned int *secs)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_register - create and register a scsi host adapter instance.
+ * @sht: pointer to scsi host template
+ * @privsize: extra bytes to allocate in hostdata array (which is the
+ * last member of the returned Scsi_Host instance)
+ *
+ * Returns pointer to new Scsi_Host instance or NULL on failure
+ *
+ * Might block: yes
+ *
+ * Notes: When this call returns to the LLD, the SCSI bus scan on
+ * this host has _not_ yet been done.
+ * The hostdata array (by default zero length) is a per host scratch
+ * area for the LLD.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/hosts.c .
+ **/
+struct Scsi_Host * scsi_register(struct scsi_host_template * sht,
+ int privsize)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_remove_device - detach and remove a SCSI device
+ * @sdev: a pointer to a scsi device instance
+ *
+ * Returns value: 0 on success, -EINVAL if device not attached
+ *
+ * Might block: yes
+ *
+ * Notes: If an LLD becomes aware that a scsi device (lu) has
+ * been removed but its host is still present then it can request
+ * the removal of that scsi device. If successful this call will
+ * lead to the slave_destroy() callback being invoked. sdev is an
+ * invalid pointer after this call.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi_sysfs.c .
+ **/
+int scsi_remove_device(struct scsi_device *sdev)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_remove_host - detach and remove all SCSI devices owned by host
+ * @shost: a pointer to a scsi host instance
+ *
+ * Returns value: 0 on success, 1 on failure (e.g. LLD busy ??)
+ *
+ * Might block: yes
+ *
+ * Notes: Should only be invoked if the "hotplug initialization
+ * model" is being used. It should be called _prior_ to
+ * scsi_unregister().
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/hosts.c .
+ **/
+int scsi_remove_host(struct Scsi_Host *shost)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_report_bus_reset - report scsi _bus_ reset observed
+ * @shost: a pointer to a scsi host involved
+ * @channel: channel (within) host on which scsi bus reset occurred
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: This only needs to be called if the reset is one which
+ * originates from an unknown location. Resets originated by the
+ * mid level itself don't need to call this, but there should be
+ * no harm. The main purpose of this is to make sure that a
+ * CHECK_CONDITION is properly treated.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi_error.c .
+ **/
+void scsi_report_bus_reset(struct Scsi_Host * shost, int channel)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_set_device - place device reference in host structure
+ * @shost: a pointer to a scsi host instance
+ * @pdev: pointer to device instance to assign
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Defined in: include/scsi/scsi_host.h .
+ **/
+void scsi_set_device(struct Scsi_Host * shost, struct device * dev)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_to_pci_dma_dir - convert SCSI subsystem direction flag to PCI
+ * @scsi_data_direction: SCSI subsystem direction flag
+ *
+ * Returns DMA_TO_DEVICE given SCSI_DATA_WRITE,
+ * DMA_FROM_DEVICE given SCSI_DATA_READ
+ * DMA_BIDIRECTIONAL given SCSI_DATA_UNKNOWN
+ * else returns DMA_NONE
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: The SCSI subsystem now uses the same values for these
+ * constants as the PCI subsystem so this function is a nop.
+ * The recommendation is not to use this conversion function anymore
+ * (in the 2.6 kernel series) as it is not needed.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi.h .
+ **/
+int scsi_to_pci_dma_dir(unsigned char scsi_data_direction)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_to_sbus_dma_dir - convert SCSI subsystem direction flag to SBUS
+ * @scsi_data_direction: SCSI subsystem direction flag
+ *
+ * Returns DMA_TO_DEVICE given SCSI_DATA_WRITE,
+ * FROM_DEVICE given SCSI_DATA_READ
+ * DMA_BIDIRECTIONAL given SCSI_DATA_UNKNOWN
+ * else returns DMA_NONE
+ *
+ * Notes: The SCSI subsystem now uses the same values for these
+ * constants as the SBUS subsystem so this function is a nop.
+ * The recommendation is not to use this conversion function anymore
+ * (in the 2.6 kernel series) as it is not needed.
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi.h .
+ **/
+int scsi_to_sbus_dma_dir(unsigned char scsi_data_direction)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_track_queue_full - track successive QUEUE_FULL events on given
+ * device to determine if and when there is a need
+ * to adjust the queue depth on the device.
+ * @sdev: pointer to SCSI device instance
+ * @depth: Current number of outstanding SCSI commands on this device,
+ * not counting the one returned as QUEUE_FULL.
+ *
+ * Returns 0 - no change needed
+ * >0 - adjust queue depth to this new depth
+ * -1 - drop back to untagged operation using host->cmd_per_lun
+ * as the untagged command depth
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: LLDs may call this at any time and we will do "The Right
+ * Thing"; interrupt context safe.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi.c .
+ **/
+int scsi_track_queue_full(Scsi_Device *sdev, int depth)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_unblock_requests - allow further commands to be queued to given host
+ *
+ * @shost: pointer to host to unblock commands on
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/scsi_lib.c .
+**/
+void scsi_unblock_requests(struct Scsi_Host * shost)
+
+
+/**
+ * scsi_unregister - unregister and free memory used by host instance
+ * @shp: pointer to scsi host instance to unregister.
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Might block: no
+ *
+ * Notes: Should not be invoked if the "hotplug initialization
+ * model" is being used. Called internally by exit_this_scsi_driver()
+ * in the "passive initialization model". Hence a LLD has no need to
+ * call this function directly.
+ *
+ * Defined in: drivers/scsi/hosts.c .
+ **/
+void scsi_unregister(struct Scsi_Host * shp)
+
+
+
+
+Interface Functions
+===================
+Interface functions are supplied (defined) by LLDs and their function
+pointers are placed in an instance of struct scsi_host_template which
+is passed to scsi_host_alloc() [or scsi_register() / init_this_scsi_driver()].
+Some are mandatory. Interface functions should be declared static. The
+accepted convention is that driver "xyz" will declare its slave_configure()
+function as:
+ static int xyz_slave_configure(struct scsi_device * sdev);
+and so forth for all interface functions listed below.
+
+A pointer to this function should be placed in the 'slave_configure' member
+of a "struct scsi_host_template" instance. A pointer to such an instance
+should be passed to the mid level's scsi_host_alloc() [or scsi_register() /
+init_this_scsi_driver()].
+
+The interface functions are also described in the include/scsi/scsi_host.h
+file immediately above their definition point in "struct scsi_host_template".
+In some cases more detail is given in scsi_host.h than below.
+
+The interface functions are listed below in alphabetical order.
+
+Summary:
+ bios_param - fetch head, sector, cylinder info for a disk
+ detect - detects HBAs this driver wants to control
+ eh_timed_out - notify the host that a command timer expired
+ eh_abort_handler - abort given command
+ eh_bus_reset_handler - issue SCSI bus reset
+ eh_device_reset_handler - issue SCSI device reset
+ eh_host_reset_handler - reset host (host bus adapter)
+ eh_strategy_handler - driver supplied alternate to scsi_unjam_host()
+ info - supply information about given host
+ ioctl - driver can respond to ioctls
+ proc_info - supports /proc/scsi/{driver_name}/{host_no}
+ queuecommand - queue scsi command, invoke 'done' on completion
+ release - release all resources associated with given host
+ slave_alloc - prior to any commands being sent to a new device
+ slave_configure - driver fine tuning for given device after attach
+ slave_destroy - given device is about to be shut down
+
+
+Details:
+
+/**
+ * bios_param - fetch head, sector, cylinder info for a disk
+ * @sdev: pointer to scsi device context (defined in
+ * include/scsi/scsi_device.h)
+ * @bdev: pointer to block device context (defined in fs.h)
+ * @capacity: device size (in 512 byte sectors)
+ * @params: three element array to place output:
+ * params[0] number of heads (max 255)
+ * params[1] number of sectors (max 63)
+ * params[2] number of cylinders
+ *
+ * Return value is ignored
+ *
+ * Locks: none
+ *
+ * Calling context: process (sd)
+ *
+ * Notes: an arbitrary geometry (based on READ CAPACITY) is used
+ * if this function is not provided. The params array is
+ * pre-initialized with made up values just in case this function
+ * doesn't output anything.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int bios_param(struct scsi_device * sdev, struct block_device *bdev,
+ sector_t capacity, int params[3])
+
+
+/**
+ * detect - detects HBAs this driver wants to control
+ * @shtp: host template for this driver.
+ *
+ * Returns number of hosts this driver wants to control. 0 means no
+ * suitable hosts found.
+ *
+ * Locks: none held
+ *
+ * Calling context: process [invoked from init_this_scsi_driver()]
+ *
+ * Notes: First function called from the SCSI mid level on this
+ * driver. Upper level drivers (e.g. sd) may not (yet) be present.
+ * For each host found, this method should call scsi_register()
+ * [see hosts.c].
+ *
+ * Defined in: LLD (required if "passive initialization mode" is used,
+ * not invoked in "hotplug initialization mode")
+ **/
+ int detect(struct scsi_host_template * shtp)
+
+
+/**
+ * eh_timed_out - The timer for the command has just fired
+ * @scp: identifies command timing out
+ *
+ * Returns:
+ *
+ * EH_HANDLED: I fixed the error, please complete the command
+ * EH_RESET_TIMER: I need more time, reset the timer and
+ * begin counting again
+ * EH_NOT_HANDLED Begin normal error recovery
+ *
+ *
+ * Locks: None held
+ *
+ * Calling context: interrupt
+ *
+ * Notes: This is to give the LLD an opportunity to do local recovery.
+ * This recovery is limited to determining if the outstanding command
+ * will ever complete. You may not abort and restart the command from
+ * this callback.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int eh_timed_out(struct scsi_cmnd * scp)
+
+
+/**
+ * eh_abort_handler - abort command associated with scp
+ * @scp: identifies command to be aborted
+ *
+ * Returns SUCCESS if command aborted else FAILED
+ *
+ * Locks: struct Scsi_Host::host_lock held (with irqsave) on entry
+ * and assumed to be held on return.
+ *
+ * Calling context: kernel thread
+ *
+ * Notes: Invoked from scsi_eh thread. No other commands will be
+ * queued on current host during eh.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int eh_abort_handler(struct scsi_cmnd * scp)
+
+
+/**
+ * eh_bus_reset_handler - issue SCSI bus reset
+ * @scp: SCSI bus that contains this device should be reset
+ *
+ * Returns SUCCESS if command aborted else FAILED
+ *
+ * Locks: struct Scsi_Host::host_lock held (with irqsave) on entry
+ * and assumed to be held on return.
+ *
+ * Calling context: kernel thread
+ *
+ * Notes: Invoked from scsi_eh thread. No other commands will be
+ * queued on current host during eh.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int eh_bus_reset_handler(struct scsi_cmnd * scp)
+
+
+/**
+ * eh_device_reset_handler - issue SCSI device reset
+ * @scp: identifies SCSI device to be reset
+ *
+ * Returns SUCCESS if command aborted else FAILED
+ *
+ * Locks: struct Scsi_Host::host_lock held (with irqsave) on entry
+ * and assumed to be held on return.
+ *
+ * Calling context: kernel thread
+ *
+ * Notes: Invoked from scsi_eh thread. No other commands will be
+ * queued on current host during eh.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int eh_device_reset_handler(struct scsi_cmnd * scp)
+
+
+/**
+ * eh_host_reset_handler - reset host (host bus adapter)
+ * @scp: SCSI host that contains this device should be reset
+ *
+ * Returns SUCCESS if command aborted else FAILED
+ *
+ * Locks: struct Scsi_Host::host_lock held (with irqsave) on entry
+ * and assumed to be held on return.
+ *
+ * Calling context: kernel thread
+ *
+ * Notes: Invoked from scsi_eh thread. No other commands will be
+ * queued on current host during eh.
+ * With the default eh_strategy in place, if none of the _abort_,
+ * _device_reset_, _bus_reset_ or this eh handler function are
+ * defined (or they all return FAILED) then the device in question
+ * will be set offline whenever eh is invoked.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int eh_host_reset_handler(struct scsi_cmnd * scp)
+
+
+/**
+ * eh_strategy_handler - driver supplied alternate to scsi_unjam_host()
+ * @shp: host on which error has occurred
+ *
+ * Returns TRUE if host unjammed, else FALSE.
+ *
+ * Locks: none
+ *
+ * Calling context: kernel thread
+ *
+ * Notes: Invoked from scsi_eh thread. LLD supplied alternate to
+ * scsi_unjam_host() found in scsi_error.c
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int eh_strategy_handler(struct Scsi_Host * shp)
+
+
+/**
+ * info - supply information about given host: driver name plus data
+ * to distinguish given host
+ * @shp: host to supply information about
+ *
+ * Return ASCII null terminated string. [This driver is assumed to
+ * manage the memory pointed to and maintain it, typically for the
+ * lifetime of this host.]
+ *
+ * Locks: none
+ *
+ * Calling context: process
+ *
+ * Notes: Often supplies PCI or ISA information such as IO addresses
+ * and interrupt numbers. If not supplied struct Scsi_Host::name used
+ * instead. It is assumed the returned information fits on one line
+ * (i.e. does not included embedded newlines).
+ * The SCSI_IOCTL_PROBE_HOST ioctl yields the string returned by this
+ * function (or struct Scsi_Host::name if this function is not
+ * available).
+ * In a similar manner, init_this_scsi_driver() outputs to the console
+ * each host's "info" (or name) for the driver it is registering.
+ * Also if proc_info() is not supplied, the output of this function
+ * is used instead.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ const char * info(struct Scsi_Host * shp)
+
+
+/**
+ * ioctl - driver can respond to ioctls
+ * @sdp: device that ioctl was issued for
+ * @cmd: ioctl number
+ * @arg: pointer to read or write data from. Since it points to
+ * user space, should use appropriate kernel functions
+ * (e.g. copy_from_user() ). In the Unix style this argument
+ * can also be viewed as an unsigned long.
+ *
+ * Returns negative "errno" value when there is a problem. 0 or a
+ * positive value indicates success and is returned to the user space.
+ *
+ * Locks: none
+ *
+ * Calling context: process
+ *
+ * Notes: The SCSI subsystem uses a "trickle down" ioctl model.
+ * The user issues an ioctl() against an upper level driver
+ * (e.g. /dev/sdc) and if the upper level driver doesn't recognize
+ * the 'cmd' then it is passed to the SCSI mid level. If the SCSI
+ * mid level does not recognize it, then the LLD that controls
+ * the device receives the ioctl. According to recent Unix standards
+ * unsupported ioctl() 'cmd' numbers should return -ENOTTY.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int ioctl(struct scsi_device *sdp, int cmd, void *arg)
+
+
+/**
+ * proc_info - supports /proc/scsi/{driver_name}/{host_no}
+ * @buffer: anchor point to output to (0==writeto1_read0) or fetch from
+ * (1==writeto1_read0).
+ * @start: where "interesting" data is written to. Ignored when
+ * 1==writeto1_read0.
+ * @offset: offset within buffer 0==writeto1_read0 is actually
+ * interested in. Ignored when 1==writeto1_read0 .
+ * @length: maximum (or actual) extent of buffer
+ * @host_no: host number of interest (struct Scsi_Host::host_no)
+ * @writeto1_read0: 1 -> data coming from user space towards driver
+ * (e.g. "echo some_string > /proc/scsi/xyz/2")
+ * 0 -> user what data from this driver
+ * (e.g. "cat /proc/scsi/xyz/2")
+ *
+ * Returns length when 1==writeto1_read0. Otherwise number of chars
+ * output to buffer past offset.
+ *
+ * Locks: none held
+ *
+ * Calling context: process
+ *
+ * Notes: Driven from scsi_proc.c which interfaces to proc_fs. proc_fs
+ * support can now be configured out of the scsi subsystem.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int proc_info(char * buffer, char ** start, off_t offset,
+ int length, int host_no, int writeto1_read0)
+
+
+/**
+ * queuecommand - queue scsi command, invoke 'done' on completion
+ * @scp: pointer to scsi command object
+ * @done: function pointer to be invoked on completion
+ *
+ * Returns 0 on success.
+ *
+ * If there's a failure, return either:
+ *
+ * SCSI_MLQUEUE_DEVICE_BUSY if the device queue is full, or
+ * SCSI_MLQUEUE_HOST_BUSY if the entire host queue is full
+ *
+ * On both of these returns, the mid-layer will requeue the I/O
+ *
+ * - if the return is SCSI_MLQUEUE_DEVICE_BUSY, only that particular
+ * device will be paused, and it will be unpaused when a command to
+ * the device returns (or after a brief delay if there are no more
+ * outstanding commands to it). Commands to other devices continue
+ * to be processed normally.
+ *
+ * - if the return is SCSI_MLQUEUE_HOST_BUSY, all I/O to the host
+ * is paused and will be unpaused when any command returns from
+ * the host (or after a brief delay if there are no outstanding
+ * commands to the host).
+ *
+ * For compatibility with earlier versions of queuecommand, any
+ * other return value is treated the same as
+ * SCSI_MLQUEUE_HOST_BUSY.
+ *
+ * Other types of errors that are detected immediately may be
+ * flagged by setting scp->result to an appropriate value,
+ * invoking the 'done' callback, and then returning 0 from this
+ * function. If the command is not performed immediately (and the
+ * LLD is starting (or will start) the given command) then this
+ * function should place 0 in scp->result and return 0.
+ *
+ * Command ownership. If the driver returns zero, it owns the
+ * command and must take responsibility for ensuring the 'done'
+ * callback is executed. Note: the driver may call done before
+ * returning zero, but after it has called done, it may not
+ * return any value other than zero. If the driver makes a
+ * non-zero return, it must not execute the command's done
+ * callback at any time.
+ *
+ * Locks: struct Scsi_Host::host_lock held on entry (with "irqsave")
+ * and is expected to be held on return.
+ *
+ * Calling context: in interrupt (soft irq) or process context
+ *
+ * Notes: This function should be relatively fast. Normally it will
+ * not wait for IO to complete. Hence the 'done' callback is invoked
+ * (often directly from an interrupt service routine) some time after
+ * this function has returned. In some cases (e.g. pseudo adapter
+ * drivers that manufacture the response to a SCSI INQUIRY)
+ * the 'done' callback may be invoked before this function returns.
+ * If the 'done' callback is not invoked within a certain period
+ * the SCSI mid level will commence error processing.
+ * If a status of CHECK CONDITION is placed in "result" when the
+ * 'done' callback is invoked, then the LLD driver should
+ * perform autosense and fill in the struct scsi_cmnd::sense_buffer
+ * array. The scsi_cmnd::sense_buffer array is zeroed prior to
+ * the mid level queuing a command to an LLD.
+ *
+ * Defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int queuecommand(struct scsi_cmnd * scp,
+ void (*done)(struct scsi_cmnd *))
+
+
+/**
+ * release - release all resources associated with given host
+ * @shp: host to be released.
+ *
+ * Return value ignored (could soon be a function returning void).
+ *
+ * Locks: none held
+ *
+ * Calling context: process
+ *
+ * Notes: Invoked from scsi_module.c's exit_this_scsi_driver().
+ * LLD's implementation of this function should call
+ * scsi_unregister(shp) prior to returning.
+ * Only needed for old-style host templates.
+ *
+ * Defined in: LLD (required in "passive initialization model",
+ * should not be defined in hotplug model)
+ **/
+ int release(struct Scsi_Host * shp)
+
+
+/**
+ * slave_alloc - prior to any commands being sent to a new device
+ * (i.e. just prior to scan) this call is made
+ * @sdp: pointer to new device (about to be scanned)
+ *
+ * Returns 0 if ok. Any other return is assumed to be an error and
+ * the device is ignored.
+ *
+ * Locks: none
+ *
+ * Calling context: process
+ *
+ * Notes: Allows the driver to allocate any resources for a device
+ * prior to its initial scan. The corresponding scsi device may not
+ * exist but the mid level is just about to scan for it (i.e. send
+ * and INQUIRY command plus ...). If a device is found then
+ * slave_configure() will be called while if a device is not found
+ * slave_destroy() is called.
+ * For more details see the include/scsi/scsi_host.h file.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int slave_alloc(struct scsi_device *sdp)
+
+
+/**
+ * slave_configure - driver fine tuning for given device just after it
+ * has been first scanned (i.e. it responded to an
+ * INQUIRY)
+ * @sdp: device that has just been attached
+ *
+ * Returns 0 if ok. Any other return is assumed to be an error and
+ * the device is taken offline. [offline devices will _not_ have
+ * slave_destroy() called on them so clean up resources.]
+ *
+ * Locks: none
+ *
+ * Calling context: process
+ *
+ * Notes: Allows the driver to inspect the response to the initial
+ * INQUIRY done by the scanning code and take appropriate action.
+ * For more details see the include/scsi/scsi_host.h file.
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ int slave_configure(struct scsi_device *sdp)
+
+
+/**
+ * slave_destroy - given device is about to be shut down. All
+ * activity has ceased on this device.
+ * @sdp: device that is about to be shut down
+ *
+ * Returns nothing
+ *
+ * Locks: none
+ *
+ * Calling context: process
+ *
+ * Notes: Mid level structures for given device are still in place
+ * but are about to be torn down. Any per device resources allocated
+ * by this driver for given device should be freed now. No further
+ * commands will be sent for this sdp instance. [However the device
+ * could be re-attached in the future in which case a new instance
+ * of struct scsi_device would be supplied by future slave_alloc()
+ * and slave_configure() calls.]
+ *
+ * Optionally defined in: LLD
+ **/
+ void slave_destroy(struct scsi_device *sdp)
+
+
+
+Data Structures
+===============
+struct scsi_host_template
+-------------------------
+There is one "struct scsi_host_template" instance per LLD ***. It is
+typically initialized as a file scope static in a driver's header file. That
+way members that are not explicitly initialized will be set to 0 or NULL.
+Member of interest:
+ name - name of driver (may contain spaces, please limit to
+ less than 80 characters)
+ proc_name - name used in "/proc/scsi/<proc_name>/<host_no>" and
+ by sysfs in one of its "drivers" directories. Hence
+ "proc_name" should only contain characters acceptable
+ to a Unix file name.
+ (*queuecommand)() - primary callback that the mid level uses to inject
+ SCSI commands into an LLD.
+The structure is defined and commented in include/scsi/scsi_host.h
+
+*** In extreme situations a single driver may have several instances
+ if it controls several different classes of hardware (e.g. an LLD
+ that handles both ISA and PCI cards and has a separate instance of
+ struct scsi_host_template for each class).
+
+struct Scsi_Host
+----------------
+There is one struct Scsi_Host instance per host (HBA) that an LLD
+controls. The struct Scsi_Host structure has many members in common
+with "struct scsi_host_template". When a new struct Scsi_Host instance
+is created (in scsi_host_alloc() in hosts.c) those common members are
+initialized from the driver's struct scsi_host_template instance. Members
+of interest:
+ host_no - system wide unique number that is used for identifying
+ this host. Issued in ascending order from 0.
+ can_queue - must be greater than 0; do not send more than can_queue
+ commands to the adapter.
+ this_id - scsi id of host (scsi initiator) or -1 if not known
+ sg_tablesize - maximum scatter gather elements allowed by host.
+ 0 implies scatter gather not supported by host
+ max_sectors - maximum number of sectors (usually 512 bytes) allowed
+ in a single SCSI command. The default value of 0 leads
+ to a setting of SCSI_DEFAULT_MAX_SECTORS (defined in
+ scsi_host.h) which is currently set to 1024. So for a
+ disk the maximum transfer size is 512 KB when max_sectors
+ is not defined. Note that this size may not be sufficient
+ for disk firmware uploads.
+ cmd_per_lun - maximum number of commands that can be queued on devices
+ controlled by the host. Overridden by LLD calls to
+ scsi_adjust_queue_depth().
+ unchecked_isa_dma - 1=>only use bottom 16 MB of ram (ISA DMA addressing
+ restriction), 0=>can use full 32 bit (or better) DMA
+ address space
+ use_clustering - 1=>SCSI commands in mid level's queue can be merged,
+ 0=>disallow SCSI command merging
+ hostt - pointer to driver's struct scsi_host_template from which
+ this struct Scsi_Host instance was spawned
+ hostt->proc_name - name of LLD. This is the driver name that sysfs uses
+ transportt - pointer to driver's struct scsi_transport_template instance
+ (if any). FC and SPI transports currently supported.
+ sh_list - a double linked list of pointers to all struct Scsi_Host
+ instances (currently ordered by ascending host_no)
+ my_devices - a double linked list of pointers to struct scsi_device
+ instances that belong to this host.
+ hostdata[0] - area reserved for LLD at end of struct Scsi_Host. Size
+ is set by the second argument (named 'xtr_bytes') to
+ scsi_host_alloc() or scsi_register().
+
+The scsi_host structure is defined in include/scsi/scsi_host.h
+
+struct scsi_device
+------------------
+Generally, there is one instance of this structure for each SCSI logical unit
+on a host. Scsi devices connected to a host are uniquely identified by a
+channel number, target id and logical unit number (lun).
+The structure is defined in include/scsi/scsi_device.h
+
+struct scsi_cmnd
+----------------
+Instances of this structure convey SCSI commands to the LLD and responses
+back to the mid level. The SCSI mid level will ensure that no more SCSI
+commands become queued against the LLD than are indicated by
+scsi_adjust_queue_depth() (or struct Scsi_Host::cmd_per_lun). There will
+be at least one instance of struct scsi_cmnd available for each SCSI device.
+Members of interest:
+ cmnd - array containing SCSI command
+ cmnd_len - length (in bytes) of SCSI command
+ sc_data_direction - direction of data transfer in data phase. See
+ "enum dma_data_direction" in include/linux/dma-mapping.h
+ request_bufflen - number of data bytes to transfer (0 if no data phase)
+ use_sg - ==0 -> no scatter gather list, hence transfer data
+ to/from request_buffer
+ - >0 -> scatter gather list (actually an array) in
+ request_buffer with use_sg elements
+ request_buffer - either contains data buffer or scatter gather list
+ depending on the setting of use_sg. Scatter gather
+ elements are defined by 'struct scatterlist' found
+ in include/asm/scatterlist.h .
+ done - function pointer that should be invoked by LLD when the
+ SCSI command is completed (successfully or otherwise).
+ Should only be called by an LLD if the LLD has accepted
+ the command (i.e. queuecommand() returned or will return
+ 0). The LLD may invoke 'done' prior to queuecommand()
+ finishing.
+ result - should be set by LLD prior to calling 'done'. A value
+ of 0 implies a successfully completed command (and all
+ data (if any) has been transferred to or from the SCSI
+ target device). 'result' is a 32 bit unsigned integer that
+ can be viewed as 4 related bytes. The SCSI status value is
+ in the LSB. See include/scsi/scsi.h status_byte(),
+ msg_byte(), host_byte() and driver_byte() macros and
+ related constants.
+ sense_buffer - an array (maximum size: SCSI_SENSE_BUFFERSIZE bytes) that
+ should be written when the SCSI status (LSB of 'result')
+ is set to CHECK_CONDITION (2). When CHECK_CONDITION is
+ set, if the top nibble of sense_buffer[0] has the value 7
+ then the mid level will assume the sense_buffer array
+ contains a valid SCSI sense buffer; otherwise the mid
+ level will issue a REQUEST_SENSE SCSI command to
+ retrieve the sense buffer. The latter strategy is error
+ prone in the presence of command queuing so the LLD should
+ always "auto-sense".
+ device - pointer to scsi_device object that this command is
+ associated with.
+ resid - an LLD should set this signed integer to the requested
+ transfer length (i.e. 'request_bufflen') less the number
+ of bytes that are actually transferred. 'resid' is
+ preset to 0 so an LLD can ignore it if it cannot detect
+ underruns (overruns should be rare). If possible an LLD
+ should set 'resid' prior to invoking 'done'. The most
+ interesting case is data transfers from a SCSI target
+ device device (i.e. READs) that underrun.
+ underflow - LLD should place (DID_ERROR << 16) in 'result' if
+ actual number of bytes transferred is less than this
+ figure. Not many LLDs implement this check and some that
+ do just output an error message to the log rather than
+ report a DID_ERROR. Better for an LLD to implement
+ 'resid'.
+
+The scsi_cmnd structure is defined in include/scsi/scsi_cmnd.h
+
+
+Locks
+=====
+Each struct Scsi_Host instance has a spin_lock called struct
+Scsi_Host::default_lock which is initialized in scsi_host_alloc() [found in
+hosts.c]. Within the same function the struct Scsi_Host::host_lock pointer
+is initialized to point at default_lock with the scsi_assign_lock() function.
+Thereafter lock and unlock operations performed by the mid level use the
+struct Scsi_Host::host_lock pointer.
+
+LLDs can override the use of struct Scsi_Host::default_lock by
+using scsi_assign_lock(). The earliest opportunity to do this would
+be in the detect() function after it has invoked scsi_register(). It
+could be replaced by a coarser grain lock (e.g. per driver) or a
+lock of equal granularity (i.e. per host). Using finer grain locks
+(e.g. per SCSI device) may be possible by juggling locks in
+queuecommand().
+
+Autosense
+=========
+Autosense (or auto-sense) is defined in the SAM-2 document as "the
+automatic return of sense data to the application client coincident
+with the completion of a SCSI command" when a status of CHECK CONDITION
+occurs. LLDs should perform autosense. This should be done when the LLD
+detects a CHECK CONDITION status by either:
+ a) instructing the SCSI protocol (e.g. SCSI Parallel Interface (SPI))
+ to perform an extra data in phase on such responses
+ b) or, the LLD issuing a REQUEST SENSE command itself
+
+Either way, when a status of CHECK CONDITION is detected, the mid level
+decides whether the LLD has performed autosense by checking struct
+scsi_cmnd::sense_buffer[0] . If this byte has an upper nibble of 7 (or 0xf)
+then autosense is assumed to have taken place. If it has another value (and
+this byte is initialized to 0 before each command) then the mid level will
+issue a REQUEST SENSE command.
+
+In the presence of queued commands the "nexus" that maintains sense
+buffer data from the command that failed until a following REQUEST SENSE
+may get out of synchronization. This is why it is best for the LLD
+to perform autosense.
+
+
+Changes since lk 2.4 series
+===========================
+io_request_lock has been replaced by several finer grained locks. The lock
+relevant to LLDs is struct Scsi_Host::host_lock and there is
+one per SCSI host.
+
+The older error handling mechanism has been removed. This means the
+LLD interface functions abort() and reset() have been removed.
+The struct scsi_host_template::use_new_eh_code flag has been removed.
+
+In the 2.4 series the SCSI subsystem configuration descriptions were
+aggregated with the configuration descriptions from all other Linux
+subsystems in the Documentation/Configure.help file. In the 2.6 series,
+the SCSI subsystem now has its own (much smaller) drivers/scsi/Kconfig
+file that contains both configuration and help information.
+
+struct SHT has been renamed to struct scsi_host_template.
+
+Addition of the "hotplug initialization model" and many extra functions
+to support it.
+
+
+Credits
+=======
+The following people have contributed to this document:
+ Mike Anderson <andmike at us dot ibm dot com>
+ James Bottomley <James dot Bottomley at steeleye dot com>
+ Patrick Mansfield <patmans at us dot ibm dot com>
+ Christoph Hellwig <hch at infradead dot org>
+ Doug Ledford <dledford at redhat dot com>
+ Andries Brouwer <Andries dot Brouwer at cwi dot nl>
+ Randy Dunlap <rddunlap at osdl dot org>
+ Alan Stern <stern at rowland dot harvard dot edu>
+
+
+Douglas Gilbert
+dgilbert at interlog dot com
+21st September 2004
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/st.txt b/Documentation/scsi/st.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..20e30cf31877
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/st.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,499 @@
+This file contains brief information about the SCSI tape driver.
+The driver is currently maintained by Kai Mäkisara (email
+Kai.Makisara@kolumbus.fi)
+
+Last modified: Mon Mar 7 21:14:44 2005 by kai.makisara
+
+
+BASICS
+
+The driver is generic, i.e., it does not contain any code tailored
+to any specific tape drive. The tape parameters can be specified with
+one of the following three methods:
+
+1. Each user can specify the tape parameters he/she wants to use
+directly with ioctls. This is administratively a very simple and
+flexible method and applicable to single-user workstations. However,
+in a multiuser environment the next user finds the tape parameters in
+state the previous user left them.
+
+2. The system manager (root) can define default values for some tape
+parameters, like block size and density using the MTSETDRVBUFFER ioctl.
+These parameters can be programmed to come into effect either when a
+new tape is loaded into the drive or if writing begins at the
+beginning of the tape. The second method is applicable if the tape
+drive performs auto-detection of the tape format well (like some
+QIC-drives). The result is that any tape can be read, writing can be
+continued using existing format, and the default format is used if
+the tape is rewritten from the beginning (or a new tape is written
+for the first time). The first method is applicable if the drive
+does not perform auto-detection well enough and there is a single
+"sensible" mode for the device. An example is a DAT drive that is
+used only in variable block mode (I don't know if this is sensible
+or not :-).
+
+The user can override the parameters defined by the system
+manager. The changes persist until the defaults again come into
+effect.
+
+3. By default, up to four modes can be defined and selected using the minor
+number (bits 5 and 6). The number of modes can be changed by changing
+ST_NBR_MODE_BITS in st.h. Mode 0 corresponds to the defaults discussed
+above. Additional modes are dormant until they are defined by the
+system manager (root). When specification of a new mode is started,
+the configuration of mode 0 is used to provide a starting point for
+definition of the new mode.
+
+Using the modes allows the system manager to give the users choices
+over some of the buffering parameters not directly accessible to the
+users (buffered and asynchronous writes). The modes also allow choices
+between formats in multi-tape operations (the explicitly overridden
+parameters are reset when a new tape is loaded).
+
+If more than one mode is used, all modes should contain definitions
+for the same set of parameters.
+
+Many Unices contain internal tables that associate different modes to
+supported devices. The Linux SCSI tape driver does not contain such
+tables (and will not do that in future). Instead of that, a utility
+program can be made that fetches the inquiry data sent by the device,
+scans its database, and sets up the modes using the ioctls. Another
+alternative is to make a small script that uses mt to set the defaults
+tailored to the system.
+
+The driver supports fixed and variable block size (within buffer
+limits). Both the auto-rewind (minor equals device number) and
+non-rewind devices (minor is 128 + device number) are implemented.
+
+In variable block mode, the byte count in write() determines the size
+of the physical block on tape. When reading, the drive reads the next
+tape block and returns to the user the data if the read() byte count
+is at least the block size. Otherwise, error ENOMEM is returned.
+
+In fixed block mode, the data transfer between the drive and the
+driver is in multiples of the block size. The write() byte count must
+be a multiple of the block size. This is not required when reading but
+may be advisable for portability.
+
+Support is provided for changing the tape partition and partitioning
+of the tape with one or two partitions. By default support for
+partitioned tape is disabled for each driver and it can be enabled
+with the ioctl MTSETDRVBUFFER.
+
+By default the driver writes one filemark when the device is closed after
+writing and the last operation has been a write. Two filemarks can be
+optionally written. In both cases end of data is signified by
+returning zero bytes for two consecutive reads.
+
+If rewind, offline, bsf, or seek is done and previous tape operation was
+write, a filemark is written before moving tape.
+
+The compile options are defined in the file linux/drivers/scsi/st_options.h.
+
+4. If the open option O_NONBLOCK is used, open succeeds even if the
+drive is not ready. If O_NONBLOCK is not used, the driver waits for
+the drive to become ready. If this does not happen in ST_BLOCK_SECONDS
+seconds, open fails with the errno value EIO. With O_NONBLOCK the
+device can be opened for writing even if there is a write protected
+tape in the drive (commands trying to write something return error if
+attempted).
+
+
+MINOR NUMBERS
+
+The tape driver currently supports 128 drives by default. This number
+can be increased by editing st.h and recompiling the driver if
+necessary. The upper limit is 2^17 drives if 4 modes for each drive
+are used.
+
+The minor numbers consist of the following bit fields:
+
+dev_upper non-rew mode dev-lower
+ 20 - 8 7 6 5 4 0
+The non-rewind bit is always bit 7 (the uppermost bit in the lowermost
+byte). The bits defining the mode are below the non-rewind bit. The
+remaining bits define the tape device number. This numbering is
+backward compatible with the numbering used when the minor number was
+only 8 bits wide.
+
+
+SYSFS SUPPORT
+
+The driver creates the directory /sys/class/scsi_tape and populates it with
+directories corresponding to the existing tape devices. There are autorewind
+and non-rewind entries for each mode. The names are stxy and nstxy, where x
+is the tape number and y a character corresponding to the mode (none, l, m,
+a). For example, the directories for the first tape device are (assuming four
+modes): st0 nst0 st0l nst0l st0m nst0m st0a nst0a.
+
+Each directory contains the entries: default_blksize default_compression
+default_density defined dev device driver. The file 'defined' contains 1
+if the mode is defined and zero if not defined. The files 'default_*' contain
+the defaults set by the user. The value -1 means the default is not set. The
+file 'dev' contains the device numbers corresponding to this device. The links
+'device' and 'driver' point to the SCSI device and driver entries.
+
+A link named 'tape' is made from the SCSI device directory to the class
+directory corresponding to the mode 0 auto-rewind device (e.g., st0).
+
+
+BSD AND SYS V SEMANTICS
+
+The user can choose between these two behaviours of the tape driver by
+defining the value of the symbol ST_SYSV. The semantics differ when a
+file being read is closed. The BSD semantics leaves the tape where it
+currently is whereas the SYS V semantics moves the tape past the next
+filemark unless the filemark has just been crossed.
+
+The default is BSD semantics.
+
+
+BUFFERING
+
+The driver tries to do transfers directly to/from user space. If this
+is not possible, a driver buffer allocated at run-time is used. If
+direct i/o is not possible for the whole transfer, the driver buffer
+is used (i.e., bounce buffers for individual pages are not
+used). Direct i/o can be impossible because of several reasons, e.g.:
+- one or more pages are at addresses not reachable by the HBA
+- the number of pages in the transfer exceeds the number of
+ scatter/gather segments permitted by the HBA
+- one or more pages can't be locked into memory (should not happen in
+ any reasonable situation)
+
+The size of the driver buffers is always at least one tape block. In fixed
+block mode, the minimum buffer size is defined (in 1024 byte units) by
+ST_FIXED_BUFFER_BLOCKS. With small block size this allows buffering of
+several blocks and using one SCSI read or write to transfer all of the
+blocks. Buffering of data across write calls in fixed block mode is
+allowed if ST_BUFFER_WRITES is non-zero and direct i/o is not used.
+Buffer allocation uses chunks of memory having sizes 2^n * (page
+size). Because of this the actual buffer size may be larger than the
+minimum allowable buffer size.
+
+NOTE that if direct i/o is used, the small writes are not buffered. This may
+cause a surprise when moving from 2.4. There small writes (e.g., tar without
+-b option) may have had good throughput but this is not true any more with
+2.6. Direct i/o can be turned off to solve this problem but a better solution
+is to use bigger write() byte counts (e.g., tar -b 64).
+
+Asynchronous writing. Writing the buffer contents to the tape is
+started and the write call returns immediately. The status is checked
+at the next tape operation. Asynchronous writes are not done with
+direct i/o and not in fixed block mode.
+
+Buffered writes and asynchronous writes may in some rare cases cause
+problems in multivolume operations if there is not enough space on the
+tape after the early-warning mark to flush the driver buffer.
+
+Read ahead for fixed block mode (ST_READ_AHEAD). Filling the buffer is
+attempted even if the user does not want to get all of the data at
+this read command. Should be disabled for those drives that don't like
+a filemark to truncate a read request or that don't like backspacing.
+
+Scatter/gather buffers (buffers that consist of chunks non-contiguous
+in the physical memory) are used if contiguous buffers can't be
+allocated. To support all SCSI adapters (including those not
+supporting scatter/gather), buffer allocation is using the following
+three kinds of chunks:
+1. The initial segment that is used for all SCSI adapters including
+those not supporting scatter/gather. The size of this buffer will be
+(PAGE_SIZE << ST_FIRST_ORDER) bytes if the system can give a chunk of
+this size (and it is not larger than the buffer size specified by
+ST_BUFFER_BLOCKS). If this size is not available, the driver halves
+the size and tries again until the size of one page. The default
+settings in st_options.h make the driver to try to allocate all of the
+buffer as one chunk.
+2. The scatter/gather segments to fill the specified buffer size are
+allocated so that as many segments as possible are used but the number
+of segments does not exceed ST_FIRST_SG.
+3. The remaining segments between ST_MAX_SG (or the module parameter
+max_sg_segs) and the number of segments used in phases 1 and 2
+are used to extend the buffer at run-time if this is necessary. The
+number of scatter/gather segments allowed for the SCSI adapter is not
+exceeded if it is smaller than the maximum number of scatter/gather
+segments specified. If the maximum number allowed for the SCSI adapter
+is smaller than the number of segments used in phases 1 and 2,
+extending the buffer will always fail.
+
+
+EOM BEHAVIOUR WHEN WRITING
+
+When the end of medium early warning is encountered, the current write
+is finished and the number of bytes is returned. The next write
+returns -1 and errno is set to ENOSPC. To enable writing a trailer,
+the next write is allowed to proceed and, if successful, the number of
+bytes is returned. After this, -1 and the number of bytes are
+alternately returned until the physical end of medium (or some other
+error) is encountered.
+
+
+MODULE PARAMETERS
+
+The buffer size, write threshold, and the maximum number of allocated buffers
+are configurable when the driver is loaded as a module. The keywords are:
+
+buffer_kbs=xxx the buffer size for fixed block mode is set
+ to xxx kilobytes
+write_threshold_kbs=xxx the write threshold in kilobytes set to xxx
+max_sg_segs=xxx the maximum number of scatter/gather
+ segments
+try_direct_io=x try direct transfer between user buffer and
+ tape drive if this is non-zero
+
+Note that if the buffer size is changed but the write threshold is not
+set, the write threshold is set to the new buffer size - 2 kB.
+
+
+BOOT TIME CONFIGURATION
+
+If the driver is compiled into the kernel, the same parameters can be
+also set using, e.g., the LILO command line. The preferred syntax is
+is to use the same keyword used when loading as module but prepended
+with 'st.'. For instance, to set the maximum number of scatter/gather
+segments, the parameter 'st.max_sg_segs=xx' should be used (xx is the
+number of scatter/gather segments).
+
+For compatibility, the old syntax from early 2.5 and 2.4 kernel
+versions is supported. The same keywords can be used as when loading
+the driver as module. If several parameters are set, the keyword-value
+pairs are separated with a comma (no spaces allowed). A colon can be
+used instead of the equal mark. The definition is prepended by the
+string st=. Here is an example:
+
+ st=buffer_kbs:64,write_threhold_kbs:60
+
+The following syntax used by the old kernel versions is also supported:
+
+ st=aa[,bb[,dd]]
+
+where
+ aa is the buffer size for fixed block mode in 1024 byte units
+ bb is the write threshold in 1024 byte units
+ dd is the maximum number of scatter/gather segments
+
+
+IOCTLS
+
+The tape is positioned and the drive parameters are set with ioctls
+defined in mtio.h The tape control program 'mt' uses these ioctls. Try
+to find an mt that supports all of the Linux SCSI tape ioctls and
+opens the device for writing if the tape contents will be modified
+(look for a package mt-st* from the Linux ftp sites; the GNU mt does
+not open for writing for, e.g., erase).
+
+The supported ioctls are:
+
+The following use the structure mtop:
+
+MTFSF Space forward over count filemarks. Tape positioned after filemark.
+MTFSFM As above but tape positioned before filemark.
+MTBSF Space backward over count filemarks. Tape positioned before
+ filemark.
+MTBSFM As above but ape positioned after filemark.
+MTFSR Space forward over count records.
+MTBSR Space backward over count records.
+MTFSS Space forward over count setmarks.
+MTBSS Space backward over count setmarks.
+MTWEOF Write count filemarks.
+MTWSM Write count setmarks.
+MTREW Rewind tape.
+MTOFFL Set device off line (often rewind plus eject).
+MTNOP Do nothing except flush the buffers.
+MTRETEN Re-tension tape.
+MTEOM Space to end of recorded data.
+MTERASE Erase tape. If the argument is zero, the short erase command
+ is used. The long erase command is used with all other values
+ of the argument.
+MTSEEK Seek to tape block count. Uses Tandberg-compatible seek (QFA)
+ for SCSI-1 drives and SCSI-2 seek for SCSI-2 drives. The file and
+ block numbers in the status are not valid after a seek.
+MTSETBLK Set the drive block size. Setting to zero sets the drive into
+ variable block mode (if applicable).
+MTSETDENSITY Sets the drive density code to arg. See drive
+ documentation for available codes.
+MTLOCK and MTUNLOCK Explicitly lock/unlock the tape drive door.
+MTLOAD and MTUNLOAD Explicitly load and unload the tape. If the
+ command argument x is between MT_ST_HPLOADER_OFFSET + 1 and
+ MT_ST_HPLOADER_OFFSET + 6, the number x is used sent to the
+ drive with the command and it selects the tape slot to use of
+ HP C1553A changer.
+MTCOMPRESSION Sets compressing or uncompressing drive mode using the
+ SCSI mode page 15. Note that some drives other methods for
+ control of compression. Some drives (like the Exabytes) use
+ density codes for compression control. Some drives use another
+ mode page but this page has not been implemented in the
+ driver. Some drives without compression capability will accept
+ any compression mode without error.
+MTSETPART Moves the tape to the partition given by the argument at the
+ next tape operation. The block at which the tape is positioned
+ is the block where the tape was previously positioned in the
+ new active partition unless the next tape operation is
+ MTSEEK. In this case the tape is moved directly to the block
+ specified by MTSEEK. MTSETPART is inactive unless
+ MT_ST_CAN_PARTITIONS set.
+MTMKPART Formats the tape with one partition (argument zero) or two
+ partitions (the argument gives in megabytes the size of
+ partition 1 that is physically the first partition of the
+ tape). The drive has to support partitions with size specified
+ by the initiator. Inactive unless MT_ST_CAN_PARTITIONS set.
+MTSETDRVBUFFER
+ Is used for several purposes. The command is obtained from count
+ with mask MT_SET_OPTIONS, the low order bits are used as argument.
+ This command is only allowed for the superuser (root). The
+ subcommands are:
+ 0
+ The drive buffer option is set to the argument. Zero means
+ no buffering.
+ MT_ST_BOOLEANS
+ Sets the buffering options. The bits are the new states
+ (enabled/disabled) the following options (in the
+ parenthesis is specified whether the option is global or
+ can be specified differently for each mode):
+ MT_ST_BUFFER_WRITES write buffering (mode)
+ MT_ST_ASYNC_WRITES asynchronous writes (mode)
+ MT_ST_READ_AHEAD read ahead (mode)
+ MT_ST_TWO_FM writing of two filemarks (global)
+ MT_ST_FAST_EOM using the SCSI spacing to EOD (global)
+ MT_ST_AUTO_LOCK automatic locking of the drive door (global)
+ MT_ST_DEF_WRITES the defaults are meant only for writes (mode)
+ MT_ST_CAN_BSR backspacing over more than one records can
+ be used for repositioning the tape (global)
+ MT_ST_NO_BLKLIMS the driver does not ask the block limits
+ from the drive (block size can be changed only to
+ variable) (global)
+ MT_ST_CAN_PARTITIONS enables support for partitioned
+ tapes (global)
+ MT_ST_SCSI2LOGICAL the logical block number is used in
+ the MTSEEK and MTIOCPOS for SCSI-2 drives instead of
+ the device dependent address. It is recommended to set
+ this flag unless there are tapes using the device
+ dependent (from the old times) (global)
+ MT_ST_SYSV sets the SYSV sematics (mode)
+ MT_ST_NOWAIT enables immediate mode (i.e., don't wait for
+ the command to finish) for some commands (e.g., rewind)
+ MT_ST_DEBUGGING debugging (global; debugging must be
+ compiled into the driver)
+ MT_ST_SETBOOLEANS
+ MT_ST_CLEARBOOLEANS
+ Sets or clears the option bits.
+ MT_ST_WRITE_THRESHOLD
+ Sets the write threshold for this device to kilobytes
+ specified by the lowest bits.
+ MT_ST_DEF_BLKSIZE
+ Defines the default block size set automatically. Value
+ 0xffffff means that the default is not used any more.
+ MT_ST_DEF_DENSITY
+ MT_ST_DEF_DRVBUFFER
+ Used to set or clear the density (8 bits), and drive buffer
+ state (3 bits). If the value is MT_ST_CLEAR_DEFAULT
+ (0xfffff) the default will not be used any more. Otherwise
+ the lowermost bits of the value contain the new value of
+ the parameter.
+ MT_ST_DEF_COMPRESSION
+ The compression default will not be used if the value of
+ the lowermost byte is 0xff. Otherwise the lowermost bit
+ contains the new default. If the bits 8-15 are set to a
+ non-zero number, and this number is not 0xff, the number is
+ used as the compression algorithm. The value
+ MT_ST_CLEAR_DEFAULT can be used to clear the compression
+ default.
+ MT_ST_SET_TIMEOUT
+ Set the normal timeout in seconds for this device. The
+ default is 900 seconds (15 minutes). The timeout should be
+ long enough for the retries done by the device while
+ reading/writing.
+ MT_ST_SET_LONG_TIMEOUT
+ Set the long timeout that is used for operations that are
+ known to take a long time. The default is 14000 seconds
+ (3.9 hours). For erase this value is further multiplied by
+ eight.
+ MT_ST_SET_CLN
+ Set the cleaning request interpretation parameters using
+ the lowest 24 bits of the argument. The driver can set the
+ generic status bit GMT_CLN if a cleaning request bit pattern
+ is found from the extended sense data. Many drives set one or
+ more bits in the extended sense data when the drive needs
+ cleaning. The bits are device-dependent. The driver is
+ given the number of the sense data byte (the lowest eight
+ bits of the argument; must be >= 18 (values 1 - 17
+ reserved) and <= the maximum requested sense data sixe),
+ a mask to select the relevant bits (the bits 9-16), and the
+ bit pattern (bits 17-23). If the bit pattern is zero, one
+ or more bits under the mask indicate cleaning request. If
+ the pattern is non-zero, the pattern must match the masked
+ sense data byte.
+
+ (The cleaning bit is set if the additional sense code and
+ qualifier 00h 17h are seen regardless of the setting of
+ MT_ST_SET_CLN.)
+
+The following ioctl uses the structure mtpos:
+MTIOCPOS Reads the current position from the drive. Uses
+ Tandberg-compatible QFA for SCSI-1 drives and the SCSI-2
+ command for the SCSI-2 drives.
+
+The following ioctl uses the structure mtget to return the status:
+MTIOCGET Returns some status information.
+ The file number and block number within file are returned. The
+ block is -1 when it can't be determined (e.g., after MTBSF).
+ The drive type is either MTISSCSI1 or MTISSCSI2.
+ The number of recovered errors since the previous status call
+ is stored in the lower word of the field mt_erreg.
+ The current block size and the density code are stored in the field
+ mt_dsreg (shifts for the subfields are MT_ST_BLKSIZE_SHIFT and
+ MT_ST_DENSITY_SHIFT).
+ The GMT_xxx status bits reflect the drive status. GMT_DR_OPEN
+ is set if there is no tape in the drive. GMT_EOD means either
+ end of recorded data or end of tape. GMT_EOT means end of tape.
+
+
+MISCELLANEOUS COMPILE OPTIONS
+
+The recovered write errors are considered fatal if ST_RECOVERED_WRITE_FATAL
+is defined.
+
+The maximum number of tape devices is determined by the define
+ST_MAX_TAPES. If more tapes are detected at driver initialization, the
+maximum is adjusted accordingly.
+
+Immediate return from tape positioning SCSI commands can be enabled by
+defining ST_NOWAIT. If this is defined, the user should take care that
+the next tape operation is not started before the previous one has
+finished. The drives and SCSI adapters should handle this condition
+gracefully, but some drive/adapter combinations are known to hang the
+SCSI bus in this case.
+
+The MTEOM command is by default implemented as spacing over 32767
+filemarks. With this method the file number in the status is
+correct. The user can request using direct spacing to EOD by setting
+ST_FAST_EOM 1 (or using the MT_ST_OPTIONS ioctl). In this case the file
+number will be invalid.
+
+When using read ahead or buffered writes the position within the file
+may not be correct after the file is closed (correct position may
+require backspacing over more than one record). The correct position
+within file can be obtained if ST_IN_FILE_POS is defined at compile
+time or the MT_ST_CAN_BSR bit is set for the drive with an ioctl.
+(The driver always backs over a filemark crossed by read ahead if the
+user does not request data that far.)
+
+
+DEBUGGING HINTS
+
+To enable debugging messages, edit st.c and #define DEBUG 1. As seen
+above, debugging can be switched off with an ioctl if debugging is
+compiled into the driver. The debugging output is not voluminous.
+
+If the tape seems to hang, I would be very interested to hear where
+the driver is waiting. With the command 'ps -l' you can see the state
+of the process using the tape. If the state is D, the process is
+waiting for something. The field WCHAN tells where the driver is
+waiting. If you have the current System.map in the correct place (in
+/boot for the procps I use) or have updated /etc/psdatabase (for kmem
+ps), ps writes the function name in the WCHAN field. If not, you have
+to look up the function from System.map.
+
+Note also that the timeouts are very long compared to most other
+drivers. This means that the Linux driver may appear hung although the
+real reason is that the tape firmware has got confused.
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/sym53c500_cs.txt b/Documentation/scsi/sym53c500_cs.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..75febcf9298c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/sym53c500_cs.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+The sym53c500_cs driver originated as an add-on to David Hinds' pcmcia-cs
+package, and was written by Tom Corner (tcorner@via.at). A rewrite was
+long overdue, and the current version addresses the following concerns:
+
+ (1) extensive kernel changes between 2.4 and 2.6.
+ (2) deprecated PCMCIA support outside the kernel.
+
+All the USE_BIOS code has been ripped out. It was never used, and could
+not have worked anyway. The USE_DMA code is likewise gone. Many thanks
+to YOKOTA Hiroshi (nsp_cs driver) and David Hinds (qlogic_cs driver) for
+the code fragments I shamelessly adapted for this work. Thanks also to
+Christoph Hellwig for his patient tutelage while I stumbled about.
+
+The Symbios Logic 53c500 chip was used in the "newer" (circa 1997) version
+of the New Media Bus Toaster PCMCIA SCSI controller. Presumably there are
+other products using this chip, but I've never laid eyes (much less hands)
+on one.
+
+Through the years, there have been a number of downloads of the pcmcia-cs
+version of this driver, and I guess it worked for those users. It worked
+for Tom Corner, and it works for me. Your mileage will probably vary.
+
+--Bob Tracy (rct@frus.com)
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/sym53c8xx_2.txt b/Documentation/scsi/sym53c8xx_2.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..7f516cdcd262
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/sym53c8xx_2.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,1059 @@
+The Linux SYM-2 driver documentation file
+
+Written by Gerard Roudier <groudier@free.fr>
+21 Rue Carnot
+95170 DEUIL LA BARRE - FRANCE
+
+Updated by Matthew Wilcox <matthew@wil.cx>
+
+2004-10-09
+===============================================================================
+
+1. Introduction
+2. Supported chips and SCSI features
+3. Advantages of this driver for newer chips.
+ 3.1 Optimized SCSI SCRIPTS
+ 3.2 New features appeared with the SYM53C896
+4. Memory mapped I/O versus normal I/O
+5. Tagged command queueing
+6. Parity checking
+7. Profiling information
+8. Control commands
+ 8.1 Set minimum synchronous period
+ 8.2 Set wide size
+ 8.3 Set maximum number of concurrent tagged commands
+ 8.4 Set debug mode
+ 8.5 Set flag (no_disc)
+ 8.6 Set verbose level
+ 8.7 Reset all logical units of a target
+ 8.8 Abort all tasks of all logical units of a target
+9. Configuration parameters
+10. Boot setup commands
+ 10.1 Syntax
+ 10.2 Available arguments
+ 10.2.1 Default number of tagged commands
+ 10.2.2 Burst max
+ 10.2.3 LED support
+ 10.2.4 Differential mode
+ 10.2.5 IRQ mode
+ 10.2.6 Check SCSI BUS
+ 10.2.7 Suggest a default SCSI id for hosts
+ 10.2.8 Verbosity level
+ 10.2.9 Debug mode
+ 10.2.10 Settle delay
+ 10.2.11 Serial NVRAM
+ 10.2.12 Exclude a host from being attached
+ 10.3 Converting from old options
+ 10.4 SCSI BUS checking boot option
+11. SCSI problem troubleshooting
+ 15.1 Problem tracking
+ 15.2 Understanding hardware error reports
+12. Serial NVRAM support (by Richard Waltham)
+ 17.1 Features
+ 17.2 Symbios NVRAM layout
+ 17.3 Tekram NVRAM layout
+
+===============================================================================
+
+1. Introduction
+
+This driver supports the whole SYM53C8XX family of PCI-SCSI controllers.
+It also support the subset of LSI53C10XX PCI-SCSI controllers that are based
+on the SYM53C8XX SCRIPTS language.
+
+It replaces the sym53c8xx+ncr53c8xx driver bundle and shares its core code
+with the FreeBSD SYM-2 driver. The `glue' that allows this driver to work
+under Linux is contained in 2 files named sym_glue.h and sym_glue.c.
+Other drivers files are intended not to depend on the Operating System
+on which the driver is used.
+
+The history of this driver can be summerized as follows:
+
+1993: ncr driver written for 386bsd and FreeBSD by:
+ Wolfgang Stanglmeier <wolf@cologne.de>
+ Stefan Esser <se@mi.Uni-Koeln.de>
+
+1996: port of the ncr driver to Linux-1.2.13 and rename it ncr53c8xx.
+ Gerard Roudier
+
+1998: new sym53c8xx driver for Linux based on LOAD/STORE instruction and that
+ adds full support for the 896 but drops support for early NCR devices.
+ Gerard Roudier
+
+1999: port of the sym53c8xx driver to FreeBSD and support for the LSI53C1010
+ 33 MHz and 66MHz Ultra-3 controllers. The new driver is named `sym'.
+ Gerard Roudier
+
+2000: Add support for early NCR devices to FreeBSD `sym' driver.
+ Break the driver into several sources and separate the OS glue
+ code from the core code that can be shared among different O/Ses.
+ Write a glue code for Linux.
+ Gerard Roudier
+
+2004: Remove FreeBSD compatibility code. Remove support for versions of
+ Linux before 2.6. Start using Linux facilities.
+
+This README file addresses the Linux version of the driver. Under FreeBSD,
+the driver documentation is the sym.8 man page.
+
+Information about new chips is available at LSILOGIC web server:
+
+ http://www.lsilogic.com/
+
+SCSI standard documentations are available at T10 site:
+
+ http://www.t10.org/
+
+Useful SCSI tools written by Eric Youngdale are part of most Linux
+distributions:
+ scsiinfo: command line tool
+ scsi-config: TCL/Tk tool using scsiinfo
+
+2. Supported chips and SCSI features
+
+The following features are supported for all chips:
+
+ Synchronous negotiation
+ Disconnection
+ Tagged command queuing
+ SCSI parity checking
+ PCI Master parity checking
+
+Other features depends on chip capabilities.
+The driver notably uses optimized SCRIPTS for devices that support
+LOAD/STORE and handles PHASE MISMATCH from SCRIPTS for devices that
+support the corresponding feature.
+
+The following table shows some characteristics of the chip family.
+
+ On board LOAD/STORE HARDWARE
+Chip SDMS BIOS Wide SCSI std. Max. sync SCRIPTS PHASE MISMATCH
+---- --------- ---- --------- ---------- ---------- --------------
+810 N N FAST10 10 MB/s N N
+810A N N FAST10 10 MB/s Y N
+815 Y N FAST10 10 MB/s N N
+825 Y Y FAST10 20 MB/s N N
+825A Y Y FAST10 20 MB/s Y N
+860 N N FAST20 20 MB/s Y N
+875 Y Y FAST20 40 MB/s Y N
+875A Y Y FAST20 40 MB/s Y Y
+876 Y Y FAST20 40 MB/s Y N
+895 Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y N
+895A Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+896 Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+897 Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+1510D Y Y FAST40 80 MB/s Y Y
+1010 Y Y FAST80 160 MB/s Y Y
+1010_66* Y Y FAST80 160 MB/s Y Y
+
+* Chip supports 33MHz and 66MHz PCI bus clock.
+
+
+Summary of other supported features:
+
+Module: allow to load the driver
+Memory mapped I/O: increases performance
+Control commands: write operations to the proc SCSI file system
+Debugging information: written to syslog (expert only)
+Scatter / gather
+Shared interrupt
+Boot setup commands
+Serial NVRAM: Symbios and Tekram formats
+
+
+3. Advantages of this driver for newer chips.
+
+3.1 Optimized SCSI SCRIPTS.
+
+All chips except the 810, 815 and 825, support new SCSI SCRIPTS instructions
+named LOAD and STORE that allow to move up to 1 DWORD from/to an IO register
+to/from memory much faster that the MOVE MEMORY instruction that is supported
+by the 53c7xx and 53c8xx family.
+
+The LOAD/STORE instructions support absolute and DSA relative addressing
+modes. The SCSI SCRIPTS had been entirely rewritten using LOAD/STORE instead
+of MOVE MEMORY instructions.
+
+Due to the lack of LOAD/STORE SCRIPTS instructions by earlier chips, this
+driver also incorporates a different SCRIPTS set based on MEMORY MOVE, in
+order to provide support for the entire SYM53C8XX chips family.
+
+3.2 New features appeared with the SYM53C896
+
+Newer chips (see above) allows handling of the phase mismatch context from
+SCRIPTS (avoids the phase mismatch interrupt that stops the SCSI processor
+until the C code has saved the context of the transfer).
+
+The 896 and 1010 chips support 64 bit PCI transactions and addressing,
+while the 895A supports 32 bit PCI transactions and 64 bit addressing.
+The SCRIPTS processor of these chips is not true 64 bit, but uses segment
+registers for bit 32-63. Another interesting feature is that LOAD/STORE
+instructions that address the on-chip RAM (8k) remain internal to the chip.
+
+4. Memory mapped I/O versus normal I/O
+
+Memory mapped I/O has less latency than normal I/O and is the recommended
+way for doing IO with PCI devices. Memory mapped I/O seems to work fine on
+most hardware configurations, but some poorly designed chipsets may break
+this feature. A configuration option is provided for normal I/O to be
+used but the driver defaults to MMIO.
+
+5. Tagged command queueing
+
+Queuing more than 1 command at a time to a device allows it to perform
+optimizations based on actual head positions and its mechanical
+characteristics. This feature may also reduce average command latency.
+In order to really gain advantage of this feature, devices must have
+a reasonable cache size (No miracle is to be expected for a low-end
+hard disk with 128 KB or less).
+Some kown old SCSI devices do not properly support tagged command queuing.
+Generally, firmware revisions that fix this kind of problems are available
+at respective vendor web/ftp sites.
+All I can say is that I never have had problem with tagged queuing using
+this driver and its predecessors. Hard disks that behaved correctly for
+me using tagged commands are the following:
+
+- IBM S12 0662
+- Conner 1080S
+- Quantum Atlas I
+- Quantum Atlas II
+- Seagate Cheetah I
+- Quantum Viking II
+- IBM DRVS
+- Quantum Atlas IV
+- Seagate Cheetah II
+
+If your controller has NVRAM, you can configure this feature per target
+from the user setup tool. The Tekram Setup program allows to tune the
+maximum number of queued commands up to 32. The Symbios Setup only allows
+to enable or disable this feature.
+
+The maximum number of simultaneous tagged commands queued to a device
+is currently set to 16 by default. This value is suitable for most SCSI
+disks. With large SCSI disks (>= 2GB, cache >= 512KB, average seek time
+<= 10 ms), using a larger value may give better performances.
+
+This driver supports up to 255 commands per device, and but using more than
+64 is generally not worth-while, unless you are using a very large disk or
+disk arrays. It is noticeable that most of recent hard disks seem not to
+accept more than 64 simultaneous commands. So, using more than 64 queued
+commands is probably just resource wasting.
+
+If your controller does not have NVRAM or if it is managed by the SDMS
+BIOS/SETUP, you can configure tagged queueing feature and device queue
+depths from the boot command-line. For example:
+
+ sym53c8xx=tags:4/t2t3q15-t4q7/t1u0q32
+
+will set tagged commands queue depths as follow:
+
+- target 2 all luns on controller 0 --> 15
+- target 3 all luns on controller 0 --> 15
+- target 4 all luns on controller 0 --> 7
+- target 1 lun 0 on controller 1 --> 32
+- all other target/lun --> 4
+
+In some special conditions, some SCSI disk firmwares may return a
+QUEUE FULL status for a SCSI command. This behaviour is managed by the
+driver using the following heuristic:
+
+- Each time a QUEUE FULL status is returned, tagged queue depth is reduced
+ to the actual number of disconnected commands.
+
+- Every 200 successfully completed SCSI commands, if allowed by the
+ current limit, the maximum number of queueable commands is incremented.
+
+Since QUEUE FULL status reception and handling is resource wasting, the
+driver notifies by default this problem to user by indicating the actual
+number of commands used and their status, as well as its decision on the
+device queue depth change.
+The heuristic used by the driver in handling QUEUE FULL ensures that the
+impact on performances is not too bad. You can get rid of the messages by
+setting verbose level to zero, as follow:
+
+1st method: boot your system using 'sym53c8xx=verb:0' option.
+2nd method: apply "setverbose 0" control command to the proc fs entry
+ corresponding to your controller after boot-up.
+
+6. Parity checking
+
+The driver supports SCSI parity checking and PCI bus master parity
+checking. These features must be enabled in order to ensure safe
+data transfers. Some flawed devices or mother boards may have problems
+with parity. The options to defeat parity checking have been removed
+from the driver.
+
+7. Profiling information
+
+This driver does not provide profiling informations as did its predecessors.
+This feature was not this useful and added complexity to the code.
+As the driver code got more complex, I have decided to remove everything
+that didn't seem actually useful.
+
+8. Control commands
+
+Control commands can be sent to the driver with write operations to
+the proc SCSI file system. The generic command syntax is the
+following:
+
+ echo "<verb> <parameters>" >/proc/scsi/sym53c8xx/0
+ (assumes controller number is 0)
+
+Using "all" for "<target>" parameter with the commands below will
+apply to all targets of the SCSI chain (except the controller).
+
+Available commands:
+
+8.1 Set minimum synchronous period factor
+
+ setsync <target> <period factor>
+
+ target: target number
+ period: minimum synchronous period.
+ Maximum speed = 1000/(4*period factor) except for special
+ cases below.
+
+ Specify a period of 0, to force asynchronous transfer mode.
+
+ 9 means 12.5 nano-seconds synchronous period
+ 10 means 25 nano-seconds synchronous period
+ 11 means 30 nano-seconds synchronous period
+ 12 means 50 nano-seconds synchronous period
+
+8.2 Set wide size
+
+ setwide <target> <size>
+
+ target: target number
+ size: 0=8 bits, 1=16bits
+
+8.3 Set maximum number of concurrent tagged commands
+
+ settags <target> <tags>
+
+ target: target number
+ tags: number of concurrent tagged commands
+ must not be greater than configured (default: 16)
+
+8.4 Set debug mode
+
+ setdebug <list of debug flags>
+
+ Available debug flags:
+ alloc: print info about memory allocations (ccb, lcb)
+ queue: print info about insertions into the command start queue
+ result: print sense data on CHECK CONDITION status
+ scatter: print info about the scatter process
+ scripts: print info about the script binding process
+ tiny: print minimal debugging information
+ timing: print timing information of the NCR chip
+ nego: print information about SCSI negotiations
+ phase: print information on script interruptions
+
+ Use "setdebug" with no argument to reset debug flags.
+
+
+8.5 Set flag (no_disc)
+
+ setflag <target> <flag>
+
+ target: target number
+
+ For the moment, only one flag is available:
+
+ no_disc: not allow target to disconnect.
+
+ Do not specify any flag in order to reset the flag. For example:
+ - setflag 4
+ will reset no_disc flag for target 4, so will allow it disconnections.
+ - setflag all
+ will allow disconnection for all devices on the SCSI bus.
+
+
+8.6 Set verbose level
+
+ setverbose #level
+
+ The driver default verbose level is 1. This command allows to change
+ th driver verbose level after boot-up.
+
+8.7 Reset all logical units of a target
+
+ resetdev <target>
+
+ target: target number
+ The driver will try to send a BUS DEVICE RESET message to the target.
+
+8.8 Abort all tasks of all logical units of a target
+
+ cleardev <target>
+
+ target: target number
+ The driver will try to send a ABORT message to all the logical units
+ of the target.
+
+
+9. Configuration parameters
+
+Under kernel configuration tools (make menuconfig, for example), it is
+possible to change some default driver configuration parameters.
+If the firmware of all your devices is perfect enough, all the
+features supported by the driver can be enabled at start-up. However,
+if only one has a flaw for some SCSI feature, you can disable the
+support by the driver of this feature at linux start-up and enable
+this feature after boot-up only for devices that support it safely.
+
+Configuration parameters:
+
+Use normal IO (default answer: n)
+ Answer "y" if you suspect your mother board to not allow memory mapped I/O.
+ May slow down performance a little.
+
+Default tagged command queue depth (default answer: 16)
+ Entering 0 defaults to tagged commands not being used.
+ This parameter can be specified from the boot command line.
+
+Maximum number of queued commands (default answer: 32)
+ This option allows you to specify the maximum number of tagged commands
+ that can be queued to a device. The maximum supported value is 255.
+
+Synchronous transfers frequency (default answer: 80)
+ This option allows you to specify the frequency in MHz the driver
+ will use at boot time for synchronous data transfer negotiations.
+ 0 means "asynchronous data transfers".
+
+10. Boot setup commands
+
+10.1 Syntax
+
+Setup commands can be passed to the driver either at boot time or as
+parameters to modprobe, as described in Documentation/kernel-parameters.txt
+
+Example of boot setup command under lilo prompt:
+
+lilo: linux root=/dev/sda2 sym53c8xx.cmd_per_lun=4 sym53c8xx.sync=10 sym53c8xx.debug=0x200
+
+- enable tagged commands, up to 4 tagged commands queued.
+- set synchronous negotiation speed to 10 Mega-transfers / second.
+- set DEBUG_NEGO flag.
+
+The following command will install the driver module with the same
+options as above.
+
+ modprobe sym53c8xx cmd_per_lun=4 sync=10 debug=0x200
+
+10.2 Available arguments
+
+10.2.1 Default number of tagged commands
+ cmd_per_lun=0 (or cmd_per_lun=1) tagged command queuing disabled
+ cmd_per_lun=#tags (#tags > 1) tagged command queuing enabled
+ #tags will be truncated to the max queued commands configuration parameter.
+
+10.2.2 Detailed control of tagged commands
+ This option allows you to specify a command queue depth for each device
+ that supports tagged command queueing.
+ Example:
+ tag_ctrl=10/t2t3q16-t5q24/t1u2q32
+ will set devices queue depth as follow:
+ - controller #0 target #2 and target #3 -> 16 commands,
+ - controller #0 target #5 -> 24 commands,
+ - controller #1 target #1 logical unit #2 -> 32 commands,
+ - all other logical units (all targets, all controllers) -> 10 commands.
+
+10.2.3 Burst max
+ burst=0 burst disabled
+ burst=255 get burst length from initial IO register settings.
+ burst=#x burst enabled (1<<#x burst transfers max)
+ #x is an integer value which is log base 2 of the burst transfers max.
+ By default the driver uses the maximum value supported by the chip.
+
+10.2.4 LED support
+ led=1 enable LED support
+ led=0 disable LED support
+ Do not enable LED support if your scsi board does not use SDMS BIOS.
+ (See 'Configuration parameters')
+
+10.2.4 Differential mode
+ diff=0 never set up diff mode
+ diff=1 set up diff mode if BIOS set it
+ diff=2 always set up diff mode
+ diff=3 set diff mode if GPIO3 is not set
+
+10.2.5 IRQ mode
+ irqm=0 always open drain
+ irqm=1 same as initial settings (assumed BIOS settings)
+ irqm=2 always totem pole
+
+10.2.6 Check SCSI BUS
+ buschk=<option bits>
+
+ Available option bits:
+ 0x0: No check.
+ 0x1: Check and do not attach the controller on error.
+ 0x2: Check and just warn on error.
+
+10.2.7 Suggest a default SCSI id for hosts
+ hostid=255 no id suggested.
+ hostid=#x (0 < x < 7) x suggested for hosts SCSI id.
+
+ If a host SCSI id is available from the NVRAM, the driver will ignore
+ any value suggested as boot option. Otherwise, if a suggested value
+ different from 255 has been supplied, it will use it. Otherwise, it will
+ try to deduce the value previously set in the hardware and use value
+ 7 if the hardware value is zero.
+
+10.2.8 Verbosity level
+ verb=0 minimal
+ verb=1 normal
+ verb=2 too much
+
+10.2.9 Debug mode
+ debug=0 clear debug flags
+ debug=#x set debug flags
+ #x is an integer value combining the following power-of-2 values:
+ DEBUG_ALLOC 0x1
+ DEBUG_PHASE 0x2
+ DEBUG_POLL 0x4
+ DEBUG_QUEUE 0x8
+ DEBUG_RESULT 0x10
+ DEBUG_SCATTER 0x20
+ DEBUG_SCRIPT 0x40
+ DEBUG_TINY 0x80
+ DEBUG_TIMING 0x100
+ DEBUG_NEGO 0x200
+ DEBUG_TAGS 0x400
+ DEBUG_FREEZE 0x800
+ DEBUG_RESTART 0x1000
+
+ You can play safely with DEBUG_NEGO. However, some of these flags may
+ generate bunches of syslog messages.
+
+10.2.10 Settle delay
+ settle=n delay for n seconds
+
+ After a bus reset, the driver will delay for n seconds before talking
+ to any device on the bus. The default is 3 seconds and safe mode will
+ default it to 10.
+
+10.2.11 Serial NVRAM
+ NB: option not currently implemented.
+ nvram=n do not look for serial NVRAM
+ nvram=y test controllers for onboard serial NVRAM
+ (alternate binary form)
+ nvram=<bits options>
+ 0x01 look for NVRAM (equivalent to nvram=y)
+ 0x02 ignore NVRAM "Synchronous negotiation" parameters for all devices
+ 0x04 ignore NVRAM "Wide negotiation" parameter for all devices
+ 0x08 ignore NVRAM "Scan at boot time" parameter for all devices
+ 0x80 also attach controllers set to OFF in the NVRAM (sym53c8xx only)
+
+10.2.12 Exclude a host from being attached
+ excl=<io_address>,...
+
+ Prevent host at a given io address from being attached.
+ For example 'excl=0xb400,0xc000' indicate to the
+ driver not to attach hosts at address 0xb400 and 0xc000.
+
+10.3 Converting from old style options
+
+Previously, the sym2 driver accepted arguments of the form
+ sym53c8xx=tags:4,sync:10,debug:0x200
+
+As a result of the new module parameters, this is no longer available.
+Most of the options have remained the same, but tags has split into
+cmd_per_lun and tag_ctrl for its two different purposes. The sample above
+would be specified as:
+ modprobe sym53c8xx cmd_per_lun=4 sync=10 debug=0x200
+
+or on the kernel boot line as:
+ sym53c8xx.cmd_per_lun=4 sym53c8xx.sync=10 sym53c8xx.debug=0x200
+
+10.4 SCSI BUS checking boot option.
+
+When this option is set to a non-zero value, the driver checks SCSI lines
+logic state, 100 micro-seconds after having asserted the SCSI RESET line.
+The driver just reads SCSI lines and checks all lines read FALSE except RESET.
+Since SCSI devices shall release the BUS at most 800 nano-seconds after SCSI
+RESET has been asserted, any signal to TRUE may indicate a SCSI BUS problem.
+Unfortunately, the following common SCSI BUS problems are not detected:
+- Only 1 terminator installed.
+- Misplaced terminators.
+- Bad quality terminators.
+On the other hand, either bad cabling, broken devices, not conformant
+devices, ... may cause a SCSI signal to be wrong when te driver reads it.
+
+15. SCSI problem troubleshooting
+
+15.1 Problem tracking
+
+Most SCSI problems are due to a non conformant SCSI bus or too buggy
+devices. If infortunately you have SCSI problems, you can check the
+following things:
+
+- SCSI bus cables
+- terminations at both end of the SCSI chain
+- linux syslog messages (some of them may help you)
+
+If you do not find the source of problems, you can configure the
+driver or devices in the NVRAM with minimal features.
+
+- only asynchronous data transfers
+- tagged commands disabled
+- disconnections not allowed
+
+Now, if your SCSI bus is ok, your system has every chance to work
+with this safe configuration but performances will not be optimal.
+
+If it still fails, then you can send your problem description to
+appropriate mailing lists or news-groups. Send me a copy in order to
+be sure I will receive it. Obviously, a bug in the driver code is
+possible.
+
+ My cyrrent email address: Gerard Roudier <groudier@free.fr>
+
+Allowing disconnections is important if you use several devices on
+your SCSI bus but often causes problems with buggy devices.
+Synchronous data transfers increases throughput of fast devices like
+hard disks. Good SCSI hard disks with a large cache gain advantage of
+tagged commands queuing.
+
+15.2 Understanding hardware error reports
+
+When the driver detects an unexpected error condition, it may display a
+message of the following pattern.
+
+sym0:1: ERROR (0:48) (1-21-65) (f/95/0) @ (script 7c0:19000000).
+sym0: script cmd = 19000000
+sym0: regdump: da 10 80 95 47 0f 01 07 75 01 81 21 80 01 09 00.
+
+Some fields in such a message may help you understand the cause of the
+problem, as follows:
+
+sym0:1: ERROR (0:48) (1-21-65) (f/95/0) @ (script 7c0:19000000).
+.....A.........B.C....D.E..F....G.H..I.......J.....K...L.......
+
+Field A : target number.
+ SCSI ID of the device the controller was talking with at the moment the
+ error occurs.
+
+Field B : DSTAT io register (DMA STATUS)
+ Bit 0x40 : MDPE Master Data Parity Error
+ Data parity error detected on the PCI BUS.
+ Bit 0x20 : BF Bus Fault
+ PCI bus fault condition detected
+ Bit 0x01 : IID Illegal Instruction Detected
+ Set by the chip when it detects an Illegal Instruction format
+ on some condition that makes an instruction illegal.
+ Bit 0x80 : DFE Dma Fifo Empty
+ Pure status bit that does not indicate an error.
+ If the reported DSTAT value contains a combination of MDPE (0x40),
+ BF (0x20), then the cause may be likely due to a PCI BUS problem.
+
+Field C : SIST io register (SCSI Interrupt Status)
+ Bit 0x08 : SGE SCSI GROSS ERROR
+ Indicates that the chip detected a severe error condition
+ on the SCSI BUS that prevents the SCSI protocol from functioning
+ properly.
+ Bit 0x04 : UDC Unexpected Disconnection
+ Indicates that the device released the SCSI BUS when the chip
+ was not expecting this to happen. A device may behave so to
+ indicate the SCSI initiator that an error condition not reportable using the SCSI protocol has occurred.
+ Bit 0x02 : RST SCSI BUS Reset
+ Generally SCSI targets do not reset the SCSI BUS, although any
+ device on the BUS can reset it at any time.
+ Bit 0x01 : PAR Parity
+ SCSI parity error detected.
+ On a faulty SCSI BUS, any error condition among SGE (0x08), UDC (0x04) and
+ PAR (0x01) may be detected by the chip. If your SCSI system sometimes
+ encounters such error conditions, especially SCSI GROSS ERROR, then a SCSI
+ BUS problem is likely the cause of these errors.
+
+For fields D,E,F,G and H, you may look into the sym53c8xx_defs.h file
+that contains some minimal comments on IO register bits.
+Field D : SOCL Scsi Output Control Latch
+ This register reflects the state of the SCSI control lines the
+ chip want to drive or compare against.
+Field E : SBCL Scsi Bus Control Lines
+ Actual value of control lines on the SCSI BUS.
+Field F : SBDL Scsi Bus Data Lines
+ Actual value of data lines on the SCSI BUS.
+Field G : SXFER SCSI Transfer
+ Contains the setting of the Synchronous Period for output and
+ the current Synchronous offset (offset 0 means asynchronous).
+Field H : SCNTL3 Scsi Control Register 3
+ Contains the setting of timing values for both asynchronous and
+ synchronous data transfers.
+Field I : SCNTL4 Scsi Control Register 4
+ Only meaninful for 53C1010 Ultra3 controllers.
+
+Understanding Fields J, K, L and dumps requires to have good knowledge of
+SCSI standards, chip cores functionnals and internal driver data structures.
+You are not required to decode and understand them, unless you want to help
+maintain the driver code.
+
+17. Serial NVRAM (added by Richard Waltham: dormouse@farsrobt.demon.co.uk)
+
+17.1 Features
+
+Enabling serial NVRAM support enables detection of the serial NVRAM included
+on Symbios and some Symbios compatible host adaptors, and Tekram boards. The
+serial NVRAM is used by Symbios and Tekram to hold set up parameters for the
+host adaptor and it's attached drives.
+
+The Symbios NVRAM also holds data on the boot order of host adaptors in a
+system with more than one host adaptor. This information is no longer used
+as it's fundamentally incompatible with the hotplug PCI model.
+
+Tekram boards using Symbios chips, DC390W/F/U, which have NVRAM are detected
+and this is used to distinguish between Symbios compatible and Tekram host
+adaptors. This is used to disable the Symbios compatible "diff" setting
+incorrectly set on Tekram boards if the CONFIG_SCSI_53C8XX_SYMBIOS_COMPAT
+configuration parameter is set enabling both Symbios and Tekram boards to be
+used together with the Symbios cards using all their features, including
+"diff" support. ("led pin" support for Symbios compatible cards can remain
+enabled when using Tekram cards. It does nothing useful for Tekram host
+adaptors but does not cause problems either.)
+
+The parameters the driver is able to get from the NVRAM depend on the
+data format used, as follow:
+
+ Tekram format Symbios format
+General and host parameters
+ Boot order N Y
+ Host SCSI ID Y Y
+ SCSI parity checking Y Y
+ Verbose boot messages N Y
+SCSI devices parameters
+ Synchronous transfer speed Y Y
+ Wide 16 / Narrow Y Y
+ Tagged Command Queuing enabled Y Y
+ Disconnections enabled Y Y
+ Scan at boot time N Y
+
+In order to speed up the system boot, for each device configured without
+the "scan at boot time" option, the driver forces an error on the
+first TEST UNIT READY command received for this device.
+
+
+17.2 Symbios NVRAM layout
+
+typical data at NVRAM address 0x100 (53c810a NVRAM)
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+00 00
+64 01
+8e 0b
+
+00 30 00 00 00 00 07 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 07 04 10 04 00 00
+
+04 00 0f 00 00 10 00 50 00 00 01 00 00 62
+04 00 03 00 00 10 00 58 00 00 01 00 00 63
+04 00 01 00 00 10 00 48 00 00 01 00 00 61
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+fe fe
+00 00
+00 00
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+NVRAM layout details
+
+NVRAM Address 0x000-0x0ff not used
+ 0x100-0x26f initialised data
+ 0x270-0x7ff not used
+
+general layout
+
+ header - 6 bytes,
+ data - 356 bytes (checksum is byte sum of this data)
+ trailer - 6 bytes
+ ---
+ total 368 bytes
+
+data area layout
+
+ controller set up - 20 bytes
+ boot configuration - 56 bytes (4x14 bytes)
+ device set up - 128 bytes (16x8 bytes)
+ unused (spare?) - 152 bytes (19x8 bytes)
+ ---
+ total 356 bytes
+
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+header
+
+00 00 - ?? start marker
+64 01 - byte count (lsb/msb excludes header/trailer)
+8e 0b - checksum (lsb/msb excludes header/trailer)
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+controller set up
+
+00 30 00 00 00 00 07 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 07 04 10 04 00 00
+ | | | |
+ | | | -- host ID
+ | | |
+ | | --Removable Media Support
+ | | 0x00 = none
+ | | 0x01 = Bootable Device
+ | | 0x02 = All with Media
+ | |
+ | --flag bits 2
+ | 0x00000001= scan order hi->low
+ | (default 0x00 - scan low->hi)
+ --flag bits 1
+ 0x00000001 scam enable
+ 0x00000010 parity enable
+ 0x00000100 verbose boot msgs
+
+remaining bytes unknown - they do not appear to change in my
+current set up for any of the controllers.
+
+default set up is identical for 53c810a and 53c875 NVRAM
+(Removable Media added Symbios BIOS version 4.09)
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+boot configuration
+
+boot order set by order of the devices in this table
+
+04 00 0f 00 00 10 00 50 00 00 01 00 00 62 -- 1st controller
+04 00 03 00 00 10 00 58 00 00 01 00 00 63 2nd controller
+04 00 01 00 00 10 00 48 00 00 01 00 00 61 3rd controller
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 4th controller
+ | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | ---- PCI io port adr
+ | | | | | --0x01 init/scan at boot time
+ | | | | --PCI device/function number (0xdddddfff)
+ | | ----- ?? PCI vendor ID (lsb/msb)
+ ----PCI device ID (lsb/msb)
+
+?? use of this data is a guess but seems reasonable
+
+remaining bytes unknown - they do not appear to change in my
+current set up
+
+default set up is identical for 53c810a and 53c875 NVRAM
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+device set up (up to 16 devices - includes controller)
+
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00 - id 0
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00
+0f 00 08 08 64 00 0a 00 - id 15
+ | | | | | |
+ | | | | ----timeout (lsb/msb)
+ | | | --synch period (0x?? 40 Mtrans/sec- fast 40) (probably 0x28)
+ | | | (0x30 20 Mtrans/sec- fast 20)
+ | | | (0x64 10 Mtrans/sec- fast )
+ | | | (0xc8 5 Mtrans/sec)
+ | | | (0x00 asynchronous)
+ | | -- ?? max sync offset (0x08 in NVRAM on 53c810a)
+ | | (0x10 in NVRAM on 53c875)
+ | --device bus width (0x08 narrow)
+ | (0x10 16 bit wide)
+ --flag bits
+ 0x00000001 - disconnect enabled
+ 0x00000010 - scan at boot time
+ 0x00000100 - scan luns
+ 0x00001000 - queue tags enabled
+
+remaining bytes unknown - they do not appear to change in my
+current set up
+
+?? use of this data is a guess but seems reasonable
+(but it could be max bus width)
+
+default set up for 53c810a NVRAM
+default set up for 53c875 NVRAM - bus width - 0x10
+ - sync offset ? - 0x10
+ - sync period - 0x30
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+?? spare device space (32 bit bus ??)
+
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 (19x8bytes)
+.
+.
+00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00
+
+default set up is identical for 53c810a and 53c875 NVRAM
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+trailer
+
+fe fe - ? end marker ?
+00 00
+00 00
+
+default set up is identical for 53c810a and 53c875 NVRAM
+-----------------------------------------------------------
+
+
+
+17.3 Tekram NVRAM layout
+
+nvram 64x16 (1024 bit)
+
+Drive settings
+
+Drive ID 0-15 (addr 0x0yyyy0 = device setup, yyyy = ID)
+ (addr 0x0yyyy1 = 0x0000)
+
+ x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x
+ | | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | | | ----- parity check 0 - off
+ | | | | | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | | ------- sync neg 0 - off
+ | | | | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | --------- disconnect 0 - off
+ | | | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | | | |
+ | | | | | ----------- start cmd 0 - off
+ | | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | | |
+ | | | | -------------- tagged cmds 0 - off
+ | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | |
+ | | | ---------------- wide neg 0 - off
+ | | | 1 - on
+ | | |
+ --------------------------- sync rate 0 - 10.0 Mtrans/sec
+ 1 - 8.0
+ 2 - 6.6
+ 3 - 5.7
+ 4 - 5.0
+ 5 - 4.0
+ 6 - 3.0
+ 7 - 2.0
+ 7 - 2.0
+ 8 - 20.0
+ 9 - 16.7
+ a - 13.9
+ b - 11.9
+
+Global settings
+
+Host flags 0 (addr 0x100000, 32)
+
+ x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x
+ | | | | | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | | | ----------- host ID 0x00 - 0x0f
+ | | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | | ----------------------- support for 0 - off
+ | | | | | | | > 2 drives 1 - on
+ | | | | | | |
+ | | | | | | ------------------------- support drives 0 - off
+ | | | | | | > 1Gbytes 1 - on
+ | | | | | |
+ | | | | | --------------------------- bus reset on 0 - off
+ | | | | | power on 1 - on
+ | | | | |
+ | | | | ----------------------------- active neg 0 - off
+ | | | | 1 - on
+ | | | |
+ | | | -------------------------------- imm seek 0 - off
+ | | | 1 - on
+ | | |
+ | | ---------------------------------- scan luns 0 - off
+ | | 1 - on
+ | |
+ -------------------------------------- removable 0 - disable
+ as BIOS dev 1 - boot device
+ 2 - all
+
+Host flags 1 (addr 0x100001, 33)
+
+ x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x
+ | | | | | |
+ | | | --------- boot delay 0 - 3 sec
+ | | | 1 - 5
+ | | | 2 - 10
+ | | | 3 - 20
+ | | | 4 - 30
+ | | | 5 - 60
+ | | | 6 - 120
+ | | |
+ --------------------------- max tag cmds 0 - 2
+ 1 - 4
+ 2 - 8
+ 3 - 16
+ 4 - 32
+
+Host flags 2 (addr 0x100010, 34)
+
+ x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x x
+ |
+ ----- F2/F6 enable 0 - off ???
+ 1 - on ???
+
+checksum (addr 0x111111)
+
+checksum = 0x1234 - (sum addr 0-63)
+
+----------------------------------------------------------------------------
+
+default nvram data:
+
+0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000
+0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000
+0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000
+0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000 0x0037 0x0000
+
+0x0f07 0x0400 0x0001 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000
+0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000
+0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000
+0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0x0000 0xfbbc
+
+
+===============================================================================
+End of Linux SYM-2 driver documentation file
diff --git a/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt b/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt
new file mode 100644
index 000000000000..e165229adf50
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Documentation/scsi/tmscsim.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,449 @@
+The tmscsim driver
+==================
+
+1. Purpose and history
+2. Installation
+3. Features
+4. Configuration via /proc/scsi/tmscsim/?
+5. Configuration via boot/module params
+6. Potential improvements
+7. Bug reports, debugging and updates
+8. Acknowledgements
+9. Copyright
+
+
+1. Purpose and history
+----------------------
+The tmscsim driver supports PCI SCSI Host Adapters based on the AM53C974
+chip. AM53C974 based SCSI adapters include:
+ Tekram DC390, DC390T
+ Dawicontrol 2974
+ QLogic Fast! PCI Basic
+ some on-board adapters
+(This is most probably not a complete list)
+
+It has originally written by C.L. Huang from the Tekram corp. to support the
+Tekram DC390(T) adapter. This is where the name comes from: tm = Tekram
+scsi = SCSI driver, m = AMD (?) as opposed to w for the DC390W/U/F
+(NCR53c8X5, X=2/7) driver. Yes, there was also a driver for the latter,
+tmscsiw, which supported DC390W/U/F adapters. It's not maintained any more,
+as the ncr53c8xx is perfectly supporting these adpaters since some time.
+
+The driver first appeared in April 1996, exclusively supported the DC390
+and has been enhanced since then in various steps. In May 1998 support for
+general AM53C974 based adapters and some possibilities to configure it were
+added. The non-DC390 support works by assuming some values for the data
+normally taken from the DC390 EEPROM. See below (chapter 5) for details.
+
+When using the DC390, the configuration is still be done using the DC390
+BIOS setup. The DC390 EEPROM is read and used by the driver, any boot or
+module parameters (chapter 5) are ignored! However, you can change settings
+dynamically, as described in chapter 4.
+
+For a more detailed description of the driver's history, see the first lines
+of tmscsim.c.
+The numbering scheme isn't consistent. The first versions went from 1.00 to
+1.12, then 1.20a to 1.20t. Finally I decided to use the ncr53c8xx scheme. So
+the next revisions will be 2.0a to 2.0X (stable), 2.1a to 2.1X (experimental),
+2.2a to 2.2X (stable, again) etc. (X = anything between a and z.) If I send
+fixes to people for testing, I create intermediate versions with a digit
+appended, e.g. 2.0c3.
+
+
+2. Installation
+---------------
+If you got any recent kernel with this driver and document included in
+linux/drivers/scsi, you basically have to do nothing special to use this
+driver. Of course you have to choose to compile SCSI support and DC390(T)
+support into your kernel or as module when configuring your kernel for
+compiling.
+NEW: You may as well compile this module outside your kernel, using the
+supplied Makefile.
+
+ If you got an old kernel (pre 2.1.127, pre 2.0.37p1) with an old version of
+ this driver: Get dc390-21125-20b.diff.gz or dc390-2036p21-20b1.diff.gz from
+ my web page and apply the patch. Apply further patches to upgrade to the
+ latest version of the driver.
+
+ If you want to do it manually, you should copy the files (dc390.h,
+ tmscsim.h, tmscsim.c, scsiiom.c and README.tmscsim) from this directory to
+ linux/drivers/scsi. You have to recompile your kernel/module of course.
+
+ You should apply the three patches included in dc390-120-kernel.diff
+ (Applying them: cd /usr/src; patch -p0 <~/dc390-120-kernel.diff)
+ The patches are against 2.1.125, so you might have to manually resolve
+ rejections when applying to another kernel version.
+
+ The patches will update the kernel startup code to allow boot parameters to
+ be passed to the driver, update the Documentation and finally offer you the
+ possibility to omit the non-DC390 parts of the driver.
+ (By selecting "Omit support for non DC390" you basically disable the
+ emulation of a DC390 EEPROM for non DC390 adapters. This saves a few bytes
+ of memory.)
+
+If you got a very old kernel without the tmscsim driver (pre 2.0.31)
+I recommend upgrading your kernel. However, if you don't want to, please
+contact me to get the appropriate patches.
+
+
+Upgrading a SCSI driver is always a delicate thing to do. The 2.0 driver has
+proven stable on many systems, but it's still a good idea to take some
+precautions. In an ideal world you would have a full backup of your disks.
+The world isn't ideal and most people don't have full backups (me neither).
+So take at least the following measures:
+* make your kernel remount the FS read-only on detecting an error:
+ tune2fs -e remount-ro /dev/sd??
+* have copies of your SCSI disk's partition tables on some safe location:
+ dd if=/dev/sda of=/mnt/floppy/sda bs=512 count=1
+ or just print it with:
+ fdisk -l | lpr
+* make sure you are able to boot Linux (e.g. from floppy disk using InitRD)
+ if your SCSI disk gets corrupted. You can use
+ ftp://student.physik.uni-dortmund.de/pub/linux/kernel/bootdisk.gz
+
+One more warning: I used to overclock my PCI bus to 41.67 MHz. My Tekram
+DC390F (Sym53c875) accepted this as well as my Millenium. But the Am53C974
+produced errors and started to corrupt my disks. So don't do that! A 37.50
+MHz PCI bus works for me, though, but I don't recommend using higher clocks
+than the 33.33 MHz being in the PCI spec.
+
+If you want to share the IRQ with another device and the driver refuses to
+do so, you might succeed with changing the DC390_IRQ type in tmscsim.c to
+SA_SHIRQ | SA_INTERRUPT.
+
+
+3.Features
+----------
+- SCSI
+ * Tagged command queueing
+ * Sync speed up to 10 MHz
+ * Disconnection
+ * Multiple LUNs
+
+- General / Linux interface
+ * Support for up to 4 AM53C974 adapters.
+ * DC390 EEPROM usage or boot/module params
+ * Information via cat /proc/scsi/tmscsim/?
+ * Dynamically configurable by writing to /proc/scsi/tmscsim/?
+ * Dynamic allocation of resources
+ * SMP support: Locking on io_request lock (Linux 2.1/2.2) or adapter
+ specific locks (Linux 2.5?)
+ * Uniform source code for Linux-2.x.y
+ * Support for dyn. addition/removal of devices via add/remove-single-device
+ (Try: echo "scsi add-single-device C B T U" >/proc/scsi/scsi
+ C = Controller, B = Bus, T = Target SCSI ID, U = Unit SCSI LUN.)
+ Use with care!
+ * Try to use the partition table for the determination of the mapping
+
+
+4. Configuration via /proc/scsi/tmscsim/?
+-----------------------------------------
+First of all look at the output of /proc/scsi/tmscsim/? by typing
+ cat /proc/scsi/tmscsim/?
+The "?" should be replaced by the SCSI host number. (The shell might do this
+for you.)
+You will see some info regarding the adapter and, at the end, a listing of
+the attached devices and their settings.
+
+Here's an example:
+garloff@kurt:/home/garloff > cat /proc/scsi/tmscsim/0
+Tekram DC390/AM53C974 PCI SCSI Host Adapter, Driver Version 2.0e7 2000-11-28
+SCSI Host Nr 1, AM53C974 Adapter Nr 0
+IOPortBase 0xb000, IRQ 10
+MaxID 8, MaxLUN 8, AdapterID 6, SelTimeout 250 ms, DelayReset 1 s
+TagMaxNum 16, Status 0x00, ACBFlag 0x00, GlitchEater 24 ns
+Statistics: Cmnds 1470165, Cmnds not sent directly 0, Out of SRB conds 0
+ Lost arbitrations 587, Sel. connected 0, Connected: No
+Nr of attached devices: 4, Nr of DCBs: 4
+Map of attached LUNs: 01 00 00 03 01 00 00 00
+Idx ID LUN Prty Sync DsCn SndS TagQ NegoPeriod SyncSpeed SyncOffs MaxCmd
+00 00 00 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes 100 ns 10.0 M 15 16
+01 03 00 Yes Yes Yes Yes No 100 ns 10.0 M 15 01
+02 03 01 Yes Yes Yes Yes No 100 ns 10.0 M 15 01
+03 04 00 Yes Yes Yes Yes No 100 ns 10.0 M 15 01
+
+Note that the settings MaxID and MaxLUN are not zero- but one-based, which
+means that a setting MaxLUN=4, will result in the support of LUNs 0..3. This
+is somehow inconvenient, but the way the mid-level SCSI code expects it to be.
+
+ACB and DCB are acronyms for Adapter Control Block and Device Control Block.
+These are data structures of the driver containing information about the
+adapter and the connected SCSI devices respectively.
+
+Idx is the device index (just a consecutive number for the driver), ID and
+LUN are the SCSI ID and LUN, Prty means Parity checking, Sync synchronous
+negotiation, DsCn Disconnection, SndS Send Start command on startup (not
+used by the driver) and TagQ Tagged Command Queueing. NegoPeriod and
+SyncSpeed are somehow redundant, because they are reciprocal values
+(1 / 112 ns = 8.9 MHz). At least in theory. The driver is able to adjust the
+NegoPeriod more accurate (4ns) than the SyncSpeed (1 / 25ns). I don't know
+if certain devices will have problems with this discrepancy. Max. speed is
+10 MHz corresp. to a min. NegoPeriod of 100 ns.
+(The driver allows slightly higher speeds if the devices (Ultra SCSI) accept
+it, but that's out of adapter spec, on your own risk and unlikely to improve
+performance. You're likely to crash your disks.)
+SyncOffs is the offset used for synchronous negotiations; max. is 15.
+The last values are only shown, if Sync is enabled. (NegoPeriod is still
+displayed in brackets to show the values which will be used after enabling
+Sync.)
+MaxCmd ist the number of commands (=tags) which can be processed at the same
+time by the device.
+
+If you want to change a setting, you can do that by writing to
+/proc/scsi/tmscsim/?. Basically you have to imitate the output of driver.
+(Don't use the brackets for NegoPeriod on Sync disabled devices.)
+You don't have to care about capitalisation. The driver will accept space,
+tab, comma, = and : as separators.
+
+There are three kinds of changes:
+
+(1) Change driver settings:
+ You type the names of the parameters and the params following it.
+ Example:
+ echo "MaxLUN=8 seltimeout 200" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/0
+
+ Note that you can only change MaxID, MaxLUN, AdapterID, SelTimeOut,
+ TagMaxNum, ACBFlag, GlitchEater and DelayReset. Don't change ACBFlag
+ unless you want to see what happens, if the driver hangs.
+
+(2) Change device settings: You write a config line to the driver. The Nr
+ must match the ID and LUN given. If you give "-" as parameter, it is
+ ignored and the corresponding setting won't be changed.
+ You can use "y" or "n" instead of "Yes" and "No" if you want to.
+ You don't need to specify a full line. The driver automatically performs
+ an INQUIRY on the device if necessary to check if it is capable to operate
+ with the given settings (Sync, TagQ).
+ Examples:
+ echo "0 0 0 y y y - y - 10 " >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/0
+ echo "3 5 0 y n y " >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/0
+
+ To give a short explanation of the first example:
+ The first three numbers, "0 0 0" (Device index 0, SCSI ID 0, SCSI LUN 0),
+ select the device to which the following parameters apply. Note that it
+ would be sufficient to use the index or both SCSI ID and LUN, but I chose
+ to require all three to have a syntax similar to the output.
+ The following "y y y - y" enables Parity checking, enables Synchronous
+ transfers, Disconnection, leaves Send Start (not used) untouched and
+ enables Tagged Command Queueing for the selected device. The "-" skips
+ the Negotiation Period setting but the "10" sets the max sync. speed to
+ 10 MHz. It's useless to specify both NegoPeriod and SyncSpeed as
+ discussed above. The values used in this example will result in maximum
+ performance.
+
+(3) Special commands: You can force a SCSI bus reset, an INQUIRY command, the
+ removal or the addition of a device's DCB and a SCSI register dump.
+ This is only used for debugging when you meet problems. The parameter of
+ the INQUIRY and REMOVE commands is the device index as shown by the
+ output of /proc/scsi/tmscsim/? in the device listing in the first column
+ (Idx). ADD takes the SCSI ID and LUN.
+ Examples:
+ echo "reset" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/0
+ echo "inquiry 1" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/0
+ echo "remove 2" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/1
+ echo "add 2 3" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/?
+ echo "dump" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/0
+
+ Note that you will meet problems when you REMOVE a device's DCB with the
+ remove command if it contains partitions which are mounted. Only use it
+ after unmounting its partitions, telling the SCSI mid-level code to
+ remove it (scsi remove-single-device) and you really need a few bytes of
+ memory.
+ The ADD command allows you to configure a device before you tell the
+ mid-level code to try detection.
+
+
+I'd suggest reviewing the output of /proc/scsi/tmscsim/? after changing
+settings to see if everything changed as requested.
+
+
+5. Configuration via boot/module parameters
+-------------------------------------------
+With the DC390, the driver reads its EEPROM settings and tries to use them.
+But you may want to override the settings prior to being able to change the
+driver configuration via /proc/scsi/tmscsim/?.
+If you do have another AM53C974 based adapter, that's even the only
+possibility to adjust settings before you are able to write to the
+/proc/scsi/tmscsim/? pseudo-file, e.g. if you want to use another
+adapter ID than 7.
+(BTW, the log message "DC390: No EEPROM found!" is normal without a DC390.)
+For this purpose, you can pass options to the driver before it is initialised
+by using kernel or module parameters. See lilo(8) or modprobe(1) manual
+pages on how to pass params to the kernel or a module.
+[NOTE: Formerly, it was not possible to override the EEPROM supplied
+ settings of the DC390 with cmd line parameters. This has changed since
+ 2.0e7]
+
+The syntax of the params is much shorter than the syntax of the /proc/...
+interface. This makes it a little bit more difficult to use. However, long
+parameter lines have the risk to be misinterpreted and the length of kernel
+parameters is limited.
+
+As the support for non-DC390 adapters works by simulating the values of the
+DC390 EEPROM, the settings are given in a DC390 BIOS' way.
+
+Here's the syntax:
+tmscsim=AdaptID,SpdIdx,DevMode,AdaptMode,TaggedCmnds,DelayReset
+
+Each of the parameters is a number, containing the described information:
+
+* AdaptID: The SCSI ID of the host adapter. Must be in the range 0..7
+ Default is 7.
+
+* SpdIdx: The index of the maximum speed as in the DC390 BIOS. The values
+ 0..7 mean 10, 8.0, 6.7, 5.7, 5.0, 4.0, 3.1 and 2 MHz resp. Default is
+ 0 (10.0 MHz).
+
+* DevMode is a bit mapped value describing the per-device features. It
+ applies to all devices. (Sync, Disc and TagQ will only apply, if the
+ device supports it.) The meaning of the bits (* = default):
+
+ Bit Val(hex) Val(dec) Meaning
+ *0 0x01 1 Parity check
+ *1 0x02 2 Synchronous Negotiation
+ *2 0x04 4 Disconnection
+ *3 0x08 8 Send Start command on startup. (Not used)
+ *4 0x10 16 Tagged Command Queueing
+
+ As usual, the desired value is obtained by adding the wanted values. If
+ you want to enable all values, e.g., you would use 31(0x1f). Default is 31.
+
+* AdaptMode is a bit mapped value describing the enabled adapter features.
+
+ Bit Val(hex) Val(dec) Meaning
+ *0 0x01 1 Support more than two drives. (Not used)
+ *1 0x02 2 Use DOS compatible mapping for HDs greater than 1GB.
+ *2 0x04 4 Reset SCSI Bus on startup.
+ *3 0x08 8 Active Negation: Improves SCSI Bus noise immunity.
+ 4 0x10 16 Immediate return on BIOS seek command. (Not used)
+ (*)5 0x20 32 Check for LUNs >= 1.
+
+ The default for LUN Check depends on CONFIG_SCSI_MULTI_LUN.
+
+* TaggedCmnds is a number indicating the maximum number of Tagged Commands.
+ It is the binary logarithm - 1 of the actual number. Max is 4 (32).
+ Value Number of Tagged Commands
+ 0 2
+ 1 4
+ 2 8
+ *3 16
+ 4 32
+
+* DelayReset is the time in seconds (minus 0.5s), the adapter waits, after a
+ bus reset. Default is 1 (corresp. to 1.5s).
+
+Example:
+ modprobe tmscsim tmscsim=6,2,31
+would set the adapter ID to 6, max. speed to 6.7 MHz, enable all device
+features and leave the adapter features, the number of Tagged Commands
+and the Delay after a reset to the defaults.
+
+As you can see, you don't need to specify all of the six params.
+If you want values to be ignored (i.e. the EEprom settings or the defaults
+will be used), you may pass -2 (not 0!) at the corresponding position.
+
+The defaults (7,0,31,15,3,1) are aggressive to allow good performance. You
+can use tmscsim=7,0,31,63,4,0 for maximum performance, if your SCSI chain
+allows it. If you meet problems, you can use tmscsim=-1 which is a shortcut
+for tmscsim=7,4,9,15,2,10.
+
+
+6. Potential improvements
+-------------------------
+Most of the intended work on the driver has been done. Here are a few ideas
+to further improve its usability:
+
+* Cleanly separate per-Target and per-LUN properties (DCB)
+* More intelligent abort() routine
+* Use new_eh code (Linux-2.1+)
+* Have the mid-level (ML) code (and not the driver) handle more of the
+ various conditions.
+* Command queueing in the driver: Eliminate Query list and use ML instead.
+* More user friendly boot/module param syntax
+
+Further investigation on these problems:
+
+* Driver hangs with sync readcdda (xcdroast) (most probably VIA PCI error)
+
+Known problems:
+Please see http://www.garloff.de/kurt/linux/dc390/problems.html
+
+* Changing the parameters of multi-lun by the tmscsim/? interface will
+ cause problems, cause these settings are mostly per Target and not per LUN
+ and should be updated accordingly. To be fixed for 2.0d24.
+* CDRs (eg Yam CRW4416) not recognized, because some buggy devices don't
+ recover from a SCSI reset in time. Use a higher delay or don't issue
+ a SCSI bus reset on driver initialization. See problems page.
+ For the CRW4416S, this seems to be solved with firmware 1.0g (reported by
+ Jean-Yves Barbier).
+* TEAC CD-532S not being recognized. (Works with 1.11).
+* Scanners (eg. Astra UMAX 1220S) don't work: Disable Sync Negotiation.
+ If this does not help, try echo "INQUIRY t" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/? (t
+ replaced by the dev index of your scanner). You may try to reset your SCSI
+ bus afterwards (echo "RESET" >/proc/scsi/tmscsim/?).
+ The problem seems to be solved as of 2.0d18, thanks to Andreas Rick.
+* If there is a valid partition table, the driver will use it for determing
+ the mapping. If there's none, a reasonable mapping (Symbios-like) will be
+ assumed. Other operating systems may not like this mapping, though
+ it's consistent with the BIOS' behaviour. Old DC390 drivers ignored the
+ partition table and used a H/S = 64/32 or 255/63 translation. So if you
+ want to be compatible to those, use this old mapping when creating
+ partition tables. Even worse, on bootup the DC390 might complain if other
+ mappings are found, so auto rebooting may fail.
+* In some situations, the driver will get stuck in an abort loop. This is a
+ bad interaction between the Mid-Layer of Linux' SCSI code and the driver.
+ Try to disable DsCn, if you meet this problem. Please contact me for
+ further debugging.
+
+
+7. Bug reports, debugging and updates
+-------------------------------------
+Whenever you have problems with the driver, you are invited to ask the
+author for help. However, I'd suggest reading the docs and trying to solve
+the problem yourself, first.
+If you find something, which you believe to be a bug, please report it to me.
+Please append the output of /proc/scsi/scsi, /proc/scsi/tmscsim/? and
+maybe the DC390 log messages to the report.
+
+Bug reports should be send to me (Kurt Garloff <dc390@garloff.de>) as well
+as to the linux-scsi list (<linux-scsi@vger.kernel.org>), as sometimes bugs
+are caused by the SCSI mid-level code.
+
+I will ask you for some more details and probably I will also ask you to
+enable some of the DEBUG options in the driver (tmscsim.c:DC390_DEBUGXXX
+defines). The driver will produce some data for the syslog facility then.
+Beware: If your syslog gets written to a SCSI disk connected to your
+AM53C974, the logging might produce log output again, and you might end
+having your box spending most of its time doing the logging.
+
+The latest version of the driver can be found at:
+ http://www.garloff.de/kurt/linux/dc390/
+ ftp://ftp.suse.com/pub/people/garloff/linux/dc390/
+
+
+8. Acknowledgements
+-------------------
+Thanks to Linus Torvalds, Alan Cox, the FSF people, the XFree86 team and
+all the others for the wonderful OS and software.
+Thanks to C.L. Huang and Philip Giang (Tekram) for the initial driver
+release and support.
+Thanks to Doug Ledford, Gérard Roudier for support with SCSI coding.
+Thanks to a lot of people (espec. Chiaki Ishikawa, Andreas Haumer, Hubert
+Tonneau) for intensively testing the driver (and even risking data loss
+doing this during early revisions).
+Recently, SuSE GmbH, Nuernberg, FRG, has been paying me for the driver
+development and maintenance. Special thanks!
+
+
+9. Copyright
+------------
+ This driver is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+ it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+ the Free Software Foundation; version 2 of the License.
+ If you want to use any later version of the GNU GPL, you will probably
+ be allowed to, but you have to ask me and Tekram <erich@tekram.com.tw>
+ before.
+
+-------------------------------------------------------------------------
+Written by Kurt Garloff <kurt@garloff.de> 1998/06/11
+Last updated 2000/11/28, driver revision 2.0e7
+$Id: README.tmscsim,v 2.25.2.7 2000/12/20 01:07:12 garloff Exp $